1 <?xml version='
1.0' encoding='UTF-
8'
?>
2 <?xml-stylesheet href=
"docbook-css-0.4/driver.css" type=
"text/css"?>
3 <!-- Converted to DocBook by Hans Schou 2004-03-29. Updated and improved
4 by Petter Reinholdtsen 2012 with input from Martin Borg. -->
9 <!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC
"-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.5//EN"
10 "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.5/docbookx.dtd"
13 <!ENTITY translationblock
"">
15 <book id=
"index" lang=
"en">
17 <title>Free Culture
</title>
19 <abbrev>"freeculture"</abbrev>
21 <subtitle>HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN
22 CULTURE AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
</subtitle>
24 <pubdate>2004-
03-
25</pubdate>
26 <releaseinfo>Version
2004-
02-
10</releaseinfo>
30 <firstname>Lawrence
</firstname>
31 <surname>Lessig
</surname>
35 <!-- <subjectset> and cover <mediaobject> Based on example from
36 http://jfearn.fedorapeople.org/en-US/Publican/2.7/html/Users_Guide/chap-Users_Guide-Creating_a_document.html
38 <subjectset scheme=
"libraryofcongress">
40 <subjectterm>Intellectual property
—United States.
</subjectterm>
43 <subjectterm>Mass media
—United States.
</subjectterm>
46 <subjectterm>Technological innovations
—United States.
</subjectterm>
49 <subjectterm>Art
—United States.
</subjectterm>
55 <publishername>The Penguin Press
</publishername>
56 <address><city>New York
</city></address>
61 <holder>Lawrence Lessig
</holder>
67 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cc.png" contentdepth=
"3em" width=
"100%" align=
"center"/>
70 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cc.svg" contentdepth=
"3em" width=
"100%" align=
"center"/>
73 <phrase>Creative Commons, Some rights reserved
</phrase>
79 This version of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is licensed under
80 a Creative Commons license. This license permits non-commercial use of
81 this work, so long as attribution is given. For more information
82 about the license, click the icon above, or visit
83 <ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/
1.0/
</ulink>
88 <title>ABOUT THE AUTHOR
</title>
91 (
<ulink url=
"http://www.lessig.org">http://www.lessig.org
</ulink>),
92 professor of law and a John A. Wilson Distinguished Faculty Scholar
93 at Stanford Law School, is founder of the Stanford Center for Internet
94 and Society and is chairman of the Creative Commons
95 (
<ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org">http://creativecommons.org
</ulink>).
96 The author of The Future of Ideas (Random House,
2001) and Code: And
97 Other Laws of Cyberspace (Basic Books,
1999), Lessig is a member of
98 the boards of the Public Library of Science, the Electronic Frontier
99 Foundation, and Public Knowledge. He was the winner of the Free
100 Software Foundation's Award for the Advancement of Free Software,
101 twice listed in BusinessWeek's
<quote>e.biz
25,
</quote> and named one of Scientific
102 American's
<quote>50 visionaries.
</quote> A graduate of the University of
103 Pennsylvania, Cambridge University, and Yale Law School, Lessig
104 clerked for Judge Richard Posner of the U.S. Seventh Circuit Court of
109 <!-- testing different ways to tag the cover page -->
110 <mediaobject role=
"cover">
111 <imageobject remap=
"lrg" role=
"front-large">
112 <imagedata fileref=
"images/cover.png" format=
"PNG" width=
"444" />
115 <imageobject remap="s" role="front">
116 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
118 <imageobject remap="xs" role="front-small">
119 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
121 <imageobject remap="cs" role="thumbnail">
122 <imagedata fileref="images/cover_thumbnail.png" format="PNG" width="444" />
127 <biblioid class=
"isbn">1-
59420-
006-
8</biblioid>
130 http://catalog.loc.gov/cgi-bin/Pwebrecon.cgi?v3=1&DB=local&CMD=010a+2003063276&CNT=10+records+per+page
132 <biblioid class=
"libraryofcongress">2003063276</biblioid>
136 <dedication id=
"salespoints">
139 You can buy a copy of this book by clicking on one of the links below:
141 <itemizedlist mark=
"number" spacing=
"compact">
142 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.amazon.com/">Amazon
</ulink></para></listitem>
143 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.barnesandnoble.com/">B
&N
</ulink></para></listitem>
144 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.penguin.com/">Penguin
</ulink></para></listitem>
145 <!-- <ulink url="">Local Bookstore</ulink> -->
148 <!-- PAGE BREAK 2 -->
149 <!-- PAGE BREAK 3 -->
150 <dedication id=
"alsobylessig">
153 ALSO BY LAWRENCE LESSIG
156 The Future of Ideas: The Fate of the Commons in a Connected World
159 Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
162 <!-- PAGE BREAK 4 -->
163 <dedication id=
"frontpublisher">
166 THE PENGUIN PRESS, NEW YORK
169 <!-- PAGE BREAK 5 -->
170 <dedication id=
"frontbookinfo">
177 HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND
178 THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN CULTURE
179 AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
186 <!-- PAGE BREAK 6 -->
189 THE PENGUIN PRESS, a member of Penguin Group (USA) Inc.
375 Hudson Street New
193 Copyright
© Lawrence Lessig. All rights reserved.
196 Excerpt from an editorial titled
<quote>The Coming of Copyright Perpetuity,
</quote>
197 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>, January
16,
2003. Copyright
198 © 2003 by The New York Times Co. Reprinted with permission.
201 Cartoon in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1711"/> by Paul Conrad, copyright Tribune
202 Media Services, Inc. All rights reserved. Reprinted with permission.
205 Diagram in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1761"/> courtesy of the office of FCC
206 Commissioner, Michael J. Copps.
209 Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
213 Free culture : how big media uses technology and the law to lock down
214 culture and control creativity / Lawrence Lessig.
223 ISBN
1-
59420-
006-
8 (hardcover)
227 1. Intellectual property
—United States.
2. Mass media
—United States.
230 3. Technological innovations
—United States.
4. Art
—United States. I. Title.
236 343.7309'
9—dc22
239 This book is printed on acid-free paper.
242 Printed in the United States of America
248 Designed by Marysarah Quinn
256 Without limiting the rights under copyright reserved above, no part of
257 this publication may be reproduced, stored in or introduced into a
258 retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means
259 (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise),
260 without the prior written permission of both the copyright owner and
261 the above publisher of this book.
264 The scanning, uploading, and distribution of this book via the
265 Internet or via any other means without the permission of the
266 publisher is illegal and punishable by law. Please purchase only
267 authorized electronic editions and do not participate in or encourage
268 electronic piracy of copyrighted materials. Your support of the
269 author's rights is appreciated.
273 <!-- PAGE BREAK 7 -->
274 <dedication><title></title>
276 To Eric Eldred
—whose work first drew me to this cause, and for whom
284 <title>List of figures
</title>
291 1 CHAPTER ONE: Creators
292 1 CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
293 1 CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
294 1 CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
299 1 CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
303 1 CHAPTER SIX: Founders
304 1 CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
305 1 CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
306 1 CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
307 1 CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
308 2 Why Hollywood Is Right
312 2 Law and Architecture: Reach
313 2 Architecture and Law: Force
314 2 Market: Concentration
317 1 CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
318 1 CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
319 2 Constraining Creators
320 2 Constraining Innovators
321 2 Corrupting Citizens
323 1 CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
324 1 CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
328 2 Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
329 2 Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
331 2 1. More Formalities
332 3 Registration and Renewal
335 2 3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
336 2 4. Liberate the Music- -Again
337 2 5. Fire Lots of Lawyers 304
343 <!-- PAGE BREAK 11 -->
345 <preface id=
"preface">
346 <title>PREFACE
</title>
347 <indexterm id=
"idxpoguedavid" class='startofrange'
>
348 <primary>Pogue, David
</primary>
351 <emphasis role=
"bold">At the end
</emphasis> of his review of my first
352 book,
<citetitle>Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle>, David
353 Pogue, a brilliant writer and author of countless technical and
354 computer-related texts, wrote this:
358 Unlike actual law, Internet software has no capacity to punish. It
359 doesn't affect people who aren't online (and only a tiny minority
360 of the world population is). And if you don't like the Internet's
361 system, you can always flip off the modem.
<footnote id=
"preface01"><para>
362 David Pogue,
<quote>Don't Just Chat, Do Something,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
30 January
2000.
367 Pogue was skeptical of the core argument of the book
—that
368 software, or
<quote>code,
</quote> functioned as a kind of law
—and his review
369 suggested the happy thought that if life in cyberspace got bad, we
370 could always
<quote>drizzle, drazzle, druzzle, drome
</quote>-like simply flip a
371 switch and be back home. Turn off the modem, unplug the computer, and
372 any troubles that exist in
<emphasis>that
</emphasis> space wouldn't
373 <quote>affect
</quote> us anymore.
376 Pogue might have been right in
1999—I'm skeptical, but maybe.
377 But even if he was right then, the point is not right now:
378 <citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is about the troubles the Internet
379 causes even after the modem is turned
381 off. It is an argument about how the battles that now rage regarding life
382 on-line have fundamentally affected
<quote>people who aren't online.
</quote> There
383 is no switch that will insulate us from the Internet's effect.
385 <indexterm startref=
"idxpoguedavid" class='endofrange'
/>
387 But unlike
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, the argument here is not much
388 about the Internet itself. It is instead about the consequence of the
389 Internet to a part of our tradition that is much more fundamental,
390 and, as hard as this is for a geek-wanna-be to admit, much more
394 That tradition is the way our culture gets made. As I explain in the
395 pages that follow, we come from a tradition of
<quote>free culture
</quote>—not
396 <quote>free
</quote> as in
<quote>free beer
</quote> (to borrow a phrase from the founder of the
397 free software movement
<footnote>
399 Richard M. Stallman,
<citetitle>Free Software, Free Societies
</citetitle> 57 (Joshua Gay, ed.
2002).
400 </para></footnote>), but
<quote>free
</quote> as in
<quote>free speech,
</quote> <quote>free markets,
</quote>
401 <quote>free trade,
</quote> <quote>free enterprise,
</quote> <quote>free will,
</quote> and
<quote>free elections.
</quote> A
402 free culture supports and protects creators and innovators. It does
403 this directly by granting intellectual property rights. But it does so
404 indirectly by limiting the reach of those rights, to guarantee that
405 follow-on creators and innovators remain
<emphasis>as free as
406 possible
</emphasis> from the control of the past. A free culture is
407 not a culture without property, just as a free market is not a market
408 in which everything is free. The opposite of a free culture is a
409 <quote>permission culture
</quote>—a culture in which creators get to create
410 only with the permission of the powerful, or of creators from the
414 If we understood this change, I believe we would resist it. Not
<quote>we
</quote>
415 on the Left or
<quote>you
</quote> on the Right, but we who have no stake in the
416 particular industries of culture that defined the twentieth century.
417 Whether you are on the Left or the Right, if you are in this sense
418 disinterested, then the story I tell here will trouble you. For the
419 changes I describe affect values that both sides of our political
420 culture deem fundamental.
422 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
424 We saw a glimpse of this bipartisan outrage in the early summer of
425 2003. As the FCC considered changes in media ownership rules that
426 would relax limits on media concentration, an extraordinary coalition
427 generated more than
700,
000 letters to the FCC opposing the change.
428 As William Safire described marching
<quote>uncomfortably alongside CodePink
429 Women for Peace and the National Rifle Association, between liberal
430 Olympia Snowe and conservative Ted Stevens,
</quote> he formulated perhaps
431 most simply just what was at stake: the concentration of power. And as
433 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
437 Does that sound unconservative? Not to me. The concentration of
438 power
—political, corporate, media, cultural
—should be anathema to
439 conservatives. The diffusion of power through local control, thereby
440 encouraging individual participation, is the essence of federalism and
441 the greatest expression of democracy.
<footnote><para> William Safire,
442 <quote>The Great Media Gulp,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 May
2003.
443 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
448 This idea is an element of the argument of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle>, though my
449 focus is not just on the concentration of power produced by
450 concentrations in ownership, but more importantly, if because less
451 visibly, on the concentration of power produced by a radical change in
452 the effective scope of the law. The law is changing; that change is
453 altering the way our culture gets made; that change should worry
454 you
—whether or not you care about the Internet, and whether you're on
455 Safire's left or on his right. The inspiration for the title and for
456 much of the argument of this book comes from the work of Richard
457 Stallman and the Free Software Foundation. Indeed, as I reread
458 Stallman's own work, especially the essays in
<citetitle>Free Software, Free
459 Society
</citetitle>, I realize that all of the theoretical insights I develop here
460 are insights Stallman described decades ago. One could thus well argue
461 that this work is
<quote>merely
</quote> derivative.
464 I accept that criticism, if indeed it is a criticism. The work of a
465 lawyer is always derivative, and I mean to do nothing more in this
466 book than to remind a culture about a tradition that has always been
467 its own. Like Stallman, I defend that tradition on the basis of
468 values. Like Stallman, I believe those are the values of freedom. And
469 like Stallman, I believe those are values of our past that will need
470 to be defended in our future. A free culture has been our past, but it
471 will only be our future if we change the path we are on right now.
474 Like Stallman's arguments for free software, an argument for free
475 culture stumbles on a confusion that is hard to avoid, and even harder
476 to understand. A free culture is not a culture without property; it is not
477 a culture in which artists don't get paid. A culture without property, or
478 in which creators can't get paid, is anarchy, not freedom. Anarchy is not
482 Instead, the free culture that I defend in this book is a balance
483 between anarchy and control. A free culture, like a free market, is
484 filled with property. It is filled with rules of property and contract
485 that get enforced by the state. But just as a free market is perverted
486 if its property becomes feudal, so too can a free culture be queered
487 by extremism in the property rights that define it. That is what I
488 fear about our culture today. It is against that extremism that this
493 <!-- PAGE BREAK 15 -->
495 <!-- PAGE BREAK 16 -->
496 <chapter label=
"0" id=
"c-introduction">
497 <title>INTRODUCTION
</title>
498 <indexterm id='idxairtraffic' class='startofrange'
>
499 <primary>air traffic, land ownership vs.
</primary>
501 <indexterm id='idxlandownership' class='startofrange'
>
502 <primary>land ownership, air traffic and
</primary>
504 <indexterm id='idxproprigtair' class='startofrange'
>
505 <primary>property rights
</primary>
506 <secondary>air traffic vs.
</secondary>
508 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
510 On December
17,
1903, on a windy North Carolina beach for just
511 shy of one hundred seconds, the Wright brothers demonstrated that a
512 heavier-than-air, self-propelled vehicle could fly. The moment was electric
513 and its importance widely understood. Almost immediately, there
514 was an explosion of interest in this newfound technology of manned
515 flight, and a gaggle of innovators began to build upon it.
518 At the time the Wright brothers invented the airplane, American
519 law held that a property owner presumptively owned not just the surface
520 of his land, but all the land below, down to the center of the earth,
521 and all the space above, to
<quote>an indefinite extent, upwards.
</quote><footnote><para>
522 St. George Tucker,
<citetitle>Blackstone's Commentaries
</citetitle> 3 (South Hackensack, N.J.:
523 Rothman Reprints,
1969),
18.
526 years, scholars had puzzled about how best to interpret the idea that
527 rights in land ran to the heavens. Did that mean that you owned the
528 stars? Could you prosecute geese for their willful and regular trespass?
531 Then came airplanes, and for the first time, this principle of American
532 law
—deep within the foundations of our tradition, and acknowledged
533 by the most important legal thinkers of our past
—mattered. If
534 my land reaches to the heavens, what happens when United flies over
535 my field? Do I have the right to banish it from my property? Am I allowed
536 to enter into an exclusive license with Delta Airlines? Could we
537 set up an auction to decide how much these rights are worth?
539 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
540 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
542 In
1945, these questions became a federal case. When North Carolina
543 farmers Thomas Lee and Tinie Causby started losing chickens
544 because of low-flying military aircraft (the terrified chickens apparently
545 flew into the barn walls and died), the Causbys filed a lawsuit saying
546 that the government was trespassing on their land. The airplanes,
547 of course, never touched the surface of the Causbys' land. But if, as
548 Blackstone, Kent, and Coke had said, their land reached to
<quote>an indefinite
549 extent, upwards,
</quote> then the government was trespassing on their
550 property, and the Causbys wanted it to stop.
552 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
553 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
555 The Supreme Court agreed to hear the Causbys' case. Congress had
556 declared the airways public, but if one's property really extended to the
557 heavens, then Congress's declaration could well have been an unconstitutional
558 <quote>taking
</quote> of property without compensation. The Court acknowledged
559 that
<quote>it is ancient doctrine that common law ownership of
560 the land extended to the periphery of the universe.
</quote> But Justice Douglas
561 had no patience for ancient doctrine. In a single paragraph, hundreds of
562 years of property law were erased. As he wrote for the Court,
566 [The] doctrine has no place in the modern world. The air is a
567 public highway, as Congress has declared. Were that not true,
568 every transcontinental flight would subject the operator to countless
569 trespass suits. Common sense revolts at the idea. To recognize
570 such private claims to the airspace would clog these highways,
571 seriously interfere with their control and development in the public
572 interest, and transfer into private ownership that to which only
573 the public has a just claim.
<footnote>
575 United States v. Causby, U.S.
328 (
1946):
256,
261. The Court did find
576 that there could be a
<quote>taking
</quote> if the government's use of its land
577 effectively destroyed the value of the Causbys' land. This example was
578 suggested to me by Keith Aoki's wonderful piece,
<quote>(Intellectual)
579 Property and Sovereignty: Notes Toward a Cultural Geography of
580 Authorship,
</quote> <citetitle>Stanford Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1996):
1293,
1333. See also Paul
581 Goldstein,
<citetitle>Real Property
</citetitle> (Mineola, N.Y.: Foundation Press,
1984),
583 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
584 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
589 <quote>Common sense revolts at the idea.
</quote>
592 This is how the law usually works. Not often this abruptly or
593 impatiently, but eventually, this is how it works. It was Douglas's style not to
594 dither. Other justices would have blathered on for pages to reach the
596 conclusion that Douglas holds in a single line:
<quote>Common sense revolts
597 at the idea.
</quote> But whether it takes pages or a few words, it is the special
598 genius of a common law system, as ours is, that the law adjusts to the
599 technologies of the time. And as it adjusts, it changes. Ideas that were
600 as solid as rock in one age crumble in another.
602 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
603 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
604 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
606 Or at least, this is how things happen when there's no one powerful
607 on the other side of the change. The Causbys were just farmers. And
608 though there were no doubt many like them who were upset by the
609 growing traffic in the air (though one hopes not many chickens flew
610 themselves into walls), the Causbys of the world would find it very
611 hard to unite and stop the idea, and the technology, that the Wright
612 brothers had birthed. The Wright brothers spat airplanes into the
613 technological meme pool; the idea then spread like a virus in a chicken
614 coop; farmers like the Causbys found themselves surrounded by
<quote>what
615 seemed reasonable
</quote> given the technology that the Wrights had produced.
616 They could stand on their farms, dead chickens in hand, and
617 shake their fists at these newfangled technologies all they wanted.
618 They could call their representatives or even file a lawsuit. But in the
619 end, the force of what seems
<quote>obvious
</quote> to everyone else
—the power of
620 <quote>common sense
</quote>—would prevail. Their
<quote>private interest
</quote> would not be
621 allowed to defeat an obvious public gain.
623 <indexterm startref='idxproprigtair' class='endofrange'
/>
624 <indexterm startref='idxlandownership' class='endofrange'
/>
625 <indexterm startref='idxairtraffic' class='endofrange'
/>
626 <indexterm id='idxarmstrongedwin' class='startofrange'
>
627 <primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary>
630 <emphasis role='strong'
>Edwin Howard Armstrong
</emphasis> is one of America's forgotten inventor
631 geniuses. He came to the great American inventor scene just after the
632 titans Thomas Edison and Alexander Graham Bell. But his work in
633 the area of radio technology was perhaps the most important of any
634 single inventor in the first fifty years of radio. He was better educated
635 than Michael Faraday, who as a bookbinder's apprentice had discovered
636 electric induction in
1831. But he had the same intuition about
637 how the world of radio worked, and on at least three occasions,
638 Armstrong invented profoundly important technologies that advanced our
639 understanding of radio.
640 <!-- PAGE BREAK 19 -->
641 <indexterm><primary>Bell, Alexander Graham
</primary></indexterm>
642 <indexterm><primary>Edison, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
643 <indexterm><primary>Faraday, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
646 On the day after Christmas,
1933, four patents were issued to Armstrong
647 for his most significant invention
—FM radio. Until then, consumer radio
648 had been amplitude-modulated (AM) radio. The theorists
649 of the day had said that frequency-modulated (FM) radio could never
650 work. They were right about FM radio in a narrow band of spectrum.
651 But Armstrong discovered that frequency-modulated radio in a wide
652 band of spectrum would deliver an astonishing fidelity of sound, with
653 much less transmitter power and static.
656 On November
5,
1935, he demonstrated the technology at a meeting of
657 the Institute of Radio Engineers at the Empire State Building in New
658 York City. He tuned his radio dial across a range of AM stations,
659 until the radio locked on a broadcast that he had arranged from
660 seventeen miles away. The radio fell totally silent, as if dead, and
661 then with a clarity no one else in that room had ever heard from an
662 electrical device, it produced the sound of an announcer's voice:
663 <quote>This is amateur station W2AG at Yonkers, New York, operating on
664 frequency modulation at two and a half meters.
</quote>
667 The audience was hearing something no one had thought possible:
671 A glass of water was poured before the microphone in Yonkers; it
672 sounded like a glass of water being poured.
… A paper was crumpled
673 and torn; it sounded like paper and not like a crackling forest
674 fire.
… Sousa marches were played from records and a piano solo
675 and guitar number were performed.
… The music was projected with a
676 live-ness rarely if ever heard before from a radio
<quote>music
677 box.
</quote><footnote><para>
678 Lawrence Lessing,
<citetitle>Man of High Fidelity: Edwin Howard Armstrong
</citetitle>
679 (Philadelphia: J. B. Lipincott Company,
1956),
209.
684 As our own common sense tells us, Armstrong had discovered a vastly
685 superior radio technology. But at the time of his invention, Armstrong
686 was working for RCA. RCA was the dominant player in the then dominant
687 AM radio market. By
1935, there were a thousand radio stations across
688 the United States, but the stations in large cities were all owned by
689 a handful of networks.
693 RCA's president, David Sarnoff, a friend of Armstrong's, was eager
694 that Armstrong discover a way to remove static from AM radio. So
695 Sarnoff was quite excited when Armstrong told him he had a device
696 that removed static from
<quote>radio.
</quote> But when Armstrong demonstrated
697 his invention, Sarnoff was not pleased.
698 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
702 I thought Armstrong would invent some kind of a filter to remove
703 static from our AM radio. I didn't think he'd start a
704 revolution
— start up a whole damn new industry to compete with
705 RCA.
<footnote><para> See
<quote>Saints: The Heroes and Geniuses of the
706 Electronic Era,
</quote> First Electronic Church of America, at
707 www.webstationone.com/fecha, available at
709 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
1</ulink>.
714 Armstrong's invention threatened RCA's AM empire, so the company
715 launched a campaign to smother FM radio. While FM may have been a
716 superior technology, Sarnoff was a superior tactician. As one author
718 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
722 The forces for FM, largely engineering, could not overcome the weight
723 of strategy devised by the sales, patent, and legal offices to subdue
724 this threat to corporate position. For FM, if allowed to develop
725 unrestrained, posed
… a complete reordering of radio power
726 … and the eventual overthrow of the carefully restricted AM system
727 on which RCA had grown to power.
<footnote><para>Lessing,
226.
732 RCA at first kept the technology in house, insisting that further
733 tests were needed. When, after two years of testing, Armstrong grew
734 impatient, RCA began to use its power with the government to stall
735 FM radio's deployment generally. In
1936, RCA hired the former head
736 of the FCC and assigned him the task of assuring that the FCC assign
737 spectrum in a way that would castrate FM
—principally by moving FM
738 radio to a different band of spectrum. At first, these efforts failed. But
739 when Armstrong and the nation were distracted by World War II,
740 RCA's work began to be more successful. Soon after the war ended, the
741 FCC announced a set of policies that would have one clear effect: FM
742 radio would be crippled. As Lawrence Lessing described it,
744 <!-- PAGE BREAK 21 -->
747 The series of body blows that FM radio received right after the
748 war, in a series of rulings manipulated through the FCC by the
749 big radio interests, were almost incredible in their force and
750 deviousness.
<footnote><para>
755 <indexterm><primary>AT
&T
</primary></indexterm>
757 To make room in the spectrum for RCA's latest gamble, television,
758 FM radio users were to be moved to a totally new spectrum band. The
759 power of FM radio stations was also cut, meaning FM could no longer
760 be used to beam programs from one part of the country to another.
761 (This change was strongly supported by AT
&T, because the loss of
762 FM relaying stations would mean radio stations would have to buy
763 wired links from AT
&T.) The spread of FM radio was thus choked, at
767 Armstrong resisted RCA's efforts. In response, RCA resisted
768 Armstrong's patents. After incorporating FM technology into the
769 emerging standard for television, RCA declared the patents
770 invalid
—baselessly, and almost fifteen years after they were
771 issued. It thus refused to pay him royalties. For six years, Armstrong
772 fought an expensive war of litigation to defend the patents. Finally,
773 just as the patents expired, RCA offered a settlement so low that it
774 would not even cover Armstrong's lawyers' fees. Defeated, broken, and
775 now broke, in
1954 Armstrong wrote a short note to his wife and then
776 stepped out of a thirteenth-story window to his death.
778 <indexterm startref='idxarmstrongedwin' class='endofrange'
/>
780 This is how the law sometimes works. Not often this tragically, and
781 rarely with heroic drama, but sometimes, this is how it works. From
782 the beginning, government and government agencies have been subject to
783 capture. They are more likely captured when a powerful interest is
784 threatened by either a legal or technical change. That powerful
785 interest too often exerts its influence within the government to get
786 the government to protect it. The rhetoric of this protection is of
787 course always public spirited; the reality is something
788 different. Ideas that were as solid as rock in one age, but that, left
789 to themselves, would crumble in
791 another, are sustained through this subtle corruption of our political
792 process. RCA had what the Causbys did not: the power to stifle the
793 effect of technological change.
796 There's no single inventor of the Internet. Nor is there any good date
797 upon which to mark its birth. Yet in a very short time, the Internet
798 has become part of ordinary American life. According to the Pew
799 Internet and American Life Project,
58 percent of Americans had access
800 to the Internet in
2002, up from
49 percent two years
801 before.
<footnote><para>
802 Amanda Lenhart,
<quote>The Ever-Shifting Internet Population: A New Look at
803 Internet Access and the Digital Divide,
</quote> Pew Internet and American
804 Life Project,
15 April
2003:
6, available at
805 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
2</ulink>.
807 That number could well exceed two thirds of the nation by the end
811 As the Internet has been integrated into ordinary life, it has
812 changed things. Some of these changes are technical
—the Internet has
813 made communication faster, it has lowered the cost of gathering data,
814 and so on. These technical changes are not the focus of this book. They
815 are important. They are not well understood. But they are the sort of
816 thing that would simply go away if we all just switched the Internet off.
817 They don't affect people who don't use the Internet, or at least they
818 don't affect them directly. They are the proper subject of a book about
819 the Internet. But this is not a book about the Internet.
822 Instead, this book is about an effect of the Internet beyond the
823 Internet itself: an effect upon how culture is made. My claim is that
824 the Internet has induced an important and unrecognized change in that
825 process. That change will radically transform a tradition that is as
826 old as the Republic itself. Most, if they recognized this change,
827 would reject it. Yet most don't even see the change that the Internet
831 We can glimpse a sense of this change by distinguishing between
832 commercial and noncommercial culture, and by mapping the law's
833 regulation of each. By
<quote>commercial culture
</quote> I mean that part of our
834 culture that is produced and sold or produced to be sold. By
835 <quote>noncommercial culture
</quote> I mean all the rest. When old men sat around
837 <!-- PAGE BREAK 23 -->
838 street corners telling stories that kids and others consumed, that was
839 noncommercial culture. When Noah Webster published his
<quote>Reader,
</quote> or
840 Joel Barlow his poetry, that was commercial culture.
841 <indexterm><primary>Barlow, Joel
</primary></indexterm>
842 <indexterm><primary>Webster, Noah
</primary></indexterm>
845 At the beginning of our history, and for just about the whole of our
846 tradition, noncommercial culture was essentially unregulated. Of
847 course, if your stories were lewd, or if your song disturbed the
848 peace, then the law might intervene. But the law was never directly
849 concerned with the creation or spread of this form of culture, and it
850 left this culture
<quote>free.
</quote> The ordinary ways in which ordinary
851 individuals shared and transformed their culture
—telling
852 stories, reenacting scenes from plays or TV, participating in fan
853 clubs, sharing music, making tapes
—were left alone by the law.
856 The focus of the law was on commercial creativity. At first slightly,
857 then quite extensively, the law protected the incentives of creators by
858 granting them exclusive rights to their creative work, so that they could
859 sell those exclusive rights in a commercial
860 marketplace.
<footnote>
862 This is not the only purpose of copyright, though it is the overwhelmingly
863 primary purpose of the copyright established in the federal constitution.
864 State copyright law historically protected not just the commercial interest in
865 publication, but also a privacy interest. By granting authors the exclusive
866 right to first publication, state copyright law gave authors the power to
867 control the spread of facts about them. See Samuel D. Warren and Louis
868 D. Brandeis,
<quote>The Right to Privacy,
</quote> Harvard Law Review
4 (
1890):
193,
870 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
872 This is also, of course, an important part of creativity and culture,
873 and it has become an increasingly important part in America. But in no
874 sense was it dominant within our tradition. It was instead just one
875 part, a controlled part, balanced with the free.
878 This rough divide between the free and the controlled has now
879 been erased.
<footnote><para>
880 See Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Prometheus Books,
882 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
884 The Internet has set the stage for this erasure and, pushed by big
885 media, the law has now affected it. For the first time in our
886 tradition, the ordinary ways in which individuals create and share
887 culture fall within the reach of the regulation of the law, which has
888 expanded to draw within its control a vast amount of culture and
889 creativity that it never reached before. The technology that preserved
890 the balance of our history
—between uses of our culture that were
891 free and uses of our culture that were only upon permission
—has
892 been undone. The consequence is that we are less and less a free
893 culture, more and more a permission culture.
895 <!-- PAGE BREAK 24 -->
897 This change gets justified as necessary to protect commercial
898 creativity. And indeed, protectionism is precisely its
899 motivation. But the protectionism that justifies the changes that I
900 will describe below is not the limited and balanced sort that has
901 defined the law in the past. This is not a protectionism to protect
902 artists. It is instead a protectionism to protect certain forms of
903 business. Corporations threatened by the potential of the Internet to
904 change the way both commercial and noncommercial culture are made and
905 shared have united to induce lawmakers to use the law to protect
906 them. It is the story of RCA and Armstrong; it is the dream of the
910 For the Internet has unleashed an extraordinary possibility for many
911 to participate in the process of building and cultivating a culture
912 that reaches far beyond local boundaries. That power has changed the
913 marketplace for making and cultivating culture generally, and that
914 change in turn threatens established content industries. The Internet
915 is thus to the industries that built and distributed content in the
916 twentieth century what FM radio was to AM radio, or what the truck was
917 to the railroad industry of the nineteenth century: the beginning of
918 the end, or at least a substantial transformation. Digital
919 technologies, tied to the Internet, could produce a vastly more
920 competitive and vibrant market for building and cultivating culture;
921 that market could include a much wider and more diverse range of
922 creators; those creators could produce and distribute a much more
923 vibrant range of creativity; and depending upon a few important
924 factors, those creators could earn more on average from this system
925 than creators do today
—all so long as the RCAs of our day don't
926 use the law to protect themselves against this competition.
929 Yet, as I argue in the pages that follow, that is precisely what is
930 happening in our culture today. These modern-day equivalents of the
931 early twentieth-century radio or nineteenth-century railroads are
932 using their power to get the law to protect them against this new,
933 more efficient, more vibrant technology for building culture. They are
934 succeeding in their plan to remake the Internet before the Internet
938 It doesn't seem this way to many. The battles over copyright and the
939 <!-- PAGE BREAK 25 -->
940 Internet seem remote to most. To the few who follow them, they seem
941 mainly about a much simpler brace of questions
—whether
<quote>piracy
</quote> will
942 be permitted, and whether
<quote>property
</quote> will be protected. The
<quote>war
</quote> that
943 has been waged against the technologies of the Internet
—what
944 Motion Picture Association of America (MPAA) president Jack Valenti
945 calls his
<quote>own terrorist war
</quote><footnote><para>
946 Amy Harmon,
<quote>Black Hawk Download: Moving Beyond Music, Pirates
947 Use New Tools to Turn the Net into an Illicit Video Club,
</quote> <citetitle>New York
948 Times
</citetitle>,
17 January
2002.
949 </para></footnote>—has been framed as a battle about the
950 rule of law and respect for property. To know which side to take in this
951 war, most think that we need only decide whether we're for property or
955 If those really were the choices, then I would be with Jack Valenti
956 and the content industry. I, too, am a believer in property, and
957 especially in the importance of what Mr. Valenti nicely calls
958 <quote>creative property.
</quote> I believe that
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong, and that the
959 law, properly tuned, should punish
<quote>piracy,
</quote> whether on or off the
963 But those simple beliefs mask a much more fundamental question
964 and a much more dramatic change. My fear is that unless we come to see
965 this change, the war to rid the world of Internet
<quote>pirates
</quote> will also rid our
966 culture of values that have been integral to our tradition from the start.
969 These values built a tradition that, for at least the first
180 years of
970 our Republic, guaranteed creators the right to build freely upon their
971 past, and protected creators and innovators from either state or private
972 control. The First Amendment protected creators against state control.
973 And as Professor Neil Netanel powerfully argues,
<footnote>
975 Neil W. Netanel,
<quote>Copyright and a Democratic Civil Society,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law
976 Journal
</citetitle> 106 (
1996):
283.
977 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
979 copyright law, properly balanced, protected creators against private
980 control. Our tradition was thus neither Soviet nor the tradition of
981 patrons. It instead carved out a wide berth within which creators
982 could cultivate and extend our culture.
985 Yet the law's response to the Internet, when tied to changes in the
986 technology of the Internet itself, has massively increased the
987 effective regulation of creativity in America. To build upon or
988 critique the culture around us one must ask, Oliver Twist
–like,
989 for permission first. Permission is, of course, often
990 granted
—but it is not often granted to the critical or the
991 independent. We have built a kind of cultural nobility; those within
992 the noble class live easily; those outside it don't. But it is
993 nobility of any form that is alien to our tradition.
995 <!-- PAGE BREAK 26. FIXME: Should "Is it" be "It is" ? -->
997 The story that follows is about this war. Is it not about the
998 <quote>centrality of technology
</quote> to ordinary life. I don't believe in gods,
999 digital or otherwise. Nor is it an effort to demonize any individual
1000 or group, for neither do I believe in a devil, corporate or
1001 otherwise. It is not a morality tale. Nor is it a call to jihad
1002 against an industry.
1005 It is instead an effort to understand a hopelessly destructive war
1006 inspired by the technologies of the Internet but reaching far beyond
1007 its code. And by understanding this battle, it is an effort to map
1008 peace. There is no good reason for the current struggle around
1009 Internet technologies to continue. There will be great harm to our
1010 tradition and culture if it is allowed to continue unchecked. We must
1011 come to understand the source of this war. We must resolve it soon.
1013 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1014 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1016 Like the Causbys' battle, this war is, in part, about
<quote>property.
</quote> The
1017 property of this war is not as tangible as the Causbys', and no
1018 innocent chicken has yet to lose its life. Yet the ideas surrounding
1019 this
<quote>property
</quote> are as obvious to most as the Causbys' claim about the
1020 sacredness of their farm was to them. We are the Causbys. Most of us
1021 take for granted the extraordinarily powerful claims that the owners
1022 of
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> now assert. Most of us, like the Causbys,
1023 treat these claims as obvious. And hence we, like the Causbys, object
1024 when a new technology interferes with this property. It is as plain to
1025 us as it was to them that the new technologies of the Internet are
1026 <quote>trespassing
</quote> upon legitimate claims of
<quote>property.
</quote> It is as plain to
1027 us as it was to them that the law should intervene to stop this
1030 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1031 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1032 <indexterm><primary>Wright brothers
</primary></indexterm>
1034 And thus, when geeks and technologists defend their Armstrong or
1035 Wright brothers technology, most of us are simply unsympathetic.
1036 Common sense does not revolt. Unlike in the case of the unlucky
1037 Causbys, common sense is on the side of the property owners in this
1039 <!--PAGE BREAK 27-->
1040 the lucky Wright brothers, the Internet has not inspired a revolution
1044 My hope is to push this common sense along. I have become increasingly
1045 amazed by the power of this idea of intellectual property and, more
1046 importantly, its power to disable critical thought by policy makers
1047 and citizens. There has never been a time in our history when more of
1048 our
<quote>culture
</quote> was as
<quote>owned
</quote> as it is now. And yet there has never
1049 been a time when the concentration of power to control the
1050 <emphasis>uses
</emphasis> of culture has been as unquestioningly
1051 accepted as it is now.
1054 The puzzle is, Why? Is it because we have come to understand a truth
1055 about the value and importance of absolute property over ideas and
1056 culture? Is it because we have discovered that our tradition of
1057 rejecting such an absolute claim was wrong?
1060 Or is it because the idea of absolute property over ideas and culture
1061 benefits the RCAs of our time and fits our own unreflective intuitions?
1064 Is the radical shift away from our tradition of free culture an instance
1065 of America correcting a mistake from its past, as we did after a bloody
1066 war with slavery, and as we are slowly doing with inequality? Or is the
1067 radical shift away from our tradition of free culture yet another example
1068 of a political system captured by a few powerful special interests?
1071 Does common sense lead to the extremes on this question because common
1072 sense actually believes in these extremes? Or does common sense stand
1073 silent in the face of these extremes because, as with Armstrong versus
1074 RCA, the more powerful side has ensured that it has the more powerful
1077 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
1078 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
1080 I don't mean to be mysterious. My own views are resolved. I believe it
1081 was right for common sense to revolt against the extremism of the
1082 Causbys. I believe it would be right for common sense to revolt
1083 against the extreme claims made today on behalf of
<quote>intellectual
1084 property.
</quote> What the law demands today is increasingly as silly as a
1085 sheriff arresting an airplane for trespass. But the consequences of
1086 this silliness will be much more profound.
1087 <!-- PAGE BREAK 28 -->
1090 The struggle that rages just now centers on two ideas:
<quote>piracy
</quote> and
1091 <quote>property.
</quote> My aim in this book's next two parts is to explore these two
1095 My method is not the usual method of an academic. I don't want to
1096 plunge you into a complex argument, buttressed with references to
1097 obscure French theorists
—however natural that is for the weird
1098 sort we academics have become. Instead I begin in each part with a
1099 collection of stories that set a context within which these apparently
1100 simple ideas can be more fully understood.
1103 The two sections set up the core claim of this book: that while the
1104 Internet has indeed produced something fantastic and new, our
1105 government, pushed by big media to respond to this
<quote>something new,
</quote> is
1106 destroying something very old. Rather than understanding the changes
1107 the Internet might permit, and rather than taking time to let
<quote>common
1108 sense
</quote> resolve how best to respond, we are allowing those most
1109 threatened by the changes to use their power to change the
1110 law
—and more importantly, to use their power to change something
1111 fundamental about who we have always been.
1114 We allow this, I believe, not because it is right, and not because
1115 most of us really believe in these changes. We allow it because the
1116 interests most threatened are among the most powerful players in our
1117 depressingly compromised process of making law. This book is the story
1118 of one more consequence of this form of corruption
—a consequence
1119 to which most of us remain oblivious.
1122 <!-- PAGE BREAK 29 -->
1123 <part id=
"c-piracy">
1124 <title><quote>PIRACY
</quote></title>
1126 <!-- PAGE BREAK 30 -->
1127 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield1" class='startofrange'
>
1128 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
1131 Since the inception of the law regulating creative property, there has
1132 been a war against
<quote>piracy.
</quote> The precise contours of this concept,
1133 <quote>piracy,
</quote> are hard to sketch, but the animating injustice is easy to
1134 capture. As Lord Mansfield wrote in a case that extended the reach of
1135 English copyright law to include sheet music,
1139 A person may use the copy by playing it, but he has no right to
1140 rob the author of the profit, by multiplying copies and disposing
1141 of them for his own use.
<footnote><para>
1143 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777) (Mansfield).
1146 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield1" class='endofrange'
/>
1149 Today we are in the middle of another
<quote>war
</quote> against
<quote>piracy.
</quote> The
1150 Internet has provoked this war. The Internet makes possible the
1151 efficient spread of content. Peer-to-peer (p2p) file sharing is among
1152 the most efficient of the efficient technologies the Internet
1153 enables. Using distributed intelligence, p2p systems facilitate the
1154 easy spread of content in a way unimagined a generation ago.
1155 <!-- PAGE BREAK 31 -->
1158 This efficiency does not respect the traditional lines of copyright.
1159 The network doesn't discriminate between the sharing of copyrighted
1160 and uncopyrighted content. Thus has there been a vast amount of
1161 sharing of copyrighted content. That sharing in turn has excited the
1162 war, as copyright owners fear the sharing will
<quote>rob the author of the
1166 The warriors have turned to the courts, to the legislatures, and
1167 increasingly to technology to defend their
<quote>property
</quote> against this
1168 <quote>piracy.
</quote> A generation of Americans, the warriors warn, is being
1169 raised to believe that
<quote>property
</quote> should be
<quote>free.
</quote> Forget tattoos,
1170 never mind body piercing
—our kids are becoming
1171 <emphasis>thieves
</emphasis>!
1174 There's no doubt that
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong, and that pirates should be
1175 punished. But before we summon the executioners, we should put this
1176 notion of
<quote>piracy
</quote> in some context. For as the concept is increasingly
1177 used, at its core is an extraordinary idea that is almost certainly wrong.
1180 The idea goes something like this:
1184 Creative work has value; whenever I use, or take, or build upon
1185 the creative work of others, I am taking from them something of
1186 value. Whenever I take something of value from someone else, I
1187 should have their permission. The taking of something of value
1188 from someone else without permission is wrong. It is a form of
1192 <indexterm><primary>Dreyfuss, Rochelle
</primary></indexterm>
1194 This view runs deep within the current debates. It is what NYU law
1195 professor Rochelle Dreyfuss criticizes as the
<quote>if value, then right
</quote>
1196 theory of creative property
<footnote><para>
1198 See Rochelle Dreyfuss,
<quote>Expressive Genericity: Trademarks as Language
1199 in the Pepsi Generation,
</quote> <citetitle>Notre Dame Law Review
</citetitle> 65 (
1990):
397.
1201 —if there is value, then someone must have a
1202 right to that value. It is the perspective that led a composers' rights
1203 organization, ASCAP, to sue the Girl Scouts for failing to pay for the
1204 songs that girls sang around Girl Scout campfires.
<footnote><para>
1206 Lisa Bannon,
<quote>The Birds May Sing, but Campers Can't Unless They Pay
1207 Up,
</quote> <citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
21 August
1996, available at
1208 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
3</ulink>; Jonathan
1209 Zittrain,
<quote>Calling Off the Copyright War: In Battle of Property vs. Free
1210 Speech, No One Wins,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
24 November
2002.
1211 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
1213 There was
<quote>value
</quote> (the songs) so there must have been a
1214 <quote>right
</quote>—even against the Girl Scouts.
1216 <indexterm><primary>ASCAP
</primary></indexterm>
1218 This idea is certainly a possible understanding of how creative
1219 property should work. It might well be a possible design for a system
1220 <!-- PAGE BREAK 32 -->
1221 of law protecting creative property. But the
<quote>if value, then right
</quote>
1222 theory of creative property has never been America's theory of
1223 creative property. It has never taken hold within our law.
1226 Instead, in our tradition, intellectual property is an instrument. It
1227 sets the groundwork for a richly creative society but remains
1228 subservient to the value of creativity. The current debate has this
1229 turned around. We have become so concerned with protecting the
1230 instrument that we are losing sight of the value.
1233 The source of this confusion is a distinction that the law no longer
1234 takes care to draw
—the distinction between republishing someone's
1235 work on the one hand and building upon or transforming that work on
1236 the other. Copyright law at its birth had only publishing as its concern;
1237 copyright law today regulates both.
1240 Before the technologies of the Internet, this conflation didn't matter
1241 all that much. The technologies of publishing were expensive; that
1242 meant the vast majority of publishing was commercial. Commercial
1243 entities could bear the burden of the law
—even the burden of the
1244 Byzantine complexity that copyright law has become. It was just one
1245 more expense of doing business.
1247 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1248 <indexterm><primary>Rise of the Creative Class, The (Florida)
</primary></indexterm>
1250 But with the birth of the Internet, this natural limit to the reach of
1251 the law has disappeared. The law controls not just the creativity of
1252 commercial creators but effectively that of anyone. Although that
1253 expansion would not matter much if copyright law regulated only
1254 <quote>copying,
</quote> when the law regulates as broadly and obscurely as it does,
1255 the extension matters a lot. The burden of this law now vastly
1256 outweighs any original benefit
—certainly as it affects
1257 noncommercial creativity, and increasingly as it affects commercial
1258 creativity as well. Thus, as we'll see more clearly in the chapters
1259 below, the law's role is less and less to support creativity, and more
1260 and more to protect certain industries against competition. Just at
1261 the time digital technology could unleash an extraordinary range of
1262 commercial and noncommercial creativity, the law burdens this
1263 creativity with insanely complex and vague rules and with the threat
1264 of obscenely severe penalties. We may
1265 <!-- PAGE BREAK 33 -->
1266 be seeing, as Richard Florida writes, the
<quote>Rise of the Creative
1267 Class.
</quote><footnote>
1270 In
<citetitle>The Rise of the Creative Class
</citetitle> (New York:
1271 Basic Books,
2002), Richard Florida documents a shift in the nature of
1272 labor toward a labor of creativity. His work, however, doesn't
1273 directly address the legal conditions under which that creativity is
1274 enabled or stifled. I certainly agree with him about the importance
1275 and significance of this change, but I also believe the conditions
1276 under which it will be enabled are much more tenuous.
1278 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1279 <indexterm><primary>Rise of the Creative Class, The (Florida)
</primary></indexterm>
1281 Unfortunately, we are also seeing an extraordinary rise of regulation of
1282 this creative class.
1285 These burdens make no sense in our tradition. We should begin by
1286 understanding that tradition a bit more and by placing in their proper
1287 context the current battles about behavior labeled
<quote>piracy.
</quote>
1291 <!-- PAGE BREAK 34 -->
1292 <chapter label=
"1" id=
"creators">
1293 <title>CHAPTER ONE: Creators
</title>
1294 <indexterm id=
"idxanimadedcartoons" class='startofrange'
>
1295 <primary>animated cartoons
</primary>
1298 In
1928, a cartoon character was born. An early Mickey Mouse
1299 made his debut in May of that year, in a silent flop called
<citetitle>Plane Crazy
</citetitle>.
1300 In November, in New York City's Colony Theater, in the first widely
1301 distributed cartoon synchronized with sound,
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle> brought
1302 to life the character that would become Mickey Mouse.
1305 Synchronized sound had been introduced to film a year earlier in the
1306 movie
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle>. That success led Walt Disney to copy the
1307 technique and mix sound with cartoons. No one knew whether it would
1308 work or, if it did work, whether it would win an audience. But when
1309 Disney ran a test in the summer of
1928, the results were unambiguous.
1310 As Disney describes that first experiment,
1314 A couple of my boys could read music, and one of them could play
1315 a mouth organ. We put them in a room where they could not see
1316 the screen and arranged to pipe their sound into the room where
1317 our wives and friends were going to see the picture.
1318 <!-- PAGE BREAK 35 -->
1321 The boys worked from a music and sound-effects score. After several
1322 false starts, sound and action got off with the gun. The mouth
1323 organist played the tune, the rest of us in the sound department
1324 bammed tin pans and blew slide whistles on the beat. The
1325 synchronization was pretty close.
1328 The effect on our little audience was nothing less than electric.
1329 They responded almost instinctively to this union of sound and
1330 motion. I thought they were kidding me. So they put me in the audience
1331 and ran the action again. It was terrible, but it was wonderful! And
1332 it was something new!
<footnote><para>
1334 Leonard Maltin,
<citetitle>Of Mice and Magic: A History of American Animated
1335 Cartoons
</citetitle> (New York: Penguin Books,
1987),
34–35.
1340 Disney's then partner, and one of animation's most extraordinary
1341 talents, Ub Iwerks, put it more strongly:
<quote>I have never been so thrilled
1342 in my life. Nothing since has ever equaled it.
</quote>
1343 <indexterm><primary>Iwerks, Ub
</primary></indexterm>
1346 Disney had created something very new, based upon something relatively
1347 new. Synchronized sound brought life to a form of creativity that had
1348 rarely
—except in Disney's hands
—been anything more than
1349 filler for other films. Throughout animation's early history, it was
1350 Disney's invention that set the standard that others struggled to
1351 match. And quite often, Disney's great genius, his spark of
1352 creativity, was built upon the work of others.
1355 This much is familiar. What you might not know is that
1928 also marks
1356 another important transition. In that year, a comic (as opposed to
1357 cartoon) genius created his last independently produced silent film.
1358 That genius was Buster Keaton. The film was
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>.
1361 Keaton was born into a vaudeville family in
1895. In the era of silent
1362 film, he had mastered using broad physical comedy as a way to spark
1363 uncontrollable laughter from his audience.
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1364 Jr
</citetitle>. was a classic of this form, famous among film buffs for its
1365 incredible stunts. The film was classic Keaton
—wildly popular
1366 and among the best of its genre.
1369 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. appeared before Disney's cartoon Steamboat
1371 <!-- PAGE BREAK 36 -->
1372 The coincidence of titles is not coincidental. Steamboat Willie is a
1373 direct cartoon parody of Steamboat Bill,
<footnote><para>
1375 I am grateful to David Gerstein and his careful history, described at
1376 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
4</ulink>.
1377 According to Dave Smith of the Disney Archives, Disney paid royalties to
1378 use the music for five songs in
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>:
<quote>Steamboat Bill,
</quote> <quote>The
1379 Simpleton
</quote> (Delille),
<quote>Mischief Makers
</quote> (Carbonara),
<quote>Joyful Hurry No.
1</quote>
1380 (Baron), and
<quote>Gawky Rube
</quote> (Lakay). A sixth song,
<quote>The Turkey in the
1381 Straw,
</quote> was already in the public domain. Letter from David Smith to
1382 Harry Surden,
10 July
2003, on file with author.
1384 and both are built upon a common song as a source. It is not just from
1385 the invention of synchronized sound in
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle> that we
1386 get
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>. It is also from Buster Keaton's invention of
1387 Steamboat Bill, Jr., itself inspired by the song
<quote>Steamboat Bill,
</quote>
1388 that we get Steamboat Willie, and then from Steamboat Willie, Mickey
1392 This
<quote>borrowing
</quote> was nothing unique, either for Disney or for the
1393 industry. Disney was always parroting the feature-length mainstream
1394 films of his day.
<footnote><para>
1396 He was also a fan of the public domain. See Chris Sprigman,
<quote>The Mouse
1397 that Ate the Public Domain,
</quote> Findlaw,
5 March
2002, at
1398 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
5</ulink>.
1400 So did many others. Early cartoons are filled with
1401 knockoffs
—slight variations on winning themes; retellings of
1402 ancient stories. The key to success was the brilliance of the
1403 differences. With Disney, it was sound that gave his animation its
1404 spark. Later, it was the quality of his work relative to the
1405 production-line cartoons with which he competed. Yet these additions
1406 were built upon a base that was borrowed. Disney added to the work of
1407 others before him, creating something new out of something just barely
1411 Sometimes this borrowing was slight. Sometimes it was significant.
1412 Think about the fairy tales of the Brothers Grimm. If you're as
1413 oblivious as I was, you're likely to think that these tales are happy,
1414 sweet stories, appropriate for any child at bedtime. In fact, the
1415 Grimm fairy tales are, well, for us, grim. It is a rare and perhaps
1416 overly ambitious parent who would dare to read these bloody,
1417 moralistic stories to his or her child, at bedtime or anytime.
1420 Disney took these stories and retold them in a way that carried them
1421 into a new age. He animated the stories, with both characters and
1422 light. Without removing the elements of fear and danger altogether, he
1423 made funny what was dark and injected a genuine emotion of compassion
1424 where before there was fear. And not just with the work of the
1425 Brothers Grimm. Indeed, the catalog of Disney work drawing upon the
1426 work of others is astonishing when set together:
<citetitle>Snow White
</citetitle>
1427 (
1937),
<citetitle>Fantasia
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Pinocchio
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Dumbo
</citetitle>
1428 (
1941),
<citetitle>Bambi
</citetitle> (
1942),
<citetitle>Song of the South
</citetitle> (
1946),
1429 <citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle> (
1950),
<citetitle>Alice in Wonderland
</citetitle> (
1951),
<citetitle>Robin
1430 Hood
</citetitle> (
1952),
<citetitle>Peter Pan
</citetitle> (
1953),
<citetitle>Lady and the Tramp
</citetitle>
1431 <!-- PAGE BREAK 37 -->
1432 (
1955),
<citetitle>Mulan
</citetitle> (
1998),
<citetitle>Sleeping Beauty
</citetitle> (
1959),
<citetitle>101
1433 Dalmatians
</citetitle> (
1961),
<citetitle>The Sword in the Stone
</citetitle> (
1963), and
1434 <citetitle>The Jungle Book
</citetitle> (
1967)
—not to mention a recent example
1435 that we should perhaps quickly forget,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>
1436 (
2003). In all of these cases, Disney (or Disney, Inc.) ripped
1437 creativity from the culture around him, mixed that creativity with his
1438 own extraordinary talent, and then burned that mix into the soul of
1439 his culture. Rip, mix, and burn.
1441 <indexterm startref=
"idxanimadedcartoons" class='endofrange'
/>
1443 This is a kind of creativity. It is a creativity that we should
1444 remember and celebrate. There are some who would say that there is no
1445 creativity except this kind. We don't need to go that far to recognize
1446 its importance. We could call this
<quote>Disney creativity,
</quote> though that
1447 would be a bit misleading. It is, more precisely,
<quote>Walt Disney
1448 creativity
</quote>—a form of expression and genius that builds upon the
1449 culture around us and makes it something different.
1451 <para> In
1928, the culture that Disney was free to draw upon was
1452 relatively fresh. The public domain in
1928 was not very old and was
1453 therefore quite vibrant. The average term of copyright was just around
1454 thirty years
—for that minority of creative work that was in fact
1455 copyrighted.
<footnote><para>
1457 Until
1976, copyright law granted an author the possibility of two terms: an
1458 initial term and a renewal term. I have calculated the
<quote>average
</quote> term by
1460 the weighted average of total registrations for any particular year,
1461 and the proportion renewing. Thus, if
100 copyrights are registered in year
1462 1, and only
15 are renewed, and the renewal term is
28 years, then the
1464 term is
32.2 years. For the renewal data and other relevant data, see the
1465 Web site associated with this book, available at
1466 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
6</ulink>.
1468 That means that for thirty years, on average, the authors or
1469 copyright holders of a creative work had an
<quote>exclusive right
</quote> to control
1470 certain uses of the work. To use this copyrighted work in limited ways
1471 required the permission of the copyright owner.
1474 At the end of a copyright term, a work passes into the public domain.
1475 No permission is then needed to draw upon or use that work. No
1476 permission and, hence, no lawyers. The public domain is a
<quote>lawyer-free
1477 zone.
</quote> Thus, most of the content from the nineteenth century was free
1478 for Disney to use and build upon in
1928. It was free for
1479 anyone
— whether connected or not, whether rich or not, whether
1480 approved or not
—to use and build upon.
1483 This is the ways things always were
—until quite recently. For most
1484 of our history, the public domain was just over the horizon. From
1485 until
1978, the average copyright term was never more than thirty-two
1486 years, meaning that most culture just a generation and a half old was
1488 <!-- PAGE BREAK 38 -->
1489 free for anyone to build upon without the permission of anyone else.
1490 Today's equivalent would be for creative work from the
1960s and
1970s
1491 to now be free for the next Walt Disney to build upon without
1492 permission. Yet today, the public domain is presumptive only for
1493 content from before the Great Depression.
1496 Of course, Walt Disney had no monopoly on
<quote>Walt Disney creativity.
</quote>
1497 Nor does America. The norm of free culture has, until recently, and
1498 except within totalitarian nations, been broadly exploited and quite
1502 Consider, for example, a form of creativity that seems strange to many
1503 Americans but that is inescapable within Japanese culture:
<citetitle>manga
</citetitle>, or
1504 comics. The Japanese are fanatics about comics. Some
40 percent of
1505 publications are comics, and
30 percent of publication revenue derives
1506 from comics. They are everywhere in Japanese society, at every
1507 magazine stand, carried by a large proportion of commuters on Japan's
1508 extraordinary system of public transportation.
1511 Americans tend to look down upon this form of culture. That's an
1512 unattractive characteristic of ours. We're likely to misunderstand
1513 much about manga, because few of us have ever read anything close to
1514 the stories that these
<quote>graphic novels
</quote> tell. For the Japanese, manga
1515 cover every aspect of social life. For us, comics are
<quote>men in tights.
</quote>
1516 And anyway, it's not as if the New York subways are filled with
1517 readers of Joyce or even Hemingway. People of different cultures
1518 distract themselves in different ways, the Japanese in this
1519 interestingly different way.
1522 But my purpose here is not to understand manga. It is to describe a
1523 variant on manga that from a lawyer's perspective is quite odd, but
1524 from a Disney perspective is quite familiar.
1527 This is the phenomenon of
<citetitle>doujinshi
</citetitle>. Doujinshi are also comics, but
1528 they are a kind of copycat comic. A rich ethic governs the creation of
1529 doujinshi. It is not doujinshi if it is
<emphasis>just
</emphasis> a
1530 copy; the artist must make a contribution to the art he copies, by
1531 transforming it either subtly or
1532 <!-- PAGE BREAK 39 -->
1533 significantly. A doujinshi comic can thus take a mainstream comic and
1534 develop it differently
—with a different story line. Or the comic can
1535 keep the character in character but change its look slightly. There is no
1536 formula for what makes the doujinshi sufficiently
<quote>different.
</quote> But they
1537 must be different if they are to be considered true doujinshi. Indeed,
1538 there are committees that review doujinshi for inclusion within shows
1539 and reject any copycat comic that is merely a copy.
1542 These copycat comics are not a tiny part of the manga market. They are
1543 huge. More than
33,
000 <quote>circles
</quote> of creators from across Japan produce
1544 these bits of Walt Disney creativity. More than
450,
000 Japanese come
1545 together twice a year, in the largest public gathering in the country,
1546 to exchange and sell them. This market exists in parallel to the
1547 mainstream commercial manga market. In some ways, it obviously
1548 competes with that market, but there is no sustained effort by those
1549 who control the commercial manga market to shut the doujinshi market
1550 down. It flourishes, despite the competition and despite the law.
1553 The most puzzling feature of the doujinshi market, for those trained
1554 in the law, at least, is that it is allowed to exist at all. Under
1555 Japanese copyright law, which in this respect (on paper) mirrors
1556 American copyright law, the doujinshi market is an illegal
1557 one. Doujinshi are plainly
<quote>derivative works.
</quote> There is no general
1558 practice by doujinshi artists of securing the permission of the manga
1559 creators. Instead, the practice is simply to take and modify the
1560 creations of others, as Walt Disney did with
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1561 Jr
</citetitle>. Under both Japanese and American law, that
<quote>taking
</quote> without
1562 the permission of the original copyright owner is illegal. It is an
1563 infringement of the original copyright to make a copy or a derivative
1564 work without the original copyright owner's permission.
1566 <indexterm id=
"idxwinickjudd" class='startofrange'
>
1567 <primary>Winick, Judd
</primary>
1570 Yet this illegal market exists and indeed flourishes in Japan, and in
1571 the view of many, it is precisely because it exists that Japanese manga
1572 flourish. As American graphic novelist Judd Winick said to me,
<quote>The
1573 early days of comics in America are very much like what's going on
1574 in Japan now.
… American comics were born out of copying each
1575 <!-- PAGE BREAK 40 -->
1576 other.
… That's how [the artists] learn to draw
—by going into comic
1577 books and not tracing them, but looking at them and copying them
</quote>
1578 and building from them.
<footnote><para>
1580 For an excellent history, see Scott McCloud,
<citetitle>Reinventing Comics
</citetitle> (New
1581 York: Perennial,
2000).
1585 American comics now are quite different, Winick explains, in part
1586 because of the legal difficulty of adapting comics the way doujinshi are
1587 allowed. Speaking of Superman, Winick told me,
<quote>there are these rules
1588 and you have to stick to them.
</quote> There are things Superman
<quote>cannot
</quote>
1589 do.
<quote>As a creator, it's frustrating having to stick to some parameters
1590 which are fifty years old.
</quote>
1592 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinickjudd" class='endofrange'
/>
1594 The norm in Japan mitigates this legal difficulty. Some say it is
1595 precisely the benefit accruing to the Japanese manga market that
1596 explains the mitigation. Temple University law professor Salil Mehra,
1597 for example, hypothesizes that the manga market accepts these
1598 technical violations because they spur the manga market to be more
1599 wealthy and productive. Everyone would be worse off if doujinshi were
1600 banned, so the law does not ban doujinshi.
<footnote><para>
1602 See Salil K. Mehra,
<quote>Copyright and Comics in Japan: Does Law Explain
1603 Why All the Comics My Kid Watches Are Japanese Imports?
</quote> <citetitle>Rutgers Law
1604 Review
</citetitle> 55 (
2002):
155,
182.
<quote>[T]here might be a collective economic
1605 rationality that would lead manga and anime artists to forgo bringing
1606 legal actions for infringement. One hypothesis is that all manga
1607 artists may be better off collectively if they set aside their
1608 individual self-interest and decide not to press their legal
1609 rights. This is essentially a prisoner's dilemma solved.
</quote>
1613 The problem with this story, however, as Mehra plainly acknowledges,
1614 is that the mechanism producing this laissez faire response is not
1615 clear. It may well be that the market as a whole is better off if
1616 doujinshi are permitted rather than banned, but that doesn't explain
1617 why individual copyright owners don't sue nonetheless. If the law has
1618 no general exception for doujinshi, and indeed in some cases
1619 individual manga artists have sued doujinshi artists, why is there not
1620 a more general pattern of blocking this
<quote>free taking
</quote> by the doujinshi
1624 I spent four wonderful months in Japan, and I asked this question
1625 as often as I could. Perhaps the best account in the end was offered by
1626 a friend from a major Japanese law firm.
<quote>We don't have enough
1627 lawyers,
</quote> he told me one afternoon. There
<quote>just aren't enough resources
1628 to prosecute cases like this.
</quote>
1631 This is a theme to which we will return: that regulation by law is a
1632 function of both the words on the books and the costs of making those
1633 words have effect. For now, focus on the obvious question that is
1634 begged: Would Japan be better off with more lawyers? Would manga
1635 <!-- PAGE BREAK 41 -->
1636 be richer if doujinshi artists were regularly prosecuted? Would the
1637 Japanese gain something important if they could end this practice of
1638 uncompensated sharing? Does piracy here hurt the victims of the
1639 piracy, or does it help them? Would lawyers fighting this piracy help
1640 their clients or hurt them?
1641 Let's pause for a moment.
1644 If you're like I was a decade ago, or like most people are when they
1645 first start thinking about these issues, then just about now you should
1646 be puzzled about something you hadn't thought through before.
1649 We live in a world that celebrates
<quote>property.
</quote> I am one of those
1650 celebrants. I believe in the value of property in general, and I also
1651 believe in the value of that weird form of property that lawyers call
1652 <quote>intellectual property.
</quote><footnote><para>
1654 The term
<citetitle>intellectual property
</citetitle> is of relatively recent origin. See
1655 Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
11 (New York: New York
1656 University Press,
2001). See also Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>
1657 (New York: Random House,
2001),
293 n.
26. The term accurately
1658 describes a set of
<quote>property
</quote> rights
—copyright, patents,
1659 trademark, and trade-secret
—but the nature of those rights is
1661 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
1663 A large, diverse society cannot survive without property; a large,
1664 diverse, and modern society cannot flourish without intellectual
1668 But it takes just a second's reflection to realize that there is
1669 plenty of value out there that
<quote>property
</quote> doesn't capture. I don't
1670 mean
<quote>money can't buy you love,
</quote> but rather, value that is plainly
1671 part of a process of production, including commercial as well as
1672 noncommercial production. If Disney animators had stolen a set of
1673 pencils to draw Steamboat Willie, we'd have no hesitation in
1674 condemning that taking as wrong
— even though trivial, even if
1675 unnoticed. Yet there was nothing wrong, at least under the law of the
1676 day, with Disney's taking from Buster Keaton or from the Brothers
1677 Grimm. There was nothing wrong with the taking from Keaton because
1678 Disney's use would have been considered
<quote>fair.
</quote> There was nothing
1679 wrong with the taking from the Grimms because the Grimms' work was in
1683 Thus, even though the things that Disney took
—or more generally,
1684 the things taken by anyone exercising Walt Disney creativity
—are
1685 valuable, our tradition does not treat those takings as wrong. Some
1687 <!-- PAGE BREAK 42 -->
1688 things remain free for the taking within a free culture, and that
1692 The same with the doujinshi culture. If a doujinshi artist broke into
1693 a publisher's office and ran off with a thousand copies of his latest
1694 work
—or even one copy
—without paying, we'd have no hesitation in
1695 saying the artist was wrong. In addition to having trespassed, he would
1696 have stolen something of value. The law bans that stealing in whatever
1697 form, whether large or small.
1700 Yet there is an obvious reluctance, even among Japanese lawyers, to
1701 say that the copycat comic artists are
<quote>stealing.
</quote> This form of Walt
1702 Disney creativity is seen as fair and right, even if lawyers in
1703 particular find it hard to say why.
1706 It's the same with a thousand examples that appear everywhere once you
1707 begin to look. Scientists build upon the work of other scientists
1708 without asking or paying for the privilege. (
<quote>Excuse me, Professor
1709 Einstein, but may I have permission to use your theory of relativity
1710 to show that you were wrong about quantum physics?
</quote>) Acting companies
1711 perform adaptations of the works of Shakespeare without securing
1712 permission from anyone. (Does
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> believe
1713 Shakespeare would be better spread within our culture if there were a
1714 central Shakespeare rights clearinghouse that all productions of
1715 Shakespeare must appeal to first?) And Hollywood goes through cycles
1716 with a certain kind of movie: five asteroid films in the late
1990s;
1717 two volcano disaster films in
1997.
1720 Creators here and everywhere are always and at all times building
1721 upon the creativity that went before and that surrounds them now.
1722 That building is always and everywhere at least partially done without
1723 permission and without compensating the original creator. No society,
1724 free or controlled, has ever demanded that every use be paid for or that
1725 permission for Walt Disney creativity must always be sought. Instead,
1726 every society has left a certain bit of its culture free for the taking
—free
1727 societies more fully than unfree, perhaps, but all societies to some degree.
1728 <!-- PAGE BREAK 43 -->
1731 The hard question is therefore not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> a
1732 culture is free. All cultures are free to some degree. The hard
1733 question instead is
<quote><emphasis>How
</emphasis> free is this culture?
</quote>
1734 How much, and how broadly, is the culture free for others to take and
1735 build upon? Is that freedom limited to party members? To members of
1736 the royal family? To the top ten corporations on the New York Stock
1737 Exchange? Or is that freedom spread broadly? To artists generally,
1738 whether affiliated with the Met or not? To musicians generally,
1739 whether white or not? To filmmakers generally, whether affiliated with
1743 Free cultures are cultures that leave a great deal open for others to
1744 build upon; unfree, or permission, cultures leave much less. Ours was a
1745 free culture. It is becoming much less so.
1748 <!-- PAGE BREAK 44 -->
1750 <chapter label=
"2" id=
"mere-copyists">
1751 <title>CHAPTER TWO:
<quote>Mere Copyists
</quote></title>
1752 <indexterm id=
"idxphotography" class='startofrange'
>
1753 <primary>photography
</primary>
1756 In
1839, Louis Daguerre invented the first practical technology for
1757 producing what we would call
<quote>photographs.
</quote> Appropriately enough, they
1758 were called
<quote>daguerreotypes.
</quote> The process was complicated and
1759 expensive, and the field was thus limited to professionals and a few
1760 zealous and wealthy amateurs. (There was even an American Daguerre
1761 Association that helped regulate the industry, as do all such
1762 associations, by keeping competition down so as to keep prices up.)
1763 <indexterm><primary>Daguerre, Louis
</primary></indexterm>
1766 Yet despite high prices, the demand for daguerreotypes was strong.
1767 This pushed inventors to find simpler and cheaper ways to make
1768 <quote>automatic pictures.
</quote> William Talbot soon discovered a process for
1769 making
<quote>negatives.
</quote> But because the negatives were glass, and had to
1770 be kept wet, the process still remained expensive and cumbersome. In
1771 the
1870s, dry plates were developed, making it easier to separate the
1772 taking of a picture from its developing. These were still plates of
1773 glass, and thus it was still not a process within reach of most
1775 <indexterm><primary>Talbot, William
</primary></indexterm>
1777 <indexterm id=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='startofrange'
>
1778 <primary>Eastman, George
</primary>
1781 The technological change that made mass photography possible
1782 didn't happen until
1888, and was the creation of a single man. George
1783 <!-- PAGE BREAK 45 -->
1784 Eastman, himself an amateur photographer, was frustrated by the
1785 technology of photographs made with plates. In a flash of insight (so
1786 to speak), Eastman saw that if the film could be made to be flexible,
1787 it could be held on a single spindle. That roll could then be sent to
1788 a developer, driving the costs of photography down substantially. By
1789 lowering the costs, Eastman expected he could dramatically broaden the
1790 population of photographers.
1793 Eastman developed flexible, emulsion-coated paper film and placed
1794 rolls of it in small, simple cameras: the Kodak. The device was
1795 marketed on the basis of its simplicity.
<quote>You press the button and we
1796 do the rest.
</quote><footnote><para>
1798 Reese V. Jenkins,
<citetitle>Images and Enterprise
</citetitle> (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press,
1975),
112.
1799 </para></footnote> As he described in
<citetitle>The Kodak Primer
</citetitle>:
1800 <indexterm><primary>Kodak Primer, The (Eastman)
</primary></indexterm>
1804 The principle of the Kodak system is the separation of the work that
1805 any person whomsoever can do in making a photograph, from the work
1806 that only an expert can do.
… We furnish anybody, man, woman or
1807 child, who has sufficient intelligence to point a box straight and
1808 press a button, with an instrument which altogether removes from the
1809 practice of photography the necessity for exceptional facilities or,
1810 in fact, any special knowledge of the art. It can be employed without
1811 preliminary study, without a darkroom and without
1812 chemicals.
<footnote>
1815 Brian Coe,
<citetitle>The Birth of Photography
</citetitle> (New York: Taplinger Publishing,
1817 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1822 For $
25, anyone could make pictures. The camera came preloaded
1823 with film, and when it had been used, the camera was returned to an
1824 Eastman factory, where the film was developed. Over time, of course,
1825 the cost of the camera and the ease with which it could be used both
1826 improved. Roll film thus became the basis for the explosive growth of
1827 popular photography. Eastman's camera first went on sale in
1888; one
1828 year later, Kodak was printing more than six thousand negatives a day.
1829 From
1888 through
1909, while industrial production was rising by
4.7
1830 percent, photographic equipment and material sales increased by
11
1831 percent.
<footnote><para>
1834 </para></footnote> Eastman Kodak's sales during the same period experienced
1835 an average annual increase of over
17 percent.
<footnote><para>
1837 Based on a chart in Jenkins, p.
178.
1840 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1843 <!-- PAGE BREAK 46 -->
1844 The real significance of Eastman's invention, however, was not
1845 economic. It was social. Professional photography gave individuals a
1846 glimpse of places they would never otherwise see. Amateur photography
1847 gave them the ability to record their own lives in a way they had
1848 never been able to do before. As author Brian Coe notes,
<quote>For the
1849 first time the snapshot album provided the man on the street with a
1850 permanent record of his family and its activities.
… For the first
1851 time in history there exists an authentic visual record of the
1852 appearance and activities of the common man made without [literary]
1853 interpretation or bias.
</quote><footnote><para>
1859 In this way, the Kodak camera and film were technologies of
1860 expression. The pencil or paintbrush was also a technology of
1861 expression, of course. But it took years of training before they could
1862 be deployed by amateurs in any useful or effective way. With the
1863 Kodak, expression was possible much sooner and more simply. The
1864 barrier to expression was lowered. Snobs would sneer at its
<quote>quality
</quote>;
1865 professionals would discount it as irrelevant. But watch a child study
1866 how best to frame a picture and you get a sense of the experience of
1867 creativity that the Kodak enabled. Democratic tools gave ordinary
1868 people a way to express themselves more easily than any tools could
1872 What was required for this technology to flourish? Obviously,
1873 Eastman's genius was an important part. But also important was the
1874 legal environment within which Eastman's invention grew. For early in
1875 the history of photography, there was a series of judicial decisions
1876 that could well have changed the course of photography substantially.
1877 Courts were asked whether the photographer, amateur or professional,
1878 required permission before he could capture and print whatever image
1879 he wanted. Their answer was no.
<footnote><para>
1881 For illustrative cases, see, for example,
<citetitle>Pavesich
</citetitle>
1882 v.
<citetitle>N.E. Life Ins. Co
</citetitle>.,
50 S.E.
68 (Ga.
1905);
1883 <citetitle>Foster-Milburn Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Chinn
</citetitle>,
123090 S.W.
364,
366
1884 (Ky.
1909);
<citetitle>Corliss
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Walker
</citetitle>,
64 F.
280 (Mass.
1889 The arguments in favor of requiring permission will sound surprisingly
1890 familiar. The photographer was
<quote>taking
</quote> something from the person or
1891 building whose photograph he shot
—pirating something of
1892 value. Some even thought he was taking the target's soul. Just as
1893 Disney was not free to take the pencils that his animators used to
1895 <!-- PAGE BREAK 47 -->
1896 Mickey, so, too, should these photographers not be free to take images
1897 that they thought valuable.
1899 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1901 On the other side was an argument that should be familiar, as well.
1902 Sure, there may be something of value being used. But citizens should
1903 have the right to capture at least those images that stand in public view.
1904 (Louis Brandeis, who would become a Supreme Court Justice, thought
1905 the rule should be different for images from private spaces.
<footnote>
1908 Samuel D. Warren and Louis D. Brandeis,
<quote>The Right to Privacy,
</quote>
1909 <citetitle>Harvard Law Review
</citetitle> 4 (
1890):
193.
1910 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1911 <indexterm><primary>Warren, Samuel D.
</primary></indexterm>
1912 </para></footnote>) It may be that this means that the photographer
1913 gets something for nothing. Just as Disney could take inspiration from
1914 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. or the Brothers Grimm, the photographer should be
1915 free to capture an image without compensating the source.
1918 Fortunately for Mr. Eastman, and for photography in general, these
1919 early decisions went in favor of the pirates. In general, no
1920 permission would be required before an image could be captured and
1921 shared with others. Instead, permission was presumed. Freedom was the
1922 default. (The law would eventually craft an exception for famous
1923 people: commercial photographers who snap pictures of famous people
1924 for commercial purposes have more restrictions than the rest of
1925 us. But in the ordinary case, the image can be captured without
1926 clearing the rights to do the capturing.
<footnote><para>
1928 See Melville B. Nimmer,
<quote>The Right of Publicity,
</quote> <citetitle>Law and Contemporary
1929 Problems
</citetitle> 19 (
1954):
203; William L. Prosser,
<quote>Privacy,
</quote> <citetitle>California Law
1930 Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1960)
398–407;
<citetitle>White
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Samsung Electronics America,
1931 Inc
</citetitle>.,
971 F.
2d
1395 (
9th Cir.
1992), cert. denied,
508 U.S.
951
1936 We can only speculate about how photography would have developed had
1937 the law gone the other way. If the presumption had been against the
1938 photographer, then the photographer would have had to demonstrate
1939 permission. Perhaps Eastman Kodak would have had to demonstrate
1940 permission, too, before it developed the film upon which images were
1941 captured. After all, if permission were not granted, then Eastman
1942 Kodak would be benefiting from the
<quote>theft
</quote> committed by the
1943 photographer. Just as Napster benefited from the copyright
1944 infringements committed by Napster users, Kodak would be benefiting
1945 from the
<quote>image-right
</quote> infringement of its photographers. We could
1946 imagine the law then requiring that some form of permission be
1947 demonstrated before a company developed pictures. We could imagine a
1948 system developing to demonstrate that permission.
1952 <!-- PAGE BREAK 48 -->
1953 But though we could imagine this system of permission, it would be
1954 very hard to see how photography could have flourished as it did if
1955 the requirement for permission had been built into the rules that
1956 govern it. Photography would have existed. It would have grown in
1957 importance over time. Professionals would have continued to use the
1958 technology as they did
—since professionals could have more
1959 easily borne the burdens of the permission system. But the spread of
1960 photography to ordinary people would not have occurred. Nothing like
1961 that growth would have been realized. And certainly, nothing like that
1962 growth in a democratic technology of expression would have been
1963 realized. If you drive through San Francisco's Presidio, you might
1964 see two gaudy yellow school buses painted over with colorful and
1965 striking images, and the logo
<quote>Just Think!
</quote> in place of the name of a
1966 school. But there's little that's
<quote>just
</quote> cerebral in the projects that
1967 these busses enable. These buses are filled with technologies that
1968 teach kids to tinker with film. Not the film of Eastman. Not even the
1969 film of your VCR. Rather the
<quote>film
</quote> of digital cameras. Just Think!
1970 is a project that enables kids to make films, as a way to understand
1971 and critique the filmed culture that they find all around them. Each
1972 year, these busses travel to more than thirty schools and enable three
1973 hundred to five hundred children to learn something about media by
1974 doing something with media. By doing, they think. By tinkering, they
1977 <indexterm startref=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='endofrange'
/>
1978 <indexterm startref=
"idxphotography" class='endofrange'
/>
1980 These buses are not cheap, but the technology they carry is
1981 increasingly so. The cost of a high-quality digital video system has
1982 fallen dramatically. As one analyst puts it,
<quote>Five years ago, a good
1983 real-time digital video editing system cost $
25,
000. Today you can get
1984 professional quality for $
595.
</quote><footnote><para>
1986 H. Edward Goldberg,
<quote>Essential Presentation Tools: Hardware and
1987 Software You Need to Create Digital Multimedia Presentations,
</quote>
1988 cadalyst, February
2002, available at
1989 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
7</ulink>.
1991 These buses are filled with technology that would have cost hundreds
1992 of thousands just ten years ago. And it is now feasible to imagine not
1993 just buses like this, but classrooms across the country where kids are
1994 learning more and more of something teachers call
<quote>media literacy.
</quote>
1997 <!-- PAGE BREAK 49 -->
1998 <quote>Media literacy,
</quote> as Dave Yanofsky, the executive director of Just
1999 Think!, puts it,
<quote>is the ability
… to understand, analyze, and
2000 deconstruct media images. Its aim is to make [kids] literate about the
2001 way media works, the way it's constructed, the way it's delivered, and
2002 the way people access it.
</quote>
2003 <indexterm><primary>Yanofsky, Dave
</primary></indexterm>
2006 This may seem like an odd way to think about
<quote>literacy.
</quote> For most
2007 people, literacy is about reading and writing. Faulkner and Hemingway
2008 and noticing split infinitives are the things that
<quote>literate
</quote> people know
2011 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
2013 Maybe. But in a world where children see on average
390 hours of
2014 television commercials per year, or between
20,
000 and
45,
000
2015 commercials generally,
<footnote><para>
2017 Judith Van Evra,
<citetitle>Television and Child Development
</citetitle> (Hillsdale, N.J.:
2018 Lawrence Erlbaum Associates,
1990);
<quote>Findings on Family and TV
2019 Study,
</quote> <citetitle>Denver Post
</citetitle>,
25 May
1997, B6.
2021 it is increasingly important to understand the
<quote>grammar
</quote> of media. For
2022 just as there is a grammar for the written word, so, too, is there one
2023 for media. And just as kids learn how to write by writing lots of
2024 terrible prose, kids learn how to write media by constructing lots of
2025 (at least at first) terrible media.
2028 A growing field of academics and activists sees this form of literacy
2029 as crucial to the next generation of culture. For though anyone who
2030 has written understands how difficult writing is
—how difficult
2031 it is to sequence the story, to keep a reader's attention, to craft
2032 language to be understandable
—few of us have any real sense of
2033 how difficult media is. Or more fundamentally, few of us have a sense
2034 of how media works, how it holds an audience or leads it through a
2035 story, how it triggers emotion or builds suspense.
2038 It took filmmaking a generation before it could do these things well.
2039 But even then, the knowledge was in the filming, not in writing about
2040 the film. The skill came from experiencing the making of a film, not
2041 from reading a book about it. One learns to write by writing and then
2042 reflecting upon what one has written. One learns to write with images
2043 by making them and then reflecting upon what one has created.
2045 <indexterm><primary>Crichton, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
2047 This grammar has changed as media has changed. When it was just film,
2048 as Elizabeth Daley, executive director of the University of Southern
2049 California's Annenberg Center for Communication and dean of the
2051 <!-- PAGE BREAK 50 -->
2052 USC School of Cinema-Television, explained to me, the grammar was
2053 about
<quote>the placement of objects, color,
… rhythm, pacing, and
2054 texture.
</quote><footnote>
2057 Interview with Elizabeth Daley and Stephanie Barish,
13 December
2059 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2060 <indexterm><primary>Daley, Elizabeth
</primary></indexterm>
2062 But as computers open up an interactive space where a story is
2063 <quote>played
</quote> as well as experienced, that grammar changes. The simple
2064 control of narrative is lost, and so other techniques are necessary. Author
2065 Michael Crichton had mastered the narrative of science fiction.
2066 But when he tried to design a computer game based on one of his
2067 works, it was a new craft he had to learn. How to lead people through
2068 a game without their feeling they have been led was not obvious, even
2069 to a wildly successful author.
<footnote><para>
2071 See Scott Steinberg,
<quote>Crichton Gets Medieval on PCs,
</quote> E!online,
4
2072 November
2000, available at
2073 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
8</ulink>;
<quote>Timeline,
</quote> 22 November
2000,
2075 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
9</ulink>.
2078 <indexterm><primary>computer games
</primary></indexterm>
2080 This skill is precisely the craft a filmmaker learns. As Daley
2081 describes,
<quote>people are very surprised about how they are led through a
2082 film. [I]t is perfectly constructed to keep you from seeing it, so you
2083 have no idea. If a filmmaker succeeds you do not know how you were
2084 led.
</quote> If you know you were led through a film, the film has failed.
2087 Yet the push for an expanded literacy
—one that goes beyond text
2088 to include audio and visual elements
—is not about making better
2089 film directors. The aim is not to improve the profession of
2090 filmmaking at all. Instead, as Daley explained,
2094 From my perspective, probably the most important digital divide
2095 is not access to a box. It's the ability to be empowered with the
2096 language that that box works in. Otherwise only a very few people
2097 can write with this language, and all the rest of us are reduced to
2102 <quote>Read-only.
</quote> Passive recipients of culture produced elsewhere.
2103 Couch potatoes. Consumers. This is the world of media from the
2107 The twenty-first century could be different. This is the crucial
2108 point: It could be both read and write. Or at least reading and better
2109 understanding the craft of writing. Or best, reading and understanding
2110 the tools that enable the writing to lead or mislead. The aim of any
2112 <!-- PAGE BREAK 51 -->
2113 and this literacy in particular, is to
<quote>empower people to choose the
2114 appropriate language for what they need to create or
2115 express.
</quote><footnote>
2118 Interview with Daley and Barish.
2119 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2120 </para></footnote> It is to enable students
<quote>to communicate in the
2121 language of the twenty-first century.
</quote><footnote><para>
2126 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2128 As with any language, this language comes more easily to some than to
2129 others. It doesn't necessarily come more easily to those who excel in
2130 written language. Daley and Stephanie Barish, director of the
2131 Institute for Multimedia Literacy at the Annenberg Center, describe
2132 one particularly poignant example of a project they ran in a high
2133 school. The high school was a very poor inner-city Los Angeles
2134 school. In all the traditional measures of success, this school was a
2135 failure. But Daley and Barish ran a program that gave kids an
2136 opportunity to use film to express meaning about something the
2137 students know something about
—gun violence.
2140 The class was held on Friday afternoons, and it created a relatively
2141 new problem for the school. While the challenge in most classes was
2142 getting the kids to come, the challenge in this class was keeping them
2143 away. The
<quote>kids were showing up at
6 A.M. and leaving at
5 at night,
</quote>
2144 said Barish. They were working harder than in any other class to do
2145 what education should be about
—learning how to express themselves.
2148 Using whatever
<quote>free web stuff they could find,
</quote> and relatively simple
2149 tools to enable the kids to mix
<quote>image, sound, and text,
</quote> Barish said
2150 this class produced a series of projects that showed something about
2151 gun violence that few would otherwise understand. This was an issue
2152 close to the lives of these students. The project
<quote>gave them a tool
2153 and empowered them to be able to both understand it and talk about
2154 it,
</quote> Barish explained. That tool succeeded in creating
2155 expression
—far more successfully and powerfully than could have
2156 been created using only text.
<quote>If you had said to these students, `you
2157 have to do it in text,' they would've just thrown their hands up and
2158 gone and done something else,
</quote> Barish described, in part, no doubt,
2159 because expressing themselves in text is not something these students
2160 can do well. Yet neither is text a form in which
2161 <emphasis>these
</emphasis> ideas can be expressed well. The power of
2162 this message depended upon its connection to this form of expression.
2166 <!-- PAGE BREAK 52 -->
2167 <quote>But isn't education about teaching kids to write?
</quote> I asked. In part,
2168 of course, it is. But why are we teaching kids to write? Education,
2169 Daley explained, is about giving students a way of
<quote>constructing
2170 meaning.
</quote> To say that that means just writing is like saying teaching
2171 writing is only about teaching kids how to spell. Text is one
2172 part
—and increasingly, not the most powerful part
—of
2173 constructing meaning. As Daley explained in the most moving part of
2178 What you want is to give these students ways of constructing
2179 meaning. If all you give them is text, they're not going to do it.
2180 Because they can't. You know, you've got Johnny who can look at a
2181 video, he can play a video game, he can do graffiti all over your
2182 walls, he can take your car apart, and he can do all sorts of other
2183 things. He just can't read your text. So Johnny comes to school and
2184 you say,
<quote>Johnny, you're illiterate. Nothing you can do matters.
</quote>
2185 Well, Johnny then has two choices: He can dismiss you or he [can]
2186 dismiss himself. If his ego is healthy at all, he's going to dismiss
2187 you. [But i]nstead, if you say,
<quote>Well, with all these things that you
2188 can do, let's talk about this issue. Play for me music that you think
2189 reflects that, or show me images that you think reflect that, or draw
2190 for me something that reflects that.
</quote> Not by giving a kid a video
2191 camera and
… saying,
<quote>Let's go have fun with the video camera and
2192 make a little movie.
</quote> But instead, really help you take these elements
2193 that you understand, that are your language, and construct meaning
2194 about the topic.
…
2197 That empowers enormously. And then what happens, of
2198 course, is eventually, as it has happened in all these classes, they
2199 bump up against the fact,
<quote>I need to explain this and I really need
2200 to write something.
</quote> And as one of the teachers told Stephanie,
2201 they would rewrite a paragraph
5,
6,
7,
8 times, till they got it right.
2204 Because they needed to. There was a reason for doing it. They
2205 needed to say something, as opposed to just jumping through
2206 your hoops. They actually needed to use a language that they
2207 <!-- PAGE BREAK 53 -->
2208 didn't speak very well. But they had come to understand that they
2209 had a lot of power with this language.
2211 <!-- FIXME removed a " from the end of the previous paragraph that did
2212 not match with any start quote. -->
2215 When two planes crashed into the World Trade Center, another into the
2216 Pentagon, and a fourth into a Pennsylvania field, all media around the
2217 world shifted to this news. Every moment of just about every day for
2218 that week, and for weeks after, television in particular, and media
2219 generally, retold the story of the events we had just witnessed. The
2220 telling was a retelling, because we had seen the events that were
2221 described. The genius of this awful act of terrorism was that the
2222 delayed second attack was perfectly timed to assure that the whole
2223 world would be watching.
2226 These retellings had an increasingly familiar feel. There was music
2227 scored for the intermissions, and fancy graphics that flashed across
2228 the screen. There was a formula to interviews. There was
<quote>balance,
</quote>
2229 and seriousness. This was news choreographed in the way we have
2230 increasingly come to expect it,
<quote>news as entertainment,
</quote> even if the
2231 entertainment is tragedy.
2233 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
2234 <indexterm><primary>CBS
</primary></indexterm>
2236 But in addition to this produced news about the
<quote>tragedy of September
2237 11,
</quote> those of us tied to the Internet came to see a very different
2238 production as well. The Internet was filled with accounts of the same
2239 events. Yet these Internet accounts had a very different flavor. Some
2240 people constructed photo pages that captured images from around the
2241 world and presented them as slide shows with text. Some offered open
2242 letters. There were sound recordings. There was anger and frustration.
2243 There were attempts to provide context. There was, in short, an
2244 extraordinary worldwide barn raising, in the sense Mike Godwin uses
2245 the term in his book
<citetitle>Cyber Rights
</citetitle>, around a news event that had
2246 captured the attention of the world. There was ABC and CBS, but there
2247 was also the Internet.
2250 I don't mean simply to praise the Internet
—though I do think the
2251 people who supported this form of speech should be praised. I mean
2252 instead to point to a significance in this form of speech. For like a
2253 Kodak, the Internet enables people to capture images. And like in a
2255 <!-- PAGE BREAK 54 -->
2256 by a student on the
<quote>Just Think!
</quote> bus, the visual images could be mixed
2260 But unlike any technology for simply capturing images, the Internet
2261 allows these creations to be shared with an extraordinary number of
2262 people, practically instantaneously. This is something new in our
2263 tradition
—not just that culture can be captured mechanically,
2264 and obviously not just that events are commented upon critically, but
2265 that this mix of captured images, sound, and commentary can be widely
2266 spread practically instantaneously.
2269 September
11 was not an aberration. It was a beginning. Around the
2270 same time, a form of communication that has grown dramatically was
2271 just beginning to come into public consciousness: the Web-log, or
2272 blog. The blog is a kind of public diary, and within some cultures,
2273 such as in Japan, it functions very much like a diary. In those
2274 cultures, it records private facts in a public way
—it's a kind
2275 of electronic
<citetitle>Jerry Springer
</citetitle>, available anywhere in the world.
2278 But in the United States, blogs have taken on a very different
2279 character. There are some who use the space simply to talk about
2280 their private life. But there are many who use the space to engage in
2281 public discourse. Discussing matters of public import, criticizing
2282 others who are mistaken in their views, criticizing politicians about
2283 the decisions they make, offering solutions to problems we all see:
2284 blogs create the sense of a virtual public meeting, but one in which
2285 we don't all hope to be there at the same time and in which
2286 conversations are not necessarily linked. The best of the blog entries
2287 are relatively short; they point directly to words used by others,
2288 criticizing with or adding to them. They are arguably the most
2289 important form of unchoreographed public discourse that we have.
2292 That's a strong statement. Yet it says as much about our democracy as
2293 it does about blogs. This is the part of America that is most
2294 difficult for those of us who love America to accept: Our democracy
2295 has atrophied. Of course we have elections, and most of the time the
2296 courts allow those elections to count. A relatively small number of
2298 <!-- PAGE BREAK 55 -->
2299 in those elections. The cycle of these elections has become totally
2300 professionalized and routinized. Most of us think this is democracy.
2303 But democracy has never just been about elections. Democracy
2304 means rule by the people, but rule means something more than mere
2305 elections. In our tradition, it also means control through reasoned
2306 discourse. This was the idea that captured the imagination of Alexis
2307 de Tocqueville, the nineteenth-century French lawyer who wrote the
2308 most important account of early
<quote>Democracy in America.
</quote> It wasn't
2309 popular elections that fascinated him
—it was the jury, an
2310 institution that gave ordinary people the right to choose life or
2311 death for other citizens. And most fascinating for him was that the
2312 jury didn't just vote about the outcome they would impose. They
2313 deliberated. Members argued about the
<quote>right
</quote> result; they tried to
2314 persuade each other of the
<quote>right
</quote> result, and in criminal cases at
2315 least, they had to agree upon a unanimous result for the process to
2316 come to an end.
<footnote><para>
2318 See, for example, Alexis de Tocqueville,
<citetitle>Democracy in America
</citetitle>,
2319 bk.
1, trans. Henry Reeve (New York: Bantam Books,
2000), ch.
16.
2323 Yet even this institution flags in American life today. And in its
2324 place, there is no systematic effort to enable citizen deliberation. Some
2325 are pushing to create just such an institution.
<footnote><para>
2327 Bruce Ackerman and James Fishkin,
<quote>Deliberation Day,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of
2328 Political Philosophy
</citetitle> 10 (
2) (
2002):
129.
2330 And in some towns in New England, something close to deliberation
2331 remains. But for most of us for most of the time, there is no time or
2332 place for
<quote>democratic deliberation
</quote> to occur.
2335 More bizarrely, there is generally not even permission for it to
2336 occur. We, the most powerful democracy in the world, have developed a
2337 strong norm against talking about politics. It's fine to talk about
2338 politics with people you agree with. But it is rude to argue about
2339 politics with people you disagree with. Political discourse becomes
2340 isolated, and isolated discourse becomes more extreme.
<footnote><para>
2342 Cass Sunstein,
<citetitle>Republic.com
</citetitle> (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
2001),
2343 65–80,
175,
182,
183,
192.
2344 </para></footnote> We say what our friends want to hear, and hear very
2345 little beyond what our friends say.
2348 Enter the blog. The blog's very architecture solves one part of this
2349 problem. People post when they want to post, and people read when they
2350 want to read. The most difficult time is synchronous time.
2351 Technologies that enable asynchronous communication, such as e-mail,
2352 increase the opportunity for communication. Blogs allow for public
2354 <!-- PAGE BREAK 56 -->
2355 discourse without the public ever needing to gather in a single public
2359 But beyond architecture, blogs also have solved the problem of
2360 norms. There's no norm (yet) in blog space not to talk about politics.
2361 Indeed, the space is filled with political speech, on both the right and
2362 the left. Some of the most popular sites are conservative or libertarian,
2363 but there are many of all political stripes. And even blogs that are not
2364 political cover political issues when the occasion merits.
2367 The significance of these blogs is tiny now, though not so tiny. The
2368 name Howard Dean may well have faded from the
2004 presidential race
2369 but for blogs. Yet even if the number of readers is small, the reading
2370 is having an effect.
2371 <indexterm><primary>Dean, Howard
</primary></indexterm>
2374 One direct effect is on stories that had a different life cycle in the
2375 mainstream media. The Trent Lott affair is an example. When Lott
2376 <quote>misspoke
</quote> at a party for Senator Strom Thurmond, essentially praising
2377 Thurmond's segregationist policies, he calculated correctly that this
2378 story would disappear from the mainstream press within forty-eight
2379 hours. It did. But he didn't calculate its life cycle in blog
2380 space. The bloggers kept researching the story. Over time, more and
2381 more instances of the same
<quote>misspeaking
</quote> emerged. Finally, the story
2382 broke back into the mainstream press. In the end, Lott was forced to
2383 resign as senate majority leader.
<footnote><para>
2385 Noah Shachtman,
<quote>With Incessant Postings, a Pundit Stirs the Pot,
</quote> New
2386 York Times,
16 January
2003, G5.
2388 <indexterm><primary>Lott, Trent
</primary></indexterm>
2391 This different cycle is possible because the same commercial pressures
2392 don't exist with blogs as with other ventures. Television and
2393 newspapers are commercial entities. They must work to keep attention.
2394 If they lose readers, they lose revenue. Like sharks, they must move
2398 But bloggers don't have a similar constraint. They can obsess, they
2399 can focus, they can get serious. If a particular blogger writes a
2400 particularly interesting story, more and more people link to that
2401 story. And as the number of links to a particular story increases, it
2402 rises in the ranks of stories. People read what is popular; what is
2403 popular has been selected by a very democratic process of
2404 peer-generated rankings.
2406 <indexterm id=
"idxwinerdave" class='startofrange'
>
2407 <primary>Winer, Dave
</primary>
2410 There's a second way, as well, in which blogs have a different cycle
2411 <!-- PAGE BREAK 57 -->
2412 from the mainstream press. As Dave Winer, one of the fathers of this
2413 movement and a software author for many decades, told me, another
2414 difference is the absence of a financial
<quote>conflict of interest.
</quote> <quote>I think you
2415 have to take the conflict of interest
</quote> out of journalism, Winer told me.
2416 <quote>An amateur journalist simply doesn't have a conflict of interest, or the
2417 conflict of interest is so easily disclosed that you know you can sort of
2418 get it out of the way.
</quote>
2420 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2422 These conflicts become more important as media becomes more
2423 concentrated (more on this below). A concentrated media can hide more
2424 from the public than an unconcentrated media can
—as CNN admitted
2425 it did after the Iraq war because it was afraid of the consequences to
2426 its own employees.
<footnote><para>
2428 Telephone interview with David Winer,
16 April
2003.
2430 It also needs to sustain a more coherent account. (In the middle of
2431 the Iraq war, I read a post on the Internet from someone who was at
2432 that time listening to a satellite uplink with a reporter in Iraq. The
2433 New York headquarters was telling the reporter over and over that her
2434 account of the war was too bleak: She needed to offer a more
2435 optimistic story. When she told New York that wasn't warranted, they
2436 told her that
<emphasis>they
</emphasis> were writing
<quote>the story.
</quote>)
2438 <para> Blog space gives amateurs a way to enter the
2439 debate
—<quote>amateur
</quote> not in the sense of inexperienced, but in the
2440 sense of an Olympic athlete, meaning not paid by anyone to give their
2441 reports. It allows for a much broader range of input into a story, as
2442 reporting on the Columbia disaster revealed, when hundreds from across
2443 the southwest United States turned to the Internet to retell what they
2444 had seen.
<footnote><para>
2446 John Schwartz,
<quote>Loss of the Shuttle: The Internet; A Wealth of
2447 Information Online,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
2 February
2003, A28; Staci
2448 D. Kramer,
<quote>Shuttle Disaster Coverage Mixed, but Strong Overall,
</quote>
2449 Online Journalism Review,
2 February
2003, available at
2450 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
10</ulink>.
2452 And it drives readers to read across the range of accounts and
2453 <quote>triangulate,
</quote> as Winer puts it, the truth. Blogs, Winer says, are
2454 <quote>communicating directly with our constituency, and the middle man is
2455 out of it
</quote>—with all the benefits, and costs, that might entail.
2458 Winer is optimistic about the future of journalism infected
2459 with blogs.
<quote>It's going to become an essential skill,
</quote> Winer predicts,
2460 for public figures and increasingly for private figures as well. It's
2461 not clear that
<quote>journalism
</quote> is happy about this
—some journalists
2462 have been told to curtail their blogging.
<footnote>
2465 See Michael Falcone,
<quote>Does an Editor's Pencil Ruin a Web Log?
</quote> <citetitle>New
2466 York Times
</citetitle>,
29 September
2003, C4. (
<quote>Not all news organizations have
2467 been as accepting of employees who blog. Kevin Sites, a CNN
2468 correspondent in Iraq who started a blog about his reporting of the
2469 war on March
9, stopped posting
12 days later at his bosses'
2470 request. Last year Steve Olafson, a
<citetitle>Houston Chronicle
</citetitle> reporter, was
2471 fired for keeping a personal Web log, published under a pseudonym,
2472 that dealt with some of the issues and people he was covering.
</quote>)
2473 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2474 <indexterm><primary>Olafson, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
2476 But it is clear that we are still in transition.
<quote>A
2478 <!-- PAGE BREAK 58 -->
2479 lot of what we are doing now is warm-up exercises,
</quote> Winer told me.
2480 There is a lot that must mature before this space has its mature effect.
2481 And as the inclusion of content in this space is the least infringing use
2482 of the Internet (meaning infringing on copyright), Winer said,
<quote>we will
2483 be the last thing that gets shut down.
</quote>
2486 This speech affects democracy. Winer thinks that happens because
<quote>you
2487 don't have to work for somebody who controls, [for] a gatekeeper.
</quote>
2488 That is true. But it affects democracy in another way as well. As
2489 more and more citizens express what they think, and defend it in
2490 writing, that will change the way people understand public issues. It
2491 is easy to be wrong and misguided in your head. It is harder when the
2492 product of your mind can be criticized by others. Of course, it is a
2493 rare human who admits that he has been persuaded that he is wrong. But
2494 it is even rarer for a human to ignore when he has been proven wrong.
2495 The writing of ideas, arguments, and criticism improves democracy.
2496 Today there are probably a couple of million blogs where such writing
2497 happens. When there are ten million, there will be something
2498 extraordinary to report.
2500 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinerdave" class='endofrange'
/>
2501 <indexterm id=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='startofrange'
>
2502 <primary>Brown, John Seely
</primary>
2504 <indexterm id='idxadvertising1' class='startofrange'
>
2505 <primary>advertising
</primary>
2508 John Seely Brown is the chief scientist of the Xerox Corporation.
2509 His work, as his Web site describes it, is
<quote>human learning and
… the
2510 creation of knowledge ecologies for creating
… innovation.
</quote>
2513 Brown thus looks at these technologies of digital creativity a bit
2514 differently from the perspectives I've sketched so far. I'm sure he
2515 would be excited about any technology that might improve
2516 democracy. But his real excitement comes from how these technologies
2520 As Brown believes, we learn by tinkering. When
<quote>a lot of us grew up,
</quote>
2521 he explains, that tinkering was done
<quote>on motorcycle engines, lawnmower
2522 engines, automobiles, radios, and so on.
</quote> But digital technologies
2523 enable a different kind of tinkering
—with abstract ideas though
2524 in concrete form. The kids at Just Think! not only think about how a
2525 commercial portrays a politician; using digital technology, they can
2526 <!-- PAGE BREAK 59 -->
2527 take the commercial apart and manipulate it, tinker with it to see how
2528 it does what it does. Digital technologies launch a kind of bricolage,
2529 or
<quote>free collage,
</quote> as Brown calls it. Many get to add to or transform
2530 the tinkering of many others.
2533 The best large-scale example of this kind of tinkering so far is free
2534 software or open-source software (FS/OSS). FS/OSS is software whose
2535 source code is shared. Anyone can download the technology that makes a
2536 FS/OSS program run. And anyone eager to learn how a particular bit of
2537 FS/OSS technology works can tinker with the code.
2540 This opportunity creates a
<quote>completely new kind of learning platform,
</quote>
2541 as Brown describes.
<quote>As soon as you start doing that, you
…
2542 unleash a free collage on the community, so that other people can
2543 start looking at your code, tinkering with it, trying it out, seeing
2544 if they can improve it.
</quote> Each effort is a kind of
2545 apprenticeship.
<quote>Open source becomes a major apprenticeship platform.
</quote>
2548 In this process,
<quote>the concrete things you tinker with are abstract.
2549 They are code.
</quote> Kids are
<quote>shifting to the ability to tinker in the
2550 abstract, and this tinkering is no longer an isolated activity that
2551 you're doing in your garage. You are tinkering with a community
2552 platform.
… You are tinkering with other people's stuff. The more
2553 you tinker the more you improve.
</quote> The more you improve, the more you
2557 This same thing happens with content, too. And it happens in the same
2558 collaborative way when that content is part of the Web. As Brown puts
2559 it,
<quote>the Web [is] the first medium that truly honors multiple forms of
2560 intelligence.
</quote> Earlier technologies, such as the typewriter or word
2561 processors, helped amplify text. But the Web amplifies much more than
2562 text.
<quote>The Web
… says if you are musical, if you are artistic, if
2563 you are visual, if you are interested in film
… [then] there is a
2564 lot you can start to do on this medium. [It] can now amplify and honor
2565 these multiple forms of intelligence.
</quote>
2567 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising1' class='endofrange'
/>
2568 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2570 Brown is talking about what Elizabeth Daley, Stephanie Barish, and
2571 Just Think! teach: that this tinkering with culture teaches as well
2573 <!-- PAGE BREAK 60 -->
2574 as creates. It develops talents differently, and it builds a different
2575 kind of recognition.
2578 Yet the freedom to tinker with these objects is not guaranteed.
2579 Indeed, as we'll see through the course of this book, that freedom is
2580 increasingly highly contested. While there's no doubt that your father
2581 had the right to tinker with the car engine, there's great doubt that
2582 your child will have the right to tinker with the images she finds all
2583 around. The law and, increasingly, technology interfere with a
2584 freedom that technology, and curiosity, would otherwise ensure.
2587 These restrictions have become the focus of researchers and scholars.
2588 Professor Ed Felten of Princeton (whom we'll see more of in chapter
2589 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>)
2590 has developed a powerful argument in favor of the
<quote>right to
2591 tinker
</quote> as it applies to computer science and to knowledge in
2592 general.
<footnote><para>
2594 See, for example, Edward Felten and Andrew Appel,
<quote>Technological Access
2595 Control Interferes with Noninfringing Scholarship,
</quote> <citetitle>Communications
2596 of the Association for Computer Machinery
</citetitle> 43 (
2000):
9.
2598 But Brown's concern is earlier, or younger, or more fundamental. It is
2599 about the learning that kids can do, or can't do, because of the law.
2602 <quote>This is where education in the twenty-first century is going,
</quote> Brown
2603 explains. We need to
<quote>understand how kids who grow up digital think
2604 and want to learn.
</quote>
2607 <quote>Yet,
</quote> as Brown continued, and as the balance of this book will
2608 evince,
<quote>we are building a legal system that completely suppresses the
2609 natural tendencies of today's digital kids.
… We're building an
2610 architecture that unleashes
60 percent of the brain [and] a legal
2611 system that closes down that part of the brain.
</quote>
2613 <indexterm startref=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='endofrange'
/>
2615 We're building a technology that takes the magic of Kodak, mixes
2616 moving images and sound, and adds a space for commentary and an
2617 opportunity to spread that creativity everywhere. But we're building
2618 the law to close down that technology.
2621 <quote>No way to run a culture,
</quote> as Brewster Kahle, whom we'll meet in
2622 chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"collectors"/>,
2623 quipped to me in a rare moment of despondence.
2625 <!-- PAGE BREAK 61 -->
2627 <chapter label=
"3" id=
"catalogs">
2628 <title>CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
</title>
2629 <indexterm><primary>RPI
</primary><see>Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute (RPI)
</see></indexterm>
2630 <indexterm id=
"idxrensselaer" class='startofrange'
>
2631 <primary>Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute (RPI)
</primary>
2634 In the fall of
2002, Jesse Jordan of Oceanside, New York, enrolled as
2635 a freshman at Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, in Troy, New York.
2636 His major at RPI was information technology. Though he is not a
2637 programmer, in October Jesse decided to begin to tinker with search
2638 engine technology that was available on the RPI network.
2641 RPI is one of America's foremost technological research institutions.
2642 It offers degrees in fields ranging from architecture and engineering
2643 to information sciences. More than
65 percent of its five thousand
2644 undergraduates finished in the top
10 percent of their high school
2645 class. The school is thus a perfect mix of talent and experience to
2646 imagine and then build, a generation for the network age.
2649 RPI's computer network links students, faculty, and administration to
2650 one another. It also links RPI to the Internet. Not everything
2651 available on the RPI network is available on the Internet. But the
2652 network is designed to enable students to get access to the Internet,
2653 as well as more intimate access to other members of the RPI community.
2656 Search engines are a measure of a network's intimacy. Google
2657 <!-- PAGE BREAK 62 -->
2658 brought the Internet much closer to all of us by fantastically
2659 improving the quality of search on the network. Specialty search
2660 engines can do this even better. The idea of
<quote>intranet
</quote> search
2661 engines, search engines that search within the network of a particular
2662 institution, is to provide users of that institution with better
2663 access to material from that institution. Businesses do this all the
2664 time, enabling employees to have access to material that people
2665 outside the business can't get. Universities do it as well.
2668 These engines are enabled by the network technology itself.
2669 Microsoft, for example, has a network file system that makes it very
2670 easy for search engines tuned to that network to query the system for
2671 information about the publicly (within that network) available
2672 content. Jesse's search engine was built to take advantage of this
2673 technology. It used Microsoft's network file system to build an index
2674 of all the files available within the RPI network.
2677 Jesse's wasn't the first search engine built for the RPI network.
2678 Indeed, his engine was a simple modification of engines that others
2679 had built. His single most important improvement over those engines
2680 was to fix a bug within the Microsoft file-sharing system that could
2681 cause a user's computer to crash. With the engines that existed
2682 before, if you tried to access a file through a Windows browser that
2683 was on a computer that was off-line, your computer could crash. Jesse
2684 modified the system a bit to fix that problem, by adding a button that
2685 a user could click to see if the machine holding the file was still
2689 Jesse's engine went on-line in late October. Over the following six
2690 months, he continued to tweak it to improve its functionality. By
2691 March, the system was functioning quite well. Jesse had more than one
2692 million files in his directory, including every type of content that might
2693 be on users' computers.
2696 Thus the index his search engine produced included pictures, which
2697 students could use to put on their own Web sites; copies of notes or
2698 research; copies of information pamphlets; movie clips that students
2699 might have created; university brochures
—basically anything that
2700 <!-- PAGE BREAK 63 -->
2701 users of the RPI network made available in a public folder of their
2705 But the index also included music files. In fact, one quarter of the
2706 files that Jesse's search engine listed were music files. But that
2707 means, of course, that three quarters were not, and
—so that this
2708 point is absolutely clear
—Jesse did nothing to induce people to
2709 put music files in their public folders. He did nothing to target the
2710 search engine to these files. He was a kid tinkering with a
2711 Google-like technology at a university where he was studying
2712 information science, and hence, tinkering was the aim. Unlike Google,
2713 or Microsoft, for that matter, he made no money from this tinkering;
2714 he was not connected to any business that would make any money from
2715 this experiment. He was a kid tinkering with technology in an
2716 environment where tinkering with technology was precisely what he was
2720 On April
3,
2003, Jesse was contacted by the dean of students at
2721 RPI. The dean informed Jesse that the Recording Industry Association
2722 of America, the RIAA, would be filing a lawsuit against him and three
2723 other students whom he didn't even know, two of them at other
2724 universities. A few hours later, Jesse was served with papers from
2725 the suit. As he read these papers and watched the news reports about
2726 them, he was increasingly astonished.
2729 <quote>It was absurd,
</quote> he told me.
<quote>I don't think I did anything
2730 wrong.
… I don't think there's anything wrong with the search
2731 engine that I ran or
… what I had done to it. I mean, I hadn't
2732 modified it in any way that promoted or enhanced the work of
2733 pirates. I just modified the search engine in a way that would make it
2734 easier to use
</quote>—again, a
<emphasis>search engine
</emphasis>,
2735 which Jesse had not himself built, using the Windows filesharing
2736 system, which Jesse had not himself built, to enable members of the
2737 RPI community to get access to content, which Jesse had not himself
2738 created or posted, and the vast majority of which had nothing to do
2742 But the RIAA branded Jesse a pirate. They claimed he operated a
2743 network and had therefore
<quote>willfully
</quote> violated copyright laws. They
2744 <!-- PAGE BREAK 64 -->
2745 demanded that he pay them the damages for his wrong. For cases of
2746 <quote>willful infringement,
</quote> the Copyright Act specifies something lawyers
2747 call
<quote>statutory damages.
</quote> These damages permit a copyright owner to
2748 claim $
150,
000 per infringement. As the RIAA alleged more than one
2749 hundred specific copyright infringements, they therefore demanded that
2750 Jesse pay them at least $
15,
000,
000.
2753 Similar lawsuits were brought against three other students: one other
2754 student at RPI, one at Michigan Technical University, and one at
2755 Princeton. Their situations were similar to Jesse's. Though each case
2756 was different in detail, the bottom line in each was exactly the same:
2757 huge demands for
<quote>damages
</quote> that the RIAA claimed it was entitled to.
2758 If you added up the claims, these four lawsuits were asking courts in
2759 the United States to award the plaintiffs close to $
100
2760 <emphasis>billion
</emphasis>—six times the
2761 <emphasis>total
</emphasis> profit of the film industry in
2762 2001.
<footnote><para>
2765 Tim Goral,
<quote>Recording Industry Goes After Campus P-
2-P Networks:
2766 Suit Alleges $
97.8 Billion in Damages,
</quote> <citetitle>Professional Media Group LCC
</citetitle> 6
2767 (
2003):
5, available at
2003 WL
55179443.
2770 <indexterm startref=
"idxrensselaer" class='endofrange'
/>
2772 Jesse called his parents. They were supportive but a bit frightened.
2773 An uncle was a lawyer. He began negotiations with the RIAA. They
2774 demanded to know how much money Jesse had. Jesse had saved
2775 $
12,
000 from summer jobs and other employment. They demanded
2776 $
12,
000 to dismiss the case.
2778 <indexterm><primary>Oppenheimer, Matt
</primary></indexterm>
2780 The RIAA wanted Jesse to admit to doing something wrong. He
2781 refused. They wanted him to agree to an injunction that would
2782 essentially make it impossible for him to work in many fields of
2783 technology for the rest of his life. He refused. They made him
2784 understand that this process of being sued was not going to be
2785 pleasant. (As Jesse's father recounted to me, the chief lawyer on the
2786 case, Matt Oppenheimer, told Jesse,
<quote>You don't want to pay another
2787 visit to a dentist like me.
</quote>) And throughout, the RIAA insisted it
2788 would not settle the case until it took every penny Jesse had saved.
2791 Jesse's family was outraged at these claims. They wanted to fight.
2792 But Jesse's uncle worked to educate the family about the nature of the
2793 American legal system. Jesse could fight the RIAA. He might even
2794 win. But the cost of fighting a lawsuit like this, Jesse was told, would be
2795 at least $
250,
000. If he won, he would not recover that money. If he
2796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 65 -->
2797 won, he would have a piece of paper saying he had won, and a piece of
2798 paper saying he and his family were bankrupt.
2801 So Jesse faced a mafia-like choice: $
250,
000 and a chance at winning,
2802 or $
12,
000 and a settlement.
2805 The recording industry insists this is a matter of law and morality.
2806 Let's put the law aside for a moment and think about the morality.
2807 Where is the morality in a lawsuit like this? What is the virtue in
2808 scapegoatism? The RIAA is an extraordinarily powerful lobby. The
2809 president of the RIAA is reported to make more than $
1 million a year.
2810 Artists, on the other hand, are not well paid. The average recording
2811 artist makes $
45,
900.
<footnote><para>
2813 Occupational Employment Survey, U.S. Dept. of Labor (
2001)
2814 (
27–2042—Musicians and Singers). See also National Endowment for
2815 the Arts,
<citetitle>More Than One in a Blue Moon
</citetitle> (
2000).
2817 There are plenty of ways for the RIAA to affect
2818 and direct policy. So where is the morality in taking money from a
2819 student for running a search engine?
<footnote><para>
2821 Douglas Lichtman makes a related point in
<quote>KaZaA and Punishment,
</quote>
2822 <citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, A24.
2826 On June
23, Jesse wired his savings to the lawyer working for the
2827 RIAA. The case against him was then dismissed. And with this, this
2828 kid who had tinkered a computer into a $
15 million lawsuit became an
2833 I was definitely not an activist [before]. I never really meant to be
2834 an activist.
… [But] I've been pushed into this. In no way did I
2835 ever foresee anything like this, but I think it's just completely
2836 absurd what the RIAA has done.
2840 Jesse's parents betray a certain pride in their reluctant activist. As
2841 his father told me, Jesse
<quote>considers himself very conservative, and so do
2842 I.
… He's not a tree hugger.
… I think it's bizarre that they would
2843 pick on him. But he wants to let people know that they're sending the
2844 wrong message. And he wants to correct the record.
</quote>
2846 <!-- PAGE BREAK 66 -->
2848 <chapter label=
"4" id=
"pirates">
2849 <title>CHAPTER FOUR:
<quote>Pirates
</quote></title>
2851 If
<quote>piracy
</quote> means using the creative property of others without
2852 their permission
—if
<quote>if value, then right
</quote> is true
—then the history of
2853 the content industry is a history of piracy. Every important sector of
2854 <quote>big media
</quote> today
—film, records, radio, and cable TV
—was born of a
2855 kind of piracy so defined. The consistent story is how last generation's
2856 pirates join this generation's country club
—until now.
2861 The film industry of Hollywood was built by fleeing pirates.
<footnote><para>
2863 I am grateful to Peter DiMauro for pointing me to this extraordinary
2864 history. See also Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
87–93,
2865 which details Edison's
<quote>adventures
</quote> with copyright and patent.
2866 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
2868 Creators and directors migrated from the East Coast to California in
2869 the early twentieth century in part to escape controls that patents
2870 granted the inventor of filmmaking, Thomas Edison. These controls were
2871 exercised through a monopoly
<quote>trust,
</quote> the Motion Pictures Patents
2872 Company, and were based on Thomas Edison's creative
2873 property
—patents. Edison formed the MPPC to exercise the rights
2874 this creative property
2875 <!-- PAGE BREAK 67 -->
2876 gave him, and the MPPC was serious about the control it demanded.
2879 As one commentator tells one part of the story,
2883 A January
1909 deadline was set for all companies to comply with
2884 the license. By February, unlicensed outlaws, who referred to
2885 themselves as independents protested the trust and carried on
2886 business without submitting to the Edison monopoly. In the
2887 summer of
1909 the independent movement was in full-swing,
2888 with producers and theater owners using illegal equipment and
2889 imported film stock to create their own underground market.
2892 With the country experiencing a tremendous expansion in the number of
2893 nickelodeons, the Patents Company reacted to the independent movement
2894 by forming a strong-arm subsidiary known as the General Film Company
2895 to block the entry of non-licensed independents. With coercive tactics
2896 that have become legendary, General Film confiscated unlicensed
2897 equipment, discontinued product supply to theaters which showed
2898 unlicensed films, and effectively monopolized distribution with the
2899 acquisition of all U.S. film exchanges, except for the one owned by
2900 the independent William Fox who defied the Trust even after his
2901 license was revoked.
<footnote><para>
2903 J. A. Aberdeen,
<citetitle>Hollywood Renegades: The Society of Independent Motion
2904 Picture Producers
</citetitle> (Cobblestone Entertainment,
2000) and expanded texts
2905 posted at
<quote>The Edison Movie Monopoly: The Motion Picture Patents
2906 Company vs. the Independent Outlaws,
</quote> available at
2907 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
11</ulink>. For a
2908 discussion of the economic motive behind both these limits and the
2909 limits imposed by Victor on phonographs, see Randal C. Picker,
<quote>From
2910 Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and
2911 the Propertization of Copyright
</quote> (September
2002), University of
2912 Chicago Law School, James M. Olin Program in Law and Economics,
2913 Working Paper No.
159.
</para></footnote>
2914 <indexterm><primary>Fox, William
</primary></indexterm>
2915 <indexterm><primary>General Film Company
</primary></indexterm>
2916 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
2920 The Napsters of those days, the
<quote>independents,
</quote> were companies like
2921 Fox. And no less than today, these independents were vigorously
2922 resisted.
<quote>Shooting was disrupted by machinery stolen, and
2923 `accidents' resulting in loss of negatives, equipment, buildings and
2924 sometimes life and limb frequently occurred.
</quote><footnote><para>
2926 Marc Wanamaker,
<quote>The First Studios,
</quote> <citetitle>The Silents Majority
</citetitle>, archived at
2927 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
12</ulink>.
2929 That led the independents to flee the East
2930 Coast. California was remote enough from Edison's reach that
2931 filmmakers there could pirate his inventions without fear of the
2932 law. And the leaders of Hollywood filmmaking, Fox most prominently,
2936 Of course, California grew quickly, and the effective enforcement
2937 of federal law eventually spread west. But because patents grant the
2938 patent holder a truly
<quote>limited
</quote> monopoly (just seventeen years at that
2940 <!-- PAGE BREAK 68 -->
2941 time), by the time enough federal marshals appeared, the patents had
2942 expired. A new industry had been born, in part from the piracy of
2943 Edison's creative property.
2946 <section id=
"recordedmusic">
2947 <title>Recorded Music
</title>
2949 The record industry was born of another kind of piracy, though to see
2950 how requires a bit of detail about the way the law regulates music.
2952 <indexterm id=
"idxfourneauxhenri" class='startofrange'
>
2953 <primary>Fourneaux, Henri
</primary>
2955 <indexterm><primary>Russel, Phil
</primary></indexterm>
2957 At the time that Edison and Henri Fourneaux invented machines
2958 for reproducing music (Edison the phonograph, Fourneaux the player
2959 piano), the law gave composers the exclusive right to control copies of
2960 their music and the exclusive right to control public performances of
2961 their music. In other words, in
1900, if I wanted a copy of Phil Russel's
2962 1899 hit
<quote>Happy Mose,
</quote> the law said I would have to pay for the right
2963 to get a copy of the musical score, and I would also have to pay for the
2964 right to perform it publicly.
2966 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2968 But what if I wanted to record
<quote>Happy Mose,
</quote> using Edison's phonograph
2969 or Fourneaux's player piano? Here the law stumbled. It was clear
2970 enough that I would have to buy any copy of the musical score that I
2971 performed in making this recording. And it was clear enough that I
2972 would have to pay for any public performance of the work I was
2973 recording. But it wasn't totally clear that I would have to pay for a
2974 <quote>public performance
</quote> if I recorded the song in my own house (even
2975 today, you don't owe the Beatles anything if you sing their songs in
2976 the shower), or if I recorded the song from memory (copies in your
2977 brain are not
—yet
— regulated by copyright law). So if I
2978 simply sang the song into a recording device in the privacy of my own
2979 home, it wasn't clear that I owed the composer anything. And more
2980 importantly, it wasn't clear whether I owed the composer anything if I
2981 then made copies of those recordings. Because of this gap in the law,
2982 then, I could effectively pirate someone else's song without paying
2983 its composer anything.
2985 <indexterm startref=
"idxfourneauxhenri" class='endofrange'
/>
2987 The composers (and publishers) were none too happy about
2988 <!-- PAGE BREAK 69 -->
2989 this capacity to pirate. As South Dakota senator Alfred Kittredge
2991 <indexterm><primary>Kittredge, Alfred
</primary></indexterm>
2995 Imagine the injustice of the thing. A composer writes a song or an
2996 opera. A publisher buys at great expense the rights to the same and
2997 copyrights it. Along come the phonographic companies and companies who
2998 cut music rolls and deliberately steal the work of the brain of the
2999 composer and publisher without any regard for [their]
3000 rights.
<footnote><para>
3002 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright: Hearings on
3003 S.
6330 and H.R.
19853 Before the ( Joint) Committees on Patents,
59th
3004 Cong.
59,
1st sess. (
1906) (statement of Senator Alfred B. Kittredge,
3005 of South Dakota, chairman), reprinted in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
3006 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and Abe Goldman, eds. (South
3007 Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
3008 <indexterm><primary>Kittredge, Alfred
</primary></indexterm>
3013 The innovators who developed the technology to record other
3014 people's works were
<quote>sponging upon the toil, the work, the talent, and
3015 genius of American composers,
</quote><footnote><para>
3017 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
223
3018 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
3020 and the
<quote>music publishing industry
</quote>
3021 was thereby
<quote>at the complete mercy of this one pirate.
</quote><footnote><para>
3023 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
226
3024 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
3027 Sousa put it, in as direct a way as possible,
<quote>When they make money
3028 out of my pieces, I want a share of it.
</quote><footnote><para>
3030 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
23
3031 (statement of John Philip Sousa, composer).
3035 These arguments have familiar echoes in the wars of our day. So, too,
3036 do the arguments on the other side. The innovators who developed the
3037 player piano argued that
<quote>it is perfectly demonstrable that the
3038 introduction of automatic music players has not deprived any composer
3039 of anything he had before their introduction.
</quote> Rather, the machines
3040 increased the sales of sheet music.
<footnote><para>
3043 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
283–84
3044 (statement of Albert Walker, representative of the Auto-Music
3045 Perforating Company of New York).
3046 </para></footnote> In any case, the innovators argued, the job of
3047 Congress was
<quote>to consider first the interest of [the public], whom
3048 they represent, and whose servants they are.
</quote> <quote>All talk about
3049 `theft,'
</quote> the general counsel of the American Graphophone Company
3050 wrote,
<quote>is the merest claptrap, for there exists no property in ideas
3051 musical, literary or artistic, except as defined by
3052 statute.
</quote><footnote><para>
3054 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
376 (prepared
3055 memorandum of Philip Mauro, general patent counsel of the American
3056 Graphophone Company Association).
3058 <indexterm><primary>American Graphophone Company
</primary></indexterm>
3061 The law soon resolved this battle in favor of the composer
3062 <emphasis>and
</emphasis> the recording artist. Congress amended the
3063 law to make sure that composers would be paid for the
<quote>mechanical
3064 reproductions
</quote> of their music. But rather than simply granting the
3065 composer complete control over the right to make mechanical
3066 reproductions, Congress gave recording artists a right to record the
3067 music, at a price set by Congress, once the composer allowed it to be
3068 recorded once. This is the part of
3070 <!-- PAGE BREAK 70 -->
3071 copyright law that makes cover songs possible. Once a composer
3072 authorizes a recording of his song, others are free to record the same
3073 song, so long as they pay the original composer a fee set by the law.
3076 American law ordinarily calls this a
<quote>compulsory license,
</quote> but I will
3077 refer to it as a
<quote>statutory license.
</quote> A statutory license is a license
3078 whose key terms are set by law. After Congress's amendment of the
3079 Copyright Act in
1909, record companies were free to distribute copies
3080 of recordings so long as they paid the composer (or copyright holder)
3081 the fee set by the statute.
3084 This is an exception within the law of copyright. When John Grisham
3085 writes a novel, a publisher is free to publish that novel only if
3086 Grisham gives the publisher permission. Grisham, in turn, is free to
3087 charge whatever he wants for that permission. The price to publish
3088 Grisham is thus set by Grisham, and copyright law ordinarily says you
3089 have no permission to use Grisham's work except with permission of
3091 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
3094 But the law governing recordings gives recording artists less. And
3095 thus, in effect, the law
<emphasis>subsidizes
</emphasis> the recording
3096 industry through a kind of piracy
—by giving recording artists a
3097 weaker right than it otherwise gives creative authors. The Beatles
3098 have less control over their creative work than Grisham does. And the
3099 beneficiaries of this less control are the recording industry and the
3100 public. The recording industry gets something of value for less than
3101 it otherwise would pay; the public gets access to a much wider range
3102 of musical creativity. Indeed, Congress was quite explicit about its
3103 reasons for granting this right. Its fear was the monopoly power of
3104 rights holders, and that that power would stifle follow-on
3105 creativity.
<footnote><para>
3108 Copyright Law Revision: Hearings on S.
2499, S.
2900, H.R.
243, and
3109 H.R.
11794 Before the ( Joint) Committee on Patents,
60th Cong.,
1st
3110 sess.,
217 (
1908) (statement of Senator Reed Smoot, chairman), reprinted
3111 in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
1909 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and
3112 Abe Goldman, eds. (South Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
3114 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
3117 While the recording industry has been quite coy about this recently,
3118 historically it has been quite a supporter of the statutory license for
3119 records. As a
1967 report from the House Committee on the Judiciary
3124 the record producers argued vigorously that the compulsory
3125 <!-- PAGE BREAK 71 -->
3126 license system must be retained. They asserted that the record
3127 industry is a half-billion-dollar business of great economic
3128 importance in the United States and throughout the world; records
3129 today are the principal means of disseminating music, and this creates
3130 special problems, since performers need unhampered access to musical
3131 material on nondiscriminatory terms. Historically, the record
3132 producers pointed out, there were no recording rights before
1909 and
3133 the
1909 statute adopted the compulsory license as a deliberate
3134 anti-monopoly condition on the grant of these rights. They argue that
3135 the result has been an outpouring of recorded music, with the public
3136 being given lower prices, improved quality, and a greater
3137 choice.
<footnote><para>
3139 Copyright Law Revision: Report to Accompany H.R.
2512, House Committee
3140 on the Judiciary,
90th Cong.,
1st sess., House Document no.
83, (
8
3141 March
1967). I am grateful to Glenn Brown for drawing my attention to
3142 this report.
</para></footnote>
3146 By limiting the rights musicians have, by partially pirating their
3147 creative work, the record producers, and the public, benefit.
3150 <section id=
"radio">
3151 <title>Radio
</title>
3153 Radio was also born of piracy.
3156 When a radio station plays a record on the air, that constitutes a
3157 <quote>public performance
</quote> of the composer's work.
<footnote><para>
3159 See
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, sections
106 and
110. At the beginning,
3160 record companies printed
<quote>Not Licensed for Radio Broadcast
</quote> and other
3161 messages purporting to restrict the ability to play a record on a
3162 radio station. Judge Learned Hand rejected the argument that a
3163 warning attached to a record might restrict the rights of the radio
3164 station. See
<citetitle>RCA Manufacturing Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Whiteman
</citetitle>,
114 F.
2d
86 (
2nd
3165 Cir.
1940). See also Randal C. Picker,
<quote>From Edison to the Broadcast
3166 Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and the Propertization of
3167 Copyright,
</quote> <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
281.
3168 <indexterm><primary>Hand, Learned
</primary></indexterm>
3169 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
3171 As I described above, the law gives the composer (or copyright holder)
3172 an exclusive right to public performances of his work. The radio
3173 station thus owes the composer money for that performance.
3176 But when the radio station plays a record, it is not only performing a
3177 copy of the
<emphasis>composer's
</emphasis> work. The radio station is
3178 also performing a copy of the
<emphasis>recording artist's
</emphasis>
3179 work. It's one thing to have
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> sung on the radio by the
3180 local children's choir; it's quite another to have it sung by the
3181 Rolling Stones or Lyle Lovett. The recording artist is adding to the
3182 value of the composition performed on the radio station. And if the
3183 law were perfectly consistent, the radio station would have to pay the
3184 recording artist for his work, just as it pays the composer of the
3186 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
3188 <!-- PAGE BREAK 72 -->
3191 But it doesn't. Under the law governing radio performances, the radio
3192 station does not have to pay the recording artist. The radio station
3193 need only pay the composer. The radio station thus gets a bit of
3194 something for nothing. It gets to perform the recording artist's work
3195 for free, even if it must pay the composer something for the privilege
3196 of playing the song.
3198 <indexterm id=
"idxmadonna" class='startofrange'
>
3199 <primary>Madonna
</primary>
3202 This difference can be huge. Imagine you compose a piece of music.
3203 Imagine it is your first. You own the exclusive right to authorize
3204 public performances of that music. So if Madonna wants to sing your
3205 song in public, she has to get your permission.
3208 Imagine she does sing your song, and imagine she likes it a lot. She
3209 then decides to make a recording of your song, and it becomes a top
3210 hit. Under our law, every time a radio station plays your song, you
3211 get some money. But Madonna gets nothing, save the indirect effect on
3212 the sale of her CDs. The public performance of her recording is not a
3213 <quote>protected
</quote> right. The radio station thus gets to
3214 <emphasis>pirate
</emphasis> the value of Madonna's work without paying
3217 <indexterm startref=
"idxmadonna" class='endofrange'
/>
3219 No doubt, one might argue that, on balance, the recording artists
3220 benefit. On average, the promotion they get is worth more than the
3221 performance rights they give up. Maybe. But even if so, the law
3222 ordinarily gives the creator the right to make this choice. By making
3223 the choice for him or her, the law gives the radio station the right
3224 to take something for nothing.
3227 <section id=
"cabletv">
3228 <title>Cable TV
</title>
3231 Cable TV was also born of a kind of piracy.
3234 When cable entrepreneurs first started wiring communities with cable
3235 television in
1948, most refused to pay broadcasters for the content
3236 that they echoed to their customers. Even when the cable companies
3237 started selling access to television broadcasts, they refused to pay
3238 <!-- PAGE BREAK 73 -->
3239 for what they sold. Cable companies were thus Napsterizing
3240 broadcasters' content, but more egregiously than anything Napster ever
3241 did
— Napster never charged for the content it enabled others to
3244 <indexterm><primary>Anello, Douglas
</primary></indexterm>
3245 <indexterm><primary>Burdick, Quentin
</primary></indexterm>
3246 <indexterm><primary>Hyde, Rosel H.
</primary></indexterm>
3248 Broadcasters and copyright owners were quick to attack this theft.
3249 Rosel Hyde, chairman of the FCC, viewed the practice as a kind of
3250 <quote>unfair and potentially destructive competition.
</quote><footnote><para>
3252 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV: Hearing on S.
1006 Before the
3253 Subcommittee on Patents, Trademarks, and Copyrights of the Senate
3254 Committee on the Judiciary,
89th Cong.,
2nd sess.,
78 (
1966)
3255 (statement of Rosel H. Hyde, chairman of the Federal Communications
3257 <indexterm><primary>Hyde, Rosel H.
</primary></indexterm>
3259 There may have been a
<quote>public interest
</quote> in spreading the reach of cable
3260 TV, but as Douglas Anello, general counsel to the National Association
3261 of Broadcasters, asked Senator Quentin Burdick during testimony,
<quote>Does public
3262 interest dictate that you use somebody else's property?
</quote><footnote><para>
3264 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
116 (statement of Douglas A. Anello,
3265 general counsel of the National Association of Broadcasters).
3267 As another broadcaster put it,
3271 The extraordinary thing about the CATV business is that it is the
3272 only business I know of where the product that is being sold is not
3273 paid for.
<footnote><para>
3275 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
126 (statement of Ernest W. Jennes,
3276 general counsel of the Association of Maximum Service Telecasters, Inc.).
3281 Again, the demand of the copyright holders seemed reasonable enough:
3285 All we are asking for is a very simple thing, that people who now
3286 take our property for nothing pay for it. We are trying to stop
3287 piracy and I don't think there is any lesser word to describe it. I
3288 think there are harsher words which would fit it.
<footnote><para>
3290 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
169 (joint statement of Arthur B.
3291 Krim, president of United Artists Corp., and John Sinn, president of
3292 United Artists Television, Inc.).
3296 <indexterm><primary>Heston, Charlton
</primary></indexterm>
3298 These were
<quote>free-ride[rs],
</quote> Screen Actor's Guild president Charlton
3299 Heston said, who were
<quote>depriving actors of
3300 compensation.
</quote><footnote><para>
3302 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
209 (statement of Charlton Heston,
3303 president of the Screen Actors Guild).
3304 <indexterm><primary>Heston, Charlton
</primary></indexterm>
3309 But again, there was another side to the debate. As Assistant Attorney
3310 General Edwin Zimmerman put it,
3314 Our point here is that unlike the problem of whether you have any
3315 copyright protection at all, the problem here is whether copyright
3316 holders who are already compensated, who already have a monopoly,
3317 should be permitted to extend that monopoly.
… The
3319 <!-- PAGE BREAK 74 -->
3320 question here is how much compensation they should have and
3321 how far back they should carry their right to compensation.
<footnote><para>
3323 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
216 (statement of Edwin M.
3324 Zimmerman, acting assistant attorney general).
3325 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3327 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3331 Copyright owners took the cable companies to court. Twice the Supreme
3332 Court held that the cable companies owed the copyright owners nothing.
3335 It took Congress almost thirty years before it resolved the question
3336 of whether cable companies had to pay for the content they
<quote>pirated.
</quote>
3337 In the end, Congress resolved this question in the same way that it
3338 resolved the question about record players and player pianos. Yes,
3339 cable companies would have to pay for the content that they broadcast;
3340 but the price they would have to pay was not set by the copyright
3341 owner. The price was set by law, so that the broadcasters couldn't
3342 exercise veto power over the emerging technologies of cable. Cable
3343 companies thus built their empire in part upon a
<quote>piracy
</quote> of the value
3344 created by broadcasters' content.
3347 These separate stories sing a common theme. If
<quote>piracy
</quote> means
3348 using value from someone else's creative property without permission
3349 from that creator
—as it is increasingly described
3350 today
<footnote><para>
3352 See, for example, National Music Publisher's Association,
<citetitle>The Engine
3353 of Free Expression: Copyright on the Internet
—The Myth of Free
3354 Information
</citetitle>, available at
3355 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
13</ulink>.
<quote>The
3356 threat of piracy
—the use of someone else's creative work without
3357 permission or compensation
—has grown with the Internet.
</quote>
3359 — then
<emphasis>every
</emphasis> industry affected by copyright
3360 today is the product and beneficiary of a certain kind of
3361 piracy. Film, records, radio, cable TV.
… The list is long and
3362 could well be expanded. Every generation welcomes the pirates from the
3363 last. Every generation
—until now.
3365 <!-- PAGE BREAK 75 -->
3368 <chapter label=
"5" id=
"piracy">
3369 <title>CHAPTER FIVE:
<quote>Piracy
</quote></title>
3371 There is piracy of copyrighted material. Lots of it. This piracy comes
3372 in many forms. The most significant is commercial piracy, the
3373 unauthorized taking of other people's content within a commercial
3374 context. Despite the many justifications that are offered in its
3375 defense, this taking is wrong. No one should condone it, and the law
3379 But as well as copy-shop piracy, there is another kind of
<quote>taking
</quote>
3380 that is more directly related to the Internet. That taking, too, seems
3381 wrong to many, and it is wrong much of the time. Before we paint this
3382 taking
<quote>piracy,
</quote> however, we should understand its nature a bit more.
3383 For the harm of this taking is significantly more ambiguous than
3384 outright copying, and the law should account for that ambiguity, as it
3385 has so often done in the past.
3386 <!-- PAGE BREAK 76 -->
3388 <section id=
"piracy-i">
3389 <title>Piracy I
</title>
3391 All across the world, but especially in Asia and Eastern Europe, there
3392 are businesses that do nothing but take others people's copyrighted
3393 content, copy it, and sell it
—all without the permission of a copyright
3394 owner. The recording industry estimates that it loses about $
4.6 billion
3395 every year to physical piracy
<footnote><para>
3397 See IFPI (International Federation of the Phonographic Industry),
<citetitle>The
3398 Recording Industry Commercial Piracy Report
2003</citetitle>, July
2003, available
3399 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
14</ulink>. See
3400 also Ben Hunt,
<quote>Companies Warned on Music Piracy Risk,
</quote> <citetitle>Financial
3401 Times
</citetitle>,
14 February
2003,
11.
3403 (that works out to one in three CDs sold worldwide). The MPAA
3404 estimates that it loses $
3 billion annually worldwide to piracy.
3407 This is piracy plain and simple. Nothing in the argument of this
3408 book, nor in the argument that most people make when talking about
3409 the subject of this book, should draw into doubt this simple point:
3410 This piracy is wrong.
3413 Which is not to say that excuses and justifications couldn't be made
3414 for it. We could, for example, remind ourselves that for the first one
3415 hundred years of the American Republic, America did not honor foreign
3416 copyrights. We were born, in this sense, a pirate nation. It might
3417 therefore seem hypocritical for us to insist so strongly that other
3418 developing nations treat as wrong what we, for the first hundred years
3419 of our existence, treated as right.
3422 That excuse isn't terribly strong. Technically, our law did not ban
3423 the taking of foreign works. It explicitly limited itself to American
3424 works. Thus the American publishers who published foreign works
3425 without the permission of foreign authors were not violating any rule.
3426 The copy shops in Asia, by contrast, are violating Asian law. Asian
3427 law does protect foreign copyrights, and the actions of the copy shops
3428 violate that law. So the wrong of piracy that they engage in is not
3429 just a moral wrong, but a legal wrong, and not just an internationally
3430 legal wrong, but a locally legal wrong as well.
3433 True, these local rules have, in effect, been imposed upon these
3434 countries. No country can be part of the world economy and choose
3435 <beginpage pagenum=
"77"/>
3436 not to protect copyright internationally. We may have been born a
3437 pirate nation, but we will not allow any other nation to have a
3441 If a country is to be treated as a sovereign, however, then its laws are
3442 its laws regardless of their source. The international law under which
3443 these nations live gives them some opportunities to escape the burden
3444 of intellectual property law.
<footnote><para>
3446 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism:
3447 <citetitle>Who Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The
3448 New Press,
2003),
10–13,
209. The Trade-Related Aspects of
3449 Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPS) agreement obligates member
3450 nations to create administrative and enforcement mechanisms for
3451 intellectual property rights, a costly proposition for developing
3452 countries. Additionally, patent rights may lead to higher prices for
3453 staple industries such as agriculture. Critics of TRIPS question the
3454 disparity between burdens imposed upon developing countries and
3455 benefits conferred to industrialized nations. TRIPS does permit
3456 governments to use patents for public, noncommercial uses without
3457 first obtaining the patent holder's permission. Developing nations may
3458 be able to use this to gain the benefits of foreign patents at lower
3459 prices. This is a promising strategy for developing nations within the
3461 <indexterm><primary>agricultural patents
</primary></indexterm>
3462 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
3463 </para></footnote> In my view, more developing nations should take
3464 advantage of that opportunity, but when they don't, then their laws
3465 should be respected. And under the laws of these nations, this piracy
3469 Alternatively, we could try to excuse this piracy by noting that in
3470 any case, it does no harm to the industry. The Chinese who get access
3471 to American CDs at
50 cents a copy are not people who would have
3472 bought those American CDs at $
15 a copy. So no one really has any
3473 less money than they otherwise would have had.
<footnote><para>
3475 For an analysis of the economic impact of copying technology, see Stan
3476 Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002),
3477 144–90.
<quote>In some instances
… the impact of piracy on the
3478 copyright holder's ability to appropriate the value of the work will
3479 be negligible. One obvious instance is the case where the individual
3480 engaging in pirating would not have purchased an original even if
3481 pirating were not an option.
</quote> Ibid.,
149.
3482 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3486 This is often true (though I have friends who have purchased many
3487 thousands of pirated DVDs who certainly have enough money to pay
3488 for the content they have taken), and it does mitigate to some degree
3489 the harm caused by such taking. Extremists in this debate love to say,
3490 <quote>You wouldn't go into Barnes
& Noble and take a book off of the shelf
3491 without paying; why should it be any different with on-line music?
</quote>
3492 The difference is, of course, that when you take a book from Barnes
&
3493 Noble, it has one less book to sell. By contrast, when you take an MP3
3494 from a computer network, there is not one less CD that can be sold.
3495 The physics of piracy of the intangible are different from the physics of
3496 piracy of the tangible.
3499 This argument is still very weak. However, although copyright is a
3500 property right of a very special sort, it
<emphasis>is
</emphasis> a
3501 property right. Like all property rights, the copyright gives the
3502 owner the right to decide the terms under which content is shared. If
3503 the copyright owner doesn't want to sell, she doesn't have to. There
3504 are exceptions: important statutory licenses that apply to copyrighted
3505 content regardless of the wish of the copyright owner. Those licenses
3506 give people the right to
<quote>take
</quote> copyrighted content whether or not the
3507 copyright owner wants to sell. But
3509 <!-- PAGE BREAK 78 -->
3510 where the law does not give people the right to take content, it is
3511 wrong to take that content even if the wrong does no harm. If we have
3512 a property system, and that system is properly balanced to the
3513 technology of a time, then it is wrong to take property without the
3514 permission of a property owner. That is exactly what
<quote>property
</quote> means.
3517 Finally, we could try to excuse this piracy with the argument that the
3518 piracy actually helps the copyright owner. When the Chinese
<quote>steal
</quote>
3519 Windows, that makes the Chinese dependent on Microsoft. Microsoft
3520 loses the value of the software that was taken. But it gains users who
3521 are used to life in the Microsoft world. Over time, as the nation
3522 grows more wealthy, more and more people will buy software rather than
3523 steal it. And hence over time, because that buying will benefit
3524 Microsoft, Microsoft benefits from the piracy. If instead of pirating
3525 Microsoft Windows, the Chinese used the free GNU/Linux operating
3526 system, then these Chinese users would not eventually be buying
3527 Microsoft. Without piracy, then, Microsoft would lose.
3528 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3529 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3531 <primary>Microsoft
</primary>
3532 <secondary>Windows operating system of
</secondary>
3534 <indexterm><primary>Windows
</primary></indexterm>
3537 This argument, too, is somewhat true. The addiction strategy is a good
3538 one. Many businesses practice it. Some thrive because of it. Law
3539 students, for example, are given free access to the two largest legal
3540 databases. The companies marketing both hope the students will become
3541 so used to their service that they will want to use it and not the
3542 other when they become lawyers (and must pay high subscription fees).
3545 Still, the argument is not terribly persuasive. We don't give the
3546 alcoholic a defense when he steals his first beer, merely because that
3547 will make it more likely that he will buy the next three. Instead, we
3548 ordinarily allow businesses to decide for themselves when it is best
3549 to give their product away. If Microsoft fears the competition of
3550 GNU/Linux, then Microsoft can give its product away, as it did, for
3551 example, with Internet Explorer to fight Netscape. A property right
3552 means giving the property owner the right to say who gets access to
3553 what
—at least ordinarily. And if the law properly balances the
3554 rights of the copyright owner with the rights of access, then
3555 violating the law is still wrong.
3556 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3557 <indexterm><primary>Internet Explorer
</primary></indexterm>
3558 <indexterm><primary>Netscape
</primary></indexterm>
3559 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3562 <!-- PAGE BREAK 79 -->
3563 Thus, while I understand the pull of these justifications for piracy,
3564 and I certainly see the motivation, in my view, in the end, these efforts
3565 at justifying commercial piracy simply don't cut it. This kind of piracy
3566 is rampant and just plain wrong. It doesn't transform the content it
3567 steals; it doesn't transform the market it competes in. It merely gives
3568 someone access to something that the law says he should not have.
3569 Nothing has changed to draw that law into doubt. This form of piracy
3573 But as the examples from the four chapters that introduced this part
3574 suggest, even if some piracy is plainly wrong, not all
<quote>piracy
</quote> is. Or
3575 at least, not all
<quote>piracy
</quote> is wrong if that term is understood in the
3576 way it is increasingly used today. Many kinds of
<quote>piracy
</quote> are useful
3577 and productive, to produce either new content or new ways of doing
3578 business. Neither our tradition nor any tradition has ever banned all
3579 <quote>piracy
</quote> in that sense of the term.
3582 This doesn't mean that there are no questions raised by the latest
3583 piracy concern, peer-to-peer file sharing. But it does mean that we
3584 need to understand the harm in peer-to-peer sharing a bit more before
3585 we condemn it to the gallows with the charge of piracy.
3588 For (
1) like the original Hollywood, p2p sharing escapes an overly
3589 controlling industry; and (
2) like the original recording industry, it
3590 simply exploits a new way to distribute content; but (
3) unlike cable
3591 TV, no one is selling the content that is shared on p2p services.
3594 These differences distinguish p2p sharing from true piracy. They
3595 should push us to find a way to protect artists while enabling this
3599 <section id=
"piracy-ii">
3600 <title>Piracy II
</title>
3602 The key to the
<quote>piracy
</quote> that the law aims to quash is a use that
<quote>rob[s]
3603 the author of [his] profit.
</quote><footnote><para>
3605 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777).
3607 This means we must determine whether
3608 and how much p2p sharing harms before we know how strongly the
3609 <!-- PAGE BREAK 80 -->
3610 law should seek to either prevent it or find an alternative to assure the
3611 author of his profit.
3614 Peer-to-peer sharing was made famous by Napster. But the inventors of
3615 the Napster technology had not made any major technological
3616 innovations. Like every great advance in innovation on the Internet
3617 (and, arguably, off the Internet as well
<footnote><para>
3619 See Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
3620 National Bestseller That Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle> (New York:
3621 HarperBusiness,
2000). Professor Christensen examines why companies
3622 that give rise to and dominate a product area are frequently unable to
3623 come up with the most creative, paradigm-shifting uses for their own
3624 products. This job usually falls to outside innovators, who
3625 reassemble existing technology in inventive ways. For a discussion of
3626 Christensen's ideas, see Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
89–92,
139.
3628 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
3629 </para></footnote>), Shawn Fanning and crew had simply
3630 put together components that had been developed independently.
3631 <indexterm><primary>Fanning, Shawn
</primary></indexterm>
3634 The result was spontaneous combustion. Launched in July
1999,
3635 Napster amassed over
10 million users within nine months. After
3636 eighteen months, there were close to
80 million registered users of the
3637 system.
<footnote><para>
3639 See Carolyn Lochhead,
<quote>Silicon Valley Dream, Hollywood Nightmare,
</quote> <citetitle>San
3640 Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24 September
2002, A1;
<quote>Rock 'n' Roll Suicide,
</quote>
3641 <citetitle>New Scientist
</citetitle>,
6 July
2002,
42; Benny Evangelista,
<quote>Napster Names CEO,
3642 Secures New Financing,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
23 May
2003, C1;
3643 <quote>Napster's Wake-Up Call,
</quote> <citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
24 June
2000,
23; John Naughton,
3644 <quote>Hollywood at War with the Internet
</quote> (London)
<citetitle>Times
</citetitle>,
26 July
2002,
18.
3646 Courts quickly shut Napster down, but other services emerged
3647 to take its place. (Kazaa is currently the most popular p2p service. It
3648 boasts over
100 million members.) These services' systems are different
3649 architecturally, though not very different in function: Each enables
3650 users to make content available to any number of other users. With a
3651 p2p system, you can share your favorite songs with your best friend
—
3652 or your
20,
000 best friends.
3655 According to a number of estimates, a huge proportion of Americans
3656 have tasted file-sharing technology. A study by Ipsos-Insight in
3657 September
2002 estimated that
60 million Americans had downloaded
3658 music
—28 percent of Americans older than
12.
<footnote><para>
3661 See Ipsos-Insight,
<citetitle>TEMPO: Keeping Pace with Online Music Distribution
</citetitle>
3662 (September
2002), reporting that
28 percent of Americans aged twelve
3663 and older have downloaded music off of the Internet and
30 percent have
3664 listened to digital music files stored on their computers.
3666 A survey by the NPD group quoted in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>
3667 estimated that
43 million citizens used file-sharing networks to
3668 exchange content in May
2003.
<footnote><para>
3670 Amy Harmon,
<quote>Industry Offers a Carrot in Online Music Fight,
</quote> <citetitle>New
3671 York Times
</citetitle>,
6 June
2003, A1.
3673 The vast majority of these are not kids. Whatever the actual figure, a
3674 massive quantity of content is being
<quote>taken
</quote> on these networks. The
3675 ease and inexpensiveness of file-sharing networks have inspired
3676 millions to enjoy music in a way that they hadn't before.
3679 Some of this enjoying involves copyright infringement. Some of it does
3680 not. And even among the part that is technically copyright
3681 infringement, calculating the actual harm to copyright owners is more
3682 complicated than one might think. So consider
—a bit more
3683 carefully than the polarized voices around this debate usually
3684 do
—the kinds of sharing that file sharing enables, and the kinds
3688 <!-- PAGE BREAK 81 -->
3689 File sharers share different kinds of content. We can divide these
3690 different kinds into four types.
3692 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
3695 There are some who use sharing networks as substitutes for purchasing
3696 content. Thus, when a new Madonna CD is released, rather than buying
3697 the CD, these users simply take it. We might quibble about whether
3698 everyone who takes it would actually have bought it if sharing didn't
3699 make it available for free. Most probably wouldn't have, but clearly
3700 there are some who would. The latter are the target of category A:
3701 users who download instead of purchasing.
3702 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
3706 There are some who use sharing networks to sample music before
3707 purchasing it. Thus, a friend sends another friend an MP3 of an artist
3708 he's not heard of. The other friend then buys CDs by that artist. This
3709 is a kind of targeted advertising, quite likely to succeed. If the
3710 friend recommending the album gains nothing from a bad recommendation,
3711 then one could expect that the recommendations will actually be quite
3712 good. The net effect of this sharing could increase the quantity of
3717 There are many who use sharing networks to get access to copyrighted
3718 content that is no longer sold or that they would not have purchased
3719 because the transaction costs off the Net are too high. This use of
3720 sharing networks is among the most rewarding for many. Songs that were
3721 part of your childhood but have long vanished from the marketplace
3722 magically appear again on the network. (One friend told me that when
3723 she discovered Napster, she spent a solid weekend
<quote>recalling
</quote> old
3724 songs. She was astonished at the range and mix of content that was
3725 available.) For content not sold, this is still technically a
3726 violation of copyright, though because the copyright owner is not
3727 selling the content anymore, the economic harm is zero
—the same
3728 harm that occurs when I sell my collection of
1960s
45-rpm records to
3732 <!-- PAGE BREAK 82 -->
3734 Finally, there are many who use sharing networks to get access
3735 to content that is not copyrighted or that the copyright owner
3740 How do these different types of sharing balance out?
3743 Let's start with some simple but important points. From the
3744 perspective of the law, only type D sharing is clearly legal. From the
3745 perspective of economics, only type A sharing is clearly
3746 harmful.
<footnote><para>
3748 See Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle>,
148–49.
3749 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3751 Type B sharing is illegal but plainly beneficial. Type C sharing is
3752 illegal, yet good for society (since more exposure to music is good)
3753 and harmless to the artist (since the work is not otherwise
3754 available). So how sharing matters on balance is a hard question to
3755 answer
—and certainly much more difficult than the current
3756 rhetoric around the issue suggests.
3759 Whether on balance sharing is harmful depends importantly on how
3760 harmful type A sharing is. Just as Edison complained about Hollywood,
3761 composers complained about piano rolls, recording artists complained
3762 about radio, and broadcasters complained about cable TV, the music
3763 industry complains that type A sharing is a kind of
<quote>theft
</quote> that is
3764 <quote>devastating
</quote> the industry.
3767 While the numbers do suggest that sharing is harmful, how
3768 harmful is harder to reckon. It has long been the recording industry's
3769 practice to blame technology for any drop in sales. The history of
3770 cassette recording is a good example. As a study by Cap Gemini Ernst
3771 & Young put it,
<quote>Rather than exploiting this new, popular
3772 technology, the labels fought it.
</quote><footnote><para>
3774 See Cap Gemini Ernst
& Young,
<citetitle>Technology Evolution and the
3775 Music Industry's Business Model Crisis
</citetitle> (
2003),
3. This report
3776 describes the music industry's effort to stigmatize the budding
3777 practice of cassette taping in the
1970s, including an advertising
3778 campaign featuring a cassette-shape skull and the caption
<quote>Home taping
3779 is killing music.
</quote> At the time digital audio tape became a threat,
3780 the Office of Technical Assessment conducted a survey of consumer
3781 behavior. In
1988,
40 percent of consumers older than ten had taped
3782 music to a cassette format. U.S. Congress, Office of Technology
3783 Assessment,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying: Technology Challenges the Law
</citetitle>,
3784 OTA-CIT-
422 (Washington, D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office,
3785 October
1989),
145–56.
</para></footnote>
3786 The labels claimed that every album taped was an album unsold, and
3787 when record sales fell by
11.4 percent in
1981, the industry claimed
3788 that its point was proved. Technology was the problem, and banning or
3789 regulating technology was the answer.
3792 Yet soon thereafter, and before Congress was given an opportunity
3793 to enact regulation, MTV was launched, and the industry had a record
3794 turnaround.
<quote>In the end,
</quote> Cap Gemini concludes,
<quote>the `crisis'
… was
3795 not the fault of the tapers
—who did not [stop after MTV came into
3796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 83 -->
3797 being]
—but had to a large extent resulted from stagnation in musical
3798 innovation at the major labels.
</quote><footnote><para>
3800 U.S. Congress,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying
</citetitle>,
4.
3804 But just because the industry was wrong before does not mean it is
3805 wrong today. To evaluate the real threat that p2p sharing presents to
3806 the industry in particular, and society in general
—or at least
3807 the society that inherits the tradition that gave us the film
3808 industry, the record industry, the radio industry, cable TV, and the
3809 VCR
—the question is not simply whether type A sharing is
3810 harmful. The question is also
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> harmful type A
3811 sharing is, and how beneficial the other types of sharing are.
3814 We start to answer this question by focusing on the net harm, from the
3815 standpoint of the industry as a whole, that sharing networks cause.
3816 The
<quote>net harm
</quote> to the industry as a whole is the amount by which type
3817 A sharing exceeds type B. If the record companies sold more records
3818 through sampling than they lost through substitution, then sharing
3819 networks would actually benefit music companies on balance. They would
3820 therefore have little
<emphasis>static
</emphasis> reason to resist
3825 Could that be true? Could the industry as a whole be gaining because
3826 of file sharing? Odd as that might sound, the data about CD sales
3827 actually suggest it might be close.
3830 In
2002, the RIAA reported that CD sales had fallen by
8.9 percent,
3831 from
882 million to
803 million units; revenues fell
6.7
3832 percent.
<footnote><para>
3834 See Recording Industry Association of America,
<citetitle>2002 Yearend Statistics
</citetitle>,
3836 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
15</ulink>. A later
3837 report indicates even greater losses. See Recording Industry
3838 Association of America,
<citetitle>Some Facts About Music Piracy
</citetitle>,
25 June
2003,
3839 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
3840 #
16</ulink>:
<quote>In the past four years, unit shipments of recorded music
3841 have fallen by
26 percent from
1.16 billion units in to
860 million
3842 units in
2002 in the United States (based on units shipped). In terms
3843 of sales, revenues are down
14 percent, from $
14.6 billion in to $
12.6
3844 billion last year (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments). The music
3845 industry worldwide has gone from a $
39 billion industry in
2000 down
3846 to a $
32 billion industry in
2002 (based on U.S. dollar value of
3849 This confirms a trend over the past few years. The RIAA blames
3850 Internet piracy for the trend, though there are many other causes that
3851 could account for this drop. SoundScan, for example, reports a more
3852 than
20 percent drop in the number of CDs released since
1999. That no
3853 doubt accounts for some of the decrease in sales. Rising prices could
3854 account for at least some of the loss.
<quote>From
1999 to
2001, the average
3855 price of a CD rose
7.2 percent, from $
13.04 to $
14.19.
</quote><footnote>
3858 Jane Black,
<quote>Big Music's Broken Record,
</quote> BusinessWeek online,
13
3859 February
2003, available at
3860 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
17</ulink>.
3861 <indexterm><primary>Black, Jane
</primary></indexterm>
3864 Competition from other forms of media could also account for some of
3865 the decline. As Jane Black of
<citetitle>BusinessWeek
</citetitle> notes,
<quote>The
3866 soundtrack to the film
<citetitle>High Fidelity
</citetitle> has a list price of
3867 $
18.98. You could get the whole movie [on DVD] for
3868 $
19.99.
</quote><footnote><para>
3875 <!-- PAGE BREAK 84 -->
3876 But let's assume the RIAA is right, and all of the decline in CD sales
3877 is because of Internet sharing. Here's the rub: In the same period
3878 that the RIAA estimates that
803 million CDs were sold, the RIAA
3879 estimates that
2.1 billion CDs were downloaded for free. Thus,
3880 although
2.6 times the total number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3881 free, sales revenue fell by just
6.7 percent.
3884 There are too many different things happening at the same time to
3885 explain these numbers definitively, but one conclusion is unavoidable:
3886 The recording industry constantly asks,
<quote>What's the difference between
3887 downloading a song and stealing a CD?
</quote>—but their own numbers
3888 reveal the difference. If I steal a CD, then there is one less CD to
3889 sell. Every taking is a lost sale. But on the basis of the numbers the
3890 RIAA provides, it is absolutely clear that the same is not true of
3891 downloads. If every download were a lost sale
—if every use of
3892 Kazaa
<quote>rob[bed] the author of [his] profit
</quote>—then the industry
3893 would have suffered a
100 percent drop in sales last year, not a
7
3894 percent drop. If
2.6 times the number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3895 free, and yet sales revenue dropped by just
6.7 percent, then there is
3896 a huge difference between
<quote>downloading a song and stealing a CD.
</quote>
3899 These are the harms
—alleged and perhaps exaggerated but, let's
3900 assume, real. What of the benefits? File sharing may impose costs on
3901 the recording industry. What value does it produce in addition to
3905 One benefit is type C sharing
—making available content that
3906 is technically still under copyright but is no longer commercially
3907 available. This is not a small category of content. There are
3908 millions of tracks that are no longer commercially
3909 available.
<footnote><para>
3911 By one estimate,
75 percent of the music released by the major labels
3912 is no longer in print. See Online Entertainment and Copyright
3913 Law
—Coming Soon to a Digital Device Near You: Hearing Before the
3914 Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
107th Cong.,
1st sess. (
3 April
3915 2001) (prepared statement of the Future of Music Coalition), available
3916 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
18</ulink>.
3918 And while it's conceivable that some of this content is not available
3919 because the artist producing the content doesn't want it to be made
3920 available, the vast majority of it is unavailable solely because the
3921 publisher or the distributor has decided it no longer makes economic
3922 sense
<emphasis>to the company
</emphasis> to make it available.
3925 In real space
—long before the Internet
—the market had a simple
3926 <!-- PAGE BREAK 85 -->
3927 response to this problem: used book and record stores. There are
3928 thousands of used book and used record stores in America
3929 today.
<footnote><para>
3931 While there are not good estimates of the number of used record stores in
3932 existence, in
2002, there were
7,
198 used book dealers in the United States,
3933 an increase of
20 percent since
1993. See Book Hunter Press,
<citetitle>The Quiet
3934 Revolution: The Expansion of the Used Book Market
</citetitle> (
2002), available at
3935 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
19</ulink>. Used records accounted for $
260 million in sales in
2002. See
3937 Association of Recording Merchandisers,
<quote>2002 Annual Survey
3940 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
20</ulink>.
3942 These stores buy content from owners, then sell the content they
3943 buy. And under American copyright law, when they buy and sell this
3944 content,
<emphasis>even if the content is still under
3945 copyright
</emphasis>, the copyright owner doesn't get a dime. Used
3946 book and record stores are commercial entities; their owners make
3947 money from the content they sell; but as with cable companies before
3948 statutory licensing, they don't have to pay the copyright owner for
3949 the content they sell.
3951 <indexterm><primary>Bernstein, Leonard
</primary></indexterm>
3953 Type C sharing, then, is very much like used book stores or used
3954 record stores. It is different, of course, because the person making
3955 the content available isn't making money from making the content
3956 available. It is also different, of course, because in real space,
3957 when I sell a record, I don't have it anymore, while in cyberspace,
3958 when someone shares my
1949 recording of Bernstein's
<quote>Two Love Songs,
</quote>
3959 I still have it. That difference would matter economically if the
3960 owner of the copyright were selling the record in competition to my
3961 sharing. But we're talking about the class of content that is not
3962 currently commercially available. The Internet is making it available,
3963 through cooperative sharing, without competing with the market.
3966 It may well be, all things considered, that it would be better if the
3967 copyright owner got something from this trade. But just because it may
3968 well be better, it doesn't follow that it would be good to ban used book
3969 stores. Or put differently, if you think that type C sharing should be
3970 stopped, do you think that libraries and used book stores should be
3974 Finally, and perhaps most importantly, file-sharing networks enable
3975 type D sharing to occur
—the sharing of content that copyright owners
3976 want to have shared or for which there is no continuing copyright. This
3977 sharing clearly benefits authors and society. Science fiction author
3978 Cory Doctorow, for example, released his first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
3979 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, both free on-line and in bookstores on the same
3981 <!-- PAGE BREAK 86 -->
3982 day. His (and his publisher's) thinking was that the on-line distribution
3983 would be a great advertisement for the
<quote>real
</quote> book. People would read
3984 part on-line, and then decide whether they liked the book or not. If
3985 they liked it, they would be more likely to buy it. Doctorow's content is
3986 type D content. If sharing networks enable his work to be spread, then
3987 both he and society are better off. (Actually, much better off: It is a
3991 Likewise for work in the public domain: This sharing benefits society
3992 with no legal harm to authors at all. If efforts to solve the problem
3993 of type A sharing destroy the opportunity for type D sharing, then we
3994 lose something important in order to protect type A content.
3997 The point throughout is this: While the recording industry
3998 understandably says,
<quote>This is how much we've lost,
</quote> we must also ask,
3999 <quote>How much has society gained from p2p sharing? What are the
4000 efficiencies? What is the content that otherwise would be
4001 unavailable?
</quote>
4004 For unlike the piracy I described in the first section of this
4005 chapter, much of the
<quote>piracy
</quote> that file sharing enables is plainly
4006 legal and good. And like the piracy I described in chapter
4007 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"pirates"/>, much of
4008 this piracy is motivated by a new way of spreading content caused by
4009 changes in the technology of distribution. Thus, consistent with the
4010 tradition that gave us Hollywood, radio, the recording industry, and
4011 cable TV, the question we should be asking about file sharing is how
4012 best to preserve its benefits while minimizing (to the extent
4013 possible) the wrongful harm it causes artists. The question is one of
4014 balance. The law should seek that balance, and that balance will be
4015 found only with time.
4018 <quote>But isn't the war just a war against illegal sharing? Isn't the target
4019 just what you call type A sharing?
</quote>
4022 You would think. And we should hope. But so far, it is not. The
4024 of the war purportedly on type A sharing alone has been felt far
4025 beyond that one class of sharing. That much is obvious from the
4027 case itself. When Napster told the district court that it had
4029 a technology to block the transfer of
99.4 percent of identified
4030 <!-- PAGE BREAK 87 -->
4031 infringing material, the district court told counsel for Napster
99.4
4032 percent was not good enough. Napster had to push the infringements
4033 <quote>down to zero.
</quote><footnote><para>
4035 See Transcript of Proceedings, In Re: Napster Copyright Litigation at
34-
4036 35 (N.D. Cal.,
11 July
2001), nos. MDL-
00-
1369 MHP, C
99-
5183
4039 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
21</ulink>. For an
4040 account of the litigation and its toll on Napster, see Joseph Menn,
4041 <citetitle>All the Rave: The Rise and Fall of Shawn Fanning's Napster
</citetitle> (New
4042 York: Crown Business,
2003),
269–82.
4046 If
99.4 percent is not good enough, then this is a war on file-sharing
4047 technologies, not a war on copyright infringement. There is no way to
4048 assure that a p2p system is used
100 percent of the time in compliance
4049 with the law, any more than there is a way to assure that
100 percent of
4050 VCRs or
100 percent of Xerox machines or
100 percent of handguns
4051 are used in compliance with the law. Zero tolerance means zero p2p.
4052 The court's ruling means that we as a society must lose the benefits of
4053 p2p, even for the totally legal and beneficial uses they serve, simply to
4054 assure that there are zero copyright infringements caused by p2p.
4057 Zero tolerance has not been our history. It has not produced the
4058 content industry that we know today. The history of American law has
4059 been a process of balance. As new technologies changed the way content
4060 was distributed, the law adjusted, after some time, to the new
4061 technology. In this adjustment, the law sought to ensure the
4062 legitimate rights of creators while protecting innovation. Sometimes
4063 this has meant more rights for creators. Sometimes less.
4066 So, as we've seen, when
<quote>mechanical reproduction
</quote> threatened the
4067 interests of composers, Congress balanced the rights of composers
4068 against the interests of the recording industry. It granted rights to
4069 composers, but also to the recording artists: Composers were to be
4070 paid, but at a price set by Congress. But when radio started
4071 broadcasting the recordings made by these recording artists, and they
4072 complained to Congress that their
<quote>creative property
</quote> was not being
4073 respected (since the radio station did not have to pay them for the
4074 creativity it broadcast), Congress rejected their claim. An indirect
4078 Cable TV followed the pattern of record albums. When the courts
4079 rejected the claim that cable broadcasters had to pay for the content
4080 they rebroadcast, Congress responded by giving broadcasters a right to
4081 compensation, but at a level set by the law. It likewise gave cable
4082 companies the right to the content, so long as they paid the statutory
4087 <!-- PAGE BREAK 88 -->
4088 This compromise, like the compromise affecting records and player
4089 pianos, served two important goals
—indeed, the two central goals
4090 of any copyright legislation. First, the law assured that new
4091 innovators would have the freedom to develop new ways to deliver
4092 content. Second, the law assured that copyright holders would be paid
4093 for the content that was distributed. One fear was that if Congress
4094 simply required cable TV to pay copyright holders whatever they
4095 demanded for their content, then copyright holders associated with
4096 broadcasters would use their power to stifle this new technology,
4097 cable. But if Congress had permitted cable to use broadcasters'
4098 content for free, then it would have unfairly subsidized cable. Thus
4099 Congress chose a path that would assure
4100 <emphasis>compensation
</emphasis> without giving the past
4101 (broadcasters) control over the future (cable).
4103 <indexterm><primary>Betamax
</primary></indexterm>
4105 In the same year that Congress struck this balance, two major
4106 producers and distributors of film content filed a lawsuit against
4107 another technology, the video tape recorder (VTR, or as we refer to
4108 them today, VCRs) that Sony had produced, the Betamax. Disney's and
4109 Universal's claim against Sony was relatively simple: Sony produced a
4110 device, Disney and Universal claimed, that enabled consumers to engage
4111 in copyright infringement. Because the device that Sony built had a
4112 <quote>record
</quote> button, the device could be used to record copyrighted movies
4113 and shows. Sony was therefore benefiting from the copyright
4114 infringement of its customers. It should therefore, Disney and
4115 Universal claimed, be partially liable for that infringement.
4118 There was something to Disney's and Universal's claim. Sony did
4119 decide to design its machine to make it very simple to record television
4120 shows. It could have built the machine to block or inhibit any direct
4121 copying from a television broadcast. Or possibly, it could have built the
4122 machine to copy only if there were a special
<quote>copy me
</quote> signal on the
4123 line. It was clear that there were many television shows that did not
4124 grant anyone permission to copy. Indeed, if anyone had asked, no
4125 doubt the majority of shows would not have authorized copying. And
4126 <!-- PAGE BREAK 89 -->
4127 in the face of this obvious preference, Sony could have designed its
4128 system to minimize the opportunity for copyright infringement. It did
4129 not, and for that, Disney and Universal wanted to hold it responsible
4130 for the architecture it chose.
4133 MPAA president Jack Valenti became the studios' most vocal
4134 champion. Valenti called VCRs
<quote>tapeworms.
</quote> He warned,
<quote>When there are
4135 20,
30,
40 million of these VCRs in the land, we will be invaded by
4136 millions of `tapeworms,' eating away at the very heart and essence of
4137 the most precious asset the copyright owner has, his
4138 copyright.
</quote><footnote><para>
4140 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders): Hearing on
4141 S.
1758 Before the Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
97th Cong.,
1st
4142 and
2nd sess.,
459 (
1982) (testimony of Jack Valenti, president, Motion
4143 Picture Association of America, Inc.).
4145 <quote>One does not have to be trained in sophisticated marketing and
4146 creative judgment,
</quote> he told Congress,
<quote>to understand the devastation
4147 on the after-theater marketplace caused by the hundreds of millions of
4148 tapings that will adversely impact on the future of the creative
4149 community in this country. It is simply a question of basic economics
4150 and plain common sense.
</quote><footnote><para>
4152 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
475.
4154 Indeed, as surveys would later show,
4155 percent of VCR owners had movie libraries of ten videos or more
<footnote><para>
4157 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
480 F. Supp.
429,
4160 — a use the Court would later hold was not
<quote>fair.
</quote> By
4161 <quote>allowing VCR owners to copy freely by the means of an exemption from
4162 copyright infringementwithout creating a mechanism to compensate
4163 copyrightowners,
</quote> Valenti testified, Congress would
<quote>take from the
4164 owners the very essence of their property: the exclusive right to
4165 control who may use their work, that is, who may copy it and thereby
4166 profit from its reproduction.
</quote><footnote><para>
4168 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
485 (testimony
4173 It took eight years for this case to be resolved by the Supreme
4174 Court. In the interim, the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals, which
4175 includes Hollywood in its jurisdiction
—leading Judge Alex
4176 Kozinski, who sits on that court, refers to it as the
<quote>Hollywood
4177 Circuit
</quote>—held that Sony would be liable for the copyright
4178 infringement made possible by its machines. Under the Ninth Circuit's
4179 rule, this totally familiar technology
—which Jack Valenti had
4180 called
<quote>the Boston Strangler of the American film industry
</quote> (worse
4181 yet, it was a
<emphasis>Japanese
</emphasis> Boston Strangler of the
4182 American film industry)
—was an illegal
4183 technology.
<footnote><para>
4185 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
659 F.
2d
963 (
9th Cir.
4188 <indexterm><primary>Kozinski, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
4191 But the Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Ninth Circuit.
4193 <!-- PAGE BREAK 90 -->
4194 And in its reversal, the Court clearly articulated its understanding of
4195 when and whether courts should intervene in such disputes. As the
4200 Sound policy, as well as history, supports our consistent deference
4201 to Congress when major technological innovations alter the
4203 for copyrighted materials. Congress has the constitutional
4205 and the institutional ability to accommodate fully the
4206 varied permutations of competing interests that are inevitably
4208 by such new technology.
<footnote><para>
4210 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
431 (
1984).
4215 Congress was asked to respond to the Supreme Court's decision. But as
4216 with the plea of recording artists about radio broadcasts, Congress
4217 ignored the request. Congress was convinced that American film got
4218 enough, this
<quote>taking
</quote> notwithstanding. If we put these cases
4219 together, a pattern is clear:
4222 <informaltable id=
"t1">
4223 <tgroup cols=
"4" align=
"char">
4227 <entry>WHOSE VALUE WAS
<quote>PIRATED
</quote></entry>
4228 <entry>RESPONSE OF THE COURTS
</entry>
4229 <entry>RESPONSE OF CONGRESS
</entry>
4234 <entry>Recordings
</entry>
4235 <entry>Composers
</entry>
4236 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4237 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4240 <entry>Radio
</entry>
4241 <entry>Recording artists
</entry>
4243 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4246 <entry>Cable TV
</entry>
4247 <entry>Broadcasters
</entry>
4248 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4249 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4253 <entry>Film creators
</entry>
4254 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4255 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4262 In each case throughout our history, a new technology changed the
4263 way content was distributed.
<footnote><para>
4265 These are the most important instances in our history, but there are other
4266 cases as well. The technology of digital audio tape (DAT), for example,
4267 was regulated by Congress to minimize the risk of piracy. The remedy
4268 Congress imposed did burden DAT producers, by taxing tape sales and
4269 controlling the technology of DAT. See Audio Home Recording Act of
4270 1992 (Title
17 of the
<citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>), Pub. L. No.
102-
563,
106 Stat.
4271 4237, codified at
17 U.S.C. §
1001. Again, however, this regulation did not
4272 eliminate the opportunity for free riding in the sense I've described. See
4273 Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
71. See also Picker,
<quote>From Edison to the Broadcast Flag,
</quote>
4274 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
293–96.
4275 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
4277 In each case, throughout our history,
4278 that change meant that someone got a
<quote>free ride
</quote> on someone else's
4282 In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of these cases did either the courts or
4283 Congress eliminate all free riding. In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of
4284 these cases did the courts or Congress insist that the law should
4285 assure that the copyright holder get all the value that his copyright
4286 created. In every case, the copyright owners complained of
<quote>piracy.
</quote>
4287 In every case, Congress acted to recognize some of the legitimacy in
4288 the behavior of the
<quote>pirates.
</quote> In each case, Congress allowed some new
4289 technology to benefit from content made before. It balanced the
4291 <!-- PAGE BREAK 91 -->
4294 When you think across these examples, and the other examples that
4295 make up the first four chapters of this section, this balance makes
4296 sense. Was Walt Disney a pirate? Would doujinshi be better if creators
4297 had to ask permission? Should tools that enable others to capture and
4298 spread images as a way to cultivate or criticize our culture be better
4300 Is it really right that building a search engine should expose you
4301 to $
15 million in damages? Would it have been better if Edison had
4302 controlled film? Should every cover band have to hire a lawyer to get
4303 permission to record a song?
4306 We could answer yes to each of these questions, but our tradition
4307 has answered no. In our tradition, as the Supreme Court has stated,
4308 copyright
<quote>has never accorded the copyright owner complete control
4309 over all possible uses of his work.
</quote><footnote><para>
4311 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
4314 Instead, the particular uses that the law regulates have been defined
4315 by balancing the good that comes from granting an exclusive right
4316 against the burdens such an exclusive right creates. And this
4317 balancing has historically been done
<emphasis>after
</emphasis> a
4318 technology has matured, or settled into the mix of technologies that
4319 facilitate the distribution of content.
4322 We should be doing the same thing today. The technology of the
4323 Internet is changing quickly. The way people connect to the Internet
4324 (wires vs. wireless) is changing very quickly. No doubt the network
4325 should not become a tool for
<quote>stealing
</quote> from artists. But neither
4326 should the law become a tool to entrench one particular way in which
4327 artists (or more accurately, distributors) get paid. As I describe in
4328 some detail in the last chapter of this book, we should be securing
4329 income to artists while we allow the market to secure the most
4330 efficient way to promote and distribute content. This will require
4331 changes in the law, at least in the interim. These changes should be
4332 designed to balance the protection of the law against the strong
4333 public interest that innovation continue.
4337 <!-- PAGE BREAK 92 -->
4338 This is especially true when a new technology enables a vastly
4339 superior mode of distribution. And this p2p has done. P2p technologies
4340 can be ideally efficient in moving content across a widely diverse
4341 network. Left to develop, they could make the network vastly more
4342 efficient. Yet these
<quote>potential public benefits,
</quote> as John Schwartz
4343 writes in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>,
<quote>could be delayed in the P2P
4344 fight.
</quote><footnote><para>
4346 John Schwartz,
<quote>New Economy: The Attack on Peer-to-Peer Software
4347 Echoes Past Efforts,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 September
2003, C3.
4349 Yet when anyone begins to talk about
<quote>balance,
</quote> the copyright warriors
4350 raise a different argument.
<quote>All this hand waving about balance and
4351 incentives,
</quote> they say,
<quote>misses a fundamental point. Our content,
</quote> the
4352 warriors insist,
<quote>is our
<emphasis>property
</emphasis>. Why should we
4353 wait for Congress to `rebalance' our property rights? Do you have to
4354 wait before calling the police when your car has been stolen? And why
4355 should Congress deliberate at all about the merits of this theft? Do
4356 we ask whether the car thief had a good use for the car before we
4360 <quote>It is
<emphasis>our property
</emphasis>,
</quote> the warriors
4361 insist.
<quote>And it should be protected just as any other property
4362 is protected.
</quote>
4364 <!-- PAGE BREAK 93 -->
4368 <part id=
"c-property">
4369 <title><quote>PROPERTY
</quote></title>
4373 <!-- PAGE BREAK 94 -->
4374 The copyright warriors are right: A copyright is a kind of
4375 property. It can be owned and sold, and the law protects against its
4376 theft. Ordinarily, the copyright owner gets to hold out for any price he
4377 wants. Markets reckon the supply and demand that partially determine
4378 the price she can get.
4381 But in ordinary language, to call a copyright a
<quote>property
</quote> right is a
4382 bit misleading, for the property of copyright is an odd kind of
4383 property. Indeed, the very idea of property in any idea or any
4384 expression is very odd. I understand what I am taking when I take the
4385 picnic table you put in your backyard. I am taking a thing, the picnic
4386 table, and after I take it, you don't have it. But what am I taking
4387 when I take the good
<emphasis>idea
</emphasis> you had to put a picnic
4388 table in the backyard
—by, for example, going to Sears, buying a
4389 table, and putting it in my backyard? What is the thing I am taking
4393 The point is not just about the thingness of picnic tables versus
4394 ideas, though that's an important difference. The point instead is that
4395 <!-- PAGE BREAK 95 -->
4396 in the ordinary case
—indeed, in practically every case except for a
4398 range of exceptions
—ideas released to the world are free. I don't
4399 take anything from you when I copy the way you dress
—though I
4400 might seem weird if I did it every day, and especially weird if you are a
4401 woman. Instead, as Thomas Jefferson said (and as is especially true
4402 when I copy the way someone else dresses),
<quote>He who receives an idea
4403 from me, receives instruction himself without lessening mine; as he who
4404 lights his taper at mine, receives light without darkening me.
</quote><footnote><para>
4406 Letter from Thomas Jefferson to Isaac McPherson (
13 August
1813) in
4407 <citetitle>The Writings of Thomas Jefferson
</citetitle>, vol.
6 (Andrew A. Lipscomb and Albert
4408 Ellery Bergh, eds.,
1903),
330,
333–34.
4412 The exceptions to free use are ideas and expressions within the
4413 reach of the law of patent and copyright, and a few other domains that
4414 I won't discuss here. Here the law says you can't take my idea or
4416 without my permission: The law turns the intangible into
4420 But how, and to what extent, and in what form
—the details,
4421 in other words
—matter. To get a good sense of how this practice
4422 of turning the intangible into property emerged, we need to place this
4423 <quote>property
</quote> in its proper context.
<footnote><para>
4425 As the legal realists taught American law, all property rights are
4426 intangible. A property right is simply a right that an individual has
4427 against the world to do or not do certain things that may or may not
4428 attach to a physical object. The right itself is intangible, even if
4429 the object to which it is (metaphorically) attached is tangible. See
4430 Adam Mossoff,
<quote>What Is Property? Putting the Pieces Back Together,
</quote>
4431 <citetitle>Arizona Law Review
</citetitle> 45 (
2003):
373,
429 n.
241.
4435 My strategy in doing this will be the same as my strategy in the
4436 preceding part. I offer four stories to help put the idea of
4437 <quote>copyright material is property
</quote> in context. Where did the idea come
4438 from? What are its limits? How does it function in practice? After
4439 these stories, the significance of this true
4440 statement
—<quote>copyright material is property
</quote>— will be a bit
4441 more clear, and its implications will be revealed as quite different
4442 from the implications that the copyright warriors would have us draw.
4446 <!-- PAGE BREAK 96 -->
4447 <chapter label=
"6" id=
"founders">
4448 <title>CHAPTER SIX: Founders
</title>
4449 <indexterm><primary>Henry V
</primary></indexterm>
4451 William Shakespeare wrote
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> in
1595. The play
4452 was first published in
1597. It was the eleventh major play that
4453 Shakespeare had written. He would continue to write plays through
4454 1613, and the plays that he wrote have continued to define
4455 Anglo-American culture ever since. So deeply have the works of a
4456 sixteenth-century writer seeped into our culture that we often don't
4457 even recognize their source. I once overheard someone commenting on
4458 Kenneth Branagh's adaptation of Henry V:
<quote>I liked it, but Shakespeare
4459 is so full of clichés.
</quote>
4462 In
1774, almost
180 years after
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> was written, the
4463 <quote>copy-right
</quote> for the work was still thought by many to be the exclusive
4464 right of a single London publisher, Jacob Tonson.
<footnote><para>
4466 Jacob Tonson is typically remembered for his associations with prominent
4467 eighteenth-century literary figures, especially John Dryden, and for his
4468 handsome
<quote>definitive editions
</quote> of classic works. In addition to
<citetitle>Romeo and
4469 Juliet
</citetitle>, he published an astonishing array of works that still remain at the
4470 heart of the English canon, including collected works of Shakespeare, Ben
4471 Jonson, John Milton, and John Dryden. See Keith Walker,
<quote>Jacob Tonson,
4472 Bookseller,
</quote> <citetitle>American Scholar
</citetitle> 61:
3 (
1992):
424–31.
4474 Tonson was the most prominent of a small group of publishers called
4475 the Conger
<footnote><para>
4477 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle> (Nashville:
4478 Vanderbilt University Press,
1968),
151–52.
4480 who controlled bookselling in England during the eighteenth
4481 century. The Conger claimed a perpetual right to control the
<quote>copy
</quote> of
4482 books that they had acquired from authors. That perpetual right meant
4484 <!-- PAGE BREAK 97 -->
4485 one else could publish copies of a book to which they held the
4486 copyright. Prices of the classics were thus kept high; competition to
4487 produce better or cheaper editions was eliminated.
4490 Now, there's something puzzling about the year
1774 to anyone who
4491 knows a little about copyright law. The better-known year in the
4492 history of copyright is
1710, the year that the British Parliament
4493 adopted the first
<quote>copyright
</quote> act. Known as the Statute of Anne, the
4494 act stated that all published works would get a copyright term of
4495 fourteen years, renewable once if the author was alive, and that all
4496 works already published by
1710 would get a single term of twenty-one
4497 additional years.
<footnote><para>
4499 As Siva Vaidhyanathan nicely argues, it is erroneous to call this a
4500 <quote>copyright law.
</quote> See Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
40.
4501 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4502 </para></footnote> Under this law,
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> should have been
4503 free in
1731. So why was there any issue about it still being under
4504 Tonson's control in
1774?
4507 The reason is that the English hadn't yet agreed on what a
<quote>copyright
</quote>
4508 was
—indeed, no one had. At the time the English passed the
4509 Statute of Anne, there was no other legislation governing copyrights.
4510 The last law regulating publishers, the Licensing Act of
1662, had
4511 expired in
1695. That law gave publishers a monopoly over publishing,
4512 as a way to make it easier for the Crown to control what was
4513 published. But after it expired, there was no positive law that said
4514 that the publishers, or
<quote>Stationers,
</quote> had an exclusive right to print
4516 <indexterm><primary>Licensing Act (
1662)
</primary></indexterm>
4519 There was no
<emphasis>positive
</emphasis> law, but that didn't mean
4520 that there was no law. The Anglo-American legal tradition looks to
4521 both the words of legislatures and the words of judges to know the
4522 rules that are to govern how people are to behave. We call the words
4523 from legislatures
<quote>positive law.
</quote> We call the words from judges
4524 <quote>common law.
</quote> The common law sets the background against which
4525 legislatures legislate; the legislature, ordinarily, can trump that
4526 background only if it passes a law to displace it. And so the real
4527 question after the licensing statutes had expired was whether the
4528 common law protected a copyright, independent of any positive law.
4531 This question was important to the publishers, or
<quote>booksellers,
</quote> as
4532 they were called, because there was growing competition from foreign
4533 publishers. The Scottish, in particular, were increasingly publishing
4534 and exporting books to England. That competition reduced the profits
4536 <!-- PAGE BREAK 98 -->
4537 of the Conger, which reacted by demanding that Parliament pass a law
4538 to again give them exclusive control over publishing. That demand
4540 resulted in the Statute of Anne.
4543 The Statute of Anne granted the author or
<quote>proprietor
</quote> of a book an
4544 exclusive right to print that book. In an important limitation,
4545 however, and to the horror of the booksellers, the law gave the
4546 bookseller that right for a limited term. At the end of that term, the
4547 copyright
<quote>expired,
</quote> and the work would then be free and could be
4548 published by anyone. Or so the legislature is thought to have
4552 Now, the thing to puzzle about for a moment is this: Why would
4553 Parliament limit the exclusive right? Not why would they limit it to
4554 the particular limit they set, but why would they limit the right
4555 <emphasis>at all?
</emphasis>
4558 For the booksellers, and the authors whom they represented, had a very
4559 strong claim. Take
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> as an example: That play
4560 was written by Shakespeare. It was his genius that brought it into the
4561 world. He didn't take anybody's property when he created this play
4562 (that's a controversial claim, but never mind), and by his creating
4563 this play, he didn't make it any harder for others to craft a play. So
4564 why is it that the law would ever allow someone else to come along and
4565 take Shakespeare's play without his, or his estate's, permission? What
4566 reason is there to allow someone else to
<quote>steal
</quote> Shakespeare's work?
4569 The answer comes in two parts. We first need to see something special
4570 about the notion of
<quote>copyright
</quote> that existed at the time of the
4571 Statute of Anne. Second, we have to see something important about
4572 <quote>booksellers.
</quote>
4575 First, about copyright. In the last three hundred years, we have come
4576 to apply the concept of
<quote>copyright
</quote> ever more broadly. But in
1710, it
4577 wasn't so much a concept as it was a very particular right. The
4578 copyright was born as a very specific set of restrictions: It forbade
4579 others from reprinting a book. In
1710, the
<quote>copy-right
</quote> was a right
4580 to use a particular machine to replicate a particular work. It did not
4581 go beyond that very narrow right. It did not control any more
4583 <!-- PAGE BREAK 99 -->
4584 a work could be
<emphasis>used
</emphasis>. Today the right includes a
4585 large collection of restrictions on the freedom of others: It grants
4586 the author the exclusive right to copy, the exclusive right to
4587 distribute, the exclusive right to perform, and so on.
4590 So, for example, even if the copyright to Shakespeare's works were
4591 perpetual, all that would have meant under the original meaning of the
4592 term was that no one could reprint Shakespeare's work without the
4593 permission of the Shakespeare estate. It would not have controlled
4594 anything, for example, about how the work could be performed, whether
4595 the work could be translated, or whether Kenneth Branagh would be
4596 allowed to make his films. The
<quote>copy-right
</quote> was only an exclusive
4597 right to print
—no less, of course, but also no more.
4599 <indexterm><primary>Henry VIII, King of England
</primary></indexterm>
4601 Even that limited right was viewed with skepticism by the British.
4602 They had had a long and ugly experience with
<quote>exclusive rights,
</quote>
4603 especially
<quote>exclusive rights
</quote> granted by the Crown. The English had
4604 fought a civil war in part about the Crown's practice of handing out
4605 monopolies
—especially monopolies for works that already
4606 existed. King Henry VIII granted a patent to print the Bible and a
4607 monopoly to Darcy to print playing cards. The English Parliament began
4608 to fight back against this power of the Crown. In
1656, it passed the
4609 Statute of Monopolies, limiting monopolies to patents for new
4610 inventions. And by
1710, Parliament was eager to deal with the growing
4611 monopoly in publishing.
4614 Thus the
<quote>copy-right,
</quote> when viewed as a monopoly right, was naturally
4615 viewed as a right that should be limited. (However convincing the
4616 claim that
<quote>it's my property, and I should have it forever,
</quote> try
4617 sounding convincing when uttering,
<quote>It's my monopoly, and I should
4618 have it forever.
</quote>) The state would protect the exclusive right, but
4619 only so long as it benefited society. The British saw the harms from
4620 specialinterest favors; they passed a law to stop them.
4623 Second, about booksellers. It wasn't just that the copyright was a
4624 monopoly. It was also that it was a monopoly held by the booksellers.
4625 Booksellers sound quaint and harmless to us. They were not viewed
4626 as harmless in seventeenth-century England. Members of the Conger
4627 <!-- PAGE BREAK 100 -->
4629 were increasingly seen as monopolists of the worst
4630 kind
—tools of the Crown's repression, selling the liberty of
4631 England to guarantee themselves a monopoly profit. The attacks against
4632 these monopolists were harsh: Milton described them as
<quote>old patentees
4633 and monopolizers in the trade of book-selling
</quote>; they were
<quote>men who do
4634 not therefore labour in an honest profession to which learning is
4635 indetted.
</quote><footnote><para>
4638 Philip Wittenberg,
<citetitle>The Protection and Marketing of Literary
4639 Property
</citetitle> (New York: J. Messner, Inc.,
1937),
31.
4643 Many believed the power the booksellers exercised over the spread of
4644 knowledge was harming that spread, just at the time the Enlightenment
4645 was teaching the importance of education and knowledge spread
4646 generally. The idea that knowledge should be free was a hallmark of
4647 the time, and these powerful commercial interests were interfering
4651 To balance this power, Parliament decided to increase competition
4652 among booksellers, and the simplest way to do that was to spread the
4653 wealth of valuable books. Parliament therefore limited the term of
4654 copyrights, and thereby guaranteed that valuable books would become
4655 open to any publisher to publish after a limited time. Thus the setting
4656 of the term for existing works to just twenty-one years was a
4658 to fight the power of the booksellers. The limitation on terms was
4659 an indirect way to assure competition among publishers, and thus the
4660 construction and spread of culture.
4663 When
1731 (
1710 +
21) came along, however, the booksellers were
4664 getting anxious. They saw the consequences of more competition, and
4665 like every competitor, they didn't like them. At first booksellers simply
4666 ignored the Statute of Anne, continuing to insist on the perpetual right
4667 to control publication. But in
1735 and
1737, they tried to persuade
4668 Parliament to extend their terms. Twenty-one years was not enough,
4669 they said; they needed more time.
4672 Parliament rejected their requests. As one pamphleteer put it, in
4673 words that echo today,
4677 I see no Reason for granting a further Term now, which will not
4678 hold as well for granting it again and again, as often as the Old
4679 <!-- PAGE BREAK 101 -->
4680 ones Expire; so that should this Bill pass, it will in Effect be
4681 establishing a perpetual Monopoly, a Thing deservedly odious in the
4682 Eye of the Law; it will be a great Cramp to Trade, a Discouragement to
4683 Learning, no Benefit to the Authors, but a general Tax on the Publick;
4684 and all this only to increase the private Gain of the
4685 Booksellers.
<footnote><para>
4687 A Letter to a Member of Parliament concerning the Bill now depending
4688 in the House of Commons, for making more effectual an Act in the
4689 Eighth Year of the Reign of Queen Anne, entitled, An Act for the
4690 Encouragement of Learning, by Vesting the Copies of Printed Books in
4691 the Authors or Purchasers of such Copies, during the Times therein
4692 mentioned (London,
1735), in Brief Amici Curiae of Tyler T. Ochoa et
4693 al.,
8,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618).
4698 Having failed in Parliament, the publishers turned to the courts in a
4699 series of cases. Their argument was simple and direct: The Statute of
4700 Anne gave authors certain protections through positive law, but those
4701 protections were not intended as replacements for the common law.
4702 Instead, they were intended simply to supplement the common law.
4703 Under common law, it was already wrong to take another person's
4704 creative
<quote>property
</quote> and use it without his permission. The Statute of
4705 Anne, the booksellers argued, didn't change that. Therefore, just
4706 because the protections of the Statute of Anne expired, that didn't
4707 mean the protections of the common law expired: Under the common law
4708 they had the right to ban the publication of a book, even if its
4709 Statute of Anne copyright had expired. This, they argued, was the only
4710 way to protect authors.
4713 This was a clever argument, and one that had the support of some of
4714 the leading jurists of the day. It also displayed extraordinary
4715 chutzpah. Until then, as law professor Raymond Patterson has put it,
4716 <quote>The publishers
… had as much concern for authors as a cattle
4717 rancher has for cattle.
</quote><footnote><para>
4719 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<quote>Free Speech, Copyright, and Fair Use,
</quote> <citetitle>Vanderbilt
4720 Law Review
</citetitle> 40 (
1987):
28. For a wonderfully compelling account, see
4721 Vaidhyanathan,
37–48.
4722 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4724 The bookseller didn't care squat for the rights of the author. His
4725 concern was the monopoly profit that the author's work gave.
4728 The booksellers' argument was not accepted without a fight.
4729 The hero of this fight was a Scottish bookseller named Alexander
4730 Donaldson.
<footnote><para>
4732 For a compelling account, see David Saunders,
<citetitle>Authorship and Copyright
</citetitle>
4733 (London: Routledge,
1992),
62–69.
4737 Donaldson was an outsider to the London Conger. He began his
4738 career in Edinburgh in
1750. The focus of his business was inexpensive
4739 reprints
<quote>of standard works whose copyright term had expired,
</quote> at least
4740 under the Statute of Anne.
<footnote><para>
4742 Mark Rose,
<citetitle>Authors and Owners
</citetitle> (Cambridge: Harvard University Press,
4744 <indexterm><primary>Rose, Mark
</primary></indexterm>
4746 Donaldson's publishing house prospered
4747 <!-- PAGE BREAK 102 -->
4748 and became
<quote>something of a center for literary Scotsmen.
</quote> <quote>[A]mong
4749 them,
</quote> Professor Mark Rose writes, was
<quote>the young James Boswell
4750 who, together with his friend Andrew Erskine, published an anthology
4751 of contemporary Scottish poems with Donaldson.
</quote><footnote><para>
4755 <indexterm><primary>Boswell, James
</primary></indexterm>
4756 <indexterm><primary>Erskine, Andrew
</primary></indexterm>
4759 When the London booksellers tried to shut down Donaldson's shop in
4760 Scotland, he responded by moving his shop to London, where he sold
4761 inexpensive editions
<quote>of the most popular English books, in defiance
4762 of the supposed common law right of Literary
4763 Property.
</quote><footnote><para>
4765 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle>,
167 (quoting
4768 His books undercut the Conger prices by
30 to
50 percent, and he
4769 rested his right to compete upon the ground that, under the Statute of
4770 Anne, the works he was selling had passed out of protection.
4773 The London booksellers quickly brought suit to block
<quote>piracy
</quote> like
4774 Donaldson's. A number of actions were successful against the
<quote>pirates,
</quote>
4775 the most important early victory being
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Taylor
</citetitle>.
4778 Millar was a bookseller who in
1729 had purchased the rights to James
4779 Thomson's poem
<quote>The Seasons.
</quote> Millar complied with the requirements of
4780 the Statute of Anne, and therefore received the full protection of the
4781 statute. After the term of copyright ended, Robert Taylor began
4782 printing a competing volume. Millar sued, claiming a perpetual common
4783 law right, the Statute of Anne notwithstanding.
<footnote><para>
4785 Howard B. Abrams,
<quote>The Historic Foundation of American Copyright Law:
4786 Exploding the Myth of Common Law Copyright,
</quote> <citetitle>Wayne Law Review
</citetitle> 29
4790 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield2" class='startofrange'
>
4791 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
4794 Astonishingly to modern lawyers, one of the greatest judges in English
4795 history, Lord Mansfield, agreed with the booksellers. Whatever
4796 protection the Statute of Anne gave booksellers, it did not, he held,
4797 extinguish any common law right. The question was whether the common
4798 law would protect the author against subsequent
<quote>pirates.
</quote>
4799 Mansfield's answer was yes: The common law would bar Taylor from
4800 reprinting Thomson's poem without Millar's permission. That common law
4801 rule thus effectively gave the booksellers a perpetual right to
4802 control the publication of any book assigned to them.
4805 Considered as a matter of abstract justice
—reasoning as if
4806 justice were just a matter of logical deduction from first
4807 principles
—Mansfield's conclusion might make some sense. But
4808 what it ignored was the larger issue that Parliament had struggled
4809 with in
1710: How best to limit
4810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 103 -->
4811 the monopoly power of publishers? Parliament's strategy was to offer a
4812 term for existing works that was long enough to buy peace in
1710, but
4813 short enough to assure that culture would pass into competition within
4814 a reasonable period of time. Within twenty-one years, Parliament
4815 believed, Britain would mature from the controlled culture that the
4816 Crown coveted to the free culture that we inherited.
4818 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield2" class='endofrange'
/>
4820 The fight to defend the limits of the Statute of Anne was not to end
4821 there, however, and it is here that Donaldson enters the mix.
4823 <indexterm><primary>Beckett, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
4825 Millar died soon after his victory, so his case was not appealed. His
4826 estate sold Thomson's poems to a syndicate of printers that included
4827 Thomas Beckett.
<footnote><para>
4831 Donaldson then released an unauthorized edition
4832 of Thomson's works. Beckett, on the strength of the decision in
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle>,
4833 got an injunction against Donaldson. Donaldson appealed the case to
4834 the House of Lords, which functioned much like our own Supreme
4835 Court. In February of
1774, that body had the chance to interpret the
4836 meaning of Parliament's limits from sixty years before.
4839 As few legal cases ever do,
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle> drew an
4840 enormous amount of attention throughout Britain. Donaldson's lawyers
4841 argued that whatever rights may have existed under the common law, the
4842 Statute of Anne terminated those rights. After passage of the Statute
4843 of Anne, the only legal protection for an exclusive right to control
4844 publication came from that statute. Thus, they argued, after the term
4845 specified in the Statute of Anne expired, works that had been
4846 protected by the statute were no longer protected.
4849 The House of Lords was an odd institution. Legal questions were
4850 presented to the House and voted upon first by the
<quote>law lords,
</quote>
4851 members of special legal distinction who functioned much like the
4852 Justices in our Supreme Court. Then, after the law lords voted, the
4853 House of Lords generally voted.
4856 The reports about the law lords' votes are mixed. On some counts,
4857 it looks as if perpetual copyright prevailed. But there is no ambiguity
4858 <!-- PAGE BREAK 104 -->
4859 about how the House of Lords voted as whole. By a two-to-one majority
4860 (
22 to
11) they voted to reject the idea of perpetual copyrights.
4861 Whatever one's understanding of the common law, now a copyright was
4862 fixed for a limited time, after which the work protected by copyright
4863 passed into the public domain.
4866 <quote>The public domain.
</quote> Before the case of
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle>
4867 v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle>, there was no clear idea of a public domain in
4868 England. Before
1774, there was a strong argument that common law
4869 copyrights were perpetual. After
1774, the public domain was
4870 born. For the first time in Anglo-American history, the legal control
4871 over creative works expired, and the greatest works in English
4872 history
—including those of Shakespeare, Bacon, Milton, Johnson,
4873 and Bunyan
—were free of legal restraint.
4874 <indexterm><primary>Bacon, Francis
</primary></indexterm>
4875 <indexterm><primary>Bunyan, John
</primary></indexterm>
4876 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Samuel
</primary></indexterm>
4877 <indexterm><primary>Milton, John
</primary></indexterm>
4878 <indexterm><primary>Shakespeare, William
</primary></indexterm>
4881 It is hard for us to imagine, but this decision by the House of Lords
4882 fueled an extraordinarily popular and political reaction. In Scotland,
4883 where most of the
<quote>pirate publishers
</quote> did their work, people
4884 celebrated the decision in the streets. As the
<citetitle>Edinburgh Advertiser
</citetitle>
4885 reported,
<quote>No private cause has so much engrossed the attention of the
4886 public, and none has been tried before the House of Lords in the
4887 decision of which so many individuals were interested.
</quote> <quote>Great
4888 rejoicing in Edinburgh upon victory over literary property: bonfires
4889 and illuminations.
</quote><footnote><para>
4895 In London, however, at least among publishers, the reaction was
4896 equally strong in the opposite direction. The
<citetitle>Morning Chronicle
</citetitle>
4901 By the above decision
… near
200,
000 pounds worth of what was
4902 honestly purchased at public sale, and which was yesterday thought
4903 property is now reduced to nothing. The Booksellers of London and
4904 Westminster, many of whom sold estates and houses to purchase
4905 Copy-right, are in a manner ruined, and those who after many years
4906 industry thought they had acquired a competency to provide for their
4907 families now find themselves without a shilling to devise to their
4908 successors.
<footnote><para>
4915 <!-- PAGE BREAK 105 -->
4916 <quote>Ruined
</quote> is a bit of an exaggeration. But it is not an exaggeration to
4917 say that the change was profound. The decision of the House of Lords
4918 meant that the booksellers could no longer control how culture in
4919 England would grow and develop. Culture in England was thereafter
4920 <emphasis>free
</emphasis>. Not in the sense that copyrights would not
4921 be respected, for of course, for a limited time after a work was
4922 published, the bookseller had an exclusive right to control the
4923 publication of that book. And not in the sense that books could be
4924 stolen, for even after a copyright expired, you still had to buy the
4925 book from someone. But
<emphasis>free
</emphasis> in the sense that the
4926 culture and its growth would no longer be controlled by a small group
4927 of publishers. As every free market does, this free market of free
4928 culture would grow as the consumers and producers chose. English
4929 culture would develop as the many English readers chose to let it
4930 develop
— chose in the books they bought and wrote; chose in the
4931 memes they repeated and endorsed. Chose in a
<emphasis>competitive
4932 context
</emphasis>, not a context in which the choices about what
4933 culture is available to people and how they get access to it are made
4934 by the few despite the wishes of the many.
4937 At least, this was the rule in a world where the Parliament is
4938 antimonopoly, resistant to the protectionist pleas of publishers. In a
4939 world where the Parliament is more pliant, free culture would be less
4942 <!-- PAGE BREAK 106 -->
4944 <chapter label=
"7" id=
"recorders">
4945 <title>CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
</title>
4947 Jon Else is a filmmaker. He is best known for his documentaries and
4948 has been very successful in spreading his art. He is also a teacher, and
4949 as a teacher myself, I envy the loyalty and admiration that his students
4950 feel for him. (I met, by accident, two of his students at a dinner party.
4954 Else worked on a documentary that I was involved in. At a break,
4955 he told me a story about the freedom to create with film in America
4959 In
1990, Else was working on a documentary about Wagner's Ring
4960 Cycle. The focus was stagehands at the San Francisco Opera.
4961 Stagehands are a particularly funny and colorful element of an opera.
4962 During a show, they hang out below the stage in the grips' lounge and
4963 in the lighting loft. They make a perfect contrast to the art on the
4965 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
4968 During one of the performances, Else was shooting some stagehands
4969 playing checkers. In one corner of the room was a television set.
4970 Playing on the television set, while the stagehands played checkers
4971 and the opera company played Wagner, was
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. As Else judged
4972 <!-- PAGE BREAK 107 -->
4973 it, this touch of cartoon helped capture the flavor of what was special
4977 Years later, when he finally got funding to complete the film, Else
4978 attempted to clear the rights for those few seconds of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>.
4979 For of course, those few seconds are copyrighted; and of course, to use
4980 copyrighted material you need the permission of the copyright owner,
4981 unless
<quote>fair use
</quote> or some other privilege applies.
4984 Else called
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> creator Matt Groening's office to get permission.
4985 Groening approved the shot. The shot was a four-and-a-halfsecond image
4986 on a tiny television set in the corner of the room. How could it hurt?
4987 Groening was happy to have it in the film, but he told Else to contact
4988 Gracie Films, the company that produces the program.
4989 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
4992 Gracie Films was okay with it, too, but they, like Groening, wanted
4993 to be careful. So they told Else to contact Fox, Gracie's parent company.
4994 Else called Fox and told them about the clip in the corner of the one
4995 room shot of the film. Matt Groening had already given permission,
4996 Else said. He was just confirming the permission with Fox.
4997 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
5000 Then, as Else told me,
<quote>two things happened. First we discovered
5001 … that Matt Groening doesn't own his own creation
—or at
5002 least that someone [at Fox] believes he doesn't own his own creation.
</quote>
5003 And second, Fox
<quote>wanted ten thousand dollars as a licensing fee for us
5004 to use this four-point-five seconds of
… entirely unsolicited
5005 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> which was in the corner of the shot.
</quote>
5008 Else was certain there was a mistake. He worked his way up to someone
5009 he thought was a vice president for licensing, Rebecca Herrera. He
5010 explained to her,
<quote>There must be some mistake here.
… We're
5011 asking for your educational rate on this.
</quote> That was the educational
5012 rate, Herrera told Else. A day or so later, Else called again to
5013 confirm what he had been told.
5016 <quote>I wanted to make sure I had my facts straight,
</quote> he told me.
<quote>Yes, you
5017 have your facts straight,
</quote> she said. It would cost $
10,
000 to use the
5018 clip of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> in the corner of a shot in a documentary film
5021 <!-- PAGE BREAK 108 -->
5022 Wagner's Ring Cycle. And then, astonishingly, Herrera told Else,
<quote>And
5023 if you quote me, I'll turn you over to our attorneys.
</quote> As an assistant
5024 to Herrera told Else later on,
<quote>They don't give a shit. They just want
5028 Else didn't have the money to buy the right to replay what was playing
5029 on the television backstage at the San Francisco Opera. To reproduce
5030 this reality was beyond the documentary filmmaker's budget. At the
5031 very last minute before the film was to be released, Else digitally
5032 replaced the shot with a clip from another film that he had worked on,
5033 <citetitle>The Day After Trinity
</citetitle>, from ten years before.
5034 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
5035 <indexterm><primary>Day After Trinity, The
</primary></indexterm>
5038 There's no doubt that someone, whether Matt Groening or Fox, owns the
5039 copyright to
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. That copyright is their property. To use
5040 that copyrighted material thus sometimes requires the permission of
5041 the copyright owner. If the use that Else wanted to make of the
5042 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> copyright were one of the uses restricted by the law, then he
5043 would need to get the permission of the copyright owner before he
5044 could use the work in that way. And in a free market, it is the owner
5045 of the copyright who gets to set the price for any use that the law
5046 says the owner gets to control.
5049 For example,
<quote>public performance
</quote> is a use of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> that the
5050 copyright owner gets to control. If you take a selection of favorite
5051 episodes, rent a movie theater, and charge for tickets to come see
<quote>My
5052 Favorite
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>,
</quote> then you need to get permission from the copyright
5053 owner. And the copyright owner (rightly, in my view) can charge
5054 whatever she wants
—$
10 or $
1,
000,
000. That's her right, as set
5058 But when lawyers hear this story about Jon Else and Fox, their first
5059 thought is
<quote>fair use.
</quote><footnote><para>
5061 For an excellent argument that such use is
<quote>fair use,
</quote> but that
5062 lawyers don't permit recognition that it is
<quote>fair use,
</quote> see Richard
5063 A. Posner with William F. Patry,
<quote>Fair Use and Statutory Reform in the
5064 Wake of
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle></quote> (draft on file with author), University of Chicago
5065 Law School,
5 August
2003.
5067 Else's use of just
4.5 seconds of an indirect shot of a
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>
5068 episode is clearly a fair use of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>—and fair use does
5069 not require the permission of anyone.
5072 <!-- PAGE BREAK 109 -->
5073 So I asked Else why he didn't just rely upon
<quote>fair use.
</quote> Here's his reply:
5077 The
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> fiasco was for me a great lesson in the gulf between what
5078 lawyers find irrelevant in some abstract sense, and what is crushingly
5079 relevant in practice to those of us actually trying to make and
5080 broadcast documentaries. I never had any doubt that it was
<quote>clearly
5081 fair use
</quote> in an absolute legal sense. But I couldn't rely on the
5082 concept in any concrete way. Here's why:
5084 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
5087 Before our films can be broadcast, the network requires that we buy
5088 Errors and Omissions insurance. The carriers require a detailed
5089 <quote>visual cue sheet
</quote> listing the source and licensing status of each
5090 shot in the film. They take a dim view of
<quote>fair use,
</quote> and a claim of
5091 <quote>fair use
</quote> can grind the application process to a halt.
5095 I probably never should have asked Matt Groening in the first
5096 place. But I knew (at least from folklore) that Fox had a history of
5097 tracking down and stopping unlicensed
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> usage, just as George
5098 Lucas had a very high profile litigating
<citetitle>Star Wars
</citetitle> usage. So I decided
5099 to play by the book, thinking that we would be granted free or cheap
5100 license to four seconds of
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>. As a documentary producer working
5101 to exhaustion on a shoestring, the last thing I wanted was to risk
5102 legal trouble, even nuisance legal trouble, and even to defend a
5104 <indexterm><primary>Lucas, George
</primary></indexterm>
5108 I did, in fact, speak with one of your colleagues at Stanford Law
5109 School
… who confirmed that it was fair use. He also confirmed
5110 that Fox would
<quote>depose and litigate you to within an inch of your
5111 life,
</quote> regardless of the merits of my claim. He made clear that it
5112 would boil down to who had the bigger legal department and the deeper
5113 pockets, me or them.
5114 <!-- PAGE BREAK 110 -->
5118 The question of fair use usually comes up at the end of the
5119 project, when we are up against a release deadline and out of
5125 In theory, fair use means you need no permission. The theory therefore
5126 supports free culture and insulates against a permission culture. But
5127 in practice, fair use functions very differently. The fuzzy lines of
5128 the law, tied to the extraordinary liability if lines are crossed,
5129 means that the effective fair use for many types of creators is
5130 slight. The law has the right aim; practice has defeated the aim.
5133 This practice shows just how far the law has come from its
5134 eighteenth-century roots. The law was born as a shield to protect
5135 publishers' profits against the unfair competition of a pirate. It has
5136 matured into a sword that interferes with any use, transformative or
5139 <!-- PAGE BREAK 111 -->
5141 <chapter label=
"8" id=
"transformers">
5142 <title>CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
</title>
5143 <indexterm><primary>Allen, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
5144 <indexterm id='idxalbenalex1' class='startofrange'
>
5145 <primary>Alben, Alex
</primary>
5148 In
1993, Alex Alben was a lawyer working at Starwave, Inc. Starwave
5149 was an innovative company founded by Microsoft cofounder Paul Allen to
5150 develop digital entertainment. Long before the Internet became
5151 popular, Starwave began investing in new technology for delivering
5152 entertainment in anticipation of the power of networks.
5154 <indexterm id='idxartistsretrospective' class='startofrange'
>
5155 <primary>artists
</primary>
5156 <secondary>retrospective compilations on
</secondary>
5159 Alben had a special interest in new technology. He was intrigued by
5160 the emerging market for CD-ROM technology
—not to distribute
5161 film, but to do things with film that otherwise would be very
5162 difficult. In
1993, he launched an initiative to develop a product to
5163 build retrospectives on the work of particular actors. The first actor
5164 chosen was Clint Eastwood. The idea was to showcase all of the work of
5165 Eastwood, with clips from his films and interviews with figures
5166 important to his career.
5169 At that time, Eastwood had made more than fifty films, as an actor and
5170 as a director. Alben began with a series of interviews with Eastwood,
5171 asking him about his career. Because Starwave produced those
5172 interviews, it was free to include them on the CD.
5175 <!-- PAGE BREAK 112 -->
5176 That alone would not have made a very interesting product, so
5177 Starwave wanted to add content from the movies in Eastwood's career:
5178 posters, scripts, and other material relating to the films Eastwood
5179 made. Most of his career was spent at Warner Brothers, and so it was
5180 relatively easy to get permission for that content.
5183 Then Alben and his team decided to include actual film clips.
<quote>Our
5184 goal was that we were going to have a clip from every one of
5185 Eastwood's films,
</quote> Alben told me. It was here that the problem
5186 arose.
<quote>No one had ever really done this before,
</quote> Alben explained.
<quote>No
5187 one had ever tried to do this in the context of an artistic look at an
5188 actor's career.
</quote>
5191 Alben brought the idea to Michael Slade, the CEO of Starwave.
5192 Slade asked,
<quote>Well, what will it take?
</quote>
5195 Alben replied,
<quote>Well, we're going to have to clear rights from
5196 everyone who appears in these films, and the music and everything
5197 else that we want to use in these film clips.
</quote> Slade said,
<quote>Great! Go
5198 for it.
</quote><footnote>
5201 Technically, the rights that Alben had to clear were mainly those of
5202 publicity
—rights an artist has to control the commercial
5203 exploitation of his image. But these rights, too, burden
<quote>Rip, Mix,
5204 Burn
</quote> creativity, as this chapter evinces.
5206 <primary>artists
</primary>
5207 <secondary>publicity rights on images of
</secondary>
5209 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5213 The problem was that neither Alben nor Slade had any idea what
5214 clearing those rights would mean. Every actor in each of the films
5215 could have a claim to royalties for the reuse of that film. But CD-
5216 ROMs had not been specified in the contracts for the actors, so there
5217 was no clear way to know just what Starwave was to do.
5220 I asked Alben how he dealt with the problem. With an obvious
5221 pride in his resourcefulness that obscured the obvious bizarreness of his
5222 tale, Alben recounted just what they did:
5226 So we very mechanically went about looking up the film clips. We made
5227 some artistic decisions about what film clips to include
—of
5228 course we were going to use the
<quote>Make my day
</quote> clip from
<citetitle>Dirty
5229 Harry
</citetitle>. But you then need to get the guy on the ground who's wiggling
5230 under the gun and you need to get his permission. And then you have
5231 to decide what you are going to pay him.
5234 <!-- PAGE BREAK 113 -->
5235 We decided that it would be fair if we offered them the dayplayer rate
5236 for the right to reuse that performance. We're talking about a clip of
5237 less than a minute, but to reuse that performance in the CD-ROM the
5238 rate at the time was about $
600. So we had to identify the
5239 people
—some of them were hard to identify because in Eastwood
5240 movies you can't tell who's the guy crashing through the
5241 glass
—is it the actor or is it the stuntman? And then we just,
5242 we put together a team, my assistant and some others, and we just
5243 started calling people.
5247 Some actors were glad to help
—Donald Sutherland, for example,
5248 followed up himself to be sure that the rights had been cleared.
5249 Others were dumbfounded at their good fortune. Alben would ask,
5250 <quote>Hey, can I pay you $
600 or maybe if you were in two films, you
5251 know, $
1,
200?
</quote> And they would say,
<quote>Are you for real? Hey, I'd love
5252 to get $
1,
200.
</quote> And some of course were a bit difficult (estranged
5253 ex-wives, in particular). But eventually, Alben and his team had
5254 cleared the rights to this retrospective CD-ROM on Clint Eastwood's
5258 It was one
<emphasis>year
</emphasis> later
—<quote>and even then we
5259 weren't sure whether we were totally in the clear.
</quote>
5262 Alben is proud of his work. The project was the first of its kind and
5263 the only time he knew of that a team had undertaken such a massive
5264 project for the purpose of releasing a retrospective.
5268 Everyone thought it would be too hard. Everyone just threw up their
5269 hands and said,
<quote>Oh, my gosh, a film, it's so many copyrights, there's
5270 the music, there's the screenplay, there's the director, there's the
5271 actors.
</quote> But we just broke it down. We just put it into its
5272 constituent parts and said,
<quote>Okay, there's this many actors, this many
5273 directors,
… this many musicians,
</quote> and we just went at it very
5274 systematically and cleared the rights.
5279 <!-- PAGE BREAK 114 -->
5280 And no doubt, the product itself was exceptionally good. Eastwood
5281 loved it, and it sold very well.
5283 <indexterm><primary>Drucker, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
5285 But I pressed Alben about how weird it seems that it would have to
5286 take a year's work simply to clear rights. No doubt Alben had done
5287 this efficiently, but as Peter Drucker has famously quipped,
<quote>There is
5288 nothing so useless as doing efficiently that which should not be done
5289 at all.
</quote><footnote><para>
5291 U.S. Department of Commerce Office of Acquisition Management,
<citetitle>Seven
5292 Steps to Performance-Based Services Acquisition
</citetitle>, available at
5293 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
22</ulink>.
5295 Did it make sense, I asked Alben, that this is the way a new work
5299 For, as he acknowledged,
<quote>very few
… have the time and resources,
5300 and the will to do this,
</quote> and thus, very few such works would ever be
5301 made. Does it make sense, I asked him, from the standpoint of what
5302 anybody really thought they were ever giving rights for originally, that
5303 you would have to go clear rights for these kinds of clips?
5307 I don't think so. When an actor renders a performance in a movie,
5308 he or she gets paid very well.
… And then when
30 seconds of
5309 that performance is used in a new product that is a retrospective
5310 of somebody's career, I don't think that that person
… should be
5311 compensated for that.
5315 Or at least, is this
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> the artist should be
5316 compensated? Would it make sense, I asked, for there to be some kind
5317 of statutory license that someone could pay and be free to make
5318 derivative use of clips like this? Did it really make sense that a
5319 follow-on creator would have to track down every artist, actor,
5320 director, musician, and get explicit permission from each? Wouldn't a
5321 lot more be created if the legal part of the creative process could be
5322 made to be more clean?
5326 Absolutely. I think that if there were some fair-licensing
5327 mechanism
—where you weren't subject to hold-ups and you weren't
5328 subject to estranged former spouses
—you'd see a lot more of this
5329 work, because it wouldn't be so daunting to try to put together a
5330 <!-- PAGE BREAK 115 -->
5331 retrospective of someone's career and meaningfully illustrate it with
5332 lots of media from that person's career. You'd build in a cost as the
5333 producer of one of these things. You'd build in a cost of paying X
5334 dollars to the talent that performed. But it would be a known
5335 cost. That's the thing that trips everybody up and makes this kind of
5336 product hard to get off the ground. If you knew I have a hundred
5337 minutes of film in this product and it's going to cost me X, then you
5338 build your budget around it, and you can get investments and
5339 everything else that you need to produce it. But if you say,
<quote>Oh, I
5340 want a hundred minutes of something and I have no idea what it's going
5341 to cost me, and a certain number of people are going to hold me up for
5342 money,
</quote> then it becomes difficult to put one of these things together.
5346 Alben worked for a big company. His company was backed by some of the
5347 richest investors in the world. He therefore had authority and access
5348 that the average Web designer would not have. So if it took him a
5349 year, how long would it take someone else? And how much creativity is
5350 never made just because the costs of clearing the rights are so high?
5352 <indexterm startref='idxartistsretrospective' class='endofrange'
/>
5354 These costs are the burdens of a kind of regulation. Put on a
5355 Republican hat for a moment, and get angry for a bit. The government
5356 defines the scope of these rights, and the scope defined determines
5357 how much it's going to cost to negotiate them. (Remember the idea that
5358 land runs to the heavens, and imagine the pilot purchasing flythrough
5359 rights as he negotiates to fly from Los Angeles to San Francisco.)
5360 These rights might well have once made sense; but as circumstances
5361 change, they make no sense at all. Or at least, a well-trained,
5362 regulationminimizing Republican should look at the rights and ask,
5363 <quote>Does this still make sense?
</quote>
5365 <indexterm startref='idxalbenalex1' class='endofrange'
/>
5367 I've seen the flash of recognition when people get this point, but only
5368 a few times. The first was at a conference of federal judges in California.
5369 The judges were gathered to discuss the emerging topic of cyber-law. I
5370 was asked to be on the panel. Harvey Saferstein, a well-respected lawyer
5372 <!-- PAGE BREAK 116 -->
5373 from an L.A. firm, introduced the panel with a video that he and a
5374 friend, Robert Fairbank, had produced.
5377 The video was a brilliant collage of film from every period in the
5378 twentieth century, all framed around the idea of a
<citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode.
5379 The execution was perfect, down to the sixty-minute stopwatch. The
5380 judges loved every minute of it.
5382 <indexterm><primary>Nimmer, David
</primary></indexterm>
5384 When the lights came up, I looked over to my copanelist, David
5385 Nimmer, perhaps the leading copyright scholar and practitioner in the
5386 nation. He had an astonished look on his face, as he peered across the
5387 room of over
250 well-entertained judges. Taking an ominous tone, he
5388 began his talk with a question:
<quote>Do you know how many federal laws
5389 were just violated in this room?
</quote>
5391 <indexterm><primary>Boies, David
</primary></indexterm>
5392 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5394 For of course, the two brilliantly talented creators who made this
5395 film hadn't done what Alben did. They hadn't spent a year clearing the
5396 rights to these clips; technically, what they had done violated the
5397 law. Of course, it wasn't as if they or anyone were going to be
5398 prosecuted for this violation (the presence of
250 judges and a gaggle
5399 of federal marshals notwithstanding). But Nimmer was making an
5400 important point: A year before anyone would have heard of the word
5401 Napster, and two years before another member of our panel, David
5402 Boies, would defend Napster before the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals,
5403 Nimmer was trying to get the judges to see that the law would not be
5404 friendly to the capacities that this technology would
5405 enable. Technology means you can now do amazing things easily; but you
5406 couldn't easily do them legally.
5409 We live in a
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> culture enabled by technology. Anyone
5410 building a presentation knows the extraordinary freedom that the cut
5411 and paste architecture of the Internet created
—in a second you can
5412 find just about any image you want; in another second, you can have it
5413 planted in your presentation.
5416 But presentations are just a tiny beginning. Using the Internet and
5417 <!-- PAGE BREAK 117 -->
5418 its archives, musicians are able to string together mixes of sound
5419 never before imagined; filmmakers are able to build movies out of
5420 clips on computers around the world. An extraordinary site in Sweden
5421 takes images of politicians and blends them with music to create
5422 biting political commentary. A site called Camp Chaos has produced
5423 some of the most biting criticism of the record industry that there is
5424 through the mixing of Flash! and music.
5425 <indexterm><primary>Camp Chaos
</primary></indexterm>
5428 All of these creations are technically illegal. Even if the creators
5429 wanted to be
<quote>legal,
</quote> the cost of complying with the law is impossibly
5430 high. Therefore, for the law-abiding sorts, a wealth of creativity is
5431 never made. And for that part that is made, if it doesn't follow the
5432 clearance rules, it doesn't get released.
5435 To some, these stories suggest a solution: Let's alter the mix of
5436 rights so that people are free to build upon our culture. Free to add
5437 or mix as they see fit. We could even make this change without
5438 necessarily requiring that the
<quote>free
</quote> use be free as in
<quote>free beer.
</quote>
5439 Instead, the system could simply make it easy for follow-on creators
5440 to compensate artists without requiring an army of lawyers to come
5441 along: a rule, for example, that says
<quote>the royalty owed the copyright
5442 owner of an unregistered work for the derivative reuse of his work
5443 will be a flat
1 percent of net revenues, to be held in escrow for the
5444 copyright owner.
</quote> Under this rule, the copyright owner could benefit
5445 from some royalty, but he would not have the benefit of a full
5446 property right (meaning the right to name his own price) unless he
5450 Who could possibly object to this? And what reason would there be
5451 for objecting? We're talking about work that is not now being made;
5452 which if made, under this plan, would produce new income for artists.
5453 What reason would anyone have to oppose it?
5456 In February
2003, DreamWorks studios announced an agreement with Mike
5457 Myers, the comic genius of
<citetitle>Saturday Night Live
</citetitle> and
5458 <!-- PAGE BREAK 118 -->
5459 Austin Powers. According to the announcement, Myers and Dream-Works
5460 would work together to form a
<quote>unique filmmaking pact.
</quote> Under the
5461 agreement, DreamWorks
<quote>will acquire the rights to existing motion
5462 picture hits and classics, write new storylines and
—with the use
5463 of stateof-the-art digital technology
—insert Myers and other
5464 actors into the film, thereby creating an entirely new piece of
5465 entertainment.
</quote>
5468 The announcement called this
<quote>film sampling.
</quote> As Myers explained,
5469 <quote>Film Sampling is an exciting way to put an original spin on existing
5470 films and allow audiences to see old movies in a new light. Rap
5471 artists have been doing this for years with music and now we are able
5472 to take that same concept and apply it to film.
</quote> Steven Spielberg is
5473 quoted as saying,
<quote>If anyone can create a way to bring old films to
5474 new audiences, it is Mike.
</quote>
5477 Spielberg is right. Film sampling by Myers will be brilliant. But if
5478 you don't think about it, you might miss the truly astonishing point
5479 about this announcement. As the vast majority of our film heritage
5480 remains under copyright, the real meaning of the DreamWorks
5481 announcement is just this: It is Mike Myers and only Mike Myers who is
5482 free to sample. Any general freedom to build upon the film archive of
5483 our culture, a freedom in other contexts presumed for us all, is now a
5484 privilege reserved for the funny and famous
—and presumably rich.
5487 This privilege becomes reserved for two sorts of reasons. The first
5488 continues the story of the last chapter: the vagueness of
<quote>fair use.
</quote>
5489 Much of
<quote>sampling
</quote> should be considered
<quote>fair use.
</quote> But few would
5490 rely upon so weak a doctrine to create. That leads to the second reason
5491 that the privilege is reserved for the few: The costs of negotiating the
5492 legal rights for the creative reuse of content are astronomically high.
5493 These costs mirror the costs with fair use: You either pay a lawyer to
5494 defend your fair use rights or pay a lawyer to track down permissions
5495 so you don't have to rely upon fair use rights. Either way, the creative
5496 process is a process of paying lawyers
—again a privilege, or perhaps a
5497 curse, reserved for the few.
5499 <!-- PAGE BREAK 119 -->
5501 <chapter label=
"9" id=
"collectors">
5502 <title>CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
</title>
5503 <indexterm id='idxarchivesdigital1' class='startofrange'
>
5504 <primary>archives, digital
</primary>
5507 In April
1996, millions of
<quote>bots
</quote>—computer codes designed to
5508 <quote>spider,
</quote> or automatically search the Internet and copy content
—began
5509 running across the Net. Page by page, these bots copied Internet-based
5510 information onto a small set of computers located in a basement in San
5511 Francisco's Presidio. Once the bots finished the whole of the Internet,
5512 they started again. Over and over again, once every two months, these
5513 bits of code took copies of the Internet and stored them.
5516 By October
2001, the bots had collected more than five years of
5517 copies. And at a small announcement in Berkeley, California, the
5518 archive that these copies created, the Internet Archive, was opened to
5519 the world. Using a technology called
<quote>the Way Back Machine,
</quote> you could
5520 enter a Web page, and see all of its copies going back to
1996, as
5521 well as when those pages changed.
5523 <indexterm id='idxorwellgeorge' class='startofrange'
>
5524 <primary>Orwell, George
</primary>
5527 This is the thing about the Internet that Orwell would have
5528 appreciated. In the dystopia described in
<citetitle>1984</citetitle>, old newspapers were
5529 constantly updated to assure that the current view of the world,
5530 approved of by the government, was not contradicted by previous news
5534 <!-- PAGE BREAK 120 -->
5535 Thousands of workers constantly reedited the past, meaning there was
5536 no way ever to know whether the story you were reading today was the
5537 story that was printed on the date published on the paper.
5540 It's the same with the Internet. If you go to a Web page today,
5541 there's no way for you to know whether the content you are reading is
5542 the same as the content you read before. The page may seem the same,
5543 but the content could easily be different. The Internet is Orwell's
5544 library
—constantly updated, without any reliable memory.
5546 <indexterm startref='idxorwellgeorge' class='endofrange'
/>
5548 Until the Way Back Machine, at least. With the Way Back Machine, and
5549 the Internet Archive underlying it, you can see what the Internet
5550 was. You have the power to see what you remember. More importantly,
5551 perhaps, you also have the power to find what you don't remember and
5552 what others might prefer you forget.
<footnote><para>
5554 The temptations remain, however. Brewster Kahle reports that the White
5555 House changes its own press releases without notice. A May
13,
2003,
5556 press release stated,
<quote>Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended.
</quote> That was
5557 later changed, without notice, to
<quote>Major Combat Operations in Iraq
5558 Have Ended.
</quote> E-mail from Brewster Kahle,
1 December
2003.
5562 We take it for granted that we can go back to see what we remember
5563 reading. Think about newspapers. If you wanted to study the reaction
5564 of your hometown newspaper to the race riots in Watts in
1965, or to
5565 Bull Connor's water cannon in
1963, you could go to your public
5566 library and look at the newspapers. Those papers probably exist on
5567 microfiche. If you're lucky, they exist in paper, too. Either way, you
5568 are free, using a library, to go back and remember
—not just what
5569 it is convenient to remember, but remember something close to the
5573 It is said that those who fail to remember history are doomed to
5574 repeat it. That's not quite correct. We
<emphasis>all
</emphasis>
5575 forget history. The key is whether we have a way to go back to
5576 rediscover what we forget. More directly, the key is whether an
5577 objective past can keep us honest. Libraries help do that, by
5578 collecting content and keeping it, for schoolchildren, for
5579 researchers, for grandma. A free society presumes this knowedge.
5582 The Internet was an exception to this presumption. Until the Internet
5583 Archive, there was no way to go back. The Internet was the
5584 quintessentially transitory medium. And yet, as it becomes more
5585 important in forming and reforming society, it becomes more and more
5586 <!-- PAGE BREAK 121 -->
5587 important to maintain in some historical form. It's just bizarre to
5588 think that we have scads of archives of newspapers from tiny towns
5589 around the world, yet there is but one copy of the Internet
—the
5590 one kept by the Internet Archive.
5593 Brewster Kahle is the founder of the Internet Archive. He was a very
5594 successful Internet entrepreneur after he was a successful computer
5595 researcher. In the
1990s, Kahle decided he had had enough business
5596 success. It was time to become a different kind of success. So he
5597 launched a series of projects designed to archive human knowledge. The
5598 Internet Archive was just the first of the projects of this Andrew
5599 Carnegie of the Internet. By December of
2002, the archive had over
10
5600 billion pages, and it was growing at about a billion pages a month.
5603 The Way Back Machine is the largest archive of human knowledge in
5604 human history. At the end of
2002, it held
<quote>two hundred and thirty
5605 terabytes of material
</quote>—and was
<quote>ten times larger than the
5606 Library of Congress.
</quote> And this was just the first of the archives that
5607 Kahle set out to build. In addition to the Internet Archive, Kahle has
5608 been constructing the Television Archive. Television, it turns out, is
5609 even more ephemeral than the Internet. While much of twentieth-century
5610 culture was constructed through television, only a tiny proportion of
5611 that culture is available for anyone to see today. Three hours of news
5612 are recorded each evening by Vanderbilt University
—thanks to a
5613 specific exemption in the copyright law. That content is indexed, and
5614 is available to scholars for a very low fee.
<quote>But other than that,
5615 [television] is almost unavailable,
</quote> Kahle told me.
<quote>If you were
5616 Barbara Walters you could get access to [the archives], but if you are
5617 just a graduate student?
</quote> As Kahle put it,
5620 <indexterm><primary>Quayle, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
5622 Do you remember when Dan Quayle was interacting with Murphy Brown?
5623 Remember that back and forth surreal experience of a politician
5624 interacting with a fictional television character? If you were a
5625 graduate student wanting to study that, and you wanted to get those
5626 original back and forth exchanges between the two, the
5628 <!-- PAGE BREAK 122 -->
5629 <citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode that came out after it
… it would be almost
5630 impossible.
… Those materials are almost unfindable.
…
5634 Why is that? Why is it that the part of our culture that is recorded
5635 in newspapers remains perpetually accessible, while the part that is
5636 recorded on videotape is not? How is it that we've created a world
5637 where researchers trying to understand the effect of media on
5638 nineteenthcentury America will have an easier time than researchers
5639 trying to understand the effect of media on twentieth-century America?
5642 In part, this is because of the law. Early in American copyright law,
5643 copyright owners were required to deposit copies of their work in
5644 libraries. These copies were intended both to facilitate the spread
5645 of knowledge and to assure that a copy of the work would be around
5646 once the copyright expired, so that others might access and copy the
5650 These rules applied to film as well. But in
1915, the Library
5651 of Congress made an exception for film. Film could be copyrighted so
5652 long as such deposits were made. But the filmmaker was then allowed to
5653 borrow back the deposits
—for an unlimited time at no cost. In
5654 1915 alone, there were more than
5,
475 films deposited and
<quote>borrowed
5655 back.
</quote> Thus, when the copyrights to films expire, there is no copy
5656 held by any library. The copy exists
—if it exists at
5657 all
—in the library archive of the film company.
<footnote><para>
5659 Doug Herrick,
<quote>Toward a National Film Collection: Motion Pictures at
5660 the Library of Congress,
</quote> <citetitle>Film Library Quarterly
</citetitle> 13 nos.
2–3
5661 (
1980):
5; Anthony Slide,
<citetitle>Nitrate Won't Wait: A History of Film
5662 Preservation in the United States
</citetitle> ( Jefferson, N.C.: McFarland
&
5667 The same is generally true about television. Television broadcasts
5668 were originally not copyrighted
—there was no way to capture the
5669 broadcasts, so there was no fear of
<quote>theft.
</quote> But as technology enabled
5670 capturing, broadcasters relied increasingly upon the law. The law
5671 required they make a copy of each broadcast for the work to be
5672 <quote>copyrighted.
</quote> But those copies were simply kept by the
5673 broadcasters. No library had any right to them; the government didn't
5674 demand them. The content of this part of American culture is
5675 practically invisible to anyone who would look.
5678 Kahle was eager to correct this. Before September
11,
2001, he and
5679 <!-- PAGE BREAK 123 -->
5680 his allies had started capturing television. They selected twenty
5681 stations from around the world and hit the Record button. After
5682 September
11, Kahle, working with dozens of others, selected twenty
5683 stations from around the world and, beginning October
11,
2001, made
5684 their coverage during the week of September
11 available free on-line.
5685 Anyone could see how news reports from around the world covered the
5688 <indexterm><primary>Movie Archive
</primary></indexterm>
5690 <primary>archive.org
</primary>
5691 <seealso>Internet Archive
</seealso>
5694 Kahle had the same idea with film. Working with Rick Prelinger, whose
5695 archive of film includes close to
45,
000 <quote>ephemeral films
</quote> (meaning
5696 films other than Hollywood movies, films that were never copyrighted),
5697 Kahle established the Movie Archive. Prelinger let Kahle digitize
5698 1,
300 films in this archive and post those films on the Internet to be
5699 downloaded for free. Prelinger's is a for-profit company. It sells
5700 copies of these films as stock footage. What he has discovered is that
5701 after he made a significant chunk available for free, his stock
5702 footage sales went up dramatically. People could easily find the
5703 material they wanted to use. Some downloaded that material and made
5704 films on their own. Others purchased copies to enable other films to
5705 be made. Either way, the archive enabled access to this important
5706 part of our culture. Want to see a copy of the
<quote>Duck and Cover
</quote> film
5707 that instructed children how to save themselves in the middle of
5708 nuclear attack? Go to archive.org, and you can download the film in a
5709 few minutes
—for free.
5712 Here again, Kahle is providing access to a part of our culture that we
5713 otherwise could not get easily, if at all. It is yet another part of
5714 what defines the twentieth century that we have lost to history. The
5715 law doesn't require these copies to be kept by anyone, or to be
5716 deposited in an archive by anyone. Therefore, there is no simple way
5720 The key here is access, not price. Kahle wants to enable free access
5721 to this content, but he also wants to enable others to sell access to
5722 it. His aim is to ensure competition in access to this important part
5723 of our culture. Not during the commercial life of a bit of creative
5724 property, but during a second life that all creative property
5725 has
—a noncommercial life.
5728 For here is an idea that we should more clearly recognize. Every bit
5729 of creative property goes through different
<quote>lives.
</quote> In its first
5732 <!-- PAGE BREAK 124 -->
5733 creator is lucky, the content is sold. In such cases the commercial
5734 market is successful for the creator. The vast majority of creative
5735 property doesn't enjoy such success, but some clearly does. For that
5736 content, commercial life is extremely important. Without this
5737 commercial market, there would be, many argue, much less creativity.
5740 After the commercial life of creative property has ended, our
5741 tradition has always supported a second life as well. A newspaper
5742 delivers the news every day to the doorsteps of America. The very next
5743 day, it is used to wrap fish or to fill boxes with fragile gifts or to
5744 build an archive of knowledge about our history. In this second life,
5745 the content can continue to inform even if that information is no
5749 The same has always been true about books. A book goes out of print
5750 very quickly (the average today is after about a year
<footnote><para>
5752 Dave Barns,
<quote>Fledgling Career in Antique Books: Woodstock Landlord,
5753 Bar Owner Starts a New Chapter by Adopting Business,
</quote> <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
5754 5 September
1997, at Metro Lake
1L. Of books published between
1927
5755 and
1946, only
2.2 percent were in print in
2002. R. Anthony Reese,
5756 <quote>The First Sale Doctrine in the Era of Digital Networks,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston
5757 College Law Review
</citetitle> 44 (
2003):
593 n.
51.
5758 </para></footnote>). After
5759 it is out of print, it can be sold in used book stores without the
5760 copyright owner getting anything and stored in libraries, where many
5761 get to read the book, also for free. Used book stores and libraries
5762 are thus the second life of a book. That second life is extremely
5763 important to the spread and stability of culture.
5766 Yet increasingly, any assumption about a stable second life for
5767 creative property does not hold true with the most important
5768 components of popular culture in the twentieth and twenty-first
5769 centuries. For these
—television, movies, music, radio, the
5770 Internet
—there is no guarantee of a second life. For these sorts
5771 of culture, it is as if we've replaced libraries with Barnes
&
5772 Noble superstores. With this culture, what's accessible is nothing but
5773 what a certain limited market demands. Beyond that, culture
5777 For most of the twentieth century, it was economics that made this
5778 so. It would have been insanely expensive to collect and make
5779 accessible all television and film and music: The cost of analog
5780 copies is extraordinarily high. So even though the law in principle
5781 would have restricted the ability of a Brewster Kahle to copy culture
5783 <!-- PAGE BREAK 125 -->
5784 real restriction was economics. The market made it impossibly
5785 difficult to do anything about this ephemeral culture; the law had
5786 little practical effect.
5789 Perhaps the single most important feature of the digital revolution is
5790 that for the first time since the Library of Alexandria, it is
5791 feasible to imagine constructing archives that hold all culture
5792 produced or distributed publicly. Technology makes it possible to
5793 imagine an archive of all books published, and increasingly makes it
5794 possible to imagine an archive of all moving images and sound.
5797 The scale of this potential archive is something we've never imagined
5798 before. The Brewster Kahles of our history have dreamed about it; but
5799 we are for the first time at a point where that dream is possible. As
5804 It looks like there's about two to three million recordings of music.
5805 Ever. There are about a hundred thousand theatrical releases of
5806 movies,
… and about one to two million movies [distributed] during
5807 the twentieth century. There are about twenty-six million different
5808 titles of books. All of these would fit on computers that would fit in
5809 this room and be able to be afforded by a small company. So we're at
5810 a turning point in our history. Universal access is the goal. And the
5811 opportunity of leading a different life, based on this, is
5812 … thrilling. It could be one of the things humankind would be most
5813 proud of. Up there with the Library of Alexandria, putting a man on
5814 the moon, and the invention of the printing press.
5818 Kahle is not the only librarian. The Internet Archive is not the only
5819 archive. But Kahle and the Internet Archive suggest what the future of
5820 libraries or archives could be.
<emphasis>When
</emphasis> the
5821 commercial life of creative property ends, I don't know. But it
5822 does. And whenever it does, Kahle and his archive hint at a world
5823 where this knowledge, and culture, remains perpetually available. Some
5824 will draw upon it to understand it;
5825 <!-- PAGE BREAK 126 -->
5826 some to criticize it. Some will use it, as Walt Disney did, to
5827 re-create the past for the future. These technologies promise
5828 something that had become unimaginable for much of our past
—a
5829 future
<emphasis>for
</emphasis> our past. The technology of digital
5830 arts could make the dream of the Library of Alexandria real again.
5833 Technologists have thus removed the economic costs of building such an
5834 archive. But lawyers' costs remain. For as much as we might like to
5835 call these
<quote>archives,
</quote> as warm as the idea of a
<quote>library
</quote> might seem,
5836 the
<quote>content
</quote> that is collected in these digital spaces is also
5837 someone's
<quote>property.
</quote> And the law of property restricts the freedoms
5838 that Kahle and others would exercise.
5840 <indexterm startref='idxarchivesdigital1' class='endofrange'
/>
5841 <!-- PAGE BREAK 127 -->
5843 <chapter label=
"10" id=
"property-i">
5844 <title>CHAPTER TEN:
<quote>Property
</quote></title>
5846 Jack Valenti has been the president of the Motion Picture Association
5847 of America since
1966. He first came to Washington, D.C., with Lyndon
5848 Johnson's administration
—literally. The famous picture of
5849 Johnson's swearing-in on Air Force One after the assassination of
5850 President Kennedy has Valenti in the background. In his almost forty
5851 years of running the MPAA, Valenti has established himself as perhaps
5852 the most prominent and effective lobbyist in Washington.
5853 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Lyndon
</primary></indexterm>
5854 <indexterm><primary>Kennedy, John F.
</primary></indexterm>
5857 The MPAA is the American branch of the international Motion Picture
5858 Association. It was formed in
1922 as a trade association whose goal
5859 was to defend American movies against increasing domestic criticism.
5860 The organization now represents not only filmmakers but producers and
5861 distributors of entertainment for television, video, and cable. Its
5862 board is made up of the chairmen and presidents of the seven major
5863 producers and distributors of motion picture and television programs
5864 in the United States: Walt Disney, Sony Pictures Entertainment, MGM,
5865 Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, and
5867 <indexterm><primary>Disney, Inc.
</primary></indexterm>
5868 <indexterm><primary>Sony Pictures Entertainment
</primary></indexterm>
5869 <indexterm><primary>MGM
</primary></indexterm>
5870 <indexterm><primary>Paramount Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5871 <indexterm><primary>Twentieth Century Fox
</primary></indexterm>
5872 <indexterm><primary>Universal Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5873 <indexterm><primary>Warner Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
5876 <!-- PAGE BREAK 128 -->
5877 Valenti is only the third president of the MPAA. No president before
5878 him has had as much influence over that organization, or over
5879 Washington. As a Texan, Valenti has mastered the single most important
5880 political skill of a Southerner
—the ability to appear simple and
5881 slow while hiding a lightning-fast intellect. To this day, Valenti
5882 plays the simple, humble man. But this Harvard MBA, and author of four
5883 books, who finished high school at the age of fifteen and flew more
5884 than fifty combat missions in World War II, is no Mr. Smith. When
5885 Valenti went to Washington, he mastered the city in a quintessentially
5889 In defending artistic liberty and the freedom of speech that our
5890 culture depends upon, the MPAA has done important good. In crafting
5891 the MPAA rating system, it has probably avoided a great deal of
5892 speech-regulating harm. But there is an aspect to the organization's
5893 mission that is both the most radical and the most important. This is
5894 the organization's effort, epitomized in Valenti's every act, to
5895 redefine the meaning of
<quote>creative property.
</quote>
5898 In
1982, Valenti's testimony to Congress captured the strategy
5903 No matter the lengthy arguments made, no matter the charges and the
5904 counter-charges, no matter the tumult and the shouting, reasonable men
5905 and women will keep returning to the fundamental issue, the central
5906 theme which animates this entire debate:
<emphasis>Creative property
5907 owners must be accorded the same rights and protection resident in all
5908 other property owners in the nation
</emphasis>. That is the issue.
5909 That is the question. And that is the rostrum on which this entire
5910 hearing and the debates to follow must rest.
<footnote><para>
5912 Home Recording of Copyrighted Works: Hearings on H.R.
4783, H.R.
5913 4794, H.R.
4808, H.R.
5250, H.R.
5488, and H.R.
5705 Before the
5914 Subcommittee on Courts, Civil Liberties, and the Administration of
5915 Justice of the Committee on the Judiciary of the House of
5916 Representatives,
97th Cong.,
2nd sess. (
1982):
65 (testimony of Jack
5922 The strategy of this rhetoric, like the strategy of most of Valenti's
5923 rhetoric, is brilliant and simple and brilliant because simple. The
5924 <quote>central theme
</quote> to which
<quote>reasonable men and women
</quote> will return is
5926 <!-- PAGE BREAK 129 -->
5927 <quote>Creative property owners must be accorded the same rights and
5928 protections resident in all other property owners in the nation.
</quote>
5929 There are no second-class citizens, Valenti might have
5930 continued. There should be no second-class property owners.
5933 This claim has an obvious and powerful intuitive pull. It is stated
5934 with such clarity as to make the idea as obvious as the notion that we
5935 use elections to pick presidents. But in fact, there is no more
5936 extreme a claim made by
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> who is serious in
5937 this debate than this claim of Valenti's. Jack Valenti, however sweet
5938 and however brilliant, is perhaps the nation's foremost extremist when
5939 it comes to the nature and scope of
<quote>creative property.
</quote> His views
5940 have
<emphasis>no
</emphasis> reasonable connection to our actual legal
5941 tradition, even if the subtle pull of his Texan charm has slowly
5942 redefined that tradition, at least in Washington.
5945 While
<quote>creative property
</quote> is certainly
<quote>property
</quote> in a nerdy and
5946 precise sense that lawyers are trained to understand,
<footnote><para>
5948 Lawyers speak of
<quote>property
</quote> not as an absolute thing, but as a bundle
5949 of rights that are sometimes associated with a particular
5950 object. Thus, my
<quote>property right
</quote> to my car gives me the right to
5951 exclusive use, but not the right to drive at
150 miles an hour. For
5952 the best effort to connect the ordinary meaning of
<quote>property
</quote> to
5953 <quote>lawyer talk,
</quote> see Bruce Ackerman,
<citetitle>Private Property and the
5954 Constitution
</citetitle> (New Haven: Yale University Press,
1977),
26–27.
5955 </para></footnote> it has never been the case, nor should it be, that
5956 <quote>creative property owners
</quote> have been
<quote>accorded the same rights and
5957 protection resident in all other property owners.
</quote> Indeed, if creative
5958 property owners were given the same rights as all other property
5959 owners, that would effect a radical, and radically undesirable, change
5963 Valenti knows this. But he speaks for an industry that cares squat for
5964 our tradition and the values it represents. He speaks for an industry
5965 that is instead fighting to restore the tradition that the British
5966 overturned in
1710. In the world that Valenti's changes would create,
5967 a powerful few would exercise powerful control over how our creative
5968 culture would develop.
5971 I have two purposes in this chapter. The first is to convince you
5972 that, historically, Valenti's claim is absolutely wrong. The second is
5973 to convince you that it would be terribly wrong for us to reject our
5974 history. We have always treated rights in creative property
5975 differently from the rights resident in all other property
5976 owners. They have never been the same. And they should never be the
5977 same, because, however counterintuitive this may seem, to make them
5978 the same would be to
5980 <!-- PAGE BREAK 130 -->
5981 fundamentally weaken the opportunity for new creators to create.
5982 Creativity depends upon the owners of creativity having less than
5986 Organizations such as the MPAA, whose board includes the most powerful
5987 of the old guard, have little interest, their rhetoric
5988 notwithstanding, in assuring that the new can displace them. No
5989 organization does. No person does. (Ask me about tenure, for example.)
5990 But what's good for the MPAA is not necessarily good for America. A
5991 society that defends the ideals of free culture must preserve
5992 precisely the opportunity for new creativity to threaten the old. To
5993 get just a hint that there is something fundamentally wrong in
5994 Valenti's argument, we need look no further than the United States
5995 Constitution itself.
5998 The framers of our Constitution loved
<quote>property.
</quote> Indeed, so strongly
5999 did they love property that they built into the Constitution an
6000 important requirement. If the government takes your property
—if
6001 it condemns your house, or acquires a slice of land from your
6002 farm
—it is required, under the Fifth Amendment's
<quote>Takings
6003 Clause,
</quote> to pay you
<quote>just compensation
</quote> for that taking. The
6004 Constitution thus guarantees that property is, in a certain sense,
6005 sacred. It cannot
<emphasis>ever
</emphasis> be taken from the property
6006 owner unless the government pays for the privilege.
6009 Yet the very same Constitution speaks very differently about what
6010 Valenti calls
<quote>creative property.
</quote> In the clause granting Congress the
6011 power to create
<quote>creative property,
</quote> the Constitution
6012 <emphasis>requires
</emphasis> that after a
<quote>limited time,
</quote> Congress
6013 take back the rights that it has granted and set the
<quote>creative
6014 property
</quote> free to the public domain. Yet when Congress does this, when
6015 the expiration of a copyright term
<quote>takes
</quote> your copyright and turns it
6016 over to the public domain, Congress does not have any obligation to
6017 pay
<quote>just compensation
</quote> for this
<quote>taking.
</quote> Instead, the same
6018 Constitution that requires compensation for your land
6019 <!-- PAGE BREAK 131 -->
6020 requires that you lose your
<quote>creative property
</quote> right without any
6021 compensation at all.
6024 The Constitution thus on its face states that these two forms of
6025 property are not to be accorded the same rights. They are plainly to
6026 be treated differently. Valenti is therefore not just asking for a
6027 change in our tradition when he argues that creative-property owners
6028 should be accorded the same rights as every other property-right
6029 owner. He is effectively arguing for a change in our Constitution
6033 Arguing for a change in our Constitution is not necessarily wrong.
6034 There was much in our original Constitution that was plainly wrong.
6035 The Constitution of
1789 entrenched slavery; it left senators to be
6036 appointed rather than elected; it made it possible for the electoral
6037 college to produce a tie between the president and his own vice
6038 president (as it did in
1800). The framers were no doubt
6039 extraordinary, but I would be the first to admit that they made big
6040 mistakes. We have since rejected some of those mistakes; no doubt
6041 there could be others that we should reject as well. So my argument is
6042 not simply that because Jefferson did it, we should, too.
6045 Instead, my argument is that because Jefferson did it, we should at
6046 least try to understand
<emphasis>why
</emphasis>. Why did the framers,
6047 fanatical property types that they were, reject the claim that
6048 creative property be given the same rights as all other property? Why
6049 did they require that for creative property there must be a public
6053 To answer this question, we need to get some perspective on the
6054 history of these
<quote>creative property
</quote> rights, and the control that they
6055 enabled. Once we see clearly how differently these rights have been
6056 defined, we will be in a better position to ask the question that
6057 should be at the core of this war: Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis>
6058 creative property should be protected, but how. Not
6059 <emphasis>whether
</emphasis> we will enforce the rights the law gives
6060 to creative-property owners, but what the particular mix of rights
6061 ought to be. Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> artists should be paid,
6062 but whether institutions designed to assure that artists get paid need
6063 also control how culture develops.
6067 <!-- PAGE BREAK 132 -->
6068 To answer these questions, we need a more general way to talk about
6069 how property is protected. More precisely, we need a more general way
6070 than the narrow language of the law allows. In
<citetitle>Code and Other Laws of
6071 Cyberspace
</citetitle>, I used a simple model to capture this more general
6072 perspective. For any particular right or regulation, this model asks
6073 how four different modalities of regulation interact to support or
6074 weaken the right or regulation. I represented it with this diagram:
6076 <figure id=
"fig-1331">
6077 <title>How four different modalities of regulation interact to support or weaken the right or regulation.
</title>
6078 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6081 At the center of this picture is a regulated dot: the individual or
6082 group that is the target of regulation, or the holder of a right. (In
6083 each case throughout, we can describe this either as regulation or as
6084 a right. For simplicity's sake, I will speak only of regulations.)
6085 The ovals represent four ways in which the individual or group might
6086 be regulated
— either constrained or, alternatively, enabled. Law
6087 is the most obvious constraint (to lawyers, at least). It constrains
6088 by threatening punishments after the fact if the rules set in advance
6089 are violated. So if, for example, you willfully infringe Madonna's
6090 copyright by copying a song from her latest CD and posting it on the
6091 Web, you can be punished
6092 <!-- PAGE BREAK 133 -->
6093 with a $
150,
000 fine. The fine is an ex post punishment for violating
6094 an ex ante rule. It is imposed by the state.
6095 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
6097 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6099 Norms are a different kind of constraint. They, too, punish an
6100 individual for violating a rule. But the punishment of a norm is
6101 imposed by a community, not (or not only) by the state. There may be
6102 no law against spitting, but that doesn't mean you won't be punished
6103 if you spit on the ground while standing in line at a movie. The
6104 punishment might not be harsh, though depending upon the community, it
6105 could easily be more harsh than many of the punishments imposed by the
6106 state. The mark of the difference is not the severity of the rule, but
6107 the source of the enforcement.
6109 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6111 The market is a third type of constraint. Its constraint is effected
6112 through conditions: You can do X if you pay Y; you'll be paid M if you
6113 do N. These constraints are obviously not independent of law or
6114 norms
—it is property law that defines what must be bought if it
6115 is to be taken legally; it is norms that say what is appropriately
6116 sold. But given a set of norms, and a background of property and
6117 contract law, the market imposes a simultaneous constraint upon how an
6118 individual or group might behave.
6120 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6122 Finally, and for the moment, perhaps, most mysteriously,
6123 <quote>architecture
</quote>—the physical world as one finds it
—is a
6124 constraint on behavior. A fallen bridge might constrain your ability
6125 to get across a river. Railroad tracks might constrain the ability of
6126 a community to integrate its social life. As with the market,
6127 architecture does not effect its constraint through ex post
6128 punishments. Instead, also as with the market, architecture effects
6129 its constraint through simultaneous conditions. These conditions are
6130 imposed not by courts enforcing contracts, or by police punishing
6131 theft, but by nature, by
<quote>architecture.
</quote> If a
500-pound boulder
6132 blocks your way, it is the law of gravity that enforces this
6133 constraint. If a $
500 airplane ticket stands between you and a flight
6134 to New York, it is the market that enforces this constraint.
6138 <!-- PAGE BREAK 134 -->
6139 So the first point about these four modalities of regulation is
6140 obvious: They interact. Restrictions imposed by one might be
6141 reinforced by another. Or restrictions imposed by one might be
6142 undermined by another.
6145 The second point follows directly: If we want to understand the
6146 effective freedom that anyone has at a given moment to do any
6147 particular thing, we have to consider how these four modalities
6148 interact. Whether or not there are other constraints (there may well
6149 be; my claim is not about comprehensiveness), these four are among the
6150 most significant, and any regulator (whether controlling or freeing)
6151 must consider how these four in particular interact.
6153 <indexterm id=
"idxdrivespeed" class='startofrange'
>
6154 <primary>driving speed, constraints on
</primary>
6156 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6157 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6158 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6160 So, for example, consider the
<quote>freedom
</quote> to drive a car at a high
6161 speed. That freedom is in part restricted by laws: speed limits that
6162 say how fast you can drive in particular places at particular
6163 times. It is in part restricted by architecture: speed bumps, for
6164 example, slow most rational drivers; governors in buses, as another
6165 example, set the maximum rate at which the driver can drive. The
6166 freedom is in part restricted by the market: Fuel efficiency drops as
6167 speed increases, thus the price of gasoline indirectly constrains
6168 speed. And finally, the norms of a community may or may not constrain
6169 the freedom to speed. Drive at
50 mph by a school in your own
6170 neighborhood and you're likely to be punished by the neighbors. The
6171 same norm wouldn't be as effective in a different town, or at night.
6174 The final point about this simple model should also be fairly clear:
6175 While these four modalities are analytically independent, law has a
6176 special role in affecting the three.
<footnote><para>
6178 By describing the way law affects the other three modalities, I don't
6179 mean to suggest that the other three don't affect law. Obviously, they
6180 do. Law's only distinction is that it alone speaks as if it has a
6181 right self-consciously to change the other three. The right of the
6182 other three is more timidly expressed. See Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Code: And
6183 Other Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books,
1999):
90–95;
6184 Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>The New Chicago School,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of Legal Studies
</citetitle>,
6187 The law, in other words, sometimes operates to increase or decrease
6188 the constraint of a particular modality. Thus, the law might be used
6189 to increase taxes on gasoline, so as to increase the incentives to
6190 drive more slowly. The law might be used to mandate more speed bumps,
6191 so as to increase the difficulty of driving rapidly. The law might be
6192 used to fund ads that stigmatize reckless driving. Or the law might be
6193 used to require that other laws be more
6194 <!-- PAGE BREAK 135 -->
6195 strict
—a federal requirement that states decrease the speed
6196 limit, for example
—so as to decrease the attractiveness of fast
6199 <indexterm startref=
"idxdrivespeed" class='endofrange'
/>
6201 <figure id=
"fig-1361">
6202 <title>Law has a special role in affecting the three.
</title>
6203 <graphic fileref=
"images/1361.png"></graphic>
6205 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6207 These constraints can thus change, and they can be changed. To
6208 understand the effective protection of liberty or protection of
6209 property at any particular moment, we must track these changes over
6210 time. A restriction imposed by one modality might be erased by
6211 another. A freedom enabled by one modality might be displaced by
6215 Some people object to this way of talking about
<quote>liberty.
</quote> They object
6216 because their focus when considering the constraints that exist at any
6217 particular moment are constraints imposed exclusively by the
6218 government. For instance, if a storm destroys a bridge, these people
6219 think it is meaningless to say that one's liberty has been
6220 restrained. A bridge has washed out, and it's harder to get from one
6221 place to another. To talk about this as a loss of freedom, they say,
6222 is to confuse the stuff of politics with the vagaries of ordinary
6223 life. I don't mean to deny the value in this narrower view, which
6224 depends upon the context of the inquiry. I do, however, mean to argue
6225 against any insistence that this narrower view is the only proper view
6226 of liberty. As I argued in
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, we come from a
6227 long tradition of political thought with a broader focus than the
6228 narrow question of what the government did when. John Stuart Mill
6229 defended freedom of speech, for example, from the tyranny of narrow
6230 minds, not from the fear of government prosecution; John Stuart Mill,
6231 <citetitle>On Liberty
</citetitle> (Indiana: Hackett Publishing Co.,
6232 1978),
19. John R. Commons famously defended the economic freedom of
6233 labor from constraints imposed by the market; John R. Commons,
<quote>The
6234 Right to Work,
</quote> in Malcom Rutherford and Warren J. Samuels, eds.,
6235 <citetitle>John R. Commons: Selected Essays
</citetitle> (London:
6236 Routledge:
1997),
62. The Americans with Disabilities Act increases
6237 the liberty of people with physical disabilities by changing the
6238 architecture of certain public places, thereby making access to those
6239 places easier;
42 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6240 12101 (
2000). Each of these interventions to change existing
6241 conditions changes the liberty of a particular group. The effect of
6242 those interventions should be accounted for in order to understand the
6243 effective liberty that each of these groups might face.
6244 <indexterm><primary>Americans with Disabilities Act (
1990)
</primary></indexterm>
6245 <indexterm><primary>Commons, John R.
</primary></indexterm>
6246 <indexterm><primary>architecture, constraint effected through
</primary></indexterm>
6247 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6250 <section id=
"hollywood">
6251 <title>Why Hollywood Is Right
</title>
6253 The most obvious point that this model reveals is just why, or just
6254 how, Hollywood is right. The copyright warriors have rallied Congress
6255 and the courts to defend copyright. This model helps us see why that
6256 rallying makes sense.
6259 Let's say this is the picture of copyright's regulation before the
6262 <figure id=
"fig-1371">
6263 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6264 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6266 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
6267 <indexterm><primary>norms, regulatory influence of
</primary></indexterm>
6269 <!-- PAGE BREAK 136 -->
6270 There is balance between law, norms, market, and architecture. The law
6271 limits the ability to copy and share content, by imposing penalties on
6272 those who copy and share content. Those penalties are reinforced by
6273 technologies that make it hard to copy and share content
6274 (architecture) and expensive to copy and share content
6275 (market). Finally, those penalties are mitigated by norms we all
6276 recognize
—kids, for example, taping other kids' records. These
6277 uses of copyrighted material may well be infringement, but the norms
6278 of our society (before the Internet, at least) had no problem with
6279 this form of infringement.
6282 Enter the Internet, or, more precisely, technologies such as MP3s and
6283 p2p sharing. Now the constraint of architecture changes dramatically,
6284 as does the constraint of the market. And as both the market and
6285 architecture relax the regulation of copyright, norms pile on. The
6286 happy balance (for the warriors, at least) of life before the Internet
6287 becomes an effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
6290 Thus the sense of, and justification for, the warriors' response.
6291 Technology has changed, the warriors say, and the effect of this
6292 change, when ramified through the market and norms, is that a balance
6293 of protection for the copyright owners' rights has been lost. This is
6295 <!-- PAGE BREAK 137 -->
6296 after the fall of Saddam, but this time no government is justifying the
6297 looting that results.
6299 <figure id=
"fig-1381">
6300 <title>effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
</title>
6301 <graphic fileref=
"images/1381.png"></graphic>
6304 Neither this analysis nor the conclusions that follow are new to the
6305 warriors. Indeed, in a
<quote>White Paper
</quote> prepared by the Commerce
6306 Department (one heavily influenced by the copyright warriors) in
1995,
6307 this mix of regulatory modalities had already been identified and the
6308 strategy to respond already mapped. In response to the changes the
6309 Internet had effected, the White Paper argued (
1) Congress should
6310 strengthen intellectual property law, (
2) businesses should adopt
6311 innovative marketing techniques, (
3) technologists should push to
6312 develop code to protect copyrighted material, and (
4) educators should
6313 educate kids to better protect copyright.
6316 This mixed strategy is just what copyright needed
—if it was to
6317 preserve the particular balance that existed before the change induced
6318 by the Internet. And it's just what we should expect the content
6319 industry to push for. It is as American as apple pie to consider the
6320 happy life you have as an entitlement, and to look to the law to
6321 protect it if something comes along to change that happy
6322 life. Homeowners living in a
6324 <!-- PAGE BREAK 138 -->
6325 flood plain have no hesitation appealing to the government to rebuild
6326 (and rebuild again) when a flood (architecture) wipes away their
6327 property (law). Farmers have no hesitation appealing to the government
6328 to bail them out when a virus (architecture) devastates their
6329 crop. Unions have no hesitation appealing to the government to bail
6330 them out when imports (market) wipe out the U.S. steel industry.
6333 Thus, there's nothing wrong or surprising in the content industry's
6334 campaign to protect itself from the harmful consequences of a
6335 technological innovation. And I would be the last person to argue that
6336 the changing technology of the Internet has not had a profound effect
6337 on the content industry's way of doing business, or as John Seely
6338 Brown describes it, its
<quote>architecture of revenue.
</quote>
6340 <indexterm><primary>railroad industry
</primary></indexterm>
6341 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
6343 But just because a particular interest asks for government support, it
6344 doesn't follow that support should be granted. And just because
6345 technology has weakened a particular way of doing business, it doesn't
6346 follow that the government should intervene to support that old way of
6347 doing business. Kodak, for example, has lost perhaps as much as
20
6348 percent of their traditional film market to the emerging technologies
6349 of digital cameras.
<footnote><para>
6351 See Geoffrey Smith,
<quote>Film vs. Digital: Can Kodak Build a Bridge?
</quote>
6352 BusinessWeek online,
2 August
1999, available at
6353 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
23</ulink>. For a more
6354 recent analysis of Kodak's place in the market, see Chana
6355 R. Schoenberger,
<quote>Can Kodak Make Up for Lost Moments?
</quote> Forbes.com,
6
6356 October
2003, available at
6357 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
24</ulink>.
6360 Does anyone believe the government should ban digital cameras just to
6361 support Kodak? Highways have weakened the freight business for
6362 railroads. Does anyone think we should ban trucks from roads
6363 <emphasis>for the purpose of
</emphasis> protecting the railroads?
6364 Closer to the subject of this book, remote channel changers have
6365 weakened the
<quote>stickiness
</quote> of television advertising (if a boring
6366 commercial comes on the TV, the remote makes it easy to surf ), and it
6367 may well be that this change has weakened the television advertising
6368 market. But does anyone believe we should regulate remotes to
6369 reinforce commercial television? (Maybe by limiting them to function
6370 only once a second, or to switch to only ten channels within an hour?)
6373 The obvious answer to these obviously rhetorical questions is no.
6374 In a free society, with a free market, supported by free enterprise and
6375 free trade, the government's role is not to support one way of doing
6376 <!-- PAGE BREAK 139 -->
6377 business against others. Its role is not to pick winners and protect
6378 them against loss. If the government did this generally, then we would
6379 never have any progress. As Microsoft chairman Bill Gates wrote in
6380 1991, in a memo criticizing software patents,
<quote>established companies
6381 have an interest in excluding future competitors.
</quote><footnote><para>
6383 Fred Warshofsky,
<citetitle>The Patent Wars
</citetitle> (New York: Wiley,
1994),
170–71.
6386 startup, established companies also have the means. (Think RCA and
6387 FM radio.) A world in which competitors with new ideas must fight
6388 not only the market but also the government is a world in which
6389 competitors with new ideas will not succeed. It is a world of stasis and
6390 increasingly concentrated stagnation. It is the Soviet Union under
6392 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
6395 Thus, while it is understandable for industries threatened with new
6396 technologies that change the way they do business to look to the
6397 government for protection, it is the special duty of policy makers to
6398 guarantee that that protection not become a deterrent to progress. It
6399 is the duty of policy makers, in other words, to assure that the
6400 changes they create, in response to the request of those hurt by
6401 changing technology, are changes that preserve the incentives and
6402 opportunities for innovation and change.
6405 In the context of laws regulating speech
—which include,
6406 obviously, copyright law
—that duty is even stronger. When the
6407 industry complaining about changing technologies is asking Congress to
6408 respond in a way that burdens speech and creativity, policy makers
6409 should be especially wary of the request. It is always a bad deal for
6410 the government to get into the business of regulating speech
6411 markets. The risks and dangers of that game are precisely why our
6412 framers created the First Amendment to our Constitution:
<quote>Congress
6413 shall make no law
… abridging the freedom of speech.
</quote> So when
6414 Congress is being asked to pass laws that would
<quote>abridge
</quote> the freedom
6415 of speech, it should ask
— carefully
—whether such
6416 regulation is justified.
6419 My argument just now, however, has nothing to do with whether
6420 <!-- PAGE BREAK 140 -->
6421 the changes that are being pushed by the copyright warriors are
6422 <quote>justified.
</quote> My argument is about their effect. For before we get to
6423 the question of justification, a hard question that depends a great
6424 deal upon your values, we should first ask whether we understand the
6425 effect of the changes the content industry wants.
6428 Here's the metaphor that will capture the argument to follow.
6430 <indexterm id=
"idxddt" class='startofrange'
>
6431 <primary>DDT
</primary>
6434 In
1873, the chemical DDT was first synthesized. In
1948, Swiss
6435 chemist Paul Hermann Müller won the Nobel Prize for his work
6436 demonstrating the insecticidal properties of DDT. By the
1950s, the
6437 insecticide was widely used around the world to kill disease-carrying
6438 pests. It was also used to increase farm production.
6439 <indexterm><primary>Müller, Paul Hermann
</primary></indexterm>
6442 No one doubts that killing disease-carrying pests or increasing crop
6443 production is a good thing. No one doubts that the work of Müller was
6444 important and valuable and probably saved lives, possibly millions.
6446 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6448 But in
1962, Rachel Carson published
<citetitle>Silent Spring
</citetitle>, which argued that
6449 DDT, whatever its primary benefits, was also having unintended
6450 environmental consequences. Birds were losing the ability to
6451 reproduce. Whole chains of the ecology were being destroyed.
6452 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6453 <indexterm><primary>Silent Sprint (Carson)
</primary></indexterm>
6456 No one set out to destroy the environment. Paul Müller certainly did
6457 not aim to harm any birds. But the effort to solve one set of problems
6458 produced another set which, in the view of some, was far worse than
6459 the problems that were originally attacked. Or more accurately, the
6460 problems DDT caused were worse than the problems it solved, at least
6461 when considering the other, more environmentally friendly ways to
6462 solve the problems that DDT was meant to solve.
6465 It is to this image precisely that Duke University law professor James
6466 Boyle appeals when he argues that we need an
<quote>environmentalism
</quote> for
6467 culture.
<footnote><para>
6469 See, for example, James Boyle,
<quote>A Politics of Intellectual Property:
6470 Environmentalism for the Net?
</quote> <citetitle>Duke Law Journal
</citetitle> 47 (
1997):
87.
6472 His point, and the point I want to develop in the balance of this
6473 chapter, is not that the aims of copyright are flawed. Or that authors
6474 should not be paid for their work. Or that music should be given away
6475 <quote>for free.
</quote> The point is that some of the ways in which we might
6476 protect authors will have unintended consequences for the cultural
6477 environment, much like DDT had for the natural environment. And just
6478 <!-- PAGE BREAK 141 -->
6479 as criticism of DDT is not an endorsement of malaria or an attack on
6480 farmers, so, too, is criticism of one particular set of regulations
6481 protecting copyright not an endorsement of anarchy or an attack on
6482 authors. It is an environment of creativity that we seek, and we
6483 should be aware of our actions' effects on the environment.
6486 My argument, in the balance of this chapter, tries to map exactly
6487 this effect. No doubt the technology of the Internet has had a dramatic
6488 effect on the ability of copyright owners to protect their content. But
6489 there should also be little doubt that when you add together the
6490 changes in copyright law over time, plus the change in technology that
6491 the Internet is undergoing just now, the net effect of these changes will
6492 not be only that copyrighted work is effectively protected. Also, and
6493 generally missed, the net effect of this massive increase in protection
6494 will be devastating to the environment for creativity.
6497 In a line: To kill a gnat, we are spraying DDT with consequences
6498 for free culture that will be far more devastating than that this gnat will
6501 <indexterm startref=
"idxddt" class='endofrange'
/>
6503 <section id=
"beginnings">
6504 <title>Beginnings
</title>
6506 America copied English copyright law. Actually, we copied and improved
6507 English copyright law. Our Constitution makes the purpose of
<quote>creative
6508 property
</quote> rights clear; its express limitations reinforce the English
6509 aim to avoid overly powerful publishers.
6512 The power to establish
<quote>creative property
</quote> rights is granted to
6513 Congress in a way that, for our Constitution, at least, is very
6514 odd. Article I, section
8, clause
8 of our Constitution states that:
6517 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science and
6518 useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors
6519 the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries.
6521 <!-- PAGE BREAK 142 -->
6522 We can call this the
<quote>Progress Clause,
</quote> for notice what this clause
6523 does not say. It does not say Congress has the power to grant
6524 <quote>creative property rights.
</quote> It says that Congress has the power
6525 <emphasis>to promote progress
</emphasis>. The grant of power is its
6526 purpose, and its purpose is a public one, not the purpose of enriching
6527 publishers, nor even primarily the purpose of rewarding authors.
6530 The Progress Clause expressly limits the term of copyrights. As we saw
6531 in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"founders"/>,
6532 the English limited the term of copyright so as to assure that a few
6533 would not exercise disproportionate control over culture by exercising
6534 disproportionate control over publishing. We can assume the framers
6535 followed the English for a similar purpose. Indeed, unlike the
6536 English, the framers reinforced that objective, by requiring that
6537 copyrights extend
<quote>to Authors
</quote> only.
6540 The design of the Progress Clause reflects something about the
6541 Constitution's design in general. To avoid a problem, the framers
6542 built structure. To prevent the concentrated power of publishers, they
6543 built a structure that kept copyrights away from publishers and kept
6544 them short. To prevent the concentrated power of a church, they banned
6545 the federal government from establishing a church. To prevent
6546 concentrating power in the federal government, they built structures
6547 to reinforce the power of the states
—including the Senate, whose
6548 members were at the time selected by the states, and an electoral
6549 college, also selected by the states, to select the president. In each
6550 case, a
<emphasis>structure
</emphasis> built checks and balances into
6551 the constitutional frame, structured to prevent otherwise inevitable
6552 concentrations of power.
6555 I doubt the framers would recognize the regulation we call
<quote>copyright
</quote>
6556 today. The scope of that regulation is far beyond anything they ever
6557 considered. To begin to understand what they did, we need to put our
6558 <quote>copyright
</quote> in context: We need to see how it has changed in the
210
6559 years since they first struck its design.
6562 Some of these changes come from the law: some in light of changes
6563 in technology, and some in light of changes in technology given a
6564 <!-- PAGE BREAK 143 -->
6565 particular concentration of market power. In terms of our model, we
6568 <figure id=
"fig-1441">
6569 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6570 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6575 <figure id=
"fig-1442">
6576 <title><quote>Copyright
</quote> today.
</title>
6577 <graphic fileref=
"images/1442.png"></graphic>
6581 <!-- PAGE BREAK 144 -->
6584 <section id=
"lawduration">
6585 <title>Law: Duration
</title>
6587 When the first Congress enacted laws to protect creative property, it
6588 faced the same uncertainty about the status of creative property that
6589 the English had confronted in
1774. Many states had passed laws
6590 protecting creative property, and some believed that these laws simply
6591 supplemented common law rights that already protected creative
6592 authorship.
<footnote>
6595 William W. Crosskey,
<citetitle>Politics and the Constitution in the History of
6596 the United States
</citetitle> (London: Cambridge University Press,
1953), vol.
1,
6597 485–86:
<quote>extinguish[ing], by plain implication of `the supreme
6598 Law of the Land,'
<emphasis>the perpetual rights which authors had, or
6599 were supposed by some to have, under the Common Law
</emphasis></quote>
6601 <indexterm><primary>Crosskey, William W.
</primary></indexterm>
6603 This meant that there was no guaranteed public domain in the United
6604 States in
1790. If copyrights were protected by the common law, then
6605 there was no simple way to know whether a work published in the United
6606 States was controlled or free. Just as in England, this lingering
6607 uncertainty would make it hard for publishers to rely upon a public
6608 domain to reprint and distribute works.
6611 That uncertainty ended after Congress passed legislation granting
6612 copyrights. Because federal law overrides any contrary state law,
6613 federal protections for copyrighted works displaced any state law
6614 protections. Just as in England the Statute of Anne eventually meant
6615 that the copyrights for all English works expired, a federal statute
6616 meant that any state copyrights expired as well.
6619 In
1790, Congress enacted the first copyright law. It created a
6620 federal copyright and secured that copyright for fourteen years. If
6621 the author was alive at the end of that fourteen years, then he could
6622 opt to renew the copyright for another fourteen years. If he did not
6623 renew the copyright, his work passed into the public domain.
6626 While there were many works created in the United States in the first
6627 ten years of the Republic, only
5 percent of the works were actually
6628 registered under the federal copyright regime. Of all the work created
6629 in the United States both before
1790 and from
1790 through
1800,
95
6630 percent immediately passed into the public domain; the balance would
6631 pass into the pubic domain within twenty-eight years at most, and more
6632 likely within fourteen years.
<footnote><para>
6634 Although
13,
000 titles were published in the United States from
1790
6635 to
1799, only
556 copyright registrations were filed; John Tebbel,
<citetitle>A
6636 History of Book Publishing in the United States
</citetitle>, vol.
1,
<citetitle>The Creation
6637 of an Industry,
1630–1865</citetitle> (New York: Bowker,
1972),
141. Of the
21,
000
6638 imprints recorded before
1790, only twelve were copyrighted under the
6639 1790 act; William J. Maher,
<citetitle>Copyright Term, Retrospective Extension
6640 and the Copyright Law of
1790 in Historical Context
</citetitle>,
7–10 (
2002),
6641 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
6642 #
25</ulink>. Thus, the overwhelming majority of works fell
6643 immediately into the public domain. Even those works that were
6644 copyrighted fell into the public domain quickly, because the term of
6645 copyright was short. The initial term of copyright was fourteen years,
6646 with the option of renewal for an additional fourteen years. Copyright
6647 Act of May
31,
1790, §
1,
1 stat.
124.
</para></footnote>
6650 This system of renewal was a crucial part of the American system
6651 of copyright. It assured that the maximum terms of copyright would be
6652 <!-- PAGE BREAK 145 -->
6653 granted only for works where they were wanted. After the initial term
6654 of fourteen years, if it wasn't worth it to an author to renew his
6655 copyright, then it wasn't worth it to society to insist on the
6659 Fourteen years may not seem long to us, but for the vast majority of
6660 copyright owners at that time, it was long enough: Only a small
6661 minority of them renewed their copyright after fourteen years; the
6662 balance allowed their work to pass into the public
6663 domain.
<footnote><para>
6665 Few copyright holders ever chose to renew their copyrights. For
6666 instance, of the
25,
006 copyrights registered in
1883, only
894 were
6667 renewed in
1910. For a year-by-year analysis of copyright renewal
6668 rates, see Barbara A. Ringer,
<quote>Study No.
31: Renewal of Copyright,
</quote>
6669 <citetitle>Studies on Copyright
</citetitle>, vol.
1 (New York: Practicing Law Institute,
6670 1963),
618. For a more recent and comprehensive analysis, see William
6671 M. Landes and Richard A. Posner,
<quote>Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,
</quote>
6672 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
471,
498–501, and
6673 accompanying figures.
</para></footnote>
6676 Even today, this structure would make sense. Most creative work
6677 has an actual commercial life of just a couple of years. Most books fall
6678 out of print after one year.
<footnote><para>
6680 See Ringer, ch.
9, n.
2.
</para></footnote> When that happens, the
6681 used books are traded free of copyright regulation. Thus the books are
6682 no longer
<emphasis>effectively
</emphasis> controlled by
6683 copyright. The only practical commercial use of the books at that time
6684 is to sell the books as used books; that use
—because it does not
6685 involve publication
—is effectively free.
6688 In the first hundred years of the Republic, the term of copyright was
6689 changed once. In
1831, the term was increased from a maximum of
28
6690 years to a maximum of
42 by increasing the initial term of copyright
6691 from
14 years to
28 years. In the next fifty years of the Republic,
6692 the term increased once again. In
1909, Congress extended the renewal
6693 term of
14 years to
28 years, setting a maximum term of
56 years.
6696 Then, beginning in
1962, Congress started a practice that has defined
6697 copyright law since. Eleven times in the last forty years, Congress
6698 has extended the terms of existing copyrights; twice in those forty
6699 years, Congress extended the term of future copyrights. Initially, the
6700 extensions of existing copyrights were short, a mere one to two years.
6701 In
1976, Congress extended all existing copyrights by nineteen years.
6702 And in
1998, in the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Congress
6703 extended the term of existing and future copyrights by twenty years.
6706 The effect of these extensions is simply to toll, or delay, the passing
6707 of works into the public domain. This latest extension means that the
6708 public domain will have been tolled for thirty-nine out of fifty-five
6709 years, or
70 percent of the time since
1962. Thus, in the twenty years
6711 <!-- PAGE BREAK 146 -->
6712 after the Sonny Bono Act, while one million patents will pass into the
6713 public domain, zero copyrights will pass into the public domain by virtue
6714 of the expiration of a copyright term.
6717 The effect of these extensions has been exacerbated by another,
6718 little-noticed change in the copyright law. Remember I said that the
6719 framers established a two-part copyright regime, requiring a copyright
6720 owner to renew his copyright after an initial term. The requirement of
6721 renewal meant that works that no longer needed copyright protection
6722 would pass more quickly into the public domain. The works remaining
6723 under protection would be those that had some continuing commercial
6727 The United States abandoned this sensible system in
1976. For
6728 all works created after
1978, there was only one copyright term
—the
6729 maximum term. For
<quote>natural
</quote> authors, that term was life plus fifty
6730 years. For corporations, the term was seventy-five years. Then, in
1992,
6731 Congress abandoned the renewal requirement for all works created
6732 before
1978. All works still under copyright would be accorded the
6733 maximum term then available. After the Sonny Bono Act, that term
6734 was ninety-five years.
6737 This change meant that American law no longer had an automatic way to
6738 assure that works that were no longer exploited passed into the public
6739 domain. And indeed, after these changes, it is unclear whether it is
6740 even possible to put works into the public domain. The public domain
6741 is orphaned by these changes in copyright law. Despite the requirement
6742 that terms be
<quote>limited,
</quote> we have no evidence that anything will limit
6746 The effect of these changes on the average duration of copyright is
6747 dramatic. In
1973, more than
85 percent of copyright owners failed to
6748 renew their copyright. That meant that the average term of copyright
6749 in
1973 was just
32.2 years. Because of the elimination of the renewal
6750 requirement, the average term of copyright is now the maximum term.
6751 In thirty years, then, the average term has tripled, from
32.2 years to
95
6752 years.
<footnote><para>
6754 These statistics are understated. Between the years
1910 and
1962 (the
6755 first year the renewal term was extended), the average term was never
6756 more than thirty-two years, and averaged thirty years. See Landes and
6757 Posner,
<quote>Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,
</quote> loc. cit.
6760 <!-- PAGE BREAK 147 -->
6762 <section id=
"lawscope">
6763 <title>Law: Scope
</title>
6765 The
<quote>scope
</quote> of a copyright is the range of rights granted by the law.
6766 The scope of American copyright has changed dramatically. Those
6767 changes are not necessarily bad. But we should understand the extent
6768 of the changes if we're to keep this debate in context.
6771 In
1790, that scope was very narrow. Copyright covered only
<quote>maps,
6772 charts, and books.
</quote> That means it didn't cover, for example, music or
6773 architecture. More significantly, the right granted by a copyright gave
6774 the author the exclusive right to
<quote>publish
</quote> copyrighted works. That
6775 means someone else violated the copyright only if he republished the
6776 work without the copyright owner's permission. Finally, the right granted
6777 by a copyright was an exclusive right to that particular book. The right
6778 did not extend to what lawyers call
<quote>derivative works.
</quote> It would not,
6779 therefore, interfere with the right of someone other than the author to
6780 translate a copyrighted book, or to adapt the story to a different form
6781 (such as a drama based on a published book).
6784 This, too, has changed dramatically. While the contours of copyright
6785 today are extremely hard to describe simply, in general terms, the
6786 right covers practically any creative work that is reduced to a
6787 tangible form. It covers music as well as architecture, drama as well
6788 as computer programs. It gives the copyright owner of that creative
6789 work not only the exclusive right to
<quote>publish
</quote> the work, but also the
6790 exclusive right of control over any
<quote>copies
</quote> of that work. And most
6791 significant for our purposes here, the right gives the copyright owner
6792 control over not only his or her particular work, but also any
6793 <quote>derivative work
</quote> that might grow out of the original work. In this
6794 way, the right covers more creative work, protects the creative work
6795 more broadly, and protects works that are based in a significant way
6796 on the initial creative work.
6799 At the same time that the scope of copyright has expanded, procedural
6800 limitations on the right have been relaxed. I've already described the
6801 complete removal of the renewal requirement in
1992. In addition
6802 <!-- PAGE BREAK 148 -->
6803 to the renewal requirement, for most of the history of American
6804 copyright law, there was a requirement that a work be registered
6805 before it could receive the protection of a copyright. There was also
6806 a requirement that any copyrighted work be marked either with that
6807 famous
© or the word
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>. And for most
6808 of the history of American copyright law, there was a requirement that
6809 works be deposited with the government before a copyright could be
6813 The reason for the registration requirement was the sensible
6814 understanding that for most works, no copyright was required. Again,
6815 in the first ten years of the Republic,
95 percent of works eligible
6816 for copyright were never copyrighted. Thus, the rule reflected the
6817 norm: Most works apparently didn't need copyright, so registration
6818 narrowed the regulation of the law to the few that did. The same
6819 reasoning justified the requirement that a work be marked as
6820 copyrighted
—that way it was easy to know whether a copyright was
6821 being claimed. The requirement that works be deposited was to assure
6822 that after the copyright expired, there would be a copy of the work
6823 somewhere so that it could be copied by others without locating the
6827 All of these
<quote>formalities
</quote> were abolished in the American system when
6828 we decided to follow European copyright law. There is no requirement
6829 that you register a work to get a copyright; the copyright now is
6830 automatic; the copyright exists whether or not you mark your work with
6831 a
©; and the copyright exists whether or not you actually make a
6832 copy available for others to copy.
6835 Consider a practical example to understand the scope of these
6839 If, in
1790, you wrote a book and you were one of the
5 percent who
6840 actually copyrighted that book, then the copyright law protected you
6841 against another publisher's taking your book and republishing it
6842 without your permission. The aim of the act was to regulate publishers
6843 so as to prevent that kind of unfair competition. In
1790, there were
6844 174 publishers in the United States.
<footnote><para>
6846 See Thomas Bender and David Sampliner,
<quote>Poets, Pirates, and the
6847 Creation of American Literature,
</quote> 29 <citetitle>New York University Journal of
6848 International Law and Politics
</citetitle> 255 (
1997), and James Gilraeth, ed.,
6849 Federal Copyright Records,
1790–1800 (U.S. G.P.O.,
1987).
6852 The Copyright Act was thus a tiny
6853 regulation of a tiny proportion of a tiny part of the creative market in
6854 the United States
—publishers.
6857 <!-- PAGE BREAK 149 -->
6858 The act left other creators totally unregulated. If I copied your poem
6859 by hand, over and over again, as a way to learn it by heart, my act
6860 was totally unregulated by the
1790 act. If I took your novel and made
6861 a play based upon it, or if I translated it or abridged it, none of
6862 those activities were regulated by the original copyright act. These
6863 creative activities remained free, while the activities of publishers
6867 Today the story is very different: If you write a book, your book is
6868 automatically protected. Indeed, not just your book. Every e-mail,
6869 every note to your spouse, every doodle,
<emphasis>every
</emphasis>
6870 creative act that's reduced to a tangible form
—all of this is
6871 automatically copyrighted. There is no need to register or mark your
6872 work. The protection follows the creation, not the steps you take to
6876 That protection gives you the right (subject to a narrow range of
6877 fair use exceptions) to control how others copy the work, whether they
6878 copy it to republish it or to share an excerpt.
6881 That much is the obvious part. Any system of copyright would
6883 competing publishing. But there's a second part to the copyright of
6884 today that is not at all obvious. This is the protection of
<quote>derivative
6885 rights.
</quote> If you write a book, no one can make a movie out of your
6886 book without permission. No one can translate it without permission.
6887 CliffsNotes can't make an abridgment unless permission is granted. All
6888 of these derivative uses of your original work are controlled by the
6889 copyright holder. The copyright, in other words, is now not just an
6891 right to your writings, but an exclusive right to your writings
6892 and a large proportion of the writings inspired by them.
6895 It is this derivative right that would seem most bizarre to our
6896 framers, though it has become second nature to us. Initially, this
6898 was created to deal with obvious evasions of a narrower
6900 If I write a book, can you change one word and then claim a
6901 copyright in a new and different book? Obviously that would make a
6902 joke of the copyright, so the law was properly expanded to include
6903 those slight modifications as well as the verbatim original work.
6906 <!-- PAGE BREAK 150 -->
6907 In preventing that joke, the law created an astonishing power
6908 within a free culture
—at least, it's astonishing when you
6909 understand that the law applies not just to the commercial publisher
6910 but to anyone with a computer. I understand the wrong in duplicating
6911 and selling someone else's work. But whatever
6912 <emphasis>that
</emphasis> wrong is, transforming someone else's work
6913 is a different wrong. Some view transformation as no wrong at
6914 all
—they believe that our law, as the framers penned it, should
6915 not protect derivative rights at all.
<footnote><para>
6917 Jonathan Zittrain,
<quote>The Copyright Cage,
</quote> <citetitle>Legal
6918 Affairs
</citetitle>, July/August
2003, available at
6919 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
26</ulink>.
6920 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
6922 Whether or not you go that far, it seems
6923 plain that whatever wrong is involved is fundamentally different from
6924 the wrong of direct piracy.
6927 Yet copyright law treats these two different wrongs in the same way. I
6928 can go to court and get an injunction against your pirating my book. I
6929 can go to court and get an injunction against your transformative use
6930 of my book.
<footnote><para>
6932 Professor Rubenfeld has presented a powerful constitutional argument
6933 about the difference that copyright law should draw (from the
6934 perspective of the First Amendment) between mere
<quote>copies
</quote> and
6935 derivative works. See Jed Rubenfeld,
<quote>The Freedom of Imagination:
6936 Copyright's Constitutionality,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law
6937 Journal
</citetitle> 112 (
2002):
1–60 (see especially
6939 <indexterm><primary>Rubenfeld, Jeb
</primary></indexterm>
6941 These two different uses of my creative work are treated the same.
6944 This again may seem right to you. If I wrote a book, then why should
6945 you be able to write a movie that takes my story and makes money from
6946 it without paying me or crediting me? Or if Disney creates a creature
6947 called
<quote>Mickey Mouse,
</quote> why should you be able to make Mickey Mouse
6948 toys and be the one to trade on the value that Disney originally
6952 These are good arguments, and, in general, my point is not that the
6953 derivative right is unjustified. My aim just now is much narrower:
6954 simply to make clear that this expansion is a significant change from
6955 the rights originally granted.
6958 <section id=
"lawreach">
6959 <title>Law and Architecture: Reach
</title>
6961 Whereas originally the law regulated only publishers, the change in
6962 copyright's scope means that the law today regulates publishers, users,
6963 and authors. It regulates them because all three are capable of making
6964 copies, and the core of the regulation of copyright law is copies.
<footnote><para>
6966 This is a simplification of the law, but not much of one. The law
6967 certainly regulates more than
<quote>copies
</quote>—a public performance of a
6968 copyrighted song, for example, is regulated even though performance
6969 per se doesn't make a copy;
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6970 106(
4). And it certainly sometimes doesn't regulate a
<quote>copy
</quote>;
17
6971 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
112(a). But the presumption under the
6972 existing law (which regulates
<quote>copies;
</quote> 17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6973 102) is that if there is a copy, there is a right.
6977 <!-- PAGE BREAK 151 -->
6978 <quote>Copies.
</quote> That certainly sounds like the obvious thing for
6979 <emphasis>copy
</emphasis>right law to regulate. But as with Jack
6980 Valenti's argument at the start of this chapter, that
<quote>creative
6981 property
</quote> deserves the
<quote>same rights
</quote> as all other property, it is the
6982 <emphasis>obvious
</emphasis> that we need to be most careful
6983 about. For while it may be obvious that in the world before the
6984 Internet, copies were the obvious trigger for copyright law, upon
6985 reflection, it should be obvious that in the world with the Internet,
6986 copies should
<emphasis>not
</emphasis> be the trigger for copyright
6987 law. More precisely, they should not
<emphasis>always
</emphasis> be
6988 the trigger for copyright law.
6991 This is perhaps the central claim of this book, so let me take this
6992 very slowly so that the point is not easily missed. My claim is that the
6993 Internet should at least force us to rethink the conditions under which
6994 the law of copyright automatically applies,
<footnote><para>
6996 Thus, my argument is not that in each place that copyright law
6997 extends, we should repeal it. It is instead that we should have a good
6998 argument for its extending where it does, and should not determine its
6999 reach on the basis of arbitrary and automatic changes caused by
7002 because it is clear that the
7003 current reach of copyright was never contemplated, much less chosen,
7004 by the legislators who enacted copyright law.
7007 We can see this point abstractly by beginning with this largely
7010 <figure id=
"fig-1521">
7011 <title>All potential uses of a book.
</title>
7012 <graphic fileref=
"images/1521.png"></graphic>
7015 <!-- PAGE BREAK 152 -->
7016 Think about a book in real space, and imagine this circle to represent
7017 all its potential
<emphasis>uses
</emphasis>. Most of these uses are
7018 unregulated by copyright law, because the uses don't create a copy. If
7019 you read a book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you
7020 give someone the book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If
7021 you resell a book, that act is not regulated (copyright law expressly
7022 states that after the first sale of a book, the copyright owner can
7023 impose no further conditions on the disposition of the book). If you
7024 sleep on the book or use it to hold up a lamp or let your puppy chew
7025 it up, those acts are not regulated by copyright law, because those
7026 acts do not make a copy.
7028 <figure id=
"fig-1531">
7029 <title>Examples of unregulated uses of a book.
</title>
7030 <graphic fileref=
"images/1531.png"></graphic>
7033 Obviously, however, some uses of a copyrighted book are regulated
7034 by copyright law. Republishing the book, for example, makes a copy. It
7035 is therefore regulated by copyright law. Indeed, this particular use stands
7036 at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work. It is the
7037 paradigmatic use properly regulated by copyright regulation (see first
7038 diagram on next page).
7041 Finally, there is a tiny sliver of otherwise regulated copying uses
7042 that remain unregulated because the law considers these
<quote>fair uses.
</quote>
7044 <!-- PAGE BREAK 153 -->
7045 <figure id=
"fig-1541">
7046 <title>Republishing stands at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work.
</title>
7047 <graphic fileref=
"images/1541.png"></graphic>
7050 These are uses that themselves involve copying, but which the law
7051 treats as unregulated because public policy demands that they remain
7052 unregulated. You are free to quote from this book, even in a review
7053 that is quite negative, without my permission, even though that
7054 quoting makes a copy. That copy would ordinarily give the copyright
7055 owner the exclusive right to say whether the copy is allowed or not,
7056 but the law denies the owner any exclusive right over such
<quote>fair uses
</quote>
7057 for public policy (and possibly First Amendment) reasons.
7059 <figure id=
"fig-1542">
7060 <title>Unregulated copying considered
<quote>fair uses.
</quote></title>
7061 <graphic fileref=
"images/1542.png"></graphic>
7064 <figure id=
"fig-1551">
7065 <title>Uses that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively regulated.
</title>
7066 <graphic fileref=
"images/1551.png"></graphic>
7069 <!-- PAGE BREAK 154 -->
7070 In real space, then, the possible uses of a book are divided into three
7071 sorts: (
1) unregulated uses, (
2) regulated uses, and (
3) regulated uses that
7072 are nonetheless deemed
<quote>fair
</quote> regardless of the copyright owner's views.
7075 Enter the Internet
—a distributed, digital network where every use
7076 of a copyrighted work produces a copy.
<footnote><para>
7078 I don't mean
<quote>nature
</quote> in the sense that it couldn't be different, but
7079 rather that its present instantiation entails a copy. Optical networks
7080 need not make copies of content they transmit, and a digital network
7081 could be designed to delete anything it copies so that the same number
7084 And because of this single, arbitrary feature of the design of a
7085 digital network, the scope of category
1 changes dramatically. Uses
7086 that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively
7087 regulated. No longer is there a set of presumptively unregulated uses
7088 that define a freedom associated with a copyrighted work. Instead,
7089 each use is now subject to the copyright, because each use also makes
7090 a copy
—category
1 gets sucked into category
2. And those who
7091 would defend the unregulated uses of copyrighted work must look
7092 exclusively to category
3, fair uses, to bear the burden of this
7096 So let's be very specific to make this general point clear. Before the
7097 Internet, if you purchased a book and read it ten times, there would
7098 be no plausible
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>-related argument that
7099 the copyright owner could make to control that use of her
7100 book. Copyright law would have nothing to say about whether you read
7101 the book once, ten times, or every
7102 <!-- PAGE BREAK 155 -->
7103 night before you went to bed. None of those instances of
7104 use
—reading
— could be regulated by copyright law because
7105 none of those uses produced a copy.
7108 But the same book as an e-book is effectively governed by a different
7109 set of rules. Now if the copyright owner says you may read the book
7110 only once or only once a month, then
<emphasis>copyright
7111 law
</emphasis> would aid the copyright owner in exercising this degree
7112 of control, because of the accidental feature of copyright law that
7113 triggers its application upon there being a copy. Now if you read the
7114 book ten times and the license says you may read it only five times,
7115 then whenever you read the book (or any portion of it) beyond the
7116 fifth time, you are making a copy of the book contrary to the
7117 copyright owner's wish.
7120 There are some people who think this makes perfect sense. My aim
7121 just now is not to argue about whether it makes sense or not. My aim
7122 is only to make clear the change. Once you see this point, a few other
7123 points also become clear:
7126 First, making category
1 disappear is not anything any policy maker
7127 ever intended. Congress did not think through the collapse of the
7128 presumptively unregulated uses of copyrighted works. There is no
7129 evidence at all that policy makers had this idea in mind when they
7130 allowed our policy here to shift. Unregulated uses were an important
7131 part of free culture before the Internet.
7134 Second, this shift is especially troubling in the context of
7135 transformative uses of creative content. Again, we can all understand
7136 the wrong in commercial piracy. But the law now purports to regulate
7137 <emphasis>any
</emphasis> transformation you make of creative work
7138 using a machine.
<quote>Copy and paste
</quote> and
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> become
7139 crimes. Tinkering with a story and releasing it to others exposes the
7140 tinkerer to at least a requirement of justification. However
7141 troubling the expansion with respect to copying a particular work, it
7142 is extraordinarily troubling with respect to transformative uses of
7146 Third, this shift from category
1 to category
2 puts an extraordinary
7148 <!-- PAGE BREAK 156 -->
7149 burden on category
3 (
<quote>fair use
</quote>) that fair use never before had to
7150 bear. If a copyright owner now tried to control how many times I
7151 could read a book on-line, the natural response would be to argue that
7152 this is a violation of my fair use rights. But there has never been
7153 any litigation about whether I have a fair use right to read, because
7154 before the Internet, reading did not trigger the application of
7155 copyright law and hence the need for a fair use defense. The right to
7156 read was effectively protected before because reading was not
7160 This point about fair use is totally ignored, even by advocates for
7161 free culture. We have been cornered into arguing that our rights
7162 depend upon fair use
—never even addressing the earlier question
7163 about the expansion in effective regulation. A thin protection
7164 grounded in fair use makes sense when the vast majority of uses are
7165 <emphasis>unregulated
</emphasis>. But when everything becomes
7166 presumptively regulated, then the protections of fair use are not
7169 <indexterm id='idxadvertising2' class='startofrange'
>
7170 <primary>advertising
</primary>
7173 The case of Video Pipeline is a good example. Video Pipeline was
7174 in the business of making
<quote>trailer
</quote> advertisements for movies available
7175 to video stores. The video stores displayed the trailers as a way to sell
7176 videos. Video Pipeline got the trailers from the film distributors, put
7177 the trailers on tape, and sold the tapes to the retail stores.
7180 The company did this for about fifteen years. Then, in
1997, it began
7181 to think about the Internet as another way to distribute these
7182 previews. The idea was to expand their
<quote>selling by sampling
</quote>
7183 technique by giving on-line stores the same ability to enable
7184 <quote>browsing.
</quote> Just as in a bookstore you can read a few pages of a book
7185 before you buy the book, so, too, you would be able to sample a bit
7186 from the movie on-line before you bought it.
7189 In
1998, Video Pipeline informed Disney and other film distributors
7190 that it intended to distribute the trailers through the Internet
7191 (rather than sending the tapes) to distributors of their videos. Two
7192 years later, Disney told Video Pipeline to stop. The owner of Video
7193 <!-- PAGE BREAK 157 -->
7194 Pipeline asked Disney to talk about the matter
—he had built a
7195 business on distributing this content as a way to help sell Disney
7196 films; he had customers who depended upon his delivering this
7197 content. Disney would agree to talk only if Video Pipeline stopped the
7198 distribution immediately. Video Pipeline thought it was within their
7199 <quote>fair use
</quote> rights to distribute the clips as they had. So they filed a
7200 lawsuit to ask the court to declare that these rights were in fact
7204 Disney countersued
—for $
100 million in damages. Those damages
7205 were predicated upon a claim that Video Pipeline had
<quote>willfully
7206 infringed
</quote> on Disney's copyright. When a court makes a finding of
7207 willful infringement, it can award damages not on the basis of the
7208 actual harm to the copyright owner, but on the basis of an amount set
7209 in the statute. Because Video Pipeline had distributed seven hundred
7210 clips of Disney movies to enable video stores to sell copies of those
7211 movies, Disney was now suing Video Pipeline for $
100 million.
7214 Disney has the right to control its property, of course. But the video
7215 stores that were selling Disney's films also had some sort of right to be
7216 able to sell the films that they had bought from Disney. Disney's claim
7217 in court was that the stores were allowed to sell the films and they were
7218 permitted to list the titles of the films they were selling, but they were
7219 not allowed to show clips of the films as a way of selling them without
7220 Disney's permission.
7222 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising2' class='endofrange'
/>
7224 Now, you might think this is a close case, and I think the courts
7225 would consider it a close case. My point here is to map the change
7226 that gives Disney this power. Before the Internet, Disney couldn't
7227 really control how people got access to their content. Once a video
7228 was in the marketplace, the
<quote>first-sale doctrine
</quote> would free the
7229 seller to use the video as he wished, including showing portions of it
7230 in order to engender sales of the entire movie video. But with the
7231 Internet, it becomes possible for Disney to centralize control over
7232 access to this content. Because each use of the Internet produces a
7233 copy, use on the Internet becomes subject to the copyright owner's
7234 control. The technology expands the scope of effective control,
7235 because the technology builds a copy into every transaction.
7238 <!-- PAGE BREAK 158 -->
7239 No doubt, a potential is not yet an abuse, and so the potential for
7240 control is not yet the abuse of control. Barnes
& Noble has the
7241 right to say you can't touch a book in their store; property law gives
7242 them that right. But the market effectively protects against that
7243 abuse. If Barnes
& Noble banned browsing, then consumers would
7244 choose other bookstores. Competition protects against the
7245 extremes. And it may well be (my argument so far does not even
7246 question this) that competition would prevent any similar danger when
7247 it comes to copyright. Sure, publishers exercising the rights that
7248 authors have assigned to them might try to regulate how many times you
7249 read a book, or try to stop you from sharing the book with anyone. But
7250 in a competitive market such as the book market, the dangers of this
7251 happening are quite slight.
7254 Again, my aim so far is simply to map the changes that this changed
7255 architecture enables. Enabling technology to enforce the control of
7256 copyright means that the control of copyright is no longer defined by
7257 balanced policy. The control of copyright is simply what private
7258 owners choose. In some contexts, at least, that fact is harmless. But
7259 in some contexts it is a recipe for disaster.
7262 <section id=
"lawforce">
7263 <title>Architecture and Law: Force
</title>
7265 The disappearance of unregulated uses would be change enough, but a
7266 second important change brought about by the Internet magnifies its
7267 significance. This second change does not affect the reach of copyright
7268 regulation; it affects how such regulation is enforced.
7271 In the world before digital technology, it was generally the law that
7272 controlled whether and how someone was regulated by copyright law.
7273 The law, meaning a court, meaning a judge: In the end, it was a human,
7274 trained in the tradition of the law and cognizant of the balances that
7275 tradition embraced, who said whether and how the law would restrict
7278 <indexterm><primary>Casablanca
</primary></indexterm>
7279 <indexterm id=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7280 <primary>Marx Brothers
</primary>
7282 <indexterm id=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7283 <primary>Warner Brothers
</primary>
7286 There's a famous story about a battle between the Marx Brothers
7287 and Warner Brothers. The Marxes intended to make a parody of
7288 <!-- PAGE BREAK 159 -->
7289 <citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>. Warner Brothers objected. They
7290 wrote a nasty letter to the Marxes, warning them that there would be
7291 serious legal consequences if they went forward with their
7292 plan.
<footnote><para>
7294 See David Lange,
<quote>Recognizing the Public Domain,
</quote> <citetitle>Law and
7295 Contemporary Problems
</citetitle> 44 (
1981):
172–73.
7299 This led the Marx Brothers to respond in kind. They warned
7300 Warner Brothers that the Marx Brothers
<quote>were brothers long before
7301 you were.
</quote><footnote><para>
7303 Ibid. See also Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and
7304 Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
1–3.
7305 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
7307 The Marx Brothers therefore owned the word
7308 <citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>, and if Warner Brothers insisted on
7309 trying to control
<citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>, then the Marx
7310 Brothers would insist on control over
<citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>.
7313 An absurd and hollow threat, of course, because Warner Brothers,
7314 like the Marx Brothers, knew that no court would ever enforce such a
7315 silly claim. This extremism was irrelevant to the real freedoms anyone
7316 (including Warner Brothers) enjoyed.
7319 On the Internet, however, there is no check on silly rules, because on
7320 the Internet, increasingly, rules are enforced not by a human but by a
7321 machine: Increasingly, the rules of copyright law, as interpreted by
7322 the copyright owner, get built into the technology that delivers
7323 copyrighted content. It is code, rather than law, that rules. And the
7324 problem with code regulations is that, unlike law, code has no
7325 shame. Code would not get the humor of the Marx Brothers. The
7326 consequence of that is not at all funny.
7328 <indexterm startref=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7329 <indexterm startref=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7331 <indexterm id=
"idxadobeebookreader" class='startofrange'
>
7332 <primary>Adobe eBook Reader
</primary>
7335 Consider the life of my Adobe eBook Reader.
7338 An e-book is a book delivered in electronic form. An Adobe eBook is
7339 not a book that Adobe has published; Adobe simply produces the
7340 software that publishers use to deliver e-books. It provides the
7341 technology, and the publisher delivers the content by using the
7345 On the next page is a picture of an old version of my Adobe eBook
7349 As you can see, I have a small collection of e-books within this
7350 e-book library. Some of these books reproduce content that is in the
7351 public domain:
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, for example, is in
7352 the public domain. Some of them reproduce content that is not in the
7353 public domain: My own book
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>
7354 is not yet within the public domain. Consider
7355 <citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> first. If you click on my e-book
7357 <!-- PAGE BREAK 160 -->
7358 <citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, you'll see a fancy cover, and then
7359 a button at the bottom called Permissions.
7361 <figure id=
"fig-1611">
7362 <title>Picture of an old version of Adobe eBook Reader
</title>
7363 <graphic fileref=
"images/1611.png"></graphic>
7366 If you click on the Permissions button, you'll see a list of the
7367 permissions that the publisher purports to grant with this book.
7369 <figure id=
"fig-1612">
7370 <title>List of the permissions that the publisher purports to grant.
</title>
7371 <graphic fileref=
"images/1612.png"></graphic>
7374 <!-- PAGE BREAK 161 -->
7375 According to my eBook Reader, I have the permission to copy to the
7376 clipboard of the computer ten text selections every ten days. (So far,
7377 I've copied no text to the clipboard.) I also have the permission to
7378 print ten pages from the book every ten days. Lastly, I have the
7379 permission to use the Read Aloud button to hear
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>
7380 read aloud through the computer.
7383 Here's the e-book for another work in the public domain (including the
7384 translation): Aristotle's
<citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>.
7385 <indexterm><primary>Aristotle
</primary></indexterm>
7386 <indexterm><primary><citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>, (Aristotle)
</primary></indexterm>
7388 <figure id=
"fig-1621">
7389 <title>E-book of Aristotle;s
<quote>Politics
</quote></title>
7390 <graphic fileref=
"images/1621.png"></graphic>
7393 According to its permissions, no printing or copying is permitted
7394 at all. But fortunately, you can use the Read Aloud button to hear
7397 <figure id=
"fig-1622">
7398 <title>List of the permissions for Aristotle;s
<quote>Politics
</quote>.
</title>
7399 <graphic fileref=
"images/1622.png"></graphic>
7402 Finally (and most embarrassingly), here are the permissions for the
7403 original e-book version of my last book,
<citetitle>The Future of
7406 <!-- PAGE BREAK 162 -->
7407 <figure id=
"fig-1631">
7408 <title>List of the permissions for
<quote>The Future of Ideas
</quote>.
</title>
7409 <graphic fileref=
"images/1631.png"></graphic>
7412 No copying, no printing, and don't you dare try to listen to this book!
7415 Now, the Adobe eBook Reader calls these controls
7416 <quote>permissions
</quote>— as if the publisher has the power to control how
7417 you use these works. For works under copyright, the copyright owner
7418 certainly does have the power
—up to the limits of the copyright
7419 law. But for work not under copyright, there is no such copyright
7420 power.
<footnote><para>
7422 In principle, a contract might impose a requirement on me. I might,
7423 for example, buy a book from you that includes a contract that says I
7424 will read it only three times, or that I promise to read it three
7425 times. But that obligation (and the limits for creating that
7426 obligation) would come from the contract, not from copyright law, and
7427 the obligations of contract would not necessarily pass to anyone who
7428 subsequently acquired the book.
7430 When my e-book of
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> says I have the
7431 permission to copy only ten text selections into the memory every ten
7432 days, what that really means is that the eBook Reader has enabled the
7433 publisher to control how I use the book on my computer, far beyond the
7434 control that the law would enable.
7437 The control comes instead from the code
—from the technology
7438 within which the e-book
<quote>lives.
</quote> Though the e-book says that these are
7439 permissions, they are not the sort of
<quote>permissions
</quote> that most of us
7440 deal with. When a teenager gets
<quote>permission
</quote> to stay out till
7441 midnight, she knows (unless she's Cinderella) that she can stay out
7442 till
2 A.M., but will suffer a punishment if she's caught. But when
7443 the Adobe eBook Reader says I have the permission to make ten copies
7444 of the text into the computer's memory, that means that after I've
7445 made ten copies, the computer will not make any more. The same with
7446 the printing restrictions: After ten pages, the eBook Reader will not
7447 print any more pages. It's the same with the silly restriction that
7448 says that you can't use the Read Aloud button to read my book
7449 aloud
—it's not that the company will sue you if you do; instead,
7450 if you push the Read Aloud button with my book, the machine simply
7454 <!-- PAGE BREAK 163 -->
7455 These are
<emphasis>controls
</emphasis>, not permissions. Imagine a
7456 world where the Marx Brothers sold word processing software that, when
7457 you tried to type
<quote>Warner Brothers,
</quote> erased
<quote>Brothers
</quote> from the
7459 <indexterm><primary>Marx Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
7462 This is the future of copyright law: not so much copyright
7463 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> as copyright
<emphasis>code
</emphasis>. The
7464 controls over access to content will not be controls that are ratified
7465 by courts; the controls over access to content will be controls that
7466 are coded by programmers. And whereas the controls that are built into
7467 the law are always to be checked by a judge, the controls that are
7468 built into the technology have no similar built-in check.
7471 How significant is this? Isn't it always possible to get around the
7472 controls built into the technology? Software used to be sold with
7473 technologies that limited the ability of users to copy the software,
7474 but those were trivial protections to defeat. Why won't it be trivial
7475 to defeat these protections as well?
7478 We've only scratched the surface of this story. Return to the Adobe
7482 Early in the life of the Adobe eBook Reader, Adobe suffered a public
7483 relations nightmare. Among the books that you could download for free
7484 on the Adobe site was a copy of
<citetitle>Alice's Adventures in
7485 Wonderland
</citetitle>. This wonderful book is in the public
7486 domain. Yet when you clicked on Permissions for that book, you got the
7488 <indexterm><primary>Alice's Adventures in Wonderland (Carroll)
</primary></indexterm>
7490 <figure id=
"fig-1641">
7491 <title>List of the permissions for
<quote>Alice's Adventures in
7492 Wonderland
</quote>.
</title>
7493 <graphic fileref=
"images/1641.png"></graphic>
7495 <beginpage pagenum=
"164"/>
7497 Here was a public domain children's book that you were not allowed to
7498 copy, not allowed to lend, not allowed to give, and, as the
7499 <quote>permissions
</quote> indicated, not allowed to
<quote>read aloud
</quote>!
7502 The public relations nightmare attached to that final permission.
7503 For the text did not say that you were not permitted to use the Read
7504 Aloud button; it said you did not have the permission to read the book
7505 aloud. That led some people to think that Adobe was restricting the
7506 right of parents, for example, to read the book to their children, which
7507 seemed, to say the least, absurd.
7510 Adobe responded quickly that it was absurd to think that it was trying
7511 to restrict the right to read a book aloud. Obviously it was only
7512 restricting the ability to use the Read Aloud button to have the book
7513 read aloud. But the question Adobe never did answer is this: Would
7514 Adobe thus agree that a consumer was free to use software to hack
7515 around the restrictions built into the eBook Reader? If some company
7516 (call it Elcomsoft) developed a program to disable the technological
7517 protection built into an Adobe eBook so that a blind person, say,
7518 could use a computer to read the book aloud, would Adobe agree that
7519 such a use of an eBook Reader was fair? Adobe didn't answer because
7520 the answer, however absurd it might seem, is no.
7523 The point is not to blame Adobe. Indeed, Adobe is among the most
7524 innovative companies developing strategies to balance open access to
7525 content with incentives for companies to innovate. But Adobe's
7526 technology enables control, and Adobe has an incentive to defend this
7527 control. That incentive is understandable, yet what it creates is
7530 <indexterm startref=
"idxadobeebookreader" class='endofrange'
/>
7532 To see the point in a particularly absurd context, consider a favorite
7533 story of mine that makes the same point.
7535 <indexterm id=
"idxaibo1" class='startofrange'
>
7536 <primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary>
7538 <indexterm id=
"idxroboticdog1" class='startofrange'
>
7539 <primary>robotic dog
</primary>
7541 <indexterm id=
"idxsonyaibo1" class='startofrange'
>
7542 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7543 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7546 Consider the robotic dog made by Sony named
<quote>Aibo.
</quote> The Aibo
7547 learns tricks, cuddles, and follows you around. It eats only electricity
7548 and that doesn't leave that much of a mess (at least in your house).
7551 The Aibo is expensive and popular. Fans from around the world
7552 have set up clubs to trade stories. One fan in particular set up a Web
7553 site to enable information about the Aibo dog to be shared. This fan set
7554 <beginpage pagenum=
"165"/>
7555 up aibopet.com (and aibohack.com, but that resolves to the same site),
7556 and on that site he provided information about how to teach an Aibo
7557 to do tricks in addition to the ones Sony had taught it.
7560 <quote>Teach
</quote> here has a special meaning. Aibos are just cute computers.
7561 You teach a computer how to do something by programming it
7562 differently. So to say that aibopet.com was giving information about
7563 how to teach the dog to do new tricks is just to say that aibopet.com
7564 was giving information to users of the Aibo pet about how to hack
7565 their computer
<quote>dog
</quote> to make it do new tricks (thus, aibohack.com).
7568 If you're not a programmer or don't know many programmers, the word
7569 <citetitle>hack
</citetitle> has a particularly unfriendly
7570 connotation. Nonprogrammers hack bushes or weeds. Nonprogrammers in
7571 horror movies do even worse. But to programmers, or coders, as I call
7572 them,
<citetitle>hack
</citetitle> is a much more positive
7573 term.
<citetitle>Hack
</citetitle> just means code that enables the
7574 program to do something it wasn't originally intended or enabled to
7575 do. If you buy a new printer for an old computer, you might find the
7576 old computer doesn't run, or
<quote>drive,
</quote> the printer. If you discovered
7577 that, you'd later be happy to discover a hack on the Net by someone
7578 who has written a driver to enable the computer to drive the printer
7582 Some hacks are easy. Some are unbelievably hard. Hackers as a
7583 community like to challenge themselves and others with increasingly
7584 difficult tasks. There's a certain respect that goes with the talent to hack
7585 well. There's a well-deserved respect that goes with the talent to hack
7589 The Aibo fan was displaying a bit of both when he hacked the program
7590 and offered to the world a bit of code that would enable the Aibo to
7591 dance jazz. The dog wasn't programmed to dance jazz. It was a clever
7592 bit of tinkering that turned the dog into a more talented creature
7593 than Sony had built.
7595 <indexterm startref=
"idxsonyaibo1" class='endofrange'
/>
7596 <indexterm startref=
"idxroboticdog1" class='endofrange'
/>
7597 <indexterm startref=
"idxaibo1" class='endofrange'
/>
7599 I've told this story in many contexts, both inside and outside the
7600 United States. Once I was asked by a puzzled member of the audience,
7601 is it permissible for a dog to dance jazz in the United States? We
7602 forget that stories about the backcountry still flow across much of
7605 <!-- PAGE BREAK 166 -->
7606 world. So let's just be clear before we continue: It's not a crime
7607 anywhere (anymore) to dance jazz. Nor is it a crime to teach your dog
7608 to dance jazz. Nor should it be a crime (though we don't have a lot to
7609 go on here) to teach your robot dog to dance jazz. Dancing jazz is a
7610 completely legal activity. One imagines that the owner of aibopet.com
7611 thought,
<emphasis>What possible problem could there be with teaching
7612 a robot dog to dance?
</emphasis>
7615 Let's put the dog to sleep for a minute, and turn to a pony show
—
7616 not literally a pony show, but rather a paper that a Princeton academic
7617 named Ed Felten prepared for a conference. This Princeton academic
7618 is well known and respected. He was hired by the government in the
7619 Microsoft case to test Microsoft's claims about what could and could
7620 not be done with its own code. In that trial, he demonstrated both his
7621 brilliance and his coolness. Under heavy badgering by Microsoft
7622 lawyers, Ed Felten stood his ground. He was not about to be bullied
7623 into being silent about something he knew very well.
7626 But Felten's bravery was really tested in April
2001.
<footnote><para>
7628 See Pamela Samuelson,
<quote>Anticircumvention Rules: Threat to Science,
</quote>
7629 <citetitle>Science
</citetitle> 293 (
2001):
2028; Brendan I. Koerner,
<quote>Play Dead: Sony Muzzles
7630 the Techies Who Teach a Robot Dog New Tricks,
</quote> <citetitle>American Prospect
</citetitle>,
7631 January
2002;
<quote>Court Dismisses Computer Scientists' Challenge to
7632 DMCA,
</quote> <citetitle>Intellectual Property Litigation Reporter
</citetitle>,
11 December
2001; Bill
7633 Holland,
<quote>Copyright Act Raising Free-Speech Concerns,
</quote> <citetitle>Billboard
</citetitle>,
7634 May
2001; Janelle Brown,
<quote>Is the RIAA Running Scared?
</quote> Salon.com,
7635 April
2001; Electronic Frontier Foundation,
<quote>Frequently Asked
7636 Questions about
<citetitle>Felten and USENIX
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> Legal Case,
</quote> available at
7637 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
27</ulink>.
7638 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
7640 He and a group of colleagues were working on a paper to be submitted
7641 at conference. The paper was intended to describe the weakness in an
7642 encryption system being developed by the Secure Digital Music
7643 Initiative as a technique to control the distribution of music.
7646 The SDMI coalition had as its goal a technology to enable content
7647 owners to exercise much better control over their content than the
7648 Internet, as it originally stood, granted them. Using encryption, SDMI
7649 hoped to develop a standard that would allow the content owner to say
7650 <quote>this music cannot be copied,
</quote> and have a computer respect that
7651 command. The technology was to be part of a
<quote>trusted system
</quote> of
7652 control that would get content owners to trust the system of the
7656 When SDMI thought it was close to a standard, it set up a competition.
7657 In exchange for providing contestants with the code to an
7658 SDMI-encrypted bit of content, contestants were to try to crack it
7659 and, if they did, report the problems to the consortium.
7662 <!-- PAGE BREAK 167 -->
7663 Felten and his team figured out the encryption system quickly. He and
7664 the team saw the weakness of this system as a type: Many encryption
7665 systems would suffer the same weakness, and Felten and his team
7666 thought it worthwhile to point this out to those who study encryption.
7669 Let's review just what Felten was doing. Again, this is the United
7670 States. We have a principle of free speech. We have this principle not
7671 just because it is the law, but also because it is a really great
7672 idea. A strongly protected tradition of free speech is likely to
7673 encourage a wide range of criticism. That criticism is likely, in
7674 turn, to improve the systems or people or ideas criticized.
7677 What Felten and his colleagues were doing was publishing a paper
7678 describing the weakness in a technology. They were not spreading free
7679 music, or building and deploying this technology. The paper was an
7680 academic essay, unintelligible to most people. But it clearly showed the
7681 weakness in the SDMI system, and why SDMI would not, as presently
7682 constituted, succeed.
7684 <indexterm id=
"idxaibo2" class='startofrange'
>
7685 <primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary>
7687 <indexterm id=
"idxroboticdog2" class='startofrange'
>
7688 <primary>robotic dog
</primary>
7690 <indexterm id=
"idxsonyaibo2" class='startofrange'
>
7691 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7692 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7695 What links these two, aibopet.com and Felten, is the letters they
7696 then received. Aibopet.com received a letter from Sony about the
7697 aibopet.com hack. Though a jazz-dancing dog is perfectly legal, Sony
7702 Your site contains information providing the means to circumvent
7703 AIBO-ware's copy protection protocol constituting a violation of the
7704 anti-circumvention provisions of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act.
7707 <indexterm startref=
"idxsonyaibo2" class='endofrange'
/>
7708 <indexterm startref=
"idxroboticdog2" class='endofrange'
/>
7709 <indexterm startref=
"idxaibo2" class='endofrange'
/>
7711 And though an academic paper describing the weakness in a system
7712 of encryption should also be perfectly legal, Felten received a letter
7713 from an RIAA lawyer that read:
7717 Any disclosure of information gained from participating in the
7718 <!-- PAGE BREAK 168 -->
7719 Public Challenge would be outside the scope of activities permitted by
7720 the Agreement and could subject you and your research team to actions
7721 under the Digital Millennium Copyright Act (
<quote>DMCA
</quote>).
7725 In both cases, this weirdly Orwellian law was invoked to control the
7726 spread of information. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act made
7727 spreading such information an offense.
7730 The DMCA was enacted as a response to copyright owners' first fear
7731 about cyberspace. The fear was that copyright control was effectively
7732 dead; the response was to find technologies that might compensate.
7733 These new technologies would be copyright protection
7734 technologies
— technologies to control the replication and
7735 distribution of copyrighted material. They were designed as
7736 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> to modify the original
7737 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> of the Internet, to reestablish some
7738 protection for copyright owners.
7741 The DMCA was a bit of law intended to back up the protection of this
7742 code designed to protect copyrighted material. It was, we could say,
7743 <emphasis>legal code
</emphasis> intended to buttress
7744 <emphasis>software code
</emphasis> which itself was intended to
7745 support the
<emphasis>legal code of copyright
</emphasis>.
7748 But the DMCA was not designed merely to protect copyrighted works to
7749 the extent copyright law protected them. Its protection, that is, did
7750 not end at the line that copyright law drew. The DMCA regulated
7751 devices that were designed to circumvent copyright protection
7752 measures. It was designed to ban those devices, whether or not the use
7753 of the copyrighted material made possible by that circumvention would
7754 have been a copyright violation.
7756 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7757 <indexterm><primary>robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7759 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7760 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7763 Aibopet.com and Felten make the point. The Aibo hack circumvented a
7764 copyright protection system for the purpose of enabling the dog to
7765 dance jazz. That enablement no doubt involved the use of copyrighted
7766 material. But as aibopet.com's site was noncommercial, and the use did
7767 not enable subsequent copyright infringements, there's no doubt that
7768 aibopet.com's hack was fair use of Sony's copyrighted material. Yet
7769 fair use is not a defense to the DMCA. The question is not whether the
7770 <!-- PAGE BREAK 169 -->
7771 use of the copyrighted material was a copyright violation. The question
7772 is whether a copyright protection system was circumvented.
7775 The threat against Felten was more attenuated, but it followed the
7776 same line of reasoning. By publishing a paper describing how a
7777 copyright protection system could be circumvented, the RIAA lawyer
7778 suggested, Felten himself was distributing a circumvention technology.
7779 Thus, even though he was not himself infringing anyone's copyright,
7780 his academic paper was enabling others to infringe others' copyright.
7782 <indexterm><primary>Rogers, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
7784 The bizarreness of these arguments is captured in a cartoon drawn in
7785 1981 by Paul Conrad. At that time, a court in California had held that
7786 the VCR could be banned because it was a copyright-infringing
7787 technology: It enabled consumers to copy films without the permission
7788 of the copyright owner. No doubt there were uses of the technology
7789 that were legal: Fred Rogers, aka
<quote><citetitle>Mr. Rogers
</citetitle>,
</quote>
7790 for example, had testified in that case that he wanted people to feel
7791 free to tape Mr. Rogers' Neighborhood.
7792 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7796 Some public stations, as well as commercial stations, program the
7797 <quote>Neighborhood
</quote> at hours when some children cannot use it. I think that
7798 it's a real service to families to be able to record such programs and
7799 show them at appropriate times. I have always felt that with the
7800 advent of all of this new technology that allows people to tape the
7801 <quote>Neighborhood
</quote> off-the-air, and I'm speaking for the
<quote>Neighborhood
</quote>
7802 because that's what I produce, that they then become much more active
7803 in the programming of their family's television life. Very frankly, I
7804 am opposed to people being programmed by others. My whole approach in
7805 broadcasting has always been
<quote>You are an important person just the way
7806 you are. You can make healthy decisions.
</quote> Maybe I'm going on too long,
7807 but I just feel that anything that allows a person to be more active
7808 in the control of his or her life, in a healthy way, is
7809 important.
<footnote><para>
7811 <citetitle>Sony Corporation of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
7812 455 fn.
27 (
1984). Rogers never changed his view about the VCR. See
7813 James Lardner,
<citetitle>Fast Forward: Hollywood, the Japanese, and the Onslaught of
7814 the VCR
</citetitle> (New York: W. W. Norton,
1987),
270–71.
7815 <indexterm><primary>Rogers, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
7820 <!-- PAGE BREAK 170 -->
7821 Even though there were uses that were legal, because there were
7822 some uses that were illegal, the court held the companies producing
7823 the VCR responsible.
7826 This led Conrad to draw the cartoon below, which we can adopt to
7828 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7831 No argument I have can top this picture, but let me try to get close.
7834 The anticircumvention provisions of the DMCA target copyright
7835 circumvention technologies. Circumvention technologies can be used for
7836 different ends. They can be used, for example, to enable massive
7837 pirating of copyrighted material
—a bad end. Or they can be used
7838 to enable the use of particular copyrighted materials in ways that
7839 would be considered fair use
—a good end.
7842 A handgun can be used to shoot a police officer or a child. Most
7843 <!-- PAGE BREAK 171 -->
7844 would agree such a use is bad. Or a handgun can be used for target
7845 practice or to protect against an intruder. At least some would say that
7846 such a use would be good. It, too, is a technology that has both good
7849 <figure id=
"fig-1711">
7850 <title>VCR/handgun cartoon.
</title>
7851 <graphic fileref=
"images/1711.png"></graphic>
7854 The obvious point of Conrad's cartoon is the weirdness of a world
7855 where guns are legal, despite the harm they can do, while VCRs (and
7856 circumvention technologies) are illegal. Flash:
<emphasis>No one ever
7857 died from copyright circumvention
</emphasis>. Yet the law bans circumvention
7858 technologies absolutely, despite the potential that they might do some
7859 good, but permits guns, despite the obvious and tragic harm they do.
7860 <indexterm><primary>Conrad, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
7862 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7863 <indexterm><primary>robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7865 <primary>Sony
</primary>
7866 <secondary>Aibo robotic dog produced by
</secondary>
7869 The Aibo and RIAA examples demonstrate how copyright owners are
7870 changing the balance that copyright law grants. Using code, copyright
7871 owners restrict fair use; using the DMCA, they punish those who would
7872 attempt to evade the restrictions on fair use that they impose through
7873 code. Technology becomes a means by which fair use can be erased; the
7874 law of the DMCA backs up that erasing.
7877 This is how
<emphasis>code
</emphasis> becomes
7878 <emphasis>law
</emphasis>. The controls built into the technology of
7879 copy and access protection become rules the violation of which is also
7880 a violation of the law. In this way, the code extends the
7881 law
—increasing its regulation, even if the subject it regulates
7882 (activities that would otherwise plainly constitute fair use) is
7883 beyond the reach of the law. Code becomes law; code extends the law;
7884 code thus extends the control that copyright owners effect
—at
7885 least for those copyright holders with the lawyers who can write the
7886 nasty letters that Felten and aibopet.com received.
7889 There is one final aspect of the interaction between architecture and
7890 law that contributes to the force of copyright's regulation. This is
7891 the ease with which infringements of the law can be detected. For
7892 contrary to the rhetoric common at the birth of cyberspace that on the
7893 Internet, no one knows you're a dog, increasingly, given changing
7894 technologies deployed on the Internet, it is easy to find the dog who
7895 committed a legal wrong. The technologies of the Internet are open to
7896 snoops as well as sharers, and the snoops are increasingly good at
7897 tracking down the identity of those who violate the rules.
7901 <!-- PAGE BREAK 172 -->
7902 For example, imagine you were part of a
<citetitle>Star Trek
</citetitle> fan club. You
7903 gathered every month to share trivia, and maybe to enact a kind of fan
7904 fiction about the show. One person would play Spock, another, Captain
7905 Kirk. The characters would begin with a plot from a real story, then
7906 simply continue it.
<footnote><para>
7908 For an early and prescient analysis, see Rebecca Tushnet,
<quote>Legal Fictions,
7909 Copyright, Fan Fiction, and a New Common Law,
</quote> <citetitle>Loyola of Los Angeles
7910 Entertainment Law Journal
</citetitle> 17 (
1997):
651.
7914 Before the Internet, this was, in effect, a totally unregulated
7915 activity. No matter what happened inside your club room, you would
7916 never be interfered with by the copyright police. You were free in
7917 that space to do as you wished with this part of our culture. You were
7918 allowed to build on it as you wished without fear of legal control.
7921 But if you moved your club onto the Internet, and made it generally
7922 available for others to join, the story would be very different. Bots
7923 scouring the Net for trademark and copyright infringement would
7924 quickly find your site. Your posting of fan fiction, depending upon
7925 the ownership of the series that you're depicting, could well inspire
7926 a lawyer's threat. And ignoring the lawyer's threat would be extremely
7927 costly indeed. The law of copyright is extremely efficient. The
7928 penalties are severe, and the process is quick.
7931 This change in the effective force of the law is caused by a change
7932 in the ease with which the law can be enforced. That change too shifts
7933 the law's balance radically. It is as if your car transmitted the speed at
7934 which you traveled at every moment that you drove; that would be just
7935 one step before the state started issuing tickets based upon the data you
7936 transmitted. That is, in effect, what is happening here.
7939 <section id=
"marketconcentration">
7940 <title>Market: Concentration
</title>
7942 So copyright's duration has increased dramatically
—tripled in
7943 the past thirty years. And copyright's scope has increased as
7944 well
—from regulating only publishers to now regulating just
7945 about everyone. And copyright's reach has changed, as every action
7946 becomes a copy and hence presumptively regulated. And as technologists
7948 <!-- PAGE BREAK 173 -->
7949 to control the use of content, and as copyright is increasingly
7950 enforced through technology, copyright's force changes, too. Misuse is
7951 easier to find and easier to control. This regulation of the creative
7952 process, which began as a tiny regulation governing a tiny part of the
7953 market for creative work, has become the single most important
7954 regulator of creativity there is. It is a massive expansion in the
7955 scope of the government's control over innovation and creativity; it
7956 would be totally unrecognizable to those who gave birth to copyright's
7960 Still, in my view, all of these changes would not matter much if it
7961 weren't for one more change that we must also consider. This is a
7962 change that is in some sense the most familiar, though its significance
7963 and scope are not well understood. It is the one that creates precisely the
7964 reason to be concerned about all the other changes I have described.
7967 This is the change in the concentration and integration of the media.
7968 In the past twenty years, the nature of media ownership has undergone
7969 a radical alteration, caused by changes in legal rules governing the
7970 media. Before this change happened, the different forms of media were
7971 owned by separate media companies. Now, the media is increasingly
7972 owned by only a few companies. Indeed, after the changes that the FCC
7973 announced in June
2003, most expect that within a few years, we will
7974 live in a world where just three companies control more than percent
7978 These changes are of two sorts: the scope of concentration, and its
7982 Changes in scope are the easier ones to describe. As Senator John
7983 McCain summarized the data produced in the FCC's review of media
7984 ownership,
<quote>five companies control
85 percent of our media sources.
</quote><footnote><para>
7986 FCC Oversight: Hearing Before the Senate Commerce, Science and
7987 Transportation Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
22 May
2003)
7988 (statement of Senator John McCain).
</para></footnote>
7989 The five recording labels of Universal Music Group, BMG, Sony Music
7990 Entertainment, Warner Music Group, and EMI control
84.8 percent of the
7991 U.S. music market.
<footnote><para>
7993 Lynette Holloway,
<quote>Despite a Marketing Blitz, CD Sales Continue to
7994 Slide,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
23 December
2002.
7996 The
<quote>five largest cable companies pipe
7997 programming to
74 percent of the cable subscribers nationwide.
</quote><footnote><para>
7999 Molly Ivins,
<quote>Media Consolidation Must Be Stopped,
</quote> <citetitle>Charleston Gazette
</citetitle>,
8002 <indexterm><primary>BMG
</primary></indexterm>
8003 <indexterm><primary>EMI
</primary></indexterm>
8004 <indexterm><primary>McCain, John
</primary></indexterm>
8005 <indexterm><primary>Universal Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
8006 <indexterm><primary>Warner Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
8009 The story with radio is even more dramatic. Before deregulation,
8010 the nation's largest radio broadcasting conglomerate owned fewer than
8011 <!-- PAGE BREAK 174 -->
8012 seventy-five stations. Today
<emphasis>one
</emphasis> company owns
8013 more than
1,
200 stations. During that period of consolidation, the
8014 total number of radio owners dropped by
34 percent. Today, in most
8015 markets, the two largest broadcasters control
74 percent of that
8016 market's revenues. Overall, just four companies control
90 percent of
8017 the nation's radio advertising revenues.
8020 Newspaper ownership is becoming more concentrated as well. Today,
8021 there are six hundred fewer daily newspapers in the United States than
8022 there were eighty years ago, and ten companies control half of the
8023 nation's circulation. There are twenty major newspaper publishers in
8024 the United States. The top ten film studios receive
99 percent of all
8025 film revenue. The ten largest cable companies account for
85 percent
8026 of all cable revenue. This is a market far from the free press the
8027 framers sought to protect. Indeed, it is a market that is quite well
8028 protected
— by the market.
8031 Concentration in size alone is one thing. The more invidious
8032 change is in the nature of that concentration. As author James Fallows
8033 put it in a recent article about Rupert Murdoch,
8034 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
8038 Murdoch's companies now constitute a production system
8039 unmatched in its integration. They supply content
—Fox movies
8040 … Fox TV shows
… Fox-controlled sports broadcasts, plus
8041 newspapers and books. They sell the content to the public and to
8042 advertisers
—in newspapers, on the broadcast network, on the
8043 cable channels. And they operate the physical distribution system
8044 through which the content reaches the customers. Murdoch's satellite
8045 systems now distribute News Corp. content in Europe and Asia; if
8046 Murdoch becomes DirecTV's largest single owner, that system will serve
8047 the same function in the United States.
<footnote><para>
8049 James Fallows,
<quote>The Age of Murdoch,
</quote> <citetitle>Atlantic Monthly
</citetitle> (September
8051 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
8056 The pattern with Murdoch is the pattern of modern media. Not
8057 just large companies owning many radio stations, but a few companies
8058 owning as many outlets of media as possible. A picture describes this
8059 pattern better than a thousand words could do:
8061 <figure id=
"fig-1761">
8062 <title>Pattern of modern media ownership.
</title>
8063 <graphic fileref=
"images/1761.png"></graphic>
8066 <!-- PAGE BREAK 175 -->
8067 Does this concentration matter? Will it affect what is made, or
8068 what is distributed? Or is it merely a more efficient way to produce and
8072 My view was that concentration wouldn't matter. I thought it was
8073 nothing more than a more efficient financial structure. But now, after
8074 reading and listening to a barrage of creators try to convince me to the
8075 contrary, I am beginning to change my mind.
8078 Here's a representative story that begins to suggest how this
8079 integration may matter.
8081 <indexterm><primary>Lear, Norman
</primary></indexterm>
8082 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
8083 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
8085 In
1969, Norman Lear created a pilot for
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle>. He took
8086 the pilot to ABC. The network didn't like it. It was too edgy, they told
8087 Lear. Make it again. Lear made a second pilot, more edgy than the
8088 first. ABC was exasperated. You're missing the point, they told Lear.
8089 We wanted less edgy, not more.
8092 Rather than comply, Lear simply took the show elsewhere. CBS
8093 was happy to have the series; ABC could not stop Lear from walking.
8094 The copyrights that Lear held assured an independence from network
8095 control.
<footnote><para>
8097 Leonard Hill,
<quote>The Axis of Access,
</quote> remarks before Weidenbaum Center
8098 Forum,
<quote>Entertainment Economics: The Movie Industry,
</quote> St. Louis,
8099 Missouri,
3 April
2003 (transcript of prepared remarks available at
8100 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
28</ulink>;
8101 for the Lear story, not included in the prepared remarks, see
8102 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
29</ulink>).
8107 <!-- PAGE BREAK 176 -->
8108 The network did not control those copyrights because the law forbade
8109 the networks from controlling the content they syndicated. The law
8110 required a separation between the networks and the content producers;
8111 that separation would guarantee Lear freedom. And as late as
1992,
8112 because of these rules, the vast majority of prime time
8113 television
—75 percent of it
—was
<quote>independent
</quote> of the
8117 In
1994, the FCC abandoned the rules that required this independence.
8118 After that change, the networks quickly changed the balance. In
1985,
8119 there were twenty-five independent television production studios; in
8120 2002, only five independent television studios remained.
<quote>In
1992,
8121 only
15 percent of new series were produced for a network by a company
8122 it controlled. Last year, the percentage of shows produced by
8123 controlled companies more than quintupled to
77 percent.
</quote> <quote>In
1992,
16
8124 new series were produced independently of conglomerate control, last
8125 year there was one.
</quote><footnote><para>
8127 NewsCorp./DirecTV Merger and Media Consolidation: Hearings on Media
8128 Ownership Before the Senate Commerce Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st
8129 sess. (
2003) (testimony of Gene Kimmelman on behalf of Consumers Union
8130 and the Consumer Federation of America), available at
8131 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
30</ulink>. Kimmelman
8132 quotes Victoria Riskin, president of Writers Guild of America, West,
8133 in her Remarks at FCC En Banc Hearing, Richmond, Virginia,
27 February
8136 In
2002,
75 percent of prime time television was owned by the networks
8137 that ran it.
<quote>In the ten-year period between
1992 and
2002, the number
8138 of prime time television hours per week produced by network studios
8139 increased over
200%, whereas the number of prime time television hours
8140 per week produced by independent studios decreased
8141 63%.
</quote><footnote><para>
8146 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
8148 Today, another Norman Lear with another
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle> would
8149 find that he had the choice either to make the show less edgy or to be
8150 fired: The content of any show developed for a network is increasingly
8151 owned by the network.
8154 While the number of channels has increased dramatically, the ownership
8155 of those channels has narrowed to an ever smaller and smaller few. As
8156 Barry Diller said to Bill Moyers,
8157 <indexterm><primary>Diller, Barry
</primary></indexterm>
8158 <indexterm><primary>Moyers, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
8162 Well, if you have companies that produce, that finance, that air on
8163 their channel and then distribute worldwide everything that goes
8164 through their controlled distribution system, then what you get is
8165 fewer and fewer actual voices participating in the process. [We
8166 <!-- PAGE BREAK 177 -->
8167 u]sed to have dozens and dozens of thriving independent production
8168 companies producing television programs. Now you have less than a
8169 handful.
<footnote><para>
8171 <quote>Barry Diller Takes on Media Deregulation,
</quote> <citetitle>Now with Bill Moyers
</citetitle>, Bill
8172 Moyers,
25 April
2003, edited transcript available at
8173 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
31</ulink>.
8178 This narrowing has an effect on what is produced. The product of such
8179 large and concentrated networks is increasingly homogenous.
8180 Increasingly safe. Increasingly sterile. The product of news shows
8181 from networks like this is increasingly tailored to the message the
8182 network wants to convey. This is not the communist party, though from
8183 the inside, it must feel a bit like the communist party. No one can
8184 question without risk of consequence
—not necessarily banishment
8185 to Siberia, but punishment nonetheless. Independent, critical,
8186 different views are quashed. This is not the environment for a
8189 <indexterm><primary>Clark, Kim B.
</primary></indexterm>
8191 Economics itself offers a parallel that explains why this integration
8192 affects creativity. Clay Christensen has written about the
<quote>Innovator's
8193 Dilemma
</quote>: the fact that large traditional firms find it rational to ignore
8194 new, breakthrough technologies that compete with their core business.
8195 The same analysis could help explain why large, traditional media
8196 companies would find it rational to ignore new cultural trends.
<footnote><para>
8198 Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The
8199 Revolutionary National Bestseller that Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle>
8200 (Cambridge: Harvard Business School Press,
1997). Christensen
8201 acknowledges that the idea was first suggested by Dean Kim Clark. See
8202 Kim B. Clark,
<quote>The Interaction of Design Hierarchies and Market
8203 Concepts in Technological Evolution,
</quote> <citetitle>Research Policy
</citetitle> 14 (
1985):
8204 235–51. For a more recent study, see Richard Foster and Sarah
8205 Kaplan,
<citetitle>Creative Destruction: Why Companies That Are Built to Last
8206 Underperform the Market
—and How to Successfully Transform Them
</citetitle>
8207 (New York: Currency/Doubleday,
2001).
</para></footnote>
8209 Lumbering giants not only don't, but should not, sprint. Yet if the
8210 field is only open to the giants, there will be far too little
8212 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
8215 I don't think we know enough about the economics of the media
8216 market to say with certainty what concentration and integration will
8217 do. The efficiencies are important, and the effect on culture is hard to
8221 But there is a quintessentially obvious example that does strongly
8222 suggest the concern.
8225 In addition to the copyright wars, we're in the middle of the drug
8226 wars. Government policy is strongly directed against the drug cartels;
8227 criminal and civil courts are filled with the consequences of this battle.
8230 Let me hereby disqualify myself from any possible appointment to
8231 any position in government by saying I believe this war is a profound
8232 mistake. I am not pro drugs. Indeed, I come from a family once
8234 <!-- PAGE BREAK 178 -->
8235 wrecked by drugs
—though the drugs that wrecked my family were
8236 all quite legal. I believe this war is a profound mistake because the
8237 collateral damage from it is so great as to make waging the war
8238 insane. When you add together the burdens on the criminal justice
8239 system, the desperation of generations of kids whose only real
8240 economic opportunities are as drug warriors, the queering of
8241 constitutional protections because of the constant surveillance this
8242 war requires, and, most profoundly, the total destruction of the legal
8243 systems of many South American nations because of the power of the
8244 local drug cartels, I find it impossible to believe that the marginal
8245 benefit in reduced drug consumption by Americans could possibly
8246 outweigh these costs.
8249 You may not be convinced. That's fine. We live in a democracy, and it
8250 is through votes that we are to choose policy. But to do that, we
8251 depend fundamentally upon the press to help inform Americans about
8254 <indexterm id='idxadvertising3' class='startofrange'
>
8255 <primary>advertising
</primary>
8258 Beginning in
1998, the Office of National Drug Control Policy launched
8259 a media campaign as part of the
<quote>war on drugs.
</quote> The campaign produced
8260 scores of short film clips about issues related to illegal drugs. In
8261 one series (the Nick and Norm series) two men are in a bar, discussing
8262 the idea of legalizing drugs as a way to avoid some of the collateral
8263 damage from the war. One advances an argument in favor of drug
8264 legalization. The other responds in a powerful and effective way
8265 against the argument of the first. In the end, the first guy changes
8266 his mind (hey, it's television). The plug at the end is a damning
8267 attack on the pro-legalization campaign.
8270 Fair enough. It's a good ad. Not terribly misleading. It delivers its
8271 message well. It's a fair and reasonable message.
8274 But let's say you think it is a wrong message, and you'd like to run a
8275 countercommercial. Say you want to run a series of ads that try to
8276 demonstrate the extraordinary collateral harm that comes from the drug
8280 Well, obviously, these ads cost lots of money. Assume you raise the
8281 <!-- PAGE BREAK 179 -->
8282 money. Assume a group of concerned citizens donates all the money in
8283 the world to help you get your message out. Can you be sure your
8284 message will be heard then?
8287 No. You cannot. Television stations have a general policy of avoiding
8288 <quote>controversial
</quote> ads. Ads sponsored by the government are deemed
8289 uncontroversial; ads disagreeing with the government are
8290 controversial. This selectivity might be thought inconsistent with
8291 the First Amendment, but the Supreme Court has held that stations have
8292 the right to choose what they run. Thus, the major channels of
8293 commercial media will refuse one side of a crucial debate the
8294 opportunity to present its case. And the courts will defend the
8295 rights of the stations to be this biased.
<footnote><para>
8297 The Marijuana Policy Project, in February
2003, sought to place ads
8298 that directly responded to the Nick and Norm series on stations within
8299 the Washington, D.C., area. Comcast rejected the ads as
<quote>against
8300 [their] policy.
</quote> The local NBC affiliate, WRC, rejected the ads
8301 without reviewing them. The local ABC affiliate, WJOA, originally
8302 agreed to run the ads and accepted payment to do so, but later decided
8303 not to run the ads and returned the collected fees. Interview with
8304 Neal Levine,
15 October
2003. These restrictions are, of course, not
8305 limited to drug policy. See, for example, Nat Ives,
<quote>On the Issue of
8306 an Iraq War, Advocacy Ads Meet with Rejection from TV Networks,
</quote> <citetitle>New
8307 York Times
</citetitle>,
13 March
2003, C4. Outside of election-related air time
8308 there is very little that the FCC or the courts are willing to do to
8309 even the playing field. For a general overview, see Rhonda Brown,
<quote>Ad
8310 Hoc Access: The Regulation of Editorial Advertising on Television and
8311 Radio,
</quote> <citetitle>Yale Law and Policy Review
</citetitle> 6 (
1988):
449–79, and for a
8312 more recent summary of the stance of the FCC and the courts, see
8313 <citetitle>Radio-Television News Directors Association
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>FCC
</citetitle>,
184 F.
3d
872
8314 (D.C. Cir.
1999). Municipal authorities exercise the same authority as
8315 the networks. In a recent example from San Francisco, the San
8316 Francisco transit authority rejected an ad that criticized its Muni
8317 diesel buses. Phillip Matier and Andrew Ross,
<quote>Antidiesel Group Fuming
8318 After Muni Rejects Ad,
</quote> SFGate.com,
16 June
2003, available at
8319 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
32</ulink>. The ground
8320 was that the criticism was
<quote>too controversial.
</quote>
8321 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
8322 <indexterm><primary>Comcast
</primary></indexterm>
8323 <indexterm><primary>Marijuana Policy Project
</primary></indexterm>
8324 <indexterm><primary>NBC
</primary></indexterm>
8325 <indexterm><primary>WJOA
</primary></indexterm>
8326 <indexterm><primary>WRC
</primary></indexterm>
8327 <indexterm><primary>advertising
</primary></indexterm>
8331 I'd be happy to defend the networks' rights, as well
—if we lived
8332 in a media market that was truly diverse. But concentration in the
8333 media throws that condition into doubt. If a handful of companies
8334 control access to the media, and that handful of companies gets to
8335 decide which political positions it will allow to be promoted on its
8336 channels, then in an obvious and important way, concentration
8337 matters. You might like the positions the handful of companies
8338 selects. But you should not like a world in which a mere few get to
8339 decide which issues the rest of us get to know about.
8341 <indexterm startref='idxadvertising3' class='endofrange'
/>
8343 <section id=
"together">
8344 <title>Together
</title>
8346 There is something innocent and obvious about the claim of the
8347 copyright warriors that the government should
<quote>protect my property.
</quote>
8348 In the abstract, it is obviously true and, ordinarily, totally
8349 harmless. No sane sort who is not an anarchist could disagree.
8352 But when we see how dramatically this
<quote>property
</quote> has changed
—
8353 when we recognize how it might now interact with both technology and
8354 markets to mean that the effective constraint on the liberty to
8355 cultivate our culture is dramatically different
—the claim begins
8358 <!-- PAGE BREAK 180 -->
8359 less innocent and obvious. Given (
1) the power of technology to
8360 supplement the law's control, and (
2) the power of concentrated
8361 markets to weaken the opportunity for dissent, if strictly enforcing
8362 the massively expanded
<quote>property
</quote> rights granted by copyright
8363 fundamentally changes the freedom within this culture to cultivate and
8364 build upon our past, then we have to ask whether this property should
8368 Not starkly. Or absolutely. My point is not that we should abolish
8369 copyright or go back to the eighteenth century. That would be a total
8370 mistake, disastrous for the most important creative enterprises within
8374 But there is a space between zero and one, Internet culture
8375 notwithstanding. And these massive shifts in the effective power of
8376 copyright regulation, tied to increased concentration of the content
8377 industry and resting in the hands of technology that will increasingly
8378 enable control over the use of culture, should drive us to consider
8379 whether another adjustment is called for. Not an adjustment that
8380 increases copyright's power. Not an adjustment that increases its
8381 term. Rather, an adjustment to restore the balance that has
8382 traditionally defined copyright's regulation
—a weakening of that
8383 regulation, to strengthen creativity.
8386 Copyright law has not been a rock of Gibraltar. It's not a set of
8387 constant commitments that, for some mysterious reason, teenagers and
8388 geeks now flout. Instead, copyright power has grown dramatically in a
8389 short period of time, as the technologies of distribution and creation
8390 have changed and as lobbyists have pushed for more control by
8391 copyright holders. Changes in the past in response to changes in
8392 technology suggest that we may well need similar changes in the
8393 future. And these changes have to be
<emphasis>reductions
</emphasis>
8394 in the scope of copyright, in response to the extraordinary increase
8395 in control that technology and the market enable.
8398 For the single point that is lost in this war on pirates is a point that
8399 we see only after surveying the range of these changes. When you add
8400 <!-- PAGE BREAK 181 -->
8401 together the effect of changing law, concentrated markets, and
8402 changing technology, together they produce an astonishing conclusion:
8403 <emphasis>Never in our history have fewer had a legal right to control
8404 more of the development of our culture than now
</emphasis>.
8407 Not when copyrights were perpetual, for when copyrights were
8408 perpetual, they affected only that precise creative work. Not when
8409 only publishers had the tools to publish, for the market then was much
8410 more diverse. Not when there were only three television networks, for
8411 even then, newspapers, film studios, radio stations, and publishers
8412 were independent of the networks.
<emphasis>Never
</emphasis> has
8413 copyright protected such a wide range of rights, against as broad a
8414 range of actors, for a term that was remotely as long. This form of
8415 regulation
—a tiny regulation of a tiny part of the creative
8416 energy of a nation at the founding
—is now a massive regulation
8417 of the overall creative process. Law plus technology plus the market
8418 now interact to turn this historically benign regulation into the most
8419 significant regulation of culture that our free society has
8420 known.
<footnote><para>
8422 Siva Vaidhyanathan captures a similar point in his
<quote>four surrenders
</quote> of
8423 copyright law in the digital age. See Vaidhyanathan,
159–60.
8424 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
8428 This has been a long chapter. Its point can now be briefly stated.
8431 At the start of this book, I distinguished between commercial and
8432 noncommercial culture. In the course of this chapter, I have
8433 distinguished between copying a work and transforming it. We can now
8434 combine these two distinctions and draw a clear map of the changes
8435 that copyright law has undergone. In
1790, the law looked like this:
8438 <informaltable id=
"t2">
8439 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8443 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8444 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8449 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8450 <entry>©</entry>
8454 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8463 The act of publishing a map, chart, and book was regulated by
8464 copyright law. Nothing else was. Transformations were free. And as
8465 copyright attached only with registration, and only those who intended
8467 <!-- PAGE BREAK 182 -->
8468 to benefit commercially would register, copying through publishing of
8469 noncommercial work was also free.
8472 By the end of the nineteenth century, the law had changed to this:
8475 <informaltable id=
"t3">
8476 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8480 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8481 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8486 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8487 <entry>©</entry>
8488 <entry>©</entry>
8491 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8500 Derivative works were now regulated by copyright law
—if
8501 published, which again, given the economics of publishing at the time,
8502 means if offered commercially. But noncommercial publishing and
8503 transformation were still essentially free.
8506 In
1909 the law changed to regulate copies, not publishing, and after
8507 this change, the scope of the law was tied to technology. As the
8508 technology of copying became more prevalent, the reach of the law
8509 expanded. Thus by
1975, as photocopying machines became more common,
8510 we could say the law began to look like this:
8513 <informaltable id=
"t4">
8514 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8519 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8524 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8525 <entry>©</entry>
8526 <entry>©</entry>
8529 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8530 <entry>©/Free
</entry>
8538 The law was interpreted to reach noncommercial copying through, say,
8539 copy machines, but still much of copying outside of the commercial
8540 market remained free. But the consequence of the emergence of digital
8541 technologies, especially in the context of a digital network, means
8542 that the law now looks like this:
8545 <informaltable id=
"t5">
8546 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8551 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8556 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8557 <entry>©</entry>
8558 <entry>©</entry>
8561 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8562 <entry>©</entry>
8563 <entry>©</entry>
8570 Every realm is governed by copyright law, whereas before most
8571 creativity was not. The law now regulates the full range of
8573 <!-- PAGE BREAK 183 -->
8574 commercial or not, transformative or not
—with the same rules
8575 designed to regulate commercial publishers.
8578 Obviously, copyright law is not the enemy. The enemy is regulation
8579 that does no good. So the question that we should be asking just now
8580 is whether extending the regulations of copyright law into each of
8581 these domains actually does any good.
8584 I have no doubt that it does good in regulating commercial copying.
8585 But I also have no doubt that it does more harm than good when
8586 regulating (as it regulates just now) noncommercial copying and,
8587 especially, noncommercial transformation. And increasingly, for the
8588 reasons sketched especially in chapters
8589 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"recorders"/> and
8590 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"transformers"/>, one
8591 might well wonder whether it does more harm than good for commercial
8592 transformation. More commercial transformative work would be created
8593 if derivative rights were more sharply restricted.
8596 The issue is therefore not simply whether copyright is property. Of
8597 course copyright is a kind of
<quote>property,
</quote> and of course, as with any
8598 property, the state ought to protect it. But first impressions
8599 notwithstanding, historically, this property right (as with all
8600 property rights
<footnote><para>
8602 It was the single most important contribution of the legal realist
8603 movement to demonstrate that all property rights are always crafted to
8604 balance public and private interests. See Thomas C. Grey,
<quote>The
8605 Disintegration of Property,
</quote> in
<citetitle>Nomos XXII: Property
</citetitle>, J. Roland
8606 Pennock and John W. Chapman, eds. (New York: New York University
8608 <indexterm><primary>legal realist movement
</primary></indexterm>
8610 has been crafted to balance the important need to give authors and
8611 artists incentives with the equally important need to assure access to
8612 creative work. This balance has always been struck in light of new
8613 technologies. And for almost half of our tradition, the
<quote>copyright
</quote>
8614 did not control
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis> the freedom of others to
8615 build upon or transform a creative work. American culture was born
8616 free, and for almost
180 years our country consistently protected a
8617 vibrant and rich free culture.
8619 <indexterm><primary>archives, digital
</primary></indexterm>
8621 We achieved that free culture because our law respected important
8622 limits on the scope of the interests protected by
<quote>property.
</quote> The very
8623 birth of
<quote>copyright
</quote> as a statutory right recognized those limits, by
8624 granting copyright owners protection for a limited time only (the
8625 story of chapter
6). The tradition of
<quote>fair use
</quote> is animated by a
8626 similar concern that is increasingly under strain as the costs of
8627 exercising any fair use right become unavoidably high (the story of
8629 <!-- PAGE BREAK 184 -->
8630 statutory rights where markets might stifle innovation is another
8631 familiar limit on the property right that copyright is (chapter
8632 8). And granting archives and libraries a broad freedom to collect,
8633 claims of property notwithstanding, is a crucial part of guaranteeing
8634 the soul of a culture (chapter
9). Free cultures, like free markets,
8635 are built with property. But the nature of the property that builds a
8636 free culture is very different from the extremist vision that
8637 dominates the debate today.
8640 Free culture is increasingly the casualty in this war on piracy. In
8641 response to a real, if not yet quantified, threat that the
8642 technologies of the Internet present to twentieth-century business
8643 models for producing and distributing culture, the law and technology
8644 are being transformed in a way that will undermine our tradition of
8645 free culture. The property right that is copyright is no longer the
8646 balanced right that it was, or was intended to be. The property right
8647 that is copyright has become unbalanced, tilted toward an extreme. The
8648 opportunity to create and transform becomes weakened in a world in
8649 which creation requires permission and creativity must check with a
8652 <!-- PAGE BREAK 185 -->
8656 <part id=
"c-puzzles">
8657 <title>PUZZLES
</title>
8659 <!-- PAGE BREAK 186 -->
8660 <chapter label=
"11" id=
"chimera">
8661 <title>CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
</title>
8662 <indexterm id=
"idxchimera" class='startofrange'
>
8663 <primary>chimeras
</primary>
8665 <indexterm id=
"idxwells" class='startofrange'
>
8666 <primary>Wells, H. G.
</primary>
8668 <indexterm id=
"idxtcotb" class='startofrange'
>
8669 <primary><quote>Country of the Blind, The
</quote> (Wells)
</primary>
8673 In a well-known short story by H. G. Wells, a mountain climber
8674 named Nunez trips (literally, down an ice slope) into an unknown and
8675 isolated valley in the Peruvian Andes.
<footnote><para>
8677 H. G. Wells,
<quote>The Country of the Blind
</quote> (
1904,
1911). See H. G. Wells,
8678 <citetitle>The Country of the Blind and Other Stories
</citetitle>, Michael Sherborne, ed. (New
8679 York: Oxford University Press,
1996).
8681 The valley is extraordinarily beautiful, with
<quote>sweet water, pasture,
8682 an even climate, slopes of rich brown soil with tangles of a shrub
8683 that bore an excellent fruit.
</quote> But the villagers are all blind. Nunez
8684 takes this as an opportunity.
<quote>In the Country of the Blind,
</quote> he tells
8685 himself,
<quote>the One-Eyed Man is King.
</quote> So he resolves to live with the
8686 villagers to explore life as a king.
8689 Things don't go quite as he planned. He tries to explain the idea of
8690 sight to the villagers. They don't understand. He tells them they are
8691 <quote>blind.
</quote> They don't have the word
<citetitle>blind
</citetitle>. They think he's just thick.
8692 Indeed, as they increasingly notice the things he can't do (hear the
8693 sound of grass being stepped on, for example), they increasingly try
8694 to control him. He, in turn, becomes increasingly frustrated.
<quote>`You
8695 don't understand,' he cried, in a voice that was meant to be great and
8696 resolute, and which broke. `You are blind and I can see. Leave me
8700 <!-- PAGE BREAK 187 -->
8701 The villagers don't leave him alone. Nor do they see (so to speak) the
8702 virtue of his special power. Not even the ultimate target of his
8703 affection, a young woman who to him seems
<quote>the most beautiful thing in
8704 the whole of creation,
</quote> understands the beauty of sight. Nunez's
8705 description of what he sees
<quote>seemed to her the most poetical of
8706 fancies, and she listened to his description of the stars and the
8707 mountains and her own sweet white-lit beauty as though it was a guilty
8708 indulgence.
</quote> <quote>She did not believe,
</quote> Wells tells us, and
<quote>she could
8709 only half understand, but she was mysteriously delighted.
</quote>
8712 When Nunez announces his desire to marry his
<quote>mysteriously delighted
</quote>
8713 love, the father and the village object.
<quote>You see, my dear,
</quote> her
8714 father instructs,
<quote>he's an idiot. He has delusions. He can't do
8715 anything right.
</quote> They take Nunez to the village doctor.
8718 After a careful examination, the doctor gives his opinion.
<quote>His brain
8719 is affected,
</quote> he reports.
8722 <quote>What affects it?
</quote> the father asks.
<quote>Those queer things that are
8723 called the eyes
… are diseased
… in such a way as to affect
8727 The doctor continues:
<quote>I think I may say with reasonable certainty
8728 that in order to cure him completely, all that we need to do is a
8729 simple and easy surgical operation
—namely, to remove these
8730 irritant bodies [the eyes].
</quote>
8733 <quote>Thank Heaven for science!
</quote> says the father to the doctor. They inform
8734 Nunez of this condition necessary for him to be allowed his bride.
8735 (You'll have to read the original to learn what happens in the end. I
8736 believe in free culture, but never in giving away the end of a story.)
8737 It sometimes happens that the eggs of twins fuse in the mother's
8738 womb. That fusion produces a
<quote>chimera.
</quote> A chimera is a single creature
8739 with two sets of DNA. The DNA in the blood, for example, might be
8740 different from the DNA of the skin. This possibility is an underused
8742 <!-- PAGE BREAK 188 -->
8743 plot for murder mysteries.
<quote>But the DNA shows with
100 percent
8744 certainty that she was not the person whose blood was at the
8745 scene.
…</quote>
8747 <indexterm startref=
"idxtcotb" class='endofrange'
/>
8748 <indexterm startref=
"idxwells" class=
"endofrange"/>
8750 Before I had read about chimeras, I would have said they were
8751 impossible. A single person can't have two sets of DNA. The very idea
8752 of DNA is that it is the code of an individual. Yet in fact, not only
8753 can two individuals have the same set of DNA (identical twins), but
8754 one person can have two different sets of DNA (a chimera). Our
8755 understanding of a
<quote>person
</quote> should reflect this reality.
8758 The more I work to understand the current struggle over copyright and
8759 culture, which I've sometimes called unfairly, and sometimes not
8760 unfairly enough,
<quote>the copyright wars,
</quote> the more I think we're dealing
8761 with a chimera. For example, in the battle over the question
<quote>What is
8762 p2p file sharing?
</quote> both sides have it right, and both sides have it
8763 wrong. One side says,
<quote>File sharing is just like two kids taping each
8764 others' records
—the sort of thing we've been doing for the last
8765 thirty years without any question at all.
</quote> That's true, at least in
8766 part. When I tell my best friend to try out a new CD that I've bought,
8767 but rather than just send the CD, I point him to my p2p server, that
8768 is, in all relevant respects, just like what every executive in every
8769 recording company no doubt did as a kid: sharing music.
8772 But the description is also false in part. For when my p2p server is
8773 on a p2p network through which anyone can get access to my music, then
8774 sure, my friends can get access, but it stretches the meaning of
8775 <quote>friends
</quote> beyond recognition to say
<quote>my ten thousand best friends
</quote> can
8776 get access. Whether or not sharing my music with my best friend is
8777 what
<quote>we have always been allowed to do,
</quote> we have not always been
8778 allowed to share music with
<quote>our ten thousand best friends.
</quote>
8781 Likewise, when the other side says,
<quote>File sharing is just like walking
8782 into a Tower Records and taking a CD off the shelf and walking out
8783 with it,
</quote> that's true, at least in part. If, after Lyle Lovett
8784 (finally) releases a new album, rather than buying it, I go to Kazaa
8785 and find a free copy to take, that is very much like stealing a copy
8787 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
8791 <!-- PAGE BREAK 189 -->
8792 But it is not quite stealing from Tower. After all, when I take a CD
8793 from Tower Records, Tower has one less CD to sell. And when I take a
8794 CD from Tower Records, I get a bit of plastic and a cover, and
8795 something to show on my shelves. (And, while we're at it, we could
8796 also note that when I take a CD from Tower Records, the maximum fine
8797 that might be imposed on me, under California law, at least, is
8798 $
1,
000. According to the RIAA, by contrast, if I download a ten-song
8799 CD, I'm liable for $
1,
500,
000 in damages.)
8802 The point is not that it is as neither side describes. The point is
8803 that it is both
—both as the RIAA describes it and as Kazaa
8804 describes it. It is a chimera. And rather than simply denying what the
8805 other side asserts, we need to begin to think about how we should
8806 respond to this chimera. What rules should govern it?
8809 We could respond by simply pretending that it is not a chimera. We
8810 could, with the RIAA, decide that every act of file sharing should be
8811 a felony. We could prosecute families for millions of dollars in
8812 damages just because file sharing occurred on a family computer. And
8813 we can get universities to monitor all computer traffic to make sure
8814 that no computer is used to commit this crime. These responses might
8815 be extreme, but each of them has either been proposed or actually
8816 implemented.
<footnote><para>
8818 For an excellent summary, see the report prepared by GartnerG2 and the
8819 Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School,
8820 <quote>Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> 27 June
2003,
8822 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
8823 #
33</ulink>. Reps. John Conyers Jr. (D-Mich.) and Howard L. Berman
8824 (D-Calif.) have introduced a bill that would treat unauthorized
8825 on-line copying as a felony offense with punishments ranging as high
8826 as five years imprisonment; see Jon Healey,
<quote>House Bill Aims to Up
8827 Stakes on Piracy,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
17 July
2003, available at
8828 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
34</ulink>. Civil
8829 penalties are currently set at $
150,
000 per copied song. For a recent
8830 (and unsuccessful) legal challenge to the RIAA's demand that an ISP
8831 reveal the identity of a user accused of sharing more than
600 songs
8832 through a family computer, see
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Verizon Internet Services (In
8833 re. Verizon Internet Services)
</citetitle>,
240 F. Supp.
2d
24
8834 (D.D.C.
2003). Such a user could face liability ranging as high as $
90
8835 million. Such astronomical figures furnish the RIAA with a powerful
8836 arsenal in its prosecution of file sharers. Settlements ranging from
8837 $
12,
000 to $
17,
500 for four students accused of heavy file sharing on
8838 university networks must have seemed a mere pittance next to the $
98
8839 billion the RIAA could seek should the matter proceed to court. See
8840 Elizabeth Young,
<quote>Downloading Could Lead to Fines,
</quote> redandblack.com,
8841 August
2003, available at
8842 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
35</ulink>. For an
8843 example of the RIAA's targeting of student file sharing, and of the
8844 subpoenas issued to universities to reveal student file-sharer
8845 identities, see James Collins,
<quote>RIAA Steps Up Bid to Force BC, MIT to
8846 Name Students,
</quote> <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
8 August
2003, D3, available at
8847 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
36</ulink>.
8848 <indexterm><primary>Conyers, John, Jr.
</primary></indexterm>
8849 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
8853 <indexterm startref=
"idxchimera" class='endofrange'
/>
8855 Alternatively, we could respond to file sharing the way many kids act
8856 as though we've responded. We could totally legalize it. Let there be
8857 no copyright liability, either civil or criminal, for making
8858 copyrighted content available on the Net. Make file sharing like
8859 gossip: regulated, if at all, by social norms but not by law.
8862 Either response is possible. I think either would be a mistake.
8863 Rather than embrace one of these two extremes, we should embrace
8864 something that recognizes the truth in both. And while I end this book
8865 with a sketch of a system that does just that, my aim in the next
8866 chapter is to show just how awful it would be for us to adopt the
8867 zero-tolerance extreme. I believe
<emphasis>either
</emphasis> extreme
8868 would be worse than a reasonable alternative. But I believe the
8869 zero-tolerance solution would be the worse of the two extremes.
8873 <!-- PAGE BREAK 190 -->
8874 Yet zero tolerance is increasingly our government's policy. In the
8875 middle of the chaos that the Internet has created, an extraordinary
8876 land grab is occurring. The law and technology are being shifted to
8877 give content holders a kind of control over our culture that they have
8878 never had before. And in this extremism, many an opportunity for new
8879 innovation and new creativity will be lost.
8882 I'm not talking about the opportunities for kids to
<quote>steal
</quote> music. My
8883 focus instead is the commercial and cultural innovation that this war
8884 will also kill. We have never seen the power to innovate spread so
8885 broadly among our citizens, and we have just begun to see the
8886 innovation that this power will unleash. Yet the Internet has already
8887 seen the passing of one cycle of innovation around technologies to
8888 distribute content. The law is responsible for this passing. As the
8889 vice president for global public policy at one of these new
8890 innovators, eMusic.com, put it when criticizing the DMCA's added
8891 protection for copyrighted material,
8895 eMusic opposes music piracy. We are a distributor of copyrighted
8896 material, and we want to protect those rights.
8899 But building a technology fortress that locks in the clout of the
8900 major labels is by no means the only way to protect copyright
8901 interests, nor is it necessarily the best. It is simply too early to
8902 answer that question. Market forces operating naturally may very well
8903 produce a totally different industry model.
8906 This is a critical point. The choices that industry sectors make
8907 with respect to these systems will in many ways directly shape the
8908 market for digital media and the manner in which digital media
8909 are distributed. This in turn will directly influence the options
8910 that are available to consumers, both in terms of the ease with
8911 which they will be able to access digital media and the equipment
8912 that they will require to do so. Poor choices made this early in the
8913 game will retard the growth of this market, hurting everyone's
8914 interests.
<footnote><para>
8916 WIPO and the DMCA One Year Later: Assessing Consumer Access to Digital
8917 Entertainment on the Internet and Other Media: Hearing Before the
8918 Subcommittee on Telecommunications, Trade, and Consumer Protection,
8919 House Committee on Commerce,
106th Cong.
29 (
1999) (statement of Peter
8920 Harter, vice president, Global Public Policy and Standards,
8921 EMusic.com), available in LEXIS, Federal Document Clearing House
8922 Congressional Testimony File.
</para></footnote>
8925 <!-- PAGE BREAK 191 -->
8927 In April
2001, eMusic.com was purchased by Vivendi Universal,
8928 one of
<quote>the major labels.
</quote> Its position on these matters has now
8930 <indexterm><primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary></indexterm>
8933 Reversing our tradition of tolerance now will not merely quash
8934 piracy. It will sacrifice values that are important to this culture,
8935 and will kill opportunities that could be extraordinarily valuable.
8938 <!-- PAGE BREAK 192 -->
8940 <chapter label=
"12" id=
"harms">
8941 <title>CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
</title>
8943 To fight
<quote>piracy,
</quote> to protect
<quote>property,
</quote> the content industry has
8944 launched a war. Lobbying and lots of campaign contributions have now
8945 brought the government into this war. As with any war, this one will
8946 have both direct and collateral damage. As with any war of
8947 prohibition, these damages will be suffered most by our own people.
8950 My aim so far has been to describe the consequences of this war, in
8951 particular, the consequences for
<quote>free culture.
</quote> But my aim now is to
8952 extend this description of consequences into an argument. Is this war
8956 In my view, it is not. There is no good reason why this time, for the
8957 first time, the law should defend the old against the new, just when the
8958 power of the property called
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> is at its greatest in
8961 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
8962 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
8964 Yet
<quote>common sense
</quote> does not see it this way. Common sense is still on
8965 the side of the Causbys and the content industry. The extreme claims
8966 of control in the name of property still resonate; the uncritical
8967 rejection of
<quote>piracy
</quote> still has play.
8969 <indexterm><primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary></indexterm>
8971 <!-- PAGE BREAK 193 -->
8972 There will be many consequences of continuing this war. I want to
8973 describe just three. All three might be said to be unintended. I am quite
8974 confident the third is unintended. I'm less sure about the first two. The
8975 first two protect modern RCAs, but there is no Howard Armstrong in
8976 the wings to fight today's monopolists of culture.
8978 <section id=
"constrain">
8979 <title>Constraining Creators
</title>
8981 In the next ten years we will see an explosion of digital
8982 technologies. These technologies will enable almost anyone to capture
8983 and share content. Capturing and sharing content, of course, is what
8984 humans have done since the dawn of man. It is how we learn and
8985 communicate. But capturing and sharing through digital technology is
8986 different. The fidelity and power are different. You could send an
8987 e-mail telling someone about a joke you saw on Comedy Central, or you
8988 could send the clip. You could write an essay about the
8989 inconsistencies in the arguments of the politician you most love to
8990 hate, or you could make a short film that puts statement against
8991 statement. You could write a poem to express your love, or you could
8992 weave together a string
—a mash-up
— of songs from your
8993 favorite artists in a collage and make it available on the Net.
8996 This digital
<quote>capturing and sharing
</quote> is in part an extension of the
8997 capturing and sharing that has always been integral to our culture,
8998 and in part it is something new. It is continuous with the Kodak, but
8999 it explodes the boundaries of Kodak-like technologies. The technology
9000 of digital
<quote>capturing and sharing
</quote> promises a world of extraordinarily
9001 diverse creativity that can be easily and broadly shared. And as that
9002 creativity is applied to democracy, it will enable a broad range of
9003 citizens to use technology to express and criticize and contribute to
9004 the culture all around.
9007 Technology has thus given us an opportunity to do something with
9008 culture that has only ever been possible for individuals in small groups,
9010 <!-- PAGE BREAK 194 -->
9012 isolated from others. Think about an old man telling a story to a
9013 collection of neighbors in a small town. Now imagine that same
9014 storytelling extended across the globe.
9017 Yet all this is possible only if the activity is presumptively legal. In
9018 the current regime of legal regulation, it is not. Forget file sharing for
9019 a moment. Think about your favorite amazing sites on the Net. Web
9020 sites that offer plot summaries from forgotten television shows; sites
9021 that catalog cartoons from the
1960s; sites that mix images and sound
9022 to criticize politicians or businesses; sites that gather newspaper articles
9023 on remote topics of science or culture. There is a vast amount of creative
9024 work spread across the Internet. But as the law is currently crafted, this
9025 work is presumptively illegal.
9028 That presumption will increasingly chill creativity, as the
9029 examples of extreme penalties for vague infringements continue to
9030 proliferate. It is impossible to get a clear sense of what's allowed
9031 and what's not, and at the same time, the penalties for crossing the
9032 line are astonishingly harsh. The four students who were threatened
9033 by the RIAA ( Jesse Jordan of chapter
3 was just one) were threatened
9034 with a $
98 billion lawsuit for building search engines that permitted
9035 songs to be copied. Yet World-Com
—which defrauded investors of
9036 $
11 billion, resulting in a loss to investors in market capitalization
9037 of over $
200 billion
—received a fine of a mere $
750
9038 million.
<footnote><para>
9040 See Lynne W. Jeter,
<citetitle>Disconnected: Deceit and Betrayal at WorldCom
</citetitle>
9041 (Hoboken, N.J.: John Wiley
& Sons,
2003),
176,
204; for details of
9042 the settlement, see MCI press release,
<quote>MCI Wins U.S. District Court
9043 Approval for SEC Settlement
</quote> (
7 July
2003), available at
9044 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
37</ulink>.
9045 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
9047 And under legislation being pushed in Congress right now, a doctor who
9048 negligently removes the wrong leg in an operation would be liable for
9049 no more than $
250,
000 in damages for pain and
9050 suffering.
<footnote>
9052 <!-- f2. --> The bill, modeled after California's tort reform model, was passed in the
9053 House of Representatives but defeated in a Senate vote in July
2003. For
9054 an overview, see Tanya Albert,
<quote>Measure Stalls in Senate: `We'll Be Back,'
9055 Say Tort Reformers,
</quote> amednews.com,
28 July
2003, available at
9056 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
38</ulink>,
9057 and
<quote>Senate Turns Back Malpractice Caps,
</quote> CBSNews.com,
9 July
2003,
9059 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
39</ulink>. President Bush has continued to urge tort reform in
9061 <indexterm><primary>Bush, George W.
</primary></indexterm>
9063 Can common sense recognize the absurdity in a world where
9064 the maximum fine for downloading two songs off the Internet is more
9065 than the fine for a doctor's negligently butchering a patient?
9066 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
9068 <indexterm><primary>art, underground
</primary></indexterm>
9070 The consequence of this legal uncertainty, tied to these extremely
9071 high penalties, is that an extraordinary amount of creativity will
9072 either never be exercised, or never be exercised in the open. We drive
9073 this creative process underground by branding the modern-day Walt
9074 Disneys
<quote>pirates.
</quote> We make it impossible for businesses to rely upon a
9075 public domain, because the boundaries of the public domain are
9078 <!-- PAGE BREAK 195 -->
9079 be unclear. It never pays to do anything except pay for the right
9080 to create, and hence only those who can pay are allowed to create. As
9081 was the case in the Soviet Union, though for very different reasons,
9082 we will begin to see a world of underground art
—not because the
9083 message is necessarily political, or because the subject is
9084 controversial, but because the very act of creating the art is legally
9085 fraught. Already, exhibits of
<quote>illegal art
</quote> tour the United
9086 States.
<footnote><para>
9089 See Danit Lidor,
<quote>Artists Just Wanna Be Free,
</quote> <citetitle>Wired
</citetitle>,
7 July
9091 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
40</ulink>. For an overview of the exhibition, see
9092 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
41</ulink>.
9094 In what does their
<quote>illegality
</quote> consist?
9095 In the act of mixing the culture around us with an expression that is
9096 critical or reflective.
9099 Part of the reason for this fear of illegality has to do with the
9100 changing law. I described that change in detail in chapter
9101 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>. But an
9102 even bigger part has to do with the increasing ease with which
9103 infractions can be tracked. As users of file-sharing systems
9104 discovered in
2002, it is a trivial matter for copyright owners to get
9105 courts to order Internet service providers to reveal who has what
9106 content. It is as if your cassette tape player transmitted a list of
9107 the songs that you played in the privacy of your own home that anyone
9108 could tune into for whatever reason they chose.
9111 Never in our history has a painter had to worry about whether
9112 his painting infringed on someone else's work; but the modern-day
9113 painter, using the tools of Photoshop, sharing content on the Web,
9114 must worry all the time. Images are all around, but the only safe images
9115 to use in the act of creation are those purchased from Corbis or another
9116 image farm. And in purchasing, censoring happens. There is a free
9117 market in pencils; we needn't worry about its effect on creativity. But
9118 there is a highly regulated, monopolized market in cultural icons; the
9119 right to cultivate and transform them is not similarly free.
9122 Lawyers rarely see this because lawyers are rarely empirical. As I
9123 described in chapter
9124 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"recorders"/>, in
9125 response to the story about documentary filmmaker Jon Else, I have
9126 been lectured again and again by lawyers who insist Else's use was
9127 fair use, and hence I am wrong to say that the law regulates such a
9132 <!-- PAGE BREAK 196 -->
9133 But fair use in America simply means the right to hire a lawyer to
9134 defend your right to create. And as lawyers love to forget, our system
9135 for defending rights such as fair use is astonishingly bad
—in
9136 practically every context, but especially here. It costs too much, it
9137 delivers too slowly, and what it delivers often has little connection
9138 to the justice underlying the claim. The legal system may be tolerable
9139 for the very rich. For everyone else, it is an embarrassment to a
9140 tradition that prides itself on the rule of law.
9143 Judges and lawyers can tell themselves that fair use provides adequate
9144 <quote>breathing room
</quote> between regulation by the law and the access the law
9145 should allow. But it is a measure of how out of touch our legal system
9146 has become that anyone actually believes this. The rules that
9147 publishers impose upon writers, the rules that film distributors
9148 impose upon filmmakers, the rules that newspapers impose upon
9149 journalists
— these are the real laws governing creativity. And
9150 these rules have little relationship to the
<quote>law
</quote> with which judges
9154 For in a world that threatens $
150,
000 for a single willful
9155 infringement of a copyright, and which demands tens of thousands of
9156 dollars to even defend against a copyright infringement claim, and
9157 which would never return to the wrongfully accused defendant anything
9158 of the costs she suffered to defend her right to speak
—in that
9159 world, the astonishingly broad regulations that pass under the name
9160 <quote>copyright
</quote> silence speech and creativity. And in that world, it takes
9161 a studied blindness for people to continue to believe they live in a
9162 culture that is free.
9165 As Jed Horovitz, the businessman behind Video Pipeline, said to me,
9169 We're losing [creative] opportunities right and left. Creative people
9170 are being forced not to express themselves. Thoughts are not being
9171 expressed. And while a lot of stuff may [still] be created, it still
9172 won't get distributed. Even if the stuff gets made
… you're not
9173 going to get it distributed in the mainstream media unless
9174 <!-- PAGE BREAK 197 -->
9175 you've got a little note from a lawyer saying,
<quote>This has been
9176 cleared.
</quote> You're not even going to get it on PBS without that kind of
9177 permission. That's the point at which they control it.
9181 <section id=
"innovators">
9182 <title>Constraining Innovators
</title>
9184 The story of the last section was a crunchy-lefty
9185 story
—creativity quashed, artists who can't speak, yada yada
9186 yada. Maybe that doesn't get you going. Maybe you think there's enough
9187 weird art out there, and enough expression that is critical of what
9188 seems to be just about everything. And if you think that, you might
9189 think there's little in this story to worry you.
9192 But there's an aspect of this story that is not lefty in any sense.
9193 Indeed, it is an aspect that could be written by the most extreme
9194 promarket ideologue. And if you're one of these sorts (and a special
9195 one at that,
188 pages into a book like this), then you can see this
9196 other aspect by substituting
<quote>free market
</quote> every place I've spoken of
9197 <quote>free culture.
</quote> The point is the same, even if the interests
9198 affecting culture are more fundamental.
9200 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
9202 The charge I've been making about the regulation of culture is the
9203 same charge free marketers make about regulating markets. Everyone, of
9204 course, concedes that some regulation of markets is necessary
—at
9205 a minimum, we need rules of property and contract, and courts to
9206 enforce both. Likewise, in this culture debate, everyone concedes that
9207 at least some framework of copyright is also required. But both
9208 perspectives vehemently insist that just because some regulation is
9209 good, it doesn't follow that more regulation is better. And both
9210 perspectives are constantly attuned to the ways in which regulation
9211 simply enables the powerful industries of today to protect themselves
9212 against the competitors of tomorrow.
9214 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9216 This is the single most dramatic effect of the shift in regulatory
9217 <!-- PAGE BREAK 198 -->
9218 strategy that I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select:
9219 labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>. The consequence of this massive
9220 threat of liability tied to the murky boundaries of copyright law is
9221 that innovators who want to innovate in this space can safely innovate
9222 only if they have the sign-off from last generation's dominant
9223 industries. That lesson has been taught through a series of cases
9224 that were designed and executed to teach venture capitalists a
9225 lesson. That lesson
—what former Napster CEO Hank Barry calls a
9226 <quote>nuclear pall
</quote> that has fallen over the Valley
—has been learned.
9229 Consider one example to make the point, a story whose beginning
9230 I told in
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle> and which has progressed in a way that
9231 even I (pessimist extraordinaire) would never have predicted.
9233 <indexterm><primary>Roberts, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
9235 In
1997, Michael Roberts launched a company called MP3.com. MP3.com
9236 was keen to remake the music business. Their goal was not just to
9237 facilitate new ways to get access to content. Their goal was also to
9238 facilitate new ways to create content. Unlike the major labels,
9239 MP3.com offered creators a venue to distribute their creativity,
9240 without demanding an exclusive engagement from the creators.
9243 To make this system work, however, MP3.com needed a reliable way to
9244 recommend music to its users. The idea behind this alternative was to
9245 leverage the revealed preferences of music listeners to recommend new
9246 artists. If you like Lyle Lovett, you're likely to enjoy Bonnie
9248 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
9251 This idea required a simple way to gather data about user preferences.
9252 MP3.com came up with an extraordinarily clever way to gather this
9253 preference data. In January
2000, the company launched a service
9254 called my.mp3.com. Using software provided by MP3.com, a user would
9255 sign into an account and then insert into her computer a CD. The
9256 software would identify the CD, and then give the user access to that
9257 content. So, for example, if you inserted a CD by Jill Sobule, then
9258 wherever you were
—at work or at home
—you could get access
9259 to that music once you signed into your account. The system was
9260 therefore a kind of music-lockbox.
9263 No doubt some could use this system to illegally copy content. But
9264 that opportunity existed with or without MP3.com. The aim of the
9266 <!-- PAGE BREAK 199 -->
9267 my.mp3.com service was to give users access to their own content, and
9268 as a by-product, by seeing the content they already owned, to discover
9269 the kind of content the users liked.
9272 To make this system function, however, MP3.com needed to copy
50,
000
9273 CDs to a server. (In principle, it could have been the user who
9274 uploaded the music, but that would have taken a great deal of time,
9275 and would have produced a product of questionable quality.) It
9276 therefore purchased
50,
000 CDs from a store, and started the process
9277 of making copies of those CDs. Again, it would not serve the content
9278 from those copies to anyone except those who authenticated that they
9279 had a copy of the CD they wanted to access. So while this was
50,
000
9280 copies, it was
50,
000 copies directed at giving customers something
9281 they had already bought.
9283 <indexterm id=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='startofrange'
>
9284 <primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary>
9287 Nine days after MP3.com launched its service, the five major labels,
9288 headed by the RIAA, brought a lawsuit against MP3.com. MP3.com settled
9289 with four of the five. Nine months later, a federal judge found
9290 MP3.com to have been guilty of willful infringement with respect to
9291 the fifth. Applying the law as it is, the judge imposed a fine against
9292 MP3.com of $
118 million. MP3.com then settled with the remaining
9293 plaintiff, Vivendi Universal, paying over $
54 million. Vivendi
9294 purchased MP3.com just about a year later.
9297 That part of the story I have told before. Now consider its conclusion.
9300 After Vivendi purchased MP3.com, Vivendi turned around and filed a
9301 malpractice lawsuit against the lawyers who had advised it that they
9302 had a good faith claim that the service they wanted to offer would be
9303 considered legal under copyright law. This lawsuit alleged that it
9304 should have been obvious that the courts would find this behavior
9305 illegal; therefore, this lawsuit sought to punish any lawyer who had
9306 dared to suggest that the law was less restrictive than the labels
9310 The clear purpose of this lawsuit (which was settled for an
9311 unspecified amount shortly after the story was no longer covered in
9312 the press) was to send an unequivocal message to lawyers advising
9314 <!-- PAGE BREAK 200 -->
9315 space: It is not just your clients who might suffer if the content
9316 industry directs its guns against them. It is also you. So those of
9317 you who believe the law should be less restrictive should realize that
9318 such a view of the law will cost you and your firm dearly.
9320 <indexterm startref=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='endofrange'
/>
9321 <indexterm><primary>Hummer, John
</primary></indexterm>
9322 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9323 <indexterm><primary>Hummer Winblad
</primary></indexterm>
9325 This strategy is not just limited to the lawyers. In April
2003,
9326 Universal and EMI brought a lawsuit against Hummer Winblad, the
9327 venture capital firm (VC) that had funded Napster at a certain stage of
9328 its development, its cofounder ( John Hummer), and general partner
9329 (Hank Barry).
<footnote><para>
9331 See Joseph Menn,
<quote>Universal, EMI Sue Napster Investor,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles
9332 Times
</citetitle>,
23 April
2003. For a parallel argument about the effects on
9333 innovation in the distribution of music, see Janelle Brown,
<quote>The Music
9334 Revolution Will Not Be Digitized,
</quote> Salon.com,
1 June
2001, available
9335 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
42</ulink>.
9336 See also Jon Healey,
<quote>Online Music Services Besieged,
</quote> <citetitle>Los Angeles
9337 Times
</citetitle>,
28 May
2001.
9339 The claim here, as well, was that the VC should have recognized the
9340 right of the content industry to control how the industry should
9341 develop. They should be held personally liable for funding a company
9342 whose business turned out to be beyond the law. Here again, the aim of
9343 the lawsuit is transparent: Any VC now recognizes that if you fund a
9344 company whose business is not approved of by the dinosaurs, you are at
9345 risk not just in the marketplace, but in the courtroom as well. Your
9346 investment buys you not only a company, it also buys you a lawsuit.
9347 So extreme has the environment become that even car manufacturers are
9348 afraid of technologies that touch content. In an article in
9349 <citetitle>Business
2.0</citetitle>, Rafe Needleman describes a
9350 discussion with BMW:
9351 <indexterm><primary>EMI
</primary></indexterm>
9352 <indexterm><primary>Universal Music Group
</primary></indexterm>
9355 <indexterm><primary>BMW
</primary></indexterm>
9357 I asked why, with all the storage capacity and computer power in
9358 the car, there was no way to play MP3 files. I was told that BMW
9359 engineers in Germany had rigged a new vehicle to play MP3s via
9360 the car's built-in sound system, but that the company's marketing
9361 and legal departments weren't comfortable with pushing this
9362 forward for release stateside. Even today, no new cars are sold in the
9363 United States with bona fide MP3 players.
… <footnote>
9366 Rafe Needleman,
<quote>Driving in Cars with MP3s,
</quote> <citetitle>Business
2.0</citetitle>,
16 June
9368 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
43</ulink>. I am grateful
9369 to Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli for this example.
9370 <indexterm><primary>Needleman, Rafe
</primary></indexterm>
9375 This is the world of the mafia
—filled with
<quote>your money or your
9376 life
</quote> offers, governed in the end not by courts but by the threats
9377 that the law empowers copyright holders to exercise. It is a system
9378 that will obviously and necessarily stifle new innovation. It is hard
9379 enough to start a company. It is impossibly hard if that company is
9380 constantly threatened by litigation.
9384 <!-- PAGE BREAK 201 -->
9385 The point is not that businesses should have a right to start illegal
9386 enterprises. The point is the definition of
<quote>illegal.
</quote> The law is a
9387 mess of uncertainty. We have no good way to know how it should apply
9388 to new technologies. Yet by reversing our tradition of judicial
9389 deference, and by embracing the astonishingly high penalties that
9390 copyright law imposes, that uncertainty now yields a reality which is
9391 far more conservative than is right. If the law imposed the death
9392 penalty for parking tickets, we'd not only have fewer parking tickets,
9393 we'd also have much less driving. The same principle applies to
9394 innovation. If innovation is constantly checked by this uncertain and
9395 unlimited liability, we will have much less vibrant innovation and
9396 much less creativity.
9398 <indexterm><primary>market constraints
</primary></indexterm>
9400 The point is directly parallel to the crunchy-lefty point about fair
9401 use. Whatever the
<quote>real
</quote> law is, realism about the effect of law in
9402 both contexts is the same. This wildly punitive system of regulation
9403 will systematically stifle creativity and innovation. It will protect
9404 some industries and some creators, but it will harm industry and
9405 creativity generally. Free market and free culture depend upon vibrant
9406 competition. Yet the effect of the law today is to stifle just this
9407 kind of competition. The effect is to produce an overregulated
9408 culture, just as the effect of too much control in the market is to
9409 produce an overregulatedregulated market.
9412 The building of a permission culture, rather than a free culture, is
9413 the first important way in which the changes I have described will
9414 burden innovation. A permission culture means a lawyer's
9415 culture
—a culture in which the ability to create requires a call
9416 to your lawyer. Again, I am not antilawyer, at least when they're kept
9417 in their proper place. I am certainly not antilaw. But our profession
9418 has lost the sense of its limits. And leaders in our profession have
9419 lost an appreciation of the high costs that our profession imposes
9420 upon others. The inefficiency of the law is an embarrassment to our
9421 tradition. And while I believe our profession should therefore do
9422 everything it can to make the law more efficient, it should at least
9423 do everything it can to limit the reach of the
9424 <!-- PAGE BREAK 202 -->
9425 law where the law is not doing any good. The transaction costs buried
9426 within a permission culture are enough to bury a wide range of
9427 creativity. Someone needs to do a lot of justifying to justify that
9428 result. The uncertainty of the law is one burden on innovation. There
9429 is a second burden that operates more directly. This is the effort by
9430 many in the content industry to use the law to directly regulate the
9431 technology of the Internet so that it better protects their content.
9434 The motivation for this response is obvious. The Internet enables the
9435 efficient spread of content. That efficiency is a feature of the
9436 Internet's design. But from the perspective of the content industry,
9437 this feature is a
<quote>bug.
</quote> The efficient spread of content means that
9438 content distributors have a harder time controlling the distribution
9439 of content. One obvious response to this efficiency is thus to make
9440 the Internet less efficient. If the Internet enables
<quote>piracy,
</quote> then,
9441 this response says, we should break the kneecaps of the Internet.
9444 The examples of this form of legislation are many. At the urging of
9445 the content industry, some in Congress have threatened legislation that
9446 would require computers to determine whether the content they access
9447 is protected or not, and to disable the spread of protected content.
<footnote><para>
9448 <!-- f6. --> <quote>Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> GartnerG2 and
9449 the Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School
9450 (
2003),
33–35, available at
9451 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9453 Congress has already launched proceedings to explore a mandatory
9454 <quote>broadcast flag
</quote> that would be required on any device capable of
9455 transmitting digital video (i.e., a computer), and that would disable
9456 the copying of any content that is marked with a broadcast flag. Other
9457 members of Congress have proposed immunizing content providers from
9458 liability for technology they might deploy that would hunt down
9459 copyright violators and disable their machines.
<footnote><para>
9461 GartnerG2,
26–27.
9465 In one sense, these solutions seem sensible. If the problem is the
9466 code, why not regulate the code to remove the problem. But any
9467 regulation of technical infrastructure will always be tuned to the
9468 particular technology of the day. It will impose significant burdens
9470 <!-- PAGE BREAK 203 -->
9471 the technology, but will likely be eclipsed by advances around exactly
9475 In March
2002, a broad coalition of technology companies, led by
9476 Intel, tried to get Congress to see the harm that such legislation
9477 would impose.
<footnote><para>
9479 See David McGuire,
<quote>Tech Execs Square Off Over Piracy,
</quote> Newsbytes,
9480 February
2002 (Entertainment).
9482 Their argument was obviously not that copyright should not be
9483 protected. Instead, they argued, any protection should not do more
9485 <indexterm><primary>Intel
</primary></indexterm>
9488 There is one more obvious way in which this war has harmed
9489 innovation
—again, a story that will be quite familiar to the
9493 Copyright may be property, but like all property, it is also a form
9494 of regulation. It is a regulation that benefits some and harms others.
9495 When done right, it benefits creators and harms leeches. When done
9496 wrong, it is regulation the powerful use to defeat competitors.
9499 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
9500 linkend=
"property-i"/>, despite this feature of copyright as
9501 regulation, and subject to important qualifications outlined by
9502 Jessica Litman in her book
<citetitle>Digital
9503 Copyright
</citetitle>,
<footnote><para>
9505 Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (Amherst,
9506 N.Y.: Prometheus Books,
2001).
9507 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
9509 overall this history of copyright is not bad. As chapter
10 details,
9510 when new technologies have come along, Congress has struck a balance
9511 to assure that the new is protected from the old. Compulsory, or
9512 statutory, licenses have been one part of that strategy. Free use (as
9513 in the case of the VCR) has been another.
9516 But that pattern of deference to new technologies has now changed
9517 with the rise of the Internet. Rather than striking a balance between
9518 the claims of a new technology and the legitimate rights of content
9519 creators, both the courts and Congress have imposed legal restrictions
9520 that will have the effect of smothering the new to benefit the old.
9523 The response by the courts has been fairly universal.
<footnote><para>
9525 The only circuit court exception is found in
<citetitle>Recording Industry
9526 Association of America (RIAA)
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Diamond Multimedia Systems
</citetitle>,
180 F.
3d
9527 1072 (
9th Cir.
1999). There the court of appeals for the Ninth Circuit
9528 reasoned that makers of a portable MP3 player were not liable for
9529 contributory copyright infringement for a device that is unable to
9530 record or redistribute music (a device whose only copying function is
9531 to render portable a music file already stored on a user's hard
9532 drive). At the district court level, the only exception is found in
9533 <citetitle>Metro-Goldwyn-Mayer Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Grokster, Ltd
</citetitle>.,
259 F. Supp.
2d
9534 1029 (C.D. Cal.,
2003), where the court found the link between the
9535 distributor and any given user's conduct too attenuated to make the
9536 distributor liable for contributory or vicarious infringement
9539 It has been mirrored in the responses threatened and actually
9540 implemented by Congress. I won't catalog all of those responses
9541 here.
<footnote><para>
9543 For example, in July
2002, Representative Howard Berman introduced the
9544 Peer-to-Peer Piracy Prevention Act (H.R.
5211), which would immunize
9545 copyright holders from liability for damage done to computers when the
9546 copyright holders use technology to stop copyright infringement. In
9547 August
2002, Representative Billy Tauzin introduced a bill to mandate
9548 that technologies capable of rebroadcasting digital copies of films
9549 broadcast on TV (i.e., computers) respect a
<quote>broadcast flag
</quote> that
9550 would disable copying of that content. And in March of the same year,
9551 Senator Fritz Hollings introduced the Consumer Broadband and Digital
9552 Television Promotion Act, which mandated copyright protection
9553 technology in all digital media devices. See GartnerG2,
<quote>Copyright and
9554 Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,
</quote> 27 June
2003,
33–34,
9556 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9557 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
9558 <indexterm><primary>Hollings, Fritz
</primary></indexterm>
9560 But there is one example that captures the flavor of them all. This is
9561 the story of the demise of Internet radio.
9565 <!-- PAGE BREAK 204 -->
9566 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
9567 linkend=
"pirates"/>, when a radio station plays a song, the recording
9568 artist doesn't get paid for that
<quote>radio performance
</quote> unless he or she
9569 is also the composer. So, for example if Marilyn Monroe had recorded a
9570 version of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote>—to memorialize her famous
9571 performance before President Kennedy at Madison Square Garden
—
9572 then whenever that recording was played on the radio, the current
9573 copyright owners of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> would get some money, whereas
9574 Marilyn Monroe would not.
9575 <indexterm><primary>Kennedy, John F.
</primary></indexterm>
9578 The reasoning behind this balance struck by Congress makes some
9579 sense. The justification was that radio was a kind of advertising. The
9580 recording artist thus benefited because by playing her music, the
9581 radio station was making it more likely that her records would be
9582 purchased. Thus, the recording artist got something, even if only
9583 indirectly. Probably this reasoning had less to do with the result
9584 than with the power of radio stations: Their lobbyists were quite good
9585 at stopping any efforts to get Congress to require compensation to the
9589 Enter Internet radio. Like regular radio, Internet radio is a
9590 technology to stream content from a broadcaster to a listener. The
9591 broadcast travels across the Internet, not across the ether of radio
9592 spectrum. Thus, I can
<quote>tune in
</quote> to an Internet radio station in
9593 Berlin while sitting in San Francisco, even though there's no way for
9594 me to tune in to a regular radio station much beyond the San Francisco
9598 This feature of the architecture of Internet radio means that there
9599 are potentially an unlimited number of radio stations that a user
9600 could tune in to using her computer, whereas under the existing
9601 architecture for broadcast radio, there is an obvious limit to the
9602 number of broadcasters and clear broadcast frequencies. Internet radio
9603 could therefore be more competitive than regular radio; it could
9604 provide a wider range of selections. And because the potential
9605 audience for Internet radio is the whole world, niche stations could
9606 easily develop and market their content to a relatively large number
9607 of users worldwide. According to some estimates, more than eighty
9608 million users worldwide have tuned in to this new form of radio.
9610 <indexterm><primary>Armstrong, Edwin Howard
</primary></indexterm>
9613 <!-- PAGE BREAK 205 -->
9614 Internet radio is thus to radio what FM was to AM. It is an
9615 improvement potentially vastly more significant than the FM
9616 improvement over AM, since not only is the technology better, so, too,
9617 is the competition. Indeed, there is a direct parallel between the
9618 fight to establish FM radio and the fight to protect Internet
9619 radio. As one author describes Howard Armstrong's struggle to enable
9624 An almost unlimited number of FM stations was possible in the
9625 shortwaves, thus ending the unnatural restrictions imposed on radio in
9626 the crowded longwaves. If FM were freely developed, the number of
9627 stations would be limited only by economics and competition rather
9628 than by technical restrictions.
… Armstrong likened the situation
9629 that had grown up in radio to that following the invention of the
9630 printing press, when governments and ruling interests attempted to
9631 control this new instrument of mass communications by imposing
9632 restrictive licenses on it. This tyranny was broken only when it
9633 became possible for men freely to acquire printing presses and freely
9634 to run them. FM in this sense was as great an invention as the
9635 printing presses, for it gave radio the opportunity to strike off its
9636 shackles.
<footnote><para>
9643 This potential for FM radio was never realized
—not
9644 because Armstrong was wrong about the technology, but because he
9645 underestimated the power of
<quote>vested interests, habits, customs and
9646 legislation
</quote><footnote><para>
9650 to retard the growth of this competing technology.
9653 Now the very same claim could be made about Internet radio. For
9654 again, there is no technical limitation that could restrict the number of
9655 Internet radio stations. The only restrictions on Internet radio are
9656 those imposed by the law. Copyright law is one such law. So the first
9657 question we should ask is, what copyright rules would govern Internet
9661 But here the power of the lobbyists is reversed. Internet radio is a
9662 new industry. The recording artists, on the other hand, have a very
9664 <!-- PAGE BREAK 206 -->
9665 powerful lobby, the RIAA. Thus when Congress considered the phenomenon
9666 of Internet radio in
1995, the lobbyists had primed Congress to adopt
9667 a different rule for Internet radio than the rule that applies to
9668 terrestrial radio. While terrestrial radio does not have to pay our
9669 hypothetical Marilyn Monroe when it plays her hypothetical recording
9670 of
<quote>Happy Birthday
</quote> on the air,
<emphasis>Internet radio
9671 does
</emphasis>. Not only is the law not neutral toward Internet
9672 radio
—the law actually burdens Internet radio more than it
9673 burdens terrestrial radio.
9676 This financial burden is not slight. As Harvard law professor
9677 William Fisher estimates, if an Internet radio station distributed adfree
9678 popular music to (on average) ten thousand listeners, twenty-four
9679 hours a day, the total artist fees that radio station would owe would be
9680 over $
1 million a year.
<footnote>
9683 This example was derived from fees set by the original Copyright
9684 Arbitration Royalty Panel (CARP) proceedings, and is drawn from an
9685 example offered by Professor William Fisher. Conference Proceedings,
9686 iLaw (Stanford),
3 July
2003, on file with author. Professors Fisher
9687 and Zittrain submitted testimony in the CARP proceeding that was
9688 ultimately rejected. See Jonathan Zittrain, Digital Performance Right
9689 in Sound Recordings and Ephemeral Recordings, Docket No.
2000-
9, CARP
9690 DTRA
1 and
2, available at
9691 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
45</ulink>.
9692 For an excellent analysis making a similar point, see Randal
9693 C. Picker,
<quote>Copyright as Entry Policy: The Case of Digital
9694 Distribution,
</quote> <citetitle>Antitrust Bulletin
</citetitle> (Summer/Fall
2002):
461:
<quote>This was
9695 not confusion, these are just old-fashioned entry barriers. Analog
9696 radio stations are protected from digital entrants, reducing entry in
9697 radio and diversity. Yes, this is done in the name of getting
9698 royalties to copyright holders, but, absent the play of powerful
9699 interests, that could have been done in a media-neutral way.
</quote>
9700 <indexterm><primary>CARP (Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel)
</primary></indexterm>
9701 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
9703 A regular radio station broadcasting the same content would pay no
9707 The burden is not financial only. Under the original rules that were
9708 proposed, an Internet radio station (but not a terrestrial radio
9709 station) would have to collect the following data from
<emphasis>every
9710 listening transaction
</emphasis>:
9712 <!-- PAGE BREAK 207 -->
9713 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
9715 name of the service;
9718 channel of the program (AM/FM stations use station ID);
9721 type of program (archived/looped/live);
9724 date of transmission;
9727 time of transmission;
9730 time zone of origination of transmission;
9733 numeric designation of the place of the sound recording within the program;
9736 duration of transmission (to nearest second);
9739 sound recording title;
9742 ISRC code of the recording;
9745 release year of the album per copyright notice and in the case of compilation albums, the release year of the album and copy- right date of the track;
9748 featured recording artist;
9757 UPC code of the retail album;
9763 copyright owner information;
9766 musical genre of the channel or program (station format);
9769 name of the service or entity;
9775 date and time that the user logged in (in the user's time zone);
9778 date and time that the user logged out (in the user's time zone);
9781 time zone where the signal was received (user);
9784 unique user identifier;
9787 the country in which the user received the transmissions.
9792 The Librarian of Congress eventually suspended these reporting
9793 requirements, pending further study. And he also changed the original
9794 rates set by the arbitration panel charged with setting rates. But the
9795 basic difference between Internet radio and terrestrial radio remains:
9796 Internet radio has to pay a
<emphasis>type of copyright fee
</emphasis>
9797 that terrestrial radio does not.
9800 Why? What justifies this difference? Was there any study of the
9801 economic consequences from Internet radio that would justify these
9802 differences? Was the motive to protect artists against piracy?
9804 <indexterm><primary>Real Networks
</primary></indexterm>
9805 <indexterm id='idxalbenalex2' class='startofrange'
>
9806 <primary>Alben, Alex
</primary>
9809 In a rare bit of candor, one RIAA expert admitted what seemed obvious
9810 to everyone at the time. As Alex Alben, vice president for Public
9811 Policy at Real Networks, told me,
9815 The RIAA, which was representing the record labels, presented
9816 some testimony about what they thought a willing buyer would
9817 pay to a willing seller, and it was much higher. It was ten times
9818 higher than what radio stations pay to perform the same songs for
9819 the same period of time. And so the attorneys representing the
9820 webcasters asked the RIAA,
… <quote>How do you come up with a
9822 <!-- PAGE BREAK 208 -->
9823 rate that's so much higher? Why is it worth more than radio? Because
9824 here we have hundreds of thousands of webcasters who want to pay, and
9825 that should establish the market rate, and if you set the rate so
9826 high, you're going to drive the small webcasters out of
9827 business.
…</quote>
9830 And the RIAA experts said,
<quote>Well, we don't really model this as an
9831 industry with thousands of webcasters,
<emphasis>we think it should be
9832 an industry with, you know, five or seven big players who can pay a
9833 high rate and it's a stable, predictable market
</emphasis>.
</quote> (Emphasis
9837 <indexterm startref='idxalbenalex2' class='endofrange'
/>
9839 Translation: The aim is to use the law to eliminate competition, so
9840 that this platform of potentially immense competition, which would
9841 cause the diversity and range of content available to explode, would not
9842 cause pain to the dinosaurs of old. There is no one, on either the right
9843 or the left, who should endorse this use of the law. And yet there is
9844 practically no one, on either the right or the left, who is doing anything
9845 effective to prevent it.
9848 <section id=
"corruptingcitizens">
9849 <title>Corrupting Citizens
</title>
9851 Overregulation stifles creativity. It smothers innovation. It gives
9853 a veto over the future. It wastes the extraordinary opportunity
9854 for a democratic creativity that digital technology enables.
9857 In addition to these important harms, there is one more that was
9858 important to our forebears, but seems forgotten today. Overregulation
9859 corrupts citizens and weakens the rule of law.
9862 The war that is being waged today is a war of prohibition. As with
9863 every war of prohibition, it is targeted against the behavior of a very
9864 large number of citizens. According to
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>,
43 million
9865 Americans downloaded music in May
2002.
<footnote><para>
9866 <!-- f15. --> Mike Graziano and Lee Rainie,
<quote>The Music Downloading Deluge,
</quote> Pew
9867 Internet and American Life Project (
24 April
2001), available at
9868 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
46</ulink>.
9869 The Pew Internet and American Life Project reported that
37 million
9870 Americans had downloaded music files from the Internet by early
2001.
9872 According to the RIAA,
9873 the behavior of those
43 million Americans is a felony. We thus have a
9874 set of rules that transform
20 percent of America into criminals. As the
9876 <!-- PAGE BREAK 209 -->
9877 RIAA launches lawsuits against not only the Napsters and Kazaas of
9878 the world, but against students building search engines, and
9880 against ordinary users downloading content, the technologies for
9881 sharing will advance to further protect and hide illegal use. It is an arms
9882 race or a civil war, with the extremes of one side inviting a more
9884 response by the other.
9887 The content industry's tactics exploit the failings of the American
9888 legal system. When the RIAA brought suit against Jesse Jordan, it
9889 knew that in Jordan it had found a scapegoat, not a defendant. The
9890 threat of having to pay either all the money in the world in damages
9891 ($
15,
000,
000) or almost all the money in the world to defend against
9892 paying all the money in the world in damages ($
250,
000 in legal fees)
9893 led Jordan to choose to pay all the money he had in the world
9894 ($
12,
000) to make the suit go away. The same strategy animates the
9895 RIAA's suits against individual users. In September
2003, the RIAA
9896 sued
261 individuals
—including a twelve-year-old girl living in public
9897 housing and a seventy-year-old man who had no idea what file sharing
9898 was.
<footnote><para>
9900 Alex Pham,
<quote>The Labels Strike Back: N.Y. Girl Settles RIAA Case,
</quote> <citetitle>Los
9901 Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, Business.
9903 As these scapegoats discovered, it will always cost more to defend
9904 against these suits than it would cost to simply settle. (The twelve
9905 year old, for example, like Jesse Jordan, paid her life savings of $
2,
000
9906 to settle the case.) Our law is an awful system for defending rights. It
9907 is an embarrassment to our tradition. And the consequence of our law
9908 as it is, is that those with the power can use the law to quash any rights
9912 Wars of prohibition are nothing new in America. This one is just
9913 something more extreme than anything we've seen before. We
9914 experimented with alcohol prohibition, at a time when the per capita
9915 consumption of alcohol was
1.5 gallons per capita per year. The war
9916 against drinking initially reduced that consumption to just
30 percent
9917 of its preprohibition levels, but by the end of prohibition,
9918 consumption was up to
70 percent of the preprohibition
9919 level. Americans were drinking just about as much, but now, a vast
9920 number were criminals.
<footnote><para>
9922 Jeffrey A. Miron and Jeffrey Zwiebel,
<quote>Alcohol Consumption During
9923 Prohibition,
</quote> <citetitle>American Economic Review
</citetitle> 81, no.
2 (
1991):
242.
9926 <!-- PAGE BREAK 210 -->
9927 launched a war on drugs aimed at reducing the consumption of regulated
9928 narcotics that
7 percent (or
16 million) Americans now use.
<footnote><para>
9930 National Drug Control Policy: Hearing Before the House Government
9931 Reform Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
5 March
2003) (statement of
9932 John P. Walters, director of National Drug Control Policy).
9934 That is a drop from the high (so to speak) in
1979 of
14 percent of
9935 the population. We regulate automobiles to the point where the vast
9936 majority of Americans violate the law every day. We run such a complex
9937 tax system that a majority of cash businesses regularly
9938 cheat.
<footnote><para>
9940 See James Andreoni, Brian Erard, and Jonathon Feinstein,
<quote>Tax
9941 Compliance,
</quote> <citetitle>Journal of Economic Literature
</citetitle> 36 (
1998):
818 (survey of
9942 compliance literature).
9944 We pride ourselves on our
<quote>free society,
</quote> but an endless array of
9945 ordinary behavior is regulated within our society. And as a result, a
9946 huge proportion of Americans regularly violate at least some law.
9947 <indexterm><primary>alcohol prohibition
</primary></indexterm>
9950 This state of affairs is not without consequence. It is a particularly
9951 salient issue for teachers like me, whose job it is to teach law
9952 students about the importance of
<quote>ethics.
</quote> As my colleague Charlie
9953 Nesson told a class at Stanford, each year law schools admit thousands
9954 of students who have illegally downloaded music, illegally consumed
9955 alcohol and sometimes drugs, illegally worked without paying taxes,
9956 illegally driven cars. These are kids for whom behaving illegally is
9957 increasingly the norm. And then we, as law professors, are supposed to
9958 teach them how to behave ethically
—how to say no to bribes, or
9959 keep client funds separate, or honor a demand to disclose a document
9960 that will mean that your case is over. Generations of
9961 Americans
—more significantly in some parts of America than in
9962 others, but still, everywhere in America today
—can't live their
9963 lives both normally and legally, since
<quote>normally
</quote> entails a certain
9964 degree of illegality.
9965 <indexterm><primary>law schools
</primary></indexterm>
9968 The response to this general illegality is either to enforce the law
9969 more severely or to change the law. We, as a society, have to learn
9970 how to make that choice more rationally. Whether a law makes sense
9971 depends, in part, at least, upon whether the costs of the law, both
9972 intended and collateral, outweigh the benefits. If the costs, intended
9973 and collateral, do outweigh the benefits, then the law ought to be
9974 changed. Alternatively, if the costs of the existing system are much
9975 greater than the costs of an alternative, then we have a good reason
9976 to consider the alternative.
9980 <!-- PAGE BREAK 211 -->
9981 My point is not the idiotic one: Just because people violate a law, we
9982 should therefore repeal it. Obviously, we could reduce murder statistics
9983 dramatically by legalizing murder on Wednesdays and Fridays. But
9984 that wouldn't make any sense, since murder is wrong every day of the
9985 week. A society is right to ban murder always and everywhere.
9988 My point is instead one that democracies understood for generations,
9989 but that we recently have learned to forget. The rule of law depends
9990 upon people obeying the law. The more often, and more repeatedly, we
9991 as citizens experience violating the law, the less we respect the
9992 law. Obviously, in most cases, the important issue is the law, not
9993 respect for the law. I don't care whether the rapist respects the law
9994 or not; I want to catch and incarcerate the rapist. But I do care
9995 whether my students respect the law. And I do care if the rules of law
9996 sow increasing disrespect because of the extreme of regulation they
9997 impose. Twenty million Americans have come of age since the Internet
9998 introduced this different idea of
<quote>sharing.
</quote> We need to be able to
9999 call these twenty million Americans
<quote>citizens,
</quote> not
<quote>felons.
</quote>
10002 When at least forty-three million citizens download content from the
10003 Internet, and when they use tools to combine that content in ways
10004 unauthorized by copyright holders, the first question we should be
10005 asking is not how best to involve the FBI. The first question should
10006 be whether this particular prohibition is really necessary in order to
10007 achieve the proper ends that copyright law serves. Is there another
10008 way to assure that artists get paid without transforming forty-three
10009 million Americans into felons? Does it make sense if there are other
10010 ways to assure that artists get paid without transforming America into
10011 a nation of felons?
10014 This abstract point can be made more clear with a particular example.
10017 We all own CDs. Many of us still own phonograph records. These pieces
10018 of plastic encode music that in a certain sense we have bought. The
10019 law protects our right to buy and sell that plastic: It is not a
10020 copyright infringement for me to sell all my classical records at a
10023 <!-- PAGE BREAK 212 -->
10024 record store and buy jazz records to replace them. That
<quote>use
</quote> of the
10025 recordings is free.
10028 But as the MP3 craze has demonstrated, there is another use of
10029 phonograph records that is effectively free. Because these recordings
10030 were made without copy-protection technologies, I am
<quote>free
</quote> to copy,
10031 or
<quote>rip,
</quote> music from my records onto a computer hard disk. Indeed,
10032 Apple Corporation went so far as to suggest that
<quote>freedom
</quote> was a
10033 right: In a series of commercials, Apple endorsed the
<quote>Rip, Mix, Burn
</quote>
10034 capacities of digital technologies.
10036 <indexterm><primary>Adromeda
</primary></indexterm>
10038 This
<quote>use
</quote> of my records is certainly valuable. I have begun a large
10039 process at home of ripping all of my and my wife's CDs, and storing
10040 them in one archive. Then, using Apple's iTunes, or a wonderful
10041 program called Andromeda, we can build different play lists of our
10042 music: Bach, Baroque, Love Songs, Love Songs of Significant
10043 Others
—the potential is endless. And by reducing the costs of
10044 mixing play lists, these technologies help build a creativity with
10045 play lists that is itself independently valuable. Compilations of
10046 songs are creative and meaningful in their own right.
10049 This use is enabled by unprotected media
—either CDs or records.
10050 But unprotected media also enable file sharing. File sharing threatens
10051 (or so the content industry believes) the ability of creators to earn
10052 a fair return from their creativity. And thus, many are beginning to
10053 experiment with technologies to eliminate unprotected media. These
10054 technologies, for example, would enable CDs that could not be
10055 ripped. Or they might enable spy programs to identify ripped content
10056 on people's machines.
10059 If these technologies took off, then the building of large archives of
10060 your own music would become quite difficult. You might hang in hacker
10061 circles, and get technology to disable the technologies that protect
10062 the content. Trading in those technologies is illegal, but maybe that
10063 doesn't bother you much. In any case, for the vast majority of people,
10064 these protection technologies would effectively destroy the archiving
10066 <!-- PAGE BREAK 213 -->
10067 use of CDs. The technology, in other words, would force us all back to
10068 the world where we either listened to music by manipulating pieces of
10069 plastic or were part of a massively complex
<quote>digital rights
10070 management
</quote> system.
10073 If the only way to assure that artists get paid were the elimination
10074 of the ability to freely move content, then these technologies to
10075 interfere with the freedom to move content would be justifiable. But
10076 what if there were another way to assure that artists are paid,
10077 without locking down any content? What if, in other words, a different
10078 system could assure compensation to artists while also preserving the
10079 freedom to move content easily?
10082 My point just now is not to prove that there is such a system. I offer
10083 a version of such a system in the last chapter of this book. For now,
10084 the only point is the relatively uncontroversial one: If a different
10085 system achieved the same legitimate objectives that the existing
10086 copyright system achieved, but left consumers and creators much more
10087 free, then we'd have a very good reason to pursue this
10088 alternative
—namely, freedom. The choice, in other words, would
10089 not be between property and piracy; the choice would be between
10090 different property systems and the freedoms each allowed.
10093 I believe there is a way to assure that artists are paid without
10094 turning forty-three million Americans into felons. But the salient
10095 feature of this alternative is that it would lead to a very different
10096 market for producing and distributing creativity. The dominant few,
10097 who today control the vast majority of the distribution of content in
10098 the world, would no longer exercise this extreme of control. Rather,
10099 they would go the way of the horse-drawn buggy.
10102 Except that this generation's buggy manufacturers have already saddled
10103 Congress, and are riding the law to protect themselves against this
10104 new form of competition. For them the choice is between fortythree
10105 million Americans as criminals and their own survival.
10108 It is understandable why they choose as they do. It is not
10109 understandable why we as a democracy continue to choose as we do. Jack
10111 <!-- PAGE BREAK 214 -->
10113 Valenti is charming; but not so charming as to justify giving up a
10114 tradition as deep and important as our tradition of free culture.
10115 There's one more aspect to this corruption that is particularly
10116 important to civil liberties, and follows directly from any war of
10117 prohibition. As Electronic Frontier Foundation attorney Fred von
10118 Lohmann describes, this is the
<quote>collateral damage
</quote> that
<quote>arises
10119 whenever you turn a very large percentage of the population into
10120 criminals.
</quote> This is the collateral damage to civil liberties
10122 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
10125 <quote>If you can treat someone as a putative lawbreaker,
</quote> von Lohmann
10127 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
10131 then all of a sudden a lot of basic civil liberty protections
10132 evaporate to one degree or another.
… If you're a copyright
10133 infringer, how can you hope to have any privacy rights? If you're a
10134 copyright infringer, how can you hope to be secure against seizures of
10135 your computer? How can you hope to continue to receive Internet
10136 access?
… Our sensibilities change as soon as we think,
<quote>Oh, well,
10137 but that person's a criminal, a lawbreaker.
</quote> Well, what this campaign
10138 against file sharing has done is turn a remarkable percentage of the
10139 American Internet-using population into
<quote>lawbreakers.
</quote>
10143 And the consequence of this transformation of the American public
10144 into criminals is that it becomes trivial, as a matter of due process, to
10145 effectively erase much of the privacy most would presume.
10148 Users of the Internet began to see this generally in
2003 as the RIAA
10149 launched its campaign to force Internet service providers to turn over
10150 the names of customers who the RIAA believed were violating copyright
10151 law. Verizon fought that demand and lost. With a simple request to a
10152 judge, and without any notice to the customer at all, the identity of
10153 an Internet user is revealed.
10156 <!-- PAGE BREAK 215 -->
10157 The RIAA then expanded this campaign, by announcing a general strategy
10158 to sue individual users of the Internet who are alleged to have
10159 downloaded copyrighted music from file-sharing systems. But as we've
10160 seen, the potential damages from these suits are astronomical: If a
10161 family's computer is used to download a single CD's worth of music,
10162 the family could be liable for $
2 million in damages. That didn't stop
10163 the RIAA from suing a number of these families, just as they had sued
10164 Jesse Jordan.
<footnote><para>
10166 See Frank Ahrens,
<quote>RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised Targets; Single
10167 Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among Defendants,
</quote>
10168 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Chris Cobbs,
<quote>Worried Parents
10169 Pull Plug on File `Stealing'; With the Music Industry Cracking Down on
10170 File Swapping, Parents are Yanking Software from Home PCs to Avoid
10171 Being Sued,
</quote> <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
30 August
2003, C1; Jefferson
10172 Graham,
<quote>Recording Industry Sues Parents,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
15 September
10173 2003,
4D; John Schwartz,
<quote>She Says She's No Music Pirate. No Snoop
10174 Fan, Either,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
25 September
2003, C1; Margo Varadi,
<quote>Is
10175 Brianna a Criminal?
</quote> <citetitle>Toronto Star
</citetitle>,
18 September
2003, P7.
10180 Even this understates the espionage that is being waged by the
10181 RIAA. A report from CNN late last summer described a strategy the
10182 RIAA had adopted to track Napster users.
<footnote><para>
10184 See
<quote>Revealed: How RIAA Tracks Downloaders: Music Industry Discloses
10185 Some Methods Used,
</quote> CNN.com, available at
10186 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
47</ulink>.
10188 Using a sophisticated hashing algorithm, the RIAA took what is in
10189 effect a fingerprint of every song in the Napster catalog. Any copy of
10190 one of those MP3s will have the same
<quote>fingerprint.
</quote>
10193 So imagine the following not-implausible scenario: Imagine a
10194 friend gives a CD to your daughter
—a collection of songs just
10195 like the cassettes you used to make as a kid. You don't know, and
10196 neither does your daughter, where these songs came from. But she
10197 copies these songs onto her computer. She then takes her computer to
10198 college and connects it to a college network, and if the college
10199 network is
<quote>cooperating
</quote> with the RIAA's espionage, and she hasn't
10200 properly protected her content from the network (do you know how to do
10201 that yourself ?), then the RIAA will be able to identify your daughter
10202 as a
<quote>criminal.
</quote> And under the rules that universities are beginning
10203 to deploy,
<footnote><para>
10205 See Jeff Adler,
<quote>Cambridge: On Campus, Pirates Are Not Penitent,
</quote>
10206 <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
18 May
2003, City Weekly,
1; Frank Ahrens,
<quote>Four
10207 Students Sued over Music Sites; Industry Group Targets File Sharing at
10208 Colleges,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
4 April
2003, E1; Elizabeth Armstrong,
10209 <quote>Students `Rip, Mix, Burn' at Their Own Risk,
</quote> <citetitle>Christian Science
10210 Monitor
</citetitle>,
2 September
2003,
20; Robert Becker and Angela Rozas,
<quote>Music
10211 Pirate Hunt Turns to Loyola; Two Students Names Are Handed Over;
10212 Lawsuit Possible,
</quote> <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
16 July
2003,
1C; Beth Cox,
<quote>RIAA
10213 Trains Antipiracy Guns on Universities,
</quote> <citetitle>Internet News
</citetitle>,
30 January
10214 2003, available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
10215 #
48</ulink>; Benny Evangelista,
<quote>Download Warning
101: Freshman
10216 Orientation This Fall to Include Record Industry Warnings Against File
10217 Sharing,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
11 August
2003, E11;
<quote>Raid, Letters
10218 Are Weapons at Universities,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
26 September
2000,
3D.
10220 your daughter can lose the right to use the university's computer
10221 network. She can, in some cases, be expelled.
10224 Now, of course, she'll have the right to defend herself. You can hire
10225 a lawyer for her (at $
300 per hour, if you're lucky), and she can
10226 plead that she didn't know anything about the source of the songs or
10227 that they came from Napster. And it may well be that the university
10228 believes her. But the university might not believe her. It might treat
10229 this
<quote>contraband
</quote> as presumptive of guilt. And as any number of
10232 <!-- PAGE BREAK 216 -->
10233 have already learned, our presumptions about innocence disappear in
10234 the middle of wars of prohibition. This war is no different.
10236 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
10240 So when we're talking about numbers like forty to sixty million
10241 Americans that are essentially copyright infringers, you create a
10242 situation where the civil liberties of those people are very much in
10243 peril in a general matter. [I don't] think [there is any] analog where
10244 you could randomly choose any person off the street and be confident
10245 that they were committing an unlawful act that could put them on the
10246 hook for potential felony liability or hundreds of millions of dollars
10247 of civil liability. Certainly we all speed, but speeding isn't the
10248 kind of an act for which we routinely forfeit civil liberties. Some
10249 people use drugs, and I think that's the closest analog, [but] many
10250 have noted that the war against drugs has eroded all of our civil
10251 liberties because it's treated so many Americans as criminals. Well, I
10252 think it's fair to say that file sharing is an order of magnitude
10253 larger number of Americans than drug use.
… If forty to sixty
10254 million Americans have become lawbreakers, then we're really on a
10255 slippery slope to lose a lot of civil liberties for all forty to sixty
10260 When forty to sixty million Americans are considered
<quote>criminals
</quote> under
10261 the law, and when the law could achieve the same objective
—
10262 securing rights to authors
—without these millions being
10263 considered
<quote>criminals,
</quote> who is the villain? Americans or the law?
10264 Which is American, a constant war on our own people or a concerted
10265 effort through our democracy to change our law?
10268 <!-- PAGE BREAK 217 -->
10272 <part id=
"c-balances">
10273 <title>BALANCES
</title>
10276 <!-- PAGE BREAK 218 -->
10278 So here's the picture: You're standing at the side of the road. Your
10279 car is on fire. You are angry and upset because in part you helped start
10280 the fire. Now you don't know how to put it out. Next to you is a bucket,
10281 filled with gasoline. Obviously, gasoline won't put the fire out.
10284 As you ponder the mess, someone else comes along. In a panic, she
10285 grabs the bucket. Before you have a chance to tell her to
10286 stop
—or before she understands just why she should
10287 stop
—the bucket is in the air. The gasoline is about to hit the
10288 blazing car. And the fire that gasoline will ignite is about to ignite
10292 A war about copyright rages all around
—and we're all focusing on
10293 the wrong thing. No doubt, current technologies threaten existing
10294 businesses. No doubt they may threaten artists. But technologies
10295 change. The industry and technologists have plenty of ways to use
10296 technology to protect themselves against the current threats of the
10297 Internet. This is a fire that if let alone would burn itself out.
10300 <!-- PAGE BREAK 219 -->
10301 Yet policy makers are not willing to leave this fire to itself. Primed
10302 with plenty of lobbyists' money, they are keen to intervene to
10303 eliminate the problem they perceive. But the problem they perceive is
10304 not the real threat this culture faces. For while we watch this small
10305 fire in the corner, there is a massive change in the way culture is
10306 made that is happening all around.
10309 Somehow we have to find a way to turn attention to this more important
10310 and fundamental issue. Somehow we have to find a way to avoid pouring
10311 gasoline onto this fire.
10314 We have not found that way yet. Instead, we seem trapped in a simpler,
10315 binary view. However much many people push to frame this debate more
10316 broadly, it is the simple, binary view that remains. We rubberneck to
10317 look at the fire when we should be keeping our eyes on the road.
10320 This challenge has been my life these last few years. It has also been
10321 my failure. In the two chapters that follow, I describe one small
10322 brace of efforts, so far failed, to find a way to refocus this
10323 debate. We must understand these failures if we're to understand what
10324 success will require.
10328 <!-- PAGE BREAK 220 -->
10329 <chapter label=
"13" id=
"eldred">
10330 <title>CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
</title>
10331 <indexterm id=
"idxhawthornenathaniel" class='startofrange'
>
10332 <primary>Hawthorne, Nathaniel
</primary>
10335 In
1995, a father was frustrated that his daughters didn't seem to
10336 like Hawthorne. No doubt there was more than one such father, but at
10337 least one did something about it. Eric Eldred, a retired computer
10338 programmer living in New Hampshire, decided to put Hawthorne on the
10339 Web. An electronic version, Eldred thought, with links to pictures and
10340 explanatory text, would make this nineteenth-century author's work
10344 It didn't work
—at least for his daughters. They didn't find
10345 Hawthorne any more interesting than before. But Eldred's experiment
10346 gave birth to a hobby, and his hobby begat a cause: Eldred would build
10347 a library of public domain works by scanning these works and making
10348 them available for free.
10351 Eldred's library was not simply a copy of certain public domain
10352 works, though even a copy would have been of great value to people
10353 across the world who can't get access to printed versions of these
10354 works. Instead, Eldred was producing derivative works from these
10355 public domain works. Just as Disney turned Grimm into stories more
10356 <!-- PAGE BREAK 221 -->
10357 accessible to the twentieth century, Eldred transformed Hawthorne, and
10358 many others, into a form more accessible
—technically
10359 accessible
—today.
10362 Eldred's freedom to do this with Hawthorne's work grew from the same
10363 source as Disney's. Hawthorne's
<citetitle>Scarlet Letter
</citetitle> had passed into the
10364 public domain in
1907. It was free for anyone to take without the
10365 permission of the Hawthorne estate or anyone else. Some, such as Dover
10366 Press and Penguin Classics, take works from the public domain and
10367 produce printed editions, which they sell in bookstores across the
10368 country. Others, such as Disney, take these stories and turn them into
10369 animated cartoons, sometimes successfully (
<citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle>), sometimes not
10370 (
<citetitle>The Hunchback of Notre Dame
</citetitle>,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>). These are all
10371 commercial publications of public domain works.
10373 <indexterm startref=
"idxhawthornenathaniel" class='endofrange'
/>
10375 The Internet created the possibility of noncommercial publications of
10376 public domain works. Eldred's is just one example. There are literally
10377 thousands of others. Hundreds of thousands from across the world have
10378 discovered this platform of expression and now use it to share works
10379 that are, by law, free for the taking. This has produced what we might
10380 call the
<quote>noncommercial publishing industry,
</quote> which before the
10381 Internet was limited to people with large egos or with political or
10382 social causes. But with the Internet, it includes a wide range of
10383 individuals and groups dedicated to spreading culture
10384 generally.
<footnote><para>
10386 There's a parallel here with pornography that is a bit hard to
10387 describe, but it's a strong one. One phenomenon that the Internet
10388 created was a world of noncommercial pornographers
—people who
10389 were distributing porn but were not making money directly or
10390 indirectly from that distribution. Such a class didn't exist before
10391 the Internet came into being because the costs of distributing porn
10392 were so high. Yet this new class of distributors got special attention
10393 in the Supreme Court, when the Court struck down the Communications
10394 Decency Act of
1996. It was partly because of the burden on
10395 noncommercial speakers that the statute was found to exceed Congress's
10396 power. The same point could have been made about noncommercial
10397 publishers after the advent of the Internet. The Eric Eldreds of the
10398 world before the Internet were extremely few. Yet one would think it
10399 at least as important to protect the Eldreds of the world as to
10400 protect noncommercial pornographers.
</para></footnote>
10403 As I said, Eldred lives in New Hampshire. In
1998, Robert Frost's
10404 collection of poems
<citetitle>New Hampshire
</citetitle> was slated to
10405 pass into the public domain. Eldred wanted to post that collection in
10406 his free public library. But Congress got in the way. As I described
10407 in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
10408 linkend=
"property-i"/>, in
1998, for the eleventh time in forty years,
10409 Congress extended the terms of existing copyrights
—this time by
10410 twenty years. Eldred would not be free to add any works more recent
10411 than
1923 to his collection until
2019. Indeed, no copyrighted work
10412 would pass into the public domain until that year (and not even then,
10413 if Congress extends the term again). By contrast, in the same period,
10414 more than
1 million patents will pass into the public domain.
10418 <!-- PAGE BREAK 222 -->
10419 This was the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act
10420 (CTEA), enacted in memory of the congressman and former musician
10421 Sonny Bono, who, his widow, Mary Bono, says, believed that
10422 <quote>copyrights should be forever.
</quote><footnote><para>
10424 The full text is:
<quote>Sonny [Bono] wanted the term of copyright
10425 protection to last forever. I am informed by staff that such a change
10426 would violate the Constitution. I invite all of you to work with me to
10427 strengthen our copyright laws in all of the ways available to us. As
10428 you know, there is also Jack Valenti's proposal for a term to last
10429 forever less one day. Perhaps the Committee may look at that next
10430 Congress,
</quote> 144 Cong. Rec. H9946,
9951-
2 (October
7,
1998).
10435 Eldred decided to fight this law. He first resolved to fight it through
10436 civil disobedience. In a series of interviews, Eldred announced that he
10437 would publish as planned, CTEA notwithstanding. But because of a
10438 second law passed in
1998, the NET (No Electronic Theft) Act, his act
10439 of publishing would make Eldred a felon
—whether or not anyone
10440 complained. This was a dangerous strategy for a disabled programmer
10444 It was here that I became involved in Eldred's battle. I was a
10446 scholar whose first passion was constitutional
10448 And though constitutional law courses never focus upon the
10449 Progress Clause of the Constitution, it had always struck me as
10451 different. As you know, the Constitution says,
10455 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science
…
10456 by securing for limited Times to Authors
… exclusive Right to
10457 their
… Writings.
…
10461 As I've described, this clause is unique within the power-granting
10462 clause of Article I, section
8 of our Constitution. Every other clause
10463 granting power to Congress simply says Congress has the power to do
10464 something
—for example, to regulate
<quote>commerce among the several
10465 states
</quote> or
<quote>declare War.
</quote> But here, the
<quote>something
</quote> is something quite
10466 specific
—to
<quote>promote
… Progress
</quote>—through means that
10467 are also specific
— by
<quote>securing
</quote> <quote>exclusive Rights
</quote> (i.e.,
10468 copyrights)
<quote>for limited Times.
</quote>
10471 In the past forty years, Congress has gotten into the practice of
10472 extending existing terms of copyright protection. What puzzled me
10473 about this was, if Congress has the power to extend existing terms,
10474 then the Constitution's requirement that terms be
<quote>limited
</quote> will have
10475 <!-- PAGE BREAK 223 -->
10476 no practical effect. If every time a copyright is about to expire,
10477 Congress has the power to extend its term, then Congress can achieve
10478 what the Constitution plainly forbids
—perpetual terms
<quote>on the
10479 installment plan,
</quote> as Professor Peter Jaszi so nicely put it.
10480 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
10483 As an academic, my first response was to hit the books. I remember
10484 sitting late at the office, scouring on-line databases for any serious
10485 consideration of the question. No one had ever challenged Congress's
10486 practice of extending existing terms. That failure may in part be why
10487 Congress seemed so untroubled in its habit. That, and the fact that
10488 the practice had become so lucrative for Congress. Congress knows that
10489 copyright owners will be willing to pay a great deal of money to see
10490 their copyright terms extended. And so Congress is quite happy to keep
10491 this gravy train going.
10494 For this is the core of the corruption in our present system of
10495 government.
<quote>Corruption
</quote> not in the sense that representatives are
10496 bribed. Rather,
<quote>corruption
</quote> in the sense that the system induces the
10497 beneficiaries of Congress's acts to raise and give money to Congress
10498 to induce it to act. There's only so much time; there's only so much
10499 Congress can do. Why not limit its actions to those things it must
10500 do
—and those things that pay? Extending copyright terms pays.
10503 If that's not obvious to you, consider the following: Say you're one
10504 of the very few lucky copyright owners whose copyright continues to
10505 make money one hundred years after it was created. The Estate of
10506 Robert Frost is a good example. Frost died in
1963. His poetry
10507 continues to be extraordinarily valuable. Thus the Robert Frost estate
10508 benefits greatly from any extension of copyright, since no publisher
10509 would pay the estate any money if the poems Frost wrote could be
10510 published by anyone for free.
10513 So imagine the Robert Frost estate is earning $
100,
000 a year from
10514 three of Frost's poems. And imagine the copyright for those poems
10515 is about to expire. You sit on the board of the Robert Frost estate.
10516 Your financial adviser comes to your board meeting with a very grim
10520 <quote>Next year,
</quote> the adviser announces,
<quote>our copyrights in works A, B,
10522 <!-- PAGE BREAK 224 -->
10523 and C will expire. That means that after next year, we will no longer be
10524 receiving the annual royalty check of $
100,
000 from the publishers of
10525 those works.
</quote>
10528 <quote>There's a proposal in Congress, however,
</quote> she continues,
<quote>that
10529 could change this. A few congressmen are floating a bill to extend the
10530 terms of copyright by twenty years. That bill would be extraordinarily
10531 valuable to us. So we should hope this bill passes.
</quote>
10534 <quote>Hope?
</quote> a fellow board member says.
<quote>Can't we be doing something
10538 <quote>Well, obviously, yes,
</quote> the adviser responds.
<quote>We could contribute
10539 to the campaigns of a number of representatives to try to assure that
10540 they support the bill.
</quote>
10543 You hate politics. You hate contributing to campaigns. So you want
10544 to know whether this disgusting practice is worth it.
<quote>How much
10545 would we get if this extension were passed?
</quote> you ask the adviser.
<quote>How
10546 much is it worth?
</quote>
10549 <quote>Well,
</quote> the adviser says,
<quote>if you're confident that you will continue
10550 to get at least $
100,
000 a year from these copyrights, and you use the
10551 `discount rate' that we use to evaluate estate investments (
6 percent),
10552 then this law would be worth $
1,
146,
000 to the estate.
</quote>
10555 You're a bit shocked by the number, but you quickly come to the
10556 correct conclusion:
10559 <quote>So you're saying it would be worth it for us to pay more than
10560 $
1,
000,
000 in campaign contributions if we were confident those
10562 would assure that the bill was passed?
</quote>
10565 <quote>Absolutely,
</quote> the adviser responds.
<quote>It is worth it to you to
10567 up to the `present value' of the income you expect from these
10568 copyrights. Which for us means over $
1,
000,
000.
</quote>
10571 You quickly get the point
—you as the member of the board and, I
10572 trust, you the reader. Each time copyrights are about to expire, every
10573 beneficiary in the position of the Robert Frost estate faces the same
10574 choice: If they can contribute to get a law passed to extend copyrights,
10575 <!-- PAGE BREAK 225 -->
10576 they will benefit greatly from that extension. And so each time
10578 are about to expire, there is a massive amount of lobbying to get
10579 the copyright term extended.
10582 Thus a congressional perpetual motion machine: So long as legislation
10583 can be bought (albeit indirectly), there will be all the incentive in
10584 the world to buy further extensions of copyright.
10587 In the lobbying that led to the passage of the Sonny Bono
10589 Term Extension Act, this
<quote>theory
</quote> about incentives was proved
10590 real. Ten of the thirteen original sponsors of the act in the House
10591 received the maximum contribution from Disney's political action
10592 committee; in the Senate, eight of the twelve sponsors received
10593 contributions.
<footnote><para>
10594 <!-- f3. --> Associated Press,
<quote>Disney Lobbying for Copyright Extension No Mickey
10595 Mouse Effort; Congress OKs Bill Granting Creators
20 More Years,
</quote>
10596 <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
17 October
1998,
22.
10598 The RIAA and the MPAA are estimated to have spent over
10599 $
1.5 million lobbying in the
1998 election cycle. They paid out more
10600 than $
200,
000 in campaign contributions.
<footnote><para>
10601 <!-- f4. --> See Nick Brown,
<quote>Fair Use No More?: Copyright in the Information
10602 Age,
</quote> available at
10603 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
49</ulink>.
10605 Disney is estimated to have
10606 contributed more than $
800,
000 to reelection campaigns in the
10607 cycle.
<footnote><para>
10609 Alan K. Ota,
<quote>Disney in Washington: The Mouse That Roars,
</quote>
10610 <citetitle>Congressional Quarterly This Week
</citetitle>,
8 August
1990, available at
10611 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
50</ulink>.
10616 Constitutional law is not oblivious to the obvious. Or at least,
10617 it need not be. So when I was considering Eldred's complaint, this
10619 about the never-ending incentives to increase the copyright term
10620 was central to my thinking. In my view, a pragmatic court committed
10621 to interpreting and applying the Constitution of our framers would see
10622 that if Congress has the power to extend existing terms, then there
10623 would be no effective constitutional requirement that terms be
10624 <quote>limited.
</quote>
10625 If they could extend it once, they would extend it again and again
10629 It was also my judgment that
<emphasis>this
</emphasis> Supreme Court
10630 would not allow Congress to extend existing terms. As anyone close to
10631 the Supreme Court's work knows, this Court has increasingly restricted
10632 the power of Congress when it has viewed Congress's actions as
10633 exceeding the power granted to it by the Constitution. Among
10634 constitutional scholars, the most famous example of this trend was the
10637 <!-- PAGE BREAK 226 -->
10638 decision in
1995 to strike down a law that banned the possession of
10642 Since
1937, the Supreme Court had interpreted Congress's granted
10643 powers very broadly; so, while the Constitution grants Congress the
10644 power to regulate only
<quote>commerce among the several states
</quote> (aka
10646 commerce
</quote>), the Supreme Court had interpreted that power to
10647 include the power to regulate any activity that merely affected
10652 As the economy grew, this standard increasingly meant that there was
10653 no limit to Congress's power to regulate, since just about every
10654 activity, when considered on a national scale, affects interstate
10655 commerce. A Constitution designed to limit Congress's power was
10656 instead interpreted to impose no limit.
10658 <indexterm><primary>Rehnquist, William H.
</primary></indexterm>
10660 The Supreme Court, under Chief Justice Rehnquist's command, changed
10661 that in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The government had
10662 argued that possessing guns near schools affected interstate
10663 commerce. Guns near schools increase crime, crime lowers property
10664 values, and so on. In the oral argument, the Chief Justice asked the
10665 government whether there was any activity that would not affect
10666 interstate commerce under the reasoning the government advanced. The
10667 government said there was not; if Congress says an activity affects
10668 interstate commerce, then that activity affects interstate
10669 commerce. The Supreme Court, the government said, was not in the
10670 position to second-guess Congress.
10673 <quote>We pause to consider the implications of the government's arguments,
</quote>
10674 the Chief Justice wrote.
<footnote><para>
10675 <!-- f6. --> <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>,
514 U.S.
549,
564 (
1995).
10677 If anything Congress says is interstate commerce must therefore be
10678 considered interstate commerce, then there would be no limit to
10679 Congress's power. The decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> was reaffirmed five years
10680 later in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>.
<footnote><para>
10682 <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>,
529 U.S.
598 (
2000).
10686 If a principle were at work here, then it should apply to the Progress
10687 Clause as much as the Commerce Clause.
<footnote><para>
10689 If it is a principle about enumerated powers, then the principle
10690 carries from one enumerated power to another. The animating point in
10691 the context of the Commerce Clause was that the interpretation offered
10692 by the government would allow the government unending power to
10693 regulate commerce
—the limitation to interstate commerce
10694 notwithstanding. The same point is true in the context of the
10695 Copyright Clause. Here, too, the government's interpretation would
10696 allow the government unending power to regulate copyrights
—the
10697 limitation to
<quote>limited times
</quote> notwithstanding.
10699 And if it is applied to the Progress Clause, the principle should
10700 yield the conclusion that Congress
10701 <!-- PAGE BREAK 227 -->
10702 can't extend an existing term. If Congress could extend an existing
10703 term, then there would be no
<quote>stopping point
</quote> to Congress's power over
10704 terms, though the Constitution expressly states that there is such a
10705 limit. Thus, the same principle applied to the power to grant
10706 copyrights should entail that Congress is not allowed to extend the
10707 term of existing copyrights.
10710 <emphasis>If
</emphasis>, that is, the principle announced in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
10711 stood for a principle. Many believed the decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> stood for
10712 politics
—a conservative Supreme Court, which believed in states'
10713 rights, using its power over Congress to advance its own personal
10714 political preferences. But I rejected that view of the Supreme Court's
10715 decision. Indeed, shortly after the decision, I wrote an article
10716 demonstrating the
<quote>fidelity
</quote> in such an interpretation of the
10717 Constitution. The idea that the Supreme Court decides cases based upon
10718 its politics struck me as extraordinarily boring. I was not going to
10719 devote my life to teaching constitutional law if these nine Justices
10720 were going to be petty politicians.
10723 Now let's pause for a moment to make sure we understand what the
10724 argument in
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was not about. By insisting on the
10725 Constitution's limits to copyright, obviously Eldred was not endorsing
10726 piracy. Indeed, in an obvious sense, he was fighting a kind of
10727 piracy
—piracy of the public domain. When Robert Frost wrote his
10728 work and when Walt Disney created Mickey Mouse, the maximum copyright
10729 term was just fifty-six years. Because of interim changes, Frost and
10730 Disney had already enjoyed a seventy-five-year monopoly for their
10731 work. They had gotten the benefit of the bargain that the Constitution
10732 envisions: In exchange for a monopoly protected for fifty-six years,
10733 they created new work. But now these entities were using their
10734 power
—expressed through the power of lobbyists' money
—to
10735 get another twenty-year dollop of monopoly. That twenty-year dollop
10736 would be taken from the public domain. Eric Eldred was fighting a
10737 piracy that affects us all.
10740 Some people view the public domain with contempt. In their brief
10742 <!-- PAGE BREAK 228 -->
10743 before the Supreme Court, the Nashville Songwriters Association
10744 wrote that the public domain is nothing more than
<quote>legal piracy.
</quote><footnote><para>
10746 Brief of the Nashville Songwriters Association,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
10747 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618), n
.10, available
10748 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
51</ulink>.
10750 But it is not piracy when the law allows it; and in our constitutional
10751 system, our law requires it. Some may not like the Constitution's
10752 requirements, but that doesn't make the Constitution a pirate's
10754 <indexterm><primary>Nashville Songwriters Association
</primary></indexterm>
10757 As we've seen, our constitutional system requires limits on
10759 as a way to assure that copyright holders do not too heavily
10761 the development and distribution of our culture. Yet, as Eric
10762 Eldred discovered, we have set up a system that assures that copyright
10763 terms will be repeatedly extended, and extended, and extended. We
10764 have created the perfect storm for the public domain. Copyrights have
10765 not expired, and will not expire, so long as Congress is free to be
10766 bought to extend them again.
10769 It is valuable copyrights that are responsible for terms being
10771 Mickey Mouse and
<quote>Rhapsody in Blue.
</quote> These works are too
10772 valuable for copyright owners to ignore. But the real harm to our
10774 from copyright extensions is not that Mickey Mouse remains
10776 Forget Mickey Mouse. Forget Robert Frost. Forget all the works
10777 from the
1920s and
1930s that have continuing commercial value. The
10778 real harm of term extension comes not from these famous works. The
10779 real harm is to the works that are not famous, not commercially
10781 and no longer available as a result.
10784 If you look at the work created in the first twenty years (
1923 to
10785 1942) affected by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act,
10786 2 percent of that work has any continuing commercial value. It was the
10787 copyright holders for that
2 percent who pushed the CTEA through.
10788 But the law and its effect were not limited to that
2 percent. The law
10789 extended the terms of copyright generally.
<footnote><para>
10790 <!-- f10. --> The figure of
2 percent is an extrapolation from the study by the
10792 Research Service, in light of the estimated renewal ranges. See Brief
10793 of Petitioners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
7, available at
10794 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
52</ulink>.
10799 Think practically about the consequence of this
10800 extension
—practically,
10801 as a businessperson, and not as a lawyer eager for more legal
10803 <!-- PAGE BREAK 229 -->
10804 work. In
1930,
10,
047 books were published. In
2000,
174 of those
10805 books were still in print. Let's say you were Brewster Kahle, and you
10806 wanted to make available to the world in your iArchive project the
10808 9,
873. What would you have to do?
10810 <indexterm><primary>archives, digital
</primary></indexterm>
10812 Well, first, you'd have to determine which of the
9,
873 books were
10813 still under copyright. That requires going to a library (these data are
10814 not on-line) and paging through tomes of books, cross-checking the
10815 titles and authors of the
9,
873 books with the copyright registration
10816 and renewal records for works published in
1930. That will produce a
10817 list of books still under copyright.
10820 Then for the books still under copyright, you would need to locate
10821 the current copyright owners. How would you do that?
10824 Most people think that there must be a list of these copyright
10826 somewhere. Practical people think this way. How could there be
10827 thousands and thousands of government monopolies without there
10828 being at least a list?
10831 But there is no list. There may be a name from
1930, and then in
10832 1959, of the person who registered the copyright. But just think
10834 about how impossibly difficult it would be to track down
10836 of such records
—especially since the person who registered is
10837 not necessarily the current owner. And we're just talking about
1930!
10840 <quote>But there isn't a list of who owns property generally,
</quote> the
10841 apologists for the system respond.
<quote>Why should there be a list of
10842 copyright owners?
</quote>
10845 Well, actually, if you think about it, there
<emphasis>are
</emphasis>
10846 plenty of lists of who owns what property. Think about deeds on
10847 houses, or titles to cars. And where there isn't a list, the code of
10848 real space is pretty good at suggesting who the owner of a bit of
10849 property is. (A swing set in your backyard is probably yours.) So
10850 formally or informally, we have a pretty good way to know who owns
10851 what tangible property.
10854 So: You walk down a street and see a house. You can know who
10855 owns the house by looking it up in the courthouse registry. If you see
10856 a car, there is ordinarily a license plate that will link the owner to the
10858 <!-- PAGE BREAK 230 -->
10859 car. If you see a bunch of children's toys sitting on the front lawn of a
10860 house, it's fairly easy to determine who owns the toys. And if you
10862 to see a baseball lying in a gutter on the side of the road, look
10863 around for a second for some kids playing ball. If you don't see any
10864 kids, then okay: Here's a bit of property whose owner we can't easily
10865 determine. It is the exception that proves the rule: that we ordinarily
10866 know quite well who owns what property.
10869 Compare this story to intangible property. You go into a library.
10870 The library owns the books. But who owns the copyrights? As I've
10872 described, there's no list of copyright owners. There are authors'
10873 names, of course, but their copyrights could have been assigned, or
10874 passed down in an estate like Grandma's old jewelry. To know who
10875 owns what, you would have to hire a private detective. The bottom
10876 line: The owner cannot easily be located. And in a regime like ours, in
10877 which it is a felony to use such property without the property owner's
10878 permission, the property isn't going to be used.
10881 The consequence with respect to old books is that they won't be
10882 digitized, and hence will simply rot away on shelves. But the
10884 for other creative works is much more dire.
10886 <indexterm id='idxageemichael' class='startofrange'
>
10887 <primary>Agee, Michael
</primary>
10889 <indexterm><primary>Hal Roach Studios
</primary></indexterm>
10890 <indexterm><primary>Laurel and Hardy Films
</primary></indexterm>
10892 Consider the story of Michael Agee, chairman of Hal Roach Studios,
10893 which owns the copyrights for the Laurel and Hardy films. Agee is a
10894 direct beneficiary of the Bono Act. The Laurel and Hardy films were
10895 made between
1921 and
1951. Only one of these films,
<citetitle>The Lucky Dog
</citetitle>, is
10896 currently out of copyright. But for the CTEA, films made after
1923
10897 would have begun entering the public domain. Because Agee controls the
10898 exclusive rights for these popular films, he makes a great deal of
10899 money. According to one estimate,
<quote>Roach has sold about
60,
000
10900 videocassettes and
50,
000 DVDs of the duo's silent
10901 films.
</quote><footnote><para>
10903 See David G. Savage,
<quote>High Court Scene of Showdown on Copyright Law,
</quote>
10904 <citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
6 October
2002; David Streitfeld,
<quote>Classic Movies,
10905 Songs, Books at Stake; Supreme Court Hears Arguments Today on Striking
10906 Down Copyright Extension,
</quote> <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
9 October
2002.
10909 <indexterm><primary>Lucky Dog, The
</primary></indexterm>
10912 Yet Agee opposed the CTEA. His reasons demonstrate a rare virtue in
10913 this culture: selflessness. He argued in a brief before the Supreme
10914 Court that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act will, if left
10915 standing, destroy a whole generation of American film.
10918 His argument is straightforward. A tiny fraction of this work has
10920 <!-- PAGE BREAK 231 -->
10921 any continuing commercial value. The rest
—to the extent it
10922 survives at all
—sits in vaults gathering dust. It may be that
10923 some of this work not now commercially valuable will be deemed to be
10924 valuable by the owners of the vaults. For this to occur, however, the
10925 commercial benefit from the work must exceed the costs of making the
10926 work available for distribution.
10929 We can't know the benefits, but we do know a lot about the costs.
10930 For most of the history of film, the costs of restoring film were very
10931 high; digital technology has lowered these costs substantially. While
10932 it cost more than $
10,
000 to restore a ninety-minute black-and-white
10933 film in
1993, it can now cost as little as $
100 to digitize one hour of
10934 mm film.
<footnote><para>
10936 Brief of Hal Roach Studios and Michael Agee as Amicus Curiae
10937 Supporting the Petitoners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
10938 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
12. See also Brief of Amicus Curiae
10939 filed on behalf of Petitioners by the Internet Archive,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
10940 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, available at
10941 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
53</ulink>.
10946 Restoration technology is not the only cost, nor the most
10948 Lawyers, too, are a cost, and increasingly, a very important one. In
10949 addition to preserving the film, a distributor needs to secure the rights.
10950 And to secure the rights for a film that is under copyright, you need to
10951 locate the copyright owner.
10954 Or more accurately,
<emphasis>owners
</emphasis>. As we've seen, there
10955 isn't only a single copyright associated with a film; there are
10956 many. There isn't a single person whom you can contact about those
10957 copyrights; there are as many as can hold the rights, which turns out
10958 to be an extremely large number. Thus the costs of clearing the rights
10959 to these films is exceptionally high.
10962 <quote>But can't you just restore the film, distribute it, and then pay the
10963 copyright owner when she shows up?
</quote> Sure, if you want to commit a
10964 felony. And even if you're not worried about committing a felony, when
10965 she does show up, she'll have the right to sue you for all the profits you
10966 have made. So, if you're successful, you can be fairly confident you'll be
10967 getting a call from someone's lawyer. And if you're not successful, you
10968 won't make enough to cover the costs of your own lawyer. Either way,
10969 you have to talk to a lawyer. And as is too often the case, saying you have
10970 to talk to a lawyer is the same as saying you won't make any money.
10973 For some films, the benefit of releasing the film may well exceed
10975 <!-- PAGE BREAK 232 -->
10976 these costs. But for the vast majority of them, there is no way the
10978 would outweigh the legal costs. Thus, for the vast majority of old
10979 films, Agee argued, the film will not be restored and distributed until
10980 the copyright expires.
10982 <indexterm startref='idxageemichael' class='endofrange'
/>
10984 But by the time the copyright for these films expires, the film will
10985 have expired. These films were produced on nitrate-based stock, and
10986 nitrate stock dissolves over time. They will be gone, and the metal
10988 in which they are now stored will be filled with nothing more
10992 Of all the creative work produced by humans anywhere, a tiny
10993 fraction has continuing commercial value. For that tiny fraction, the
10994 copyright is a crucially important legal device. For that tiny fraction,
10995 the copyright creates incentives to produce and distribute the
10997 work. For that tiny fraction, the copyright acts as an
<quote>engine of
10998 free expression.
</quote>
11001 But even for that tiny fraction, the actual time during which the
11002 creative work has a commercial life is extremely short. As I've
11004 most books go out of print within one year. The same is true of
11005 music and film. Commercial culture is sharklike. It must keep moving.
11006 And when a creative work falls out of favor with the commercial
11008 the commercial life ends.
11011 Yet that doesn't mean the life of the creative work ends. We don't
11012 keep libraries of books in order to compete with Barnes
& Noble, and
11013 we don't have archives of films because we expect people to choose
11015 spending Friday night watching new movies and spending
11017 night watching a
1930 news documentary. The noncommercial life
11018 of culture is important and valuable
—for entertainment but also, and
11019 more importantly, for knowledge. To understand who we are, and
11020 where we came from, and how we have made the mistakes that we
11021 have, we need to have access to this history.
11024 Copyrights in this context do not drive an engine of free expression.
11026 <!-- PAGE BREAK 233 -->
11027 In this context, there is no need for an exclusive right. Copyrights in
11028 this context do no good.
11031 Yet, for most of our history, they also did little harm. For most of
11032 our history, when a work ended its commercial life, there was no
11033 <emphasis>copyright-related use
</emphasis> that would be inhibited by
11034 an exclusive right. When a book went out of print, you could not buy
11035 it from a publisher. But you could still buy it from a used book
11036 store, and when a used book store sells it, in America, at least,
11037 there is no need to pay the copyright owner anything. Thus, the
11038 ordinary use of a book after its commercial life ended was a use that
11039 was independent of copyright law.
11042 The same was effectively true of film. Because the costs of restoring
11043 a film
—the real economic costs, not the lawyer costs
—were
11044 so high, it was never at all feasible to preserve or restore
11045 film. Like the remains of a great dinner, when it's over, it's
11046 over. Once a film passed out of its commercial life, it may have been
11047 archived for a bit, but that was the end of its life so long as the
11048 market didn't have more to offer.
11051 In other words, though copyright has been relatively short for most
11052 of our history, long copyrights wouldn't have mattered for the works
11053 that lost their commercial value. Long copyrights for these works
11054 would not have interfered with anything.
11057 But this situation has now changed.
11059 <indexterm id='idxarchivesdigital2' class='startofrange'
>
11060 <primary>archives, digital
</primary>
11063 One crucially important consequence of the emergence of digital
11064 technologies is to enable the archive that Brewster Kahle dreams of.
11065 Digital technologies now make it possible to preserve and give access
11066 to all sorts of knowledge. Once a book goes out of print, we can now
11067 imagine digitizing it and making it available to everyone,
11068 forever. Once a film goes out of distribution, we could digitize it
11069 and make it available to everyone, forever. Digital technologies give
11070 new life to copyrighted material after it passes out of its commercial
11071 life. It is now possible to preserve and assure universal access to
11072 this knowledge and culture, whereas before it was not.
11075 <!-- PAGE BREAK 234 -->
11076 And now copyright law does get in the way. Every step of producing
11077 this digital archive of our culture infringes on the exclusive right
11078 of copyright. To digitize a book is to copy it. To do that requires
11079 permission of the copyright owner. The same with music, film, or any
11080 other aspect of our culture protected by copyright. The effort to make
11081 these things available to history, or to researchers, or to those who
11082 just want to explore, is now inhibited by a set of rules that were
11083 written for a radically different context.
11086 Here is the core of the harm that comes from extending terms: Now that
11087 technology enables us to rebuild the library of Alexandria, the law
11088 gets in the way. And it doesn't get in the way for any useful
11089 <emphasis>copyright
</emphasis> purpose, for the purpose of copyright
11090 is to enable the commercial market that spreads culture. No, we are
11091 talking about culture after it has lived its commercial life. In this
11092 context, copyright is serving no purpose
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis>
11093 related to the spread of knowledge. In this context, copyright is not
11094 an engine of free expression. Copyright is a brake.
11097 You may well ask,
<quote>But if digital technologies lower the costs for
11098 Brewster Kahle, then they will lower the costs for Random House, too.
11099 So won't Random House do as well as Brewster Kahle in spreading
11100 culture widely?
</quote>
11103 Maybe. Someday. But there is absolutely no evidence to suggest that
11104 publishers would be as complete as libraries. If Barnes
& Noble
11105 offered to lend books from its stores for a low price, would that
11106 eliminate the need for libraries? Only if you think that the only role
11107 of a library is to serve what
<quote>the market
</quote> would demand. But if you
11108 think the role of a library is bigger than this
—if you think its
11109 role is to archive culture, whether there's a demand for any
11110 particular bit of that culture or not
—then we can't count on the
11111 commercial market to do our library work for us.
11113 <indexterm startref='idxarchivesdigital2' class='endofrange'
/>
11115 I would be the first to agree that it should do as much as it can: We
11116 should rely upon the market as much as possible to spread and enable
11117 culture. My message is absolutely not antimarket. But where we see the
11118 market is not doing the job, then we should allow nonmarket forces the
11120 <!-- PAGE BREAK 235 -->
11121 freedom to fill the gaps. As one researcher calculated for American
11122 culture,
94 percent of the films, books, and music produced between
11123 and
1946 is not commercially available. However much you love the
11124 commercial market, if access is a value, then
6 percent is a failure
11125 to provide that value.
<footnote><para>
11127 Jason Schultz,
<quote>The Myth of the
1976 Copyright `Chaos' Theory,
</quote> 20
11128 December
2002, available at
11129 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
54</ulink>.
11134 In January
1999, we filed a lawsuit on Eric Eldred's behalf in federal
11135 district court in Washington, D.C., asking the court to declare the
11136 Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act unconstitutional. The two
11137 central claims that we made were (
1) that extending existing terms
11138 violated the Constitution's
<quote>limited Times
</quote> requirement, and (
2) that
11139 extending terms by another twenty years violated the First Amendment.
11142 The district court dismissed our claims without even hearing an
11143 argument. A panel of the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit also
11144 dismissed our claims, though after hearing an extensive argument. But
11145 that decision at least had a dissent, by one of the most conservative
11146 judges on that court. That dissent gave our claims life.
11149 Judge David Sentelle said the CTEA violated the requirement that
11150 copyrights be for
<quote>limited Times
</quote> only. His argument was as elegant as
11151 it was simple: If Congress can extend existing terms, then there is no
11152 <quote>stopping point
</quote> to Congress's power under the Copyright Clause. The
11153 power to extend existing terms means Congress is not required to grant
11154 terms that are
<quote>limited.
</quote> Thus, Judge Sentelle argued, the court had
11155 to interpret the term
<quote>limited Times
</quote> to give it meaning. And the best
11156 interpretation, Judge Sentelle argued, would be to deny Congress the
11157 power to extend existing terms.
11160 We asked the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit as a whole to
11161 hear the case. Cases are ordinarily heard in panels of three, except for
11162 important cases or cases that raise issues specific to the circuit as a
11163 whole, where the court will sit
<quote>en banc
</quote> to hear the case.
11166 The Court of Appeals rejected our request to hear the case en banc.
11167 This time, Judge Sentelle was joined by the most liberal member of the
11169 <!-- PAGE BREAK 236 -->
11170 D.C. Circuit, Judge David Tatel. Both the most conservative and the
11171 most liberal judges in the D.C. Circuit believed Congress had
11172 overstepped its bounds.
11175 It was here that most expected Eldred v. Ashcroft would die, for the
11176 Supreme Court rarely reviews any decision by a court of appeals. (It
11177 hears about one hundred cases a year, out of more than five thousand
11178 appeals.) And it practically never reviews a decision that upholds a
11179 statute when no other court has yet reviewed the statute.
11182 But in February
2002, the Supreme Court surprised the world by
11183 granting our petition to review the D.C. Circuit opinion. Argument
11184 was set for October of
2002. The summer would be spent writing
11185 briefs and preparing for argument.
11188 It is over a year later as I write these words. It is still
11189 astonishingly hard. If you know anything at all about this story, you
11190 know that we lost the appeal. And if you know something more than just
11191 the minimum, you probably think there was no way this case could have
11192 been won. After our defeat, I received literally thousands of missives
11193 by well-wishers and supporters, thanking me for my work on behalf of
11194 this noble but doomed cause. And none from this pile was more
11195 significant to me than the e-mail from my client, Eric Eldred.
11198 But my client and these friends were wrong. This case could have
11199 been won. It should have been won. And no matter how hard I try to
11200 retell this story to myself, I can never escape believing that my own
11203 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11205 The mistake was made early, though it became obvious only at the very
11206 end. Our case had been supported from the very beginning by an
11207 extraordinary lawyer, Geoffrey Stewart, and by the law firm he had
11208 moved to, Jones, Day, Reavis and Pogue. Jones Day took a great deal of
11210 <!-- PAGE BREAK 237 -->
11211 from its copyright-protectionist clients for supporting us. They
11212 ignored this pressure (something that few law firms today would ever
11213 do), and throughout the case, they gave it everything they could.
11215 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11216 <indexterm><primary>Bromberg, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
11217 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11219 There were three key lawyers on the case from Jones Day. Geoff
11220 Stewart was the first, but then Dan Bromberg and Don Ayer became
11221 quite involved. Bromberg and Ayer in particular had a common view
11222 about how this case would be won: We would only win, they repeatedly
11223 told me, if we could make the issue seem
<quote>important
</quote> to the Supreme
11224 Court. It had to seem as if dramatic harm were being done to free
11225 speech and free culture; otherwise, they would never vote against
<quote>the
11226 most powerful media companies in the world.
</quote>
11229 I hate this view of the law. Of course I thought the Sonny Bono Act
11230 was a dramatic harm to free speech and free culture. Of course I still
11231 think it is. But the idea that the Supreme Court decides the law based
11232 on how important they believe the issues are is just wrong. It might be
11233 <quote>right
</quote> as in
<quote>true,
</quote> I thought, but it is
<quote>wrong
</quote> as in
<quote>it just shouldn't be
11234 that way.
</quote> As I believed that any faithful interpretation of what the
11235 framers of our Constitution did would yield the conclusion that the
11236 CTEA was unconstitutional, and as I believed that any faithful
11238 of what the First Amendment means would yield the
11239 conclusion that the power to extend existing copyright terms is
11241 I was not persuaded that we had to sell our case like soap.
11242 Just as a law that bans the swastika is unconstitutional not because the
11243 Court likes Nazis but because such a law would violate the
11245 so too, in my view, would the Court decide whether Congress's
11246 law was constitutional based on the Constitution, not based on whether
11247 they liked the values that the framers put in the Constitution.
11250 In any case, I thought, the Court must already see the danger and
11251 the harm caused by this sort of law. Why else would they grant review?
11252 There was no reason to hear the case in the Supreme Court if they
11253 weren't convinced that this regulation was harmful. So in my view, we
11254 didn't need to persuade them that this law was bad, we needed to show
11255 why it was unconstitutional.
11258 There was one way, however, in which I felt politics would matter
11260 <!-- PAGE BREAK 238 -->
11261 and in which I thought a response was appropriate. I was convinced
11262 that the Court would not hear our arguments if it thought these were
11263 just the arguments of a group of lefty loons. This Supreme Court was
11264 not about to launch into a new field of judicial review if it seemed
11265 that this field of review was simply the preference of a small
11266 political minority. Although my focus in the case was not to
11267 demonstrate how bad the Sonny Bono Act was but to demonstrate that it
11268 was unconstitutional, my hope was to make this argument against a
11269 background of briefs that covered the full range of political
11270 views. To show that this claim against the CTEA was grounded in
11271 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> and not politics, then, we tried to gather
11272 the widest range of credible critics
—credible not because they
11273 were rich and famous, but because they, in the aggregate, demonstrated
11274 that this law was unconstitutional regardless of one's politics.
11277 The first step happened all by itself. Phyllis Schlafly's
11278 organization, Eagle Forum, had been an opponent of the CTEA from the
11279 very beginning. Mrs. Schlafly viewed the CTEA as a sellout by
11280 Congress. In November
1998, she wrote a stinging editorial attacking
11281 the Republican Congress for allowing the law to pass. As she wrote,
11282 <quote>Do you sometimes wonder why bills that create a financial windfall to
11283 narrow special interests slide easily through the intricate
11284 legislative process, while bills that benefit the general public seem
11285 to get bogged down?
</quote> The answer, as the editorial documented, was the
11286 power of money. Schlafly enumerated Disney's contributions to the key
11287 players on the committees. It was money, not justice, that gave Mickey
11288 Mouse twenty more years in Disney's control, Schlafly argued.
11289 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11290 <indexterm><primary>Schlafly, Phyllis
</primary></indexterm>
11293 In the Court of Appeals, Eagle Forum was eager to file a brief
11294 supporting our position. Their brief made the argument that became the
11295 core claim in the Supreme Court: If Congress can extend the term of
11296 existing copyrights, there is no limit to Congress's power to set
11297 terms. That strong conservative argument persuaded a strong
11298 conservative judge, Judge Sentelle.
11301 In the Supreme Court, the briefs on our side were about as diverse as
11302 it gets. They included an extraordinary historical brief by the Free
11304 <!-- PAGE BREAK 239 -->
11305 Software Foundation (home of the GNU project that made GNU/ Linux
11306 possible). They included a powerful brief about the costs of
11307 uncertainty by Intel. There were two law professors' briefs, one by
11308 copyright scholars and one by First Amendment scholars. There was an
11309 exhaustive and uncontroverted brief by the world's experts in the
11310 history of the Progress Clause. And of course, there was a new brief
11311 by Eagle Forum, repeating and strengthening its arguments.
11312 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
11313 <indexterm><primary>Intel
</primary></indexterm>
11314 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
11315 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11318 Those briefs framed a legal argument. Then to support the legal
11319 argument, there were a number of powerful briefs by libraries and
11320 archives, including the Internet Archive, the American Association of
11321 Law Libraries, and the National Writers Union.
11322 <indexterm><primary>American Association of Law Libraries
</primary></indexterm>
11323 <indexterm><primary>National Writers Union
</primary></indexterm>
11325 <indexterm><primary>Hal Roach Studios
</primary></indexterm>
11327 But two briefs captured the policy argument best. One made the
11328 argument I've already described: A brief by Hal Roach Studios argued
11329 that unless the law was struck, a whole generation of American film
11330 would disappear. The other made the economic argument absolutely
11333 <indexterm><primary>Akerlof, George
</primary></indexterm>
11334 <indexterm><primary>Arrow, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
11335 <indexterm><primary>Buchanan, James
</primary></indexterm>
11336 <indexterm><primary>Coase, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11337 <indexterm><primary>Friedman, Milton
</primary></indexterm>
11339 This economists' brief was signed by seventeen economists, including
11340 five Nobel Prize winners, including Ronald Coase, James Buchanan,
11341 Milton Friedman, Kenneth Arrow, and George Akerlof. The economists, as
11342 the list of Nobel winners demonstrates, spanned the political
11343 spectrum. Their conclusions were powerful: There was no plausible
11344 claim that extending the terms of existing copyrights would do
11345 anything to increase incentives to create. Such extensions were
11346 nothing more than
<quote>rent-seeking
</quote>—the fancy term economists use
11347 to describe special-interest legislation gone wild.
11350 The same effort at balance was reflected in the legal team we gathered
11351 to write our briefs in the case. The Jones Day lawyers had been with
11352 us from the start. But when the case got to the Supreme Court, we
11353 added three lawyers to help us frame this argument to this Court: Alan
11354 Morrison, a lawyer from Public Citizen, a Washington group that had
11355 made constitutional history with a series of seminal victories in the
11356 Supreme Court defending individual rights; my colleague and dean,
11357 Kathleen Sullivan, who had argued many cases in the Court, and
11359 <!-- PAGE BREAK 240 -->
11360 who had advised us early on about a First Amendment strategy; and
11361 finally, former solicitor general Charles Fried.
11362 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11363 <indexterm><primary>Morrison, Alan
</primary></indexterm>
11364 <indexterm><primary>Public Citizen
</primary></indexterm>
11365 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11368 Fried was a special victory for our side. Every other former solicitor
11369 general was hired by the other side to defend Congress's power to give
11370 media companies the special favor of extended copyright terms. Fried
11371 was the only one who turned down that lucrative assignment to stand up
11372 for something he believed in. He had been Ronald Reagan's chief lawyer
11373 in the Supreme Court. He had helped craft the line of cases that
11374 limited Congress's power in the context of the Commerce Clause. And
11375 while he had argued many positions in the Supreme Court that I
11376 personally disagreed with, his joining the cause was a vote of
11377 confidence in our argument.
11378 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11381 The government, in defending the statute, had its collection of
11382 friends, as well. Significantly, however, none of these
<quote>friends
</quote> included
11383 historians or economists. The briefs on the other side of the case were
11384 written exclusively by major media companies, congressmen, and
11388 The media companies were not surprising. They had the most to gain
11389 from the law. The congressmen were not surprising either
—they
11390 were defending their power and, indirectly, the gravy train of
11391 contributions such power induced. And of course it was not surprising
11392 that the copyright holders would defend the idea that they should
11393 continue to have the right to control who did what with content they
11397 Dr. Seuss's representatives, for example, argued that it was
11398 better for the Dr. Seuss estate to control what happened to
11399 Dr. Seuss's work
— better than allowing it to fall into the
11400 public domain
—because if this creativity were in the public
11401 domain, then people could use it to
<quote>glorify drugs or to create
11402 pornography.
</quote><footnote><para>
11404 Brief of Amici Dr. Seuss Enterprise et al.,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
11405 U.S. (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
19.
11407 That was also the motive of the Gershwin estate, which defended its
11408 <quote>protection
</quote> of the work of George Gershwin. They refuse, for example,
11409 to license
<citetitle>Porgy and Bess
</citetitle> to anyone who refuses to use African
11410 Americans in the cast.
<footnote><para>
11412 Dinitia Smith,
<quote>Immortal Words, Immortal Royalties? Even Mickey
11413 Mouse Joins the Fray,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
28 March
1998, B7.
11416 <!-- PAGE BREAK 241 -->
11417 their view of how this part of American culture should be controlled,
11418 and they wanted this law to help them effect that control.
11419 <indexterm><primary>Gershwin, George
</primary></indexterm>
11422 This argument made clear a theme that is rarely noticed in this
11423 debate. When Congress decides to extend the term of existing
11424 copyrights, Congress is making a choice about which speakers it will
11425 favor. Famous and beloved copyright owners, such as the Gershwin
11426 estate and Dr. Seuss, come to Congress and say,
<quote>Give us twenty years
11427 to control the speech about these icons of American culture. We'll do
11428 better with them than anyone else.
</quote> Congress of course likes to reward
11429 the popular and famous by giving them what they want. But when
11430 Congress gives people an exclusive right to speak in a certain way,
11431 that's just what the First Amendment is traditionally meant to block.
11434 We argued as much in a final brief. Not only would upholding the CTEA
11435 mean that there was no limit to the power of Congress to extend
11436 copyrights
—extensions that would further concentrate the market;
11437 it would also mean that there was no limit to Congress's power to play
11438 favorites, through copyright, with who has the right to speak.
11439 Between February and October, there was little I did beyond preparing
11440 for this case. Early on, as I said, I set the strategy.
11442 <indexterm><primary>Rehnquist, William H.
</primary></indexterm>
11443 <indexterm><primary>O'Connor, Sandra Day
</primary></indexterm>
11445 The Supreme Court was divided into two important camps. One camp we
11446 called
<quote>the Conservatives.
</quote> The other we called
<quote>the Rest.
</quote> The
11447 Conservatives included Chief Justice Rehnquist, Justice O'Connor,
11448 Justice Scalia, Justice Kennedy, and Justice Thomas. These five had
11449 been the most consistent in limiting Congress's power. They were the
11450 five who had supported the
<citetitle>Lopez/Morrison
</citetitle> line
11451 of cases that said that an enumerated power had to be interpreted to
11452 assure that Congress's powers had limits.
11454 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11456 The Rest were the four Justices who had strongly opposed limits on
11457 Congress's power. These four
—Justice Stevens, Justice Souter,
11458 Justice Ginsburg, and Justice Breyer
—had repeatedly argued that
11460 <!-- PAGE BREAK 242 -->
11461 gives Congress broad discretion to decide how best to implement its
11462 powers. In case after case, these justices had argued that the Court's
11463 role should be one of deference. Though the votes of these four
11464 justices were the votes that I personally had most consistently agreed
11465 with, they were also the votes that we were least likely to get.
11468 In particular, the least likely was Justice Ginsburg's. In addition to
11469 her general view about deference to Congress (except where issues of
11470 gender are involved), she had been particularly deferential in the
11471 context of intellectual property protections. She and her daughter (an
11472 excellent and well-known intellectual property scholar) were cut from
11473 the same intellectual property cloth. We expected she would agree with
11474 the writings of her daughter: that Congress had the power in this
11475 context to do as it wished, even if what Congress wished made little
11478 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11480 Close behind Justice Ginsburg were two justices whom we also viewed as
11481 unlikely allies, though possible surprises. Justice Souter strongly
11482 favored deference to Congress, as did Justice Breyer. But both were
11483 also very sensitive to free speech concerns. And as we strongly
11484 believed, there was a very important free speech argument against
11485 these retrospective extensions.
11488 The only vote we could be confident about was that of Justice
11489 Stevens. History will record Justice Stevens as one of the greatest
11490 judges on this Court. His votes are consistently eclectic, which just
11491 means that no simple ideology explains where he will stand. But he
11492 had consistently argued for limits in the context of intellectual property
11493 generally. We were fairly confident he would recognize limits here.
11496 This analysis of
<quote>the Rest
</quote> showed most clearly where our focus had to
11497 be: on the Conservatives. To win this case, we had to crack open these
11498 five and get at least a majority to go our way. Thus, the single
11499 overriding argument that animated our claim rested on the
11500 Conservatives' most important jurisprudential innovation
—the
11501 argument that Judge Sentelle had relied upon in the Court of Appeals,
11502 that Congress's power must be interpreted so that its enumerated
11503 powers have limits.
11506 This then was the core of our strategy
—a strategy for which I am
11507 responsible. We would get the Court to see that just as with the
11508 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
11509 <!-- PAGE BREAK 243 -->
11510 case, under the government's argument here, Congress would always have
11511 unlimited power to extend existing terms. If anything was plain about
11512 Congress's power under the Progress Clause, it was that this power was
11513 supposed to be
<quote>limited.
</quote> Our aim would be to get the Court to
11514 reconcile
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> with
11515 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>: If Congress's power to regulate commerce
11516 was limited, then so, too, must Congress's power to regulate copyright
11520 The argument on the government's side came down to this: Congress has
11521 done it before. It should be allowed to do it again. The government
11522 claimed that from the very beginning, Congress has been extending the
11523 term of existing copyrights. So, the government argued, the Court
11524 should not now say that practice is unconstitutional.
11527 There was some truth to the government's claim, but not much. We
11528 certainly agreed that Congress had extended existing terms in
1831
11529 and in
1909. And of course, in
1962, Congress began extending
11531 terms regularly
—eleven times in forty years.
11534 But this
<quote>consistency
</quote> should be kept in perspective. Congress
11536 existing terms once in the first hundred years of the Republic.
11537 It then extended existing terms once again in the next fifty. Those rare
11538 extensions are in contrast to the now regular practice of extending
11540 terms. Whatever restraint Congress had had in the past, that
11542 was now gone. Congress was now in a cycle of extensions; there
11543 was no reason to expect that cycle would end. This Court had not
11545 to intervene where Congress was in a similar cycle of extension.
11546 There was no reason it couldn't intervene here.
11547 Oral argument was scheduled for the first week in October. I
11549 in D.C. two weeks before the argument. During those two
11550 weeks, I was repeatedly
<quote>mooted
</quote> by lawyers who had volunteered to
11552 <!-- PAGE BREAK 244 -->
11553 help in the case. Such
<quote>moots
</quote> are basically practice rounds, where
11554 wannabe justices fire questions at wannabe winners.
11557 I was convinced that to win, I had to keep the Court focused on a
11558 single point: that if this extension is permitted, then there is no limit to
11559 the power to set terms. Going with the government would mean that
11560 terms would be effectively unlimited; going with us would give
11562 a clear line to follow: Don't extend existing terms. The moots
11563 were an effective practice; I found ways to take every question back to
11566 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11567 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11569 One moot was before the lawyers at Jones Day. Don Ayer was the
11570 skeptic. He had served in the Reagan Justice Department with Solicitor
11571 General Charles Fried. He had argued many cases before the Supreme
11572 Court. And in his review of the moot, he let his concern speak:
11573 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11576 <quote>I'm just afraid that unless they really see the harm, they won't be
11577 willing to upset this practice that the government says has been a
11578 consistent practice for two hundred years. You have to make them see
11579 the harm
—passionately get them to see the harm. For if they
11580 don't see that, then we haven't any chance of winning.
</quote>
11582 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11584 He may have argued many cases before this Court, I thought, but
11585 he didn't understand its soul. As a clerk, I had seen the Justices do the
11586 right thing
—not because of politics but because it was right. As a law
11587 professor, I had spent my life teaching my students that this Court
11588 does the right thing
—not because of politics but because it is right. As
11589 I listened to Ayer's plea for passion in pressing politics, I understood
11590 his point, and I rejected it. Our argument was right. That was enough.
11591 Let the politicians learn to see that it was also good.
11592 The night before the argument, a line of people began to form
11593 in front of the Supreme Court. The case had become a focus of the
11594 press and of the movement to free culture. Hundreds stood in line
11596 <!-- PAGE BREAK 245 -->
11597 for the chance to see the proceedings. Scores spent the night on the
11598 Supreme Court steps so that they would be assured a seat.
11601 Not everyone has to wait in line. People who know the Justices can
11602 ask for seats they control. (I asked Justice Scalia's chambers for seats for
11603 my parents, for example.) Members of the Supreme Court bar can get
11604 a seat in a special section reserved for them. And senators and
11606 have a special place where they get to sit, too. And finally, of
11607 course, the press has a gallery, as do clerks working for the Justices on
11608 the Court. As we entered that morning, there was no place that was
11609 not taken. This was an argument about intellectual property law, yet
11610 the halls were filled. As I walked in to take my seat at the front of the
11611 Court, I saw my parents sitting on the left. As I sat down at the table,
11612 I saw Jack Valenti sitting in the special section ordinarily reserved for
11613 family of the Justices.
11616 When the Chief Justice called me to begin my argument, I began
11617 where I intended to stay: on the question of the limits on Congress's
11618 power. This was a case about enumerated powers, I said, and whether
11619 those enumerated powers had any limit.
11621 <indexterm><primary>O'Connor, Sandra Day
</primary></indexterm>
11623 Justice O'Connor stopped me within one minute of my opening.
11624 The history was bothering her.
11628 justice o'connor: Congress has extended the term so often
11629 through the years, and if you are right, don't we run the risk of
11630 upsetting previous extensions of time? I mean, this seems to be a
11631 practice that began with the very first act.
11635 She was quite willing to concede
<quote>that this flies directly in the face
11636 of what the framers had in mind.
</quote> But my response again and again
11637 was to emphasize limits on Congress's power.
11641 mr. lessig: Well, if it flies in the face of what the framers had in
11642 mind, then the question is, is there a way of interpreting their
11643 <!-- PAGE BREAK 246 -->
11644 words that gives effect to what they had in mind, and the answer
11649 There were two points in this argument when I should have seen
11650 where the Court was going. The first was a question by Justice
11651 Kennedy, who observed,
11655 justice kennedy: Well, I suppose implicit in the argument that
11656 the '
76 act, too, should have been declared void, and that we
11657 might leave it alone because of the disruption, is that for all these
11658 years the act has impeded progress in science and the useful arts.
11659 I just don't see any empirical evidence for that.
11663 Here follows my clear mistake. Like a professor correcting a
11669 mr. lessig: Justice, we are not making an empirical claim at all.
11670 Nothing in our Copyright Clause claim hangs upon the empirical
11671 assertion about impeding progress. Our only argument is this is a
11672 structural limit necessary to assure that what would be an effectively
11673 perpetual term not be permitted under the copyright laws.
11676 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11678 That was a correct answer, but it wasn't the right answer. The right
11679 answer was instead that there was an obvious and profound harm. Any
11680 number of briefs had been written about it. He wanted to hear it. And
11681 here was the place Don Ayer's advice should have mattered. This was a
11682 softball; my answer was a swing and a miss.
11685 The second came from the Chief, for whom the whole case had been
11686 crafted. For the Chief Justice had crafted the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> ruling,
11687 and we hoped that he would see this case as its second cousin.
11690 It was clear a second into his question that he wasn't at all
11691 sympathetic. To him, we were a bunch of anarchists. As he asked:
11693 <!-- PAGE BREAK 247 -->
11697 chief justice: Well, but you want more than that. You want the
11698 right to copy verbatim other people's books, don't you?
11701 mr. lessig: We want the right to copy verbatim works that
11702 should be in the public domain and would be in the public
11704 but for a statute that cannot be justified under ordinary First
11705 Amendment analysis or under a proper reading of the limits built
11706 into the Copyright Clause.
11709 <indexterm><primary>Olson, Theodore B.
</primary></indexterm>
11711 Things went better for us when the government gave its argument;
11712 for now the Court picked up on the core of our claim. As Justice Scalia
11713 asked Solicitor General Olson,
11717 justice scalia: You say that the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11718 time would be a violation [of the Constitution], but that's precisely
11719 the argument that's being made by petitioners here, that a limited
11720 time which is extendable is the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11725 When Olson was finished, it was my turn to give a closing rebuttal.
11726 Olson's flailing had revived my anger. But my anger still was directed
11727 to the academic, not the practical. The government was arguing as if
11728 this were the first case ever to consider limits on Congress's
11729 Copyright and Patent Clause power. Ever the professor and not the
11730 advocate, I closed by pointing out the long history of the Court
11731 imposing limits on Congress's power in the name of the Copyright and
11732 Patent Clause
— indeed, the very first case striking a law of
11733 Congress as exceeding a specific enumerated power was based upon the
11734 Copyright and Patent Clause. All true. But it wasn't going to move the
11738 As I left the court that day, I knew there were a hundred points I
11739 wished I could remake. There were a hundred questions I wished I had
11741 <!-- PAGE BREAK 248 -->
11742 answered differently. But one way of thinking about this case left me
11746 The government had been asked over and over again, what is the limit?
11747 Over and over again, it had answered there is no limit. This was
11748 precisely the answer I wanted the Court to hear. For I could not
11749 imagine how the Court could understand that the government believed
11750 Congress's power was unlimited under the terms of the Copyright
11751 Clause, and sustain the government's argument. The solicitor general
11752 had made my argument for me. No matter how often I tried, I could not
11753 understand how the Court could find that Congress's power under the
11754 Commerce Clause was limited, but under the Copyright Clause,
11755 unlimited. In those rare moments when I let myself believe that we may
11756 have prevailed, it was because I felt this Court
—in particular,
11757 the Conservatives
—would feel itself constrained by the rule of
11758 law that it had established elsewhere.
11761 The morning of January
15,
2003, I was five minutes late to the office
11762 and missed the
7:
00 A.M. call from the Supreme Court clerk. Listening to
11763 the message, I could tell in an instant that she had bad news to report.The
11764 Supreme Court had affirmed the decision of the Court of Appeals. Seven
11765 justices had voted in the majority. There were two dissents.
11768 A few seconds later, the opinions arrived by e-mail. I took the
11769 phone off the hook, posted an announcement to our blog, and sat
11770 down to see where I had been wrong in my reasoning.
11773 My
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. Here was a case that pitted all the
11774 money in the world against
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. And here
11775 was the last naïve law professor, scouring the pages, looking for
11779 I first scoured the opinion, looking for how the Court would
11780 distinguish the principle in this case from the principle in
11781 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The argument was nowhere to be found. The case was not even
11782 cited. The argument that was the core argument of our case did not
11783 even appear in the Court's opinion.
11787 <!-- PAGE BREAK 249 -->
11788 Justice Ginsburg simply ignored the enumerated powers argument.
11789 Consistent with her view that Congress's power was not limited
11790 generally, she had found Congress's power not limited here.
11793 Her opinion was perfectly reasonable
—for her, and for Justice
11794 Souter. Neither believes in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. It would be too much to expect them
11795 to write an opinion that recognized, much less explained, the doctrine
11796 they had worked so hard to defeat.
11799 But as I realized what had happened, I couldn't quite believe what I
11800 was reading. I had said there was no way this Court could reconcile
11801 limited powers with the Commerce Clause and unlimited powers with the
11802 Progress Clause. It had never even occurred to me that they could
11803 reconcile the two simply
<emphasis>by not addressing the
11804 argument
</emphasis>. There was no inconsistency because they would not
11805 talk about the two together. There was therefore no principle that
11806 followed from the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case: In that context, Congress's power would
11807 be limited, but in this context it would not.
11810 Yet by what right did they get to choose which of the framers' values
11811 they would respect? By what right did they
—the silent
11812 five
—get to select the part of the Constitution they would
11813 enforce based on the values they thought important? We were right back
11814 to the argument that I said I hated at the start: I had failed to
11815 convince them that the issue here was important, and I had failed to
11816 recognize that however much I might hate a system in which the Court
11817 gets to pick the constitutional values that it will respect, that is
11818 the system we have.
11820 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11822 Justices Breyer and Stevens wrote very strong dissents. Stevens's
11823 opinion was crafted internal to the law: He argued that the tradition
11824 of intellectual property law should not support this unjustified
11825 extension of terms. He based his argument on a parallel analysis that
11826 had governed in the context of patents (so had we). But the rest of
11827 the Court discounted the parallel
—without explaining how the
11828 very same words in the Progress Clause could come to mean totally
11829 different things depending upon whether the words were about patents
11830 or copyrights. The Court let Justice Stevens's charge go unanswered.
11832 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11834 <!-- PAGE BREAK 250 -->
11835 Justice Breyer's opinion, perhaps the best opinion he has ever
11836 written, was external to the Constitution. He argued that the term of
11837 copyrights has become so long as to be effectively unlimited. We had
11838 said that under the current term, a copyright gave an author
99.8
11839 percent of the value of a perpetual term. Breyer said we were wrong,
11840 that the actual number was
99.9997 percent of a perpetual term. Either
11841 way, the point was clear: If the Constitution said a term had to be
11842 <quote>limited,
</quote> and the existing term was so long as to be effectively
11843 unlimited, then it was unconstitutional.
11846 These two justices understood all the arguments we had made. But
11847 because neither believed in the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case, neither was willing to push
11848 it as a reason to reject this extension. The case was decided without
11849 anyone having addressed the argument that we had carried from Judge
11850 Sentelle. It was
<citetitle>Hamlet
</citetitle> without the Prince.
11853 Defeat brings depression. They say it is a sign of health when
11854 depression gives way to anger. My anger came quickly, but it didn't cure
11855 the depression. This anger was of two sorts.
11857 <indexterm><primary>originalism
</primary></indexterm>
11859 It was first anger with the five
<quote>Conservatives.
</quote> It would have been
11860 one thing for them to have explained why the principle of
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> didn't
11861 apply in this case. That wouldn't have been a very convincing
11862 argument, I don't believe, having read it made by others, and having
11863 tried to make it myself. But it at least would have been an act of
11864 integrity. These justices in particular have repeatedly said that the
11865 proper mode of interpreting the Constitution is
<quote>originalism
</quote>—to
11866 first understand the framers' text, interpreted in their context, in
11867 light of the structure of the Constitution. That method had produced
11868 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> and many other
<quote>originalist
</quote> rulings. Where was their
11869 <quote>originalism
</quote> now?
11872 Here, they had joined an opinion that never once tried to explain
11873 what the framers had meant by crafting the Progress Clause as they
11874 did; they joined an opinion that never once tried to explain how the
11875 structure of that clause would affect the interpretation of Congress's
11877 <!-- PAGE BREAK 251 -->
11878 power. And they joined an opinion that didn't even try to explain why
11879 this grant of power could be unlimited, whereas the Commerce Clause
11880 would be limited. In short, they had joined an opinion that did not
11881 apply to, and was inconsistent with, their own method for interpreting
11882 the Constitution. This opinion may well have yielded a result that
11883 they liked. It did not produce a reason that was consistent with their
11887 My anger with the Conservatives quickly yielded to anger with
11889 For I had let a view of the law that I liked interfere with a view of
11892 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11894 Most lawyers, and most law professors, have little patience for
11895 idealism about courts in general and this Supreme Court in particular.
11896 Most have a much more pragmatic view. When Don Ayer said that this
11897 case would be won based on whether I could convince the Justices that
11898 the framers' values were important, I fought the idea, because I
11899 didn't want to believe that that is how this Court decides. I insisted
11900 on arguing this case as if it were a simple application of a set of
11901 principles. I had an argument that followed in logic. I didn't need
11902 to waste my time showing it should also follow in popularity.
11905 As I read back over the transcript from that argument in October, I
11906 can see a hundred places where the answers could have taken the
11907 conversation in different directions, where the truth about the harm
11908 that this unchecked power will cause could have been made clear to
11909 this Court. Justice Kennedy in good faith wanted to be shown. I,
11910 idiotically, corrected his question. Justice Souter in good faith
11911 wanted to be shown the First Amendment harms. I, like a math teacher,
11912 reframed the question to make the logical point. I had shown them how
11913 they could strike this law of Congress if they wanted to. There were a
11914 hundred places where I could have helped them want to, yet my
11915 stubbornness, my refusal to give in, stopped me. I have stood before
11916 hundreds of audiences trying to persuade; I have used passion in that
11917 effort to persuade; but I
11918 <!-- PAGE BREAK 252 -->
11919 refused to stand before this audience and try to persuade with the
11920 passion I had used elsewhere. It was not the basis on which a court
11921 should decide the issue.
11923 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11925 Would it have been different if I had argued it differently? Would it
11926 have been different if Don Ayer had argued it? Or Charles Fried? Or
11928 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11931 My friends huddled around me to insist it would not. The Court
11932 was not ready, my friends insisted. This was a loss that was destined. It
11933 would take a great deal more to show our society why our framers were
11934 right. And when we do that, we will be able to show that Court.
11937 Maybe, but I doubt it. These Justices have no financial interest in
11938 doing anything except the right thing. They are not lobbied. They have
11939 little reason to resist doing right. I can't help but think that if I had
11940 stepped down from this pretty picture of dispassionate justice, I could
11944 And even if I couldn't, then that doesn't excuse what happened in
11945 January. For at the start of this case, one of America's leading
11946 intellectual property professors stated publicly that my bringing this
11947 case was a mistake.
<quote>The Court is not ready,
</quote> Peter Jaszi said; this
11948 issue should not be raised until it is.
11949 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
11952 After the argument and after the decision, Peter said to me, and
11953 publicly, that he was wrong. But if indeed that Court could not have
11954 been persuaded, then that is all the evidence that's needed to know that
11955 here again Peter was right. Either I was not ready to argue this case in
11956 a way that would do some good or they were not ready to hear this case
11957 in a way that would do some good. Either way, the decision to bring
11958 this case
—a decision I had made four years before
—was wrong.
11959 While the reaction to the Sonny Bono Act itself was almost
11960 unanimously negative, the reaction to the Court's decision was mixed.
11961 No one, at least in the press, tried to say that extending the term of
11962 copyright was a good idea. We had won that battle over ideas. Where
11964 <!-- PAGE BREAK 253 -->
11965 the decision was praised, it was praised by papers that had been
11966 skeptical of the Court's activism in other cases. Deference was a good
11967 thing, even if it left standing a silly law. But where the decision
11968 was attacked, it was attacked because it left standing a silly and
11969 harmful law.
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> wrote in its editorial,
11973 In effect, the Supreme Court's decision makes it likely that we are
11974 seeing the beginning of the end of public domain and the birth of
11975 copyright perpetuity. The public domain has been a grand experiment,
11976 one that should not be allowed to die. The ability to draw freely on
11977 the entire creative output of humanity is one of the reasons we live
11978 in a time of such fruitful creative ferment.
11982 The best responses were in the cartoons. There was a gaggle of
11983 hilarious images
—of Mickey in jail and the like. The best, from
11984 my view of the case, was Ruben Bolling's, reproduced on the next page
11985 (
<xref linkend=
"fig-18"/>). The
<quote>powerful and wealthy
</quote> line is a bit
11986 unfair. But the punch in the face felt exactly like that.
11987 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben
</primary></indexterm>
11989 <figure id=
"fig-18">
11990 <title>Tom the Dancing Bug cartoon
</title>
11991 <graphic fileref=
"images/18.png"></graphic>
11992 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben
</primary></indexterm>
11995 The image that will always stick in my head is that evoked by the
11996 quote from
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>. That
<quote>grand experiment
</quote> we call the
11997 <quote>public domain
</quote> is over? When I can make light of it, I think,
<quote>Honey,
11998 I shrunk the Constitution.
</quote> But I can rarely make light of it. We had
11999 in our Constitution a commitment to free culture. In the case that I
12000 fathered, the Supreme Court effectively renounced that commitment. A
12001 better lawyer would have made them see differently.
12003 <!-- PAGE BREAK 254 -->
12005 <chapter label=
"14" id=
"eldred-ii">
12006 <title>CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
</title>
12008 The day
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was decided, fate would have it that I was to travel to
12009 Washington, D.C. (The day the rehearing petition in
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was
12010 denied
—meaning the case was really finally over
—fate would
12011 have it that I was giving a speech to technologists at Disney World.)
12012 This was a particularly long flight to my least favorite city. The
12013 drive into the city from Dulles was delayed because of traffic, so I
12014 opened up my computer and wrote an op-ed piece.
12016 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
12018 It was an act of contrition. During the whole of the flight from San
12019 Francisco to Washington, I had heard over and over again in my head
12020 the same advice from Don Ayer: You need to make them see why it is
12021 important. And alternating with that command was the question of
12022 Justice Kennedy:
<quote>For all these years the act has impeded progress in
12023 science and the useful arts. I just don't see any empirical evidence for
12024 that.
</quote> And so, having failed in the argument of constitutional principle,
12025 finally, I turned to an argument of politics.
12028 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> published the piece. In it, I proposed a simple
12029 fix: Fifty years after a work has been published, the copyright owner
12030 <!-- PAGE BREAK 256 -->
12031 would be required to register the work and pay a small fee. If he paid
12032 the fee, he got the benefit of the full term of copyright. If he did not,
12033 the work passed into the public domain.
12036 We called this the Eldred Act, but that was just to give it a name.
12037 Eric Eldred was kind enough to let his name be used once again, but as
12038 he said early on, it won't get passed unless it has another name.
12041 Or another two names. For depending upon your perspective, this
12042 is either the
<quote>Public Domain Enhancement Act
</quote> or the
<quote>Copyright
12043 Term Deregulation Act.
</quote> Either way, the essence of the idea is clear
12044 and obvious: Remove copyright where it is doing nothing except
12045 blocking access and the spread of knowledge. Leave it for as long as
12046 Congress allows for those works where its worth is at least $
1. But for
12047 everything else, let the content go.
12049 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
12051 The reaction to this idea was amazingly strong. Steve Forbes endorsed
12052 it in an editorial. I received an avalanche of e-mail and letters
12053 expressing support. When you focus the issue on lost creativity,
12054 people can see the copyright system makes no sense. As a good
12055 Republican might say, here government regulation is simply getting in
12056 the way of innovation and creativity. And as a good Democrat might
12057 say, here the government is blocking access and the spread of
12058 knowledge for no good reason. Indeed, there is no real difference
12059 between Democrats and Republicans on this issue. Anyone can recognize
12060 the stupid harm of the present system.
12063 Indeed, many recognized the obvious benefit of the registration
12064 requirement. For one of the hardest things about the current system
12065 for people who want to license content is that there is no obvious
12066 place to look for the current copyright owners. Since registration is
12067 not required, since marking content is not required, since no
12068 formality at all is required, it is often impossibly hard to locate
12069 copyright owners to ask permission to use or license their work. This
12070 system would lower these costs, by establishing at least one registry
12071 where copyright owners could be identified.
12073 <indexterm><primary>Berlin Act (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12074 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12076 <!-- PAGE BREAK 257 -->
12077 As I described in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
12078 linkend=
"property-i"/>, formalities in copyright law were
12079 removed in
1976, when Congress followed the Europeans by abandoning
12080 any formal requirement before a copyright is granted.
<footnote><para>
12082 Until the
1908 Berlin Act of the Berne Convention, national copyright
12083 legislation sometimes made protection depend upon compliance with
12084 formalities such as registration, deposit, and affixation of notice of
12085 the author's claim of copyright. However, starting with the
1908 act,
12086 every text of the Convention has provided that
<quote>the enjoyment and the
12087 exercise
</quote> of rights guaranteed by the Convention
<quote>shall not be subject
12088 to any formality.
</quote> The prohibition against formalities is presently
12089 embodied in Article
5(
2) of the Paris Text of the Berne
12090 Convention. Many countries continue to impose some form of deposit or
12091 registration requirement, albeit not as a condition of
12092 copyright. French law, for example, requires the deposit of copies of
12093 works in national repositories, principally the National Museum.
12094 Copies of books published in the United Kingdom must be deposited in
12095 the British Library. The German Copyright Act provides for a Registrar
12096 of Authors where the author's true name can be filed in the case of
12097 anonymous or pseudonymous works. Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>International
12098 Intellectual Property Law, Cases and Materials
</citetitle> (New York: Foundation
12099 Press,
2001),
153–54.
</para></footnote>
12100 The Europeans are said to view copyright as a
<quote>natural right.
</quote> Natural
12101 rights don't need forms to exist. Traditions, like the Anglo-American
12102 tradition that required copyright owners to follow form if their
12103 rights were to be protected, did not, the Europeans thought, properly
12104 respect the dignity of the author. My right as a creator turns on my
12105 creativity, not upon the special favor of the government.
12108 That's great rhetoric. It sounds wonderfully romantic. But it is
12109 absurd copyright policy. It is absurd especially for authors, because
12110 a world without formalities harms the creator. The ability to spread
12111 <quote>Walt Disney creativity
</quote> is destroyed when there is no simple way to
12112 know what's protected and what's not.
12114 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
12116 The fight against formalities achieved its first real victory in
12117 Berlin in
1908. International copyright lawyers amended the Berne
12118 Convention in
1908, to require copyright terms of life plus fifty
12119 years, as well as the abolition of copyright formalities. The
12120 formalities were hated because the stories of inadvertent loss were
12121 increasingly common. It was as if a Charles Dickens character ran all
12122 copyright offices, and the failure to dot an
<citetitle>i
</citetitle> or cross a
12123 <citetitle>t
</citetitle> resulted in the loss of widows' only income.
12126 These complaints were real and sensible. And the strictness of the
12127 formalities, especially in the United States, was absurd. The law
12128 should always have ways of forgiving innocent mistakes. There is no
12129 reason copyright law couldn't, as well. Rather than abandoning
12130 formalities totally, the response in Berlin should have been to
12131 embrace a more equitable system of registration.
12134 Even that would have been resisted, however, because registration
12135 in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries was still expensive. It was
12136 also a hassle. The abolishment of formalities promised not only to save
12137 the starving widows, but also to lighten an unnecessary regulatory
12139 imposed upon creators.
12142 In addition to the practical complaint of authors in
1908, there was
12143 a moral claim as well. There was no reason that creative property
12145 <!-- PAGE BREAK 258 -->
12146 should be a second-class form of property. If a carpenter builds a
12147 table, his rights over the table don't depend upon filing a form with
12148 the government. He has a property right over the table
<quote>naturally,
</quote>
12149 and he can assert that right against anyone who would steal the table,
12150 whether or not he has informed the government of his ownership of the
12154 This argument is correct, but its implications are misleading. For the
12155 argument in favor of formalities does not depend upon creative
12156 property being second-class property. The argument in favor of
12157 formalities turns upon the special problems that creative property
12158 presents. The law of formalities responds to the special physics of
12159 creative property, to assure that it can be efficiently and fairly
12163 No one thinks, for example, that land is second-class property just
12164 because you have to register a deed with a court if your sale of land
12165 is to be effective. And few would think a car is second-class property
12166 just because you must register the car with the state and tag it with
12167 a license. In both of those cases, everyone sees that there is an
12168 important reason to secure registration
—both because it makes
12169 the markets more efficient and because it better secures the rights of
12170 the owner. Without a registration system for land, landowners would
12171 perpetually have to guard their property. With registration, they can
12172 simply point the police to a deed. Without a registration system for
12173 cars, auto theft would be much easier. With a registration system, the
12174 thief has a high burden to sell a stolen car. A slight burden is
12175 placed on the property owner, but those burdens produce a much better
12176 system of protection for property generally.
12179 It is similarly special physics that makes formalities important in
12180 copyright law. Unlike a carpenter's table, there's nothing in nature that
12181 makes it relatively obvious who might own a particular bit of creative
12182 property. A recording of Lyle Lovett's latest album can exist in a billion
12183 places without anything necessarily linking it back to a particular
12184 owner. And like a car, there's no way to buy and sell creative property
12185 with confidence unless there is some simple way to authenticate who is
12186 the author and what rights he has. Simple transactions are destroyed in
12188 <!-- PAGE BREAK 259 -->
12189 a world without formalities. Complex, expensive,
12190 <emphasis>lawyer
</emphasis> transactions take their place.
12191 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
12194 This was the understanding of the problem with the Sonny Bono
12195 Act that we tried to demonstrate to the Court. This was the part it
12196 didn't
<quote>get.
</quote> Because we live in a system without formalities, there is no
12197 way easily to build upon or use culture from our past. If copyright
12198 terms were, as Justice Story said they would be,
<quote>short,
</quote> then this
12199 wouldn't matter much. For fourteen years, under the framers' system, a
12200 work would be presumptively controlled. After fourteen years, it would
12201 be presumptively uncontrolled.
12204 But now that copyrights can be just about a century long, the
12205 inability to know what is protected and what is not protected becomes
12206 a huge and obvious burden on the creative process. If the only way a
12207 library can offer an Internet exhibit about the New Deal is to hire a
12208 lawyer to clear the rights to every image and sound, then the
12209 copyright system is burdening creativity in a way that has never been
12210 seen before
<emphasis>because there are no formalities
</emphasis>.
12213 The Eldred Act was designed to respond to exactly this problem. If
12214 it is worth $
1 to you, then register your work and you can get the
12215 longer term. Others will know how to contact you and, therefore, how
12216 to get your permission if they want to use your work. And you will get
12217 the benefit of an extended copyright term.
12220 If it isn't worth it to you to register to get the benefit of an extended
12221 term, then it shouldn't be worth it for the government to defend your
12222 monopoly over that work either. The work should pass into the public
12223 domain where anyone can copy it, or build archives with it, or create a
12224 movie based on it. It should become free if it is not worth $
1 to you.
12227 Some worry about the burden on authors. Won't the burden of
12228 registering the work mean that the $
1 is really misleading? Isn't the
12229 hassle worth more than $
1? Isn't that the real problem with
12233 It is. The hassle is terrible. The system that exists now is awful. I
12234 completely agree that the Copyright Office has done a terrible job (no
12235 doubt because they are terribly funded) in enabling simple and cheap
12237 <!-- PAGE BREAK 260 -->
12238 registrations. Any real solution to the problem of formalities must
12239 address the real problem of
<emphasis>governments
</emphasis> standing
12240 at the core of any system of formalities. In this book, I offer such a
12241 solution. That solution essentially remakes the Copyright Office. For
12242 now, assume it was Amazon that ran the registration system. Assume it
12243 was one-click registration. The Eldred Act would propose a simple,
12244 one-click registration fifty years after a work was published. Based
12245 upon historical data, that system would move up to
98 percent of
12246 commercial work, commercial work that no longer had a commercial life,
12247 into the public domain within fifty years. What do you think?
12249 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
12251 When Steve Forbes endorsed the idea, some in Washington began to pay
12252 attention. Many people contacted me pointing to representatives who
12253 might be willing to introduce the Eldred Act. And I had a few who
12254 directly suggested that they might be willing to take the first step.
12257 One representative, Zoe Lofgren of California, went so far as to get
12258 the bill drafted. The draft solved any problem with international
12259 law. It imposed the simplest requirement upon copyright owners
12260 possible. In May
2003, it looked as if the bill would be
12261 introduced. On May
16, I posted on the Eldred Act blog,
<quote>we are
12262 close.
</quote> There was a general reaction in the blog community that
12263 something good might happen here.
12264 <indexterm><primary>Lofgren, Zoe
</primary></indexterm>
12267 But at this stage, the lobbyists began to intervene. Jack Valenti and
12268 the MPAA general counsel came to the congresswoman's office to give
12269 the view of the MPAA. Aided by his lawyer, as Valenti told me, Valenti
12270 informed the congresswoman that the MPAA would oppose the Eldred
12271 Act. The reasons are embarrassingly thin. More importantly, their
12272 thinness shows something clear about what this debate is really about.
12275 The MPAA argued first that Congress had
<quote>firmly rejected the central
12276 concept in the proposed bill
</quote>—that copyrights be renewed. That
12277 was true, but irrelevant, as Congress's
<quote>firm rejection
</quote> had occurred
12278 <!-- PAGE BREAK 261 -->
12279 long before the Internet made subsequent uses much more likely.
12280 Second, they argued that the proposal would harm poor copyright
12281 owners
—apparently those who could not afford the $
1 fee. Third,
12282 they argued that Congress had determined that extending a copyright
12283 term would encourage restoration work. Maybe in the case of the small
12284 percentage of work covered by copyright law that is still commercially
12285 valuable, but again this was irrelevant, as the proposal would not cut
12286 off the extended term unless the $
1 fee was not paid. Fourth, the MPAA
12287 argued that the bill would impose
<quote>enormous
</quote> costs, since a
12288 registration system is not free. True enough, but those costs are
12289 certainly less than the costs of clearing the rights for a copyright
12290 whose owner is not known. Fifth, they worried about the risks if the
12291 copyright to a story underlying a film were to pass into the public
12292 domain. But what risk is that? If it is in the public domain, then the
12293 film is a valid derivative use.
12296 Finally, the MPAA argued that existing law enabled copyright owners to
12297 do this if they wanted. But the whole point is that there are
12298 thousands of copyright owners who don't even know they have a
12299 copyright to give. Whether they are free to give away their copyright
12300 or not
—a controversial claim in any case
—unless they know
12301 about a copyright, they're not likely to.
12304 At the beginning of this book, I told two stories about the law
12305 reacting to changes in technology. In the one, common sense prevailed.
12306 In the other, common sense was delayed. The difference between the two
12307 stories was the power of the opposition
—the power of the side
12308 that fought to defend the status quo. In both cases, a new technology
12309 threatened old interests. But in only one case did those interest's
12310 have the power to protect themselves against this new competitive
12314 I used these two cases as a way to frame the war that this book has
12315 been about. For here, too, a new technology is forcing the law to react.
12316 And here, too, we should ask, is the law following or resisting common
12317 sense? If common sense supports the law, what explains this common
12322 <!-- PAGE BREAK 262 -->
12323 When the issue is piracy, it is right for the law to back the
12324 copyright owners. The commercial piracy that I described is wrong and
12325 harmful, and the law should work to eliminate it. When the issue is
12326 p2p sharing, it is easy to understand why the law backs the owners
12327 still: Much of this sharing is wrong, even if much is harmless. When
12328 the issue is copyright terms for the Mickey Mouses of the world, it is
12329 possible still to understand why the law favors Hollywood: Most people
12330 don't recognize the reasons for limiting copyright terms; it is thus
12331 still possible to see good faith within the resistance.
12334 But when the copyright owners oppose a proposal such as the Eldred
12335 Act, then, finally, there is an example that lays bare the naked
12336 selfinterest driving this war. This act would free an extraordinary
12337 range of content that is otherwise unused. It wouldn't interfere with
12338 any copyright owner's desire to exercise continued control over his
12339 content. It would simply liberate what Kevin Kelly calls the
<quote>Dark
12340 Content
</quote> that fills archives around the world. So when the warriors
12341 oppose a change like this, we should ask one simple question:
12342 <indexterm><primary>Kelly, Kevin
</primary></indexterm>
12345 What does this industry really want?
12348 With very little effort, the warriors could protect their content. So
12349 the effort to block something like the Eldred Act is not really about
12350 protecting
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> content. The effort to block the
12351 Eldred Act is an effort to assure that nothing more passes into the
12352 public domain. It is another step to assure that the public domain
12353 will never compete, that there will be no use of content that is not
12354 commercially controlled, and that there will be no commercial use of
12355 content that doesn't require
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> permission
12359 The opposition to the Eldred Act reveals how extreme the other side
12360 is. The most powerful and sexy and well loved of lobbies really has as
12361 its aim not the protection of
<quote>property
</quote> but the rejection of a
12362 tradition. Their aim is not simply to protect what is
12363 theirs.
<emphasis>Their aim is to assure that all there is is what is
12367 It is not hard to understand why the warriors take this view. It is not
12368 hard to see why it would benefit them if the competition of the public
12370 <!-- PAGE BREAK 263 -->
12371 domain tied to the Internet could somehow be quashed. Just as RCA
12372 feared the competition of FM, they fear the competition of a public
12373 domain connected to a public that now has the means to create with it
12374 and to share its own creation.
12376 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12377 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12379 What is hard to understand is why the public takes this view. It is
12380 as if the law made airplanes trespassers. The MPAA stands with the
12381 Causbys and demands that their remote and useless property rights be
12382 respected, so that these remote and forgotten copyright holders might
12383 block the progress of others.
12386 All this seems to follow easily from this untroubled acceptance of the
12387 <quote>property
</quote> in intellectual property. Common sense supports it, and so
12388 long as it does, the assaults will rain down upon the technologies of
12389 the Internet. The consequence will be an increasing
<quote>permission
12390 society.
</quote> The past can be cultivated only if you can identify the
12391 owner and gain permission to build upon his work. The future will be
12392 controlled by this dead (and often unfindable) hand of the past.
12394 <!-- PAGE BREAK 264 -->
12397 <chapter label=
"15" id=
"c-conclusion">
12398 <title>CONCLUSION
</title>
12399 <indexterm id=
"idxantiretroviraldrugs" class='startofrange'
>
12400 <primary>antiretroviral drugs
</primary>
12402 <indexterm id=
"idxhivaidstherapies" class='startofrange'
>
12403 <primary>HIV/AIDS therapies
</primary>
12405 <indexterm id=
"idxafricahivmed" class='startofrange'
>
12406 <primary>Africa, medications for HIV patients in
</primary>
12409 There are more than
35 million people with the AIDS virus
12410 worldwide. Twenty-five million of them live in sub-Saharan Africa.
12411 Seventeen million have already died. Seventeen million Africans
12412 is proportional percentage-wise to seven million Americans. More
12413 importantly, it is seventeen million Africans.
12416 There is no cure for AIDS, but there are drugs to slow its
12417 progression. These antiretroviral therapies are still experimental,
12418 but they have already had a dramatic effect. In the United States,
12419 AIDS patients who regularly take a cocktail of these drugs increase
12420 their life expectancy by ten to twenty years. For some, the drugs make
12421 the disease almost invisible.
12424 These drugs are expensive. When they were first introduced in the
12425 United States, they cost between $
10,
000 and $
15,
000 per person per
12426 year. Today, some cost $
25,
000 per year. At these prices, of course, no
12427 African nation can afford the drugs for the vast majority of its
12429 $
15,
000 is thirty times the per capita gross national product of
12430 Zimbabwe. At these prices, the drugs are totally unavailable.
<footnote><para>
12431 <!-- f1. --> Commission on Intellectual Property Rights,
<quote>Final Report: Integrating
12432 Intellectual Property Rights and Development Policy
</quote> (London,
2002),
12434 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
55</ulink>. According to a World Health Organization press
12436 issued
9 July
2002, only
230,
000 of the
6 million who need drugs in
12437 the developing world receive them
—and half of them are in Brazil.
12441 <!-- PAGE BREAK 265 -->
12442 These prices are not high because the ingredients of the drugs are
12443 expensive. These prices are high because the drugs are protected by
12444 patents. The drug companies that produced these life-saving mixes
12445 enjoy at least a twenty-year monopoly for their inventions. They use
12446 that monopoly power to extract the most they can from the market. That
12447 power is in turn used to keep the prices high.
12450 There are many who are skeptical of patents, especially drug
12451 patents. I am not. Indeed, of all the areas of research that might be
12452 supported by patents, drug research is, in my view, the clearest case
12453 where patents are needed. The patent gives the drug company some
12454 assurance that if it is successful in inventing a new drug to treat a
12455 disease, it will be able to earn back its investment and more. This is
12456 socially an extremely valuable incentive. I am the last person who
12457 would argue that the law should abolish it, at least without other
12461 But it is one thing to support patents, even drug patents. It is
12462 another thing to determine how best to deal with a crisis. And as
12463 African leaders began to recognize the devastation that AIDS was
12464 bringing, they started looking for ways to import HIV treatments at
12465 costs significantly below the market price.
12468 In
1997, South Africa tried one tack. It passed a law to allow the
12469 importation of patented medicines that had been produced or sold in
12470 another nation's market with the consent of the patent owner. For
12471 example, if the drug was sold in India, it could be imported into
12472 Africa from India. This is called
<quote>parallel importation,
</quote> and it is
12473 generally permitted under international trade law and is specifically
12474 permitted within the European Union.
<footnote>
12477 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism: Who
12478 Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The New Press,
2003),
37.
12479 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12480 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12484 However, the United States government opposed the bill. Indeed, more
12485 than opposed. As the International Intellectual Property Association
12486 characterized it,
<quote>The U.S. government pressured South Africa
…
12487 not to permit compulsory licensing or parallel
12488 imports.
</quote><footnote><para>
12490 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12491 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12492 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12493 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
14, available at
12494 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
56</ulink>. For a
12495 firsthand account of the struggle over South Africa, see Hearing
12496 Before the Subcommittee on Criminal Justice, Drug Policy, and Human
12497 Resources, House Committee on Government Reform, H. Rep.,
1st sess.,
12498 Ser. No.
106-
126 (
22 July
1999),
150–57 (statement of James
12501 Through the Office of the United States Trade Representative, the
12502 government asked South Africa to change the law
—and to add
12503 pressure to that request, in
1998, the USTR listed South Africa for
12504 possible trade sanctions.
12505 <!-- PAGE BREAK 266 -->
12506 That same year, more than forty pharmaceutical companies began
12507 proceedings in the South African courts to challenge the government's
12508 actions. The United States was then joined by other governments from
12509 the EU. Their claim, and the claim of the pharmaceutical companies,
12510 was that South Africa was violating its obligations under
12511 international law by discriminating against a particular kind of
12512 patent
— pharmaceutical patents. The demand of these governments,
12513 with the United States in the lead, was that South Africa respect
12514 these patents as it respects any other patent, regardless of any
12515 effect on the treatment of AIDS within South Africa.
<footnote><para>
12517 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12518 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12519 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12520 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
15.
</para></footnote>
12523 We should place the intervention by the United States in context. No
12524 doubt patents are not the most important reason that Africans don't
12525 have access to drugs. Poverty and the total absence of an effective
12526 health care infrastructure matter more. But whether patents are the
12527 most important reason or not, the price of drugs has an effect on
12528 their demand, and patents affect price. And so, whether massive or
12529 marginal, there was an effect from our government's intervention to
12530 stop the flow of medications into Africa.
12533 By stopping the flow of HIV treatment into Africa, the United
12534 States government was not saving drugs for United States citizens.
12535 This is not like wheat (if they eat it, we can't); instead, the flow that the
12536 United States intervened to stop was, in effect, a flow of knowledge:
12537 information about how to take chemicals that exist within Africa, and
12538 turn those chemicals into drugs that would save
15 to
30 million lives.
12541 Nor was the intervention by the United States going to protect the
12542 profits of United States drug companies
—at least, not substantially. It
12543 was not as if these countries were in the position to buy the drugs for
12544 the prices the drug companies were charging. Again, the Africans are
12545 wildly too poor to afford these drugs at the offered prices. Stopping the
12546 parallel import of these drugs would not substantially increase the sales
12550 Instead, the argument in favor of restricting this flow of
12551 information, which was needed to save the lives of millions, was an
12553 <!-- PAGE BREAK 267 -->
12554 about the sanctity of property.
<footnote><para>
12556 See Sabin Russell,
<quote>New Crusade to Lower AIDS Drug Costs: Africa's
12557 Needs at Odds with Firms' Profit Motive,
</quote> <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24
12558 May
1999, A1, available at
12559 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
57</ulink>
12560 (
<quote>compulsory licenses and gray markets pose a threat to the entire
12561 system of intellectual property protection
</quote>); Robert Weissman,
<quote>AIDS
12562 and Developing Countries: Democratizing Access to Essential
12563 Medicines,
</quote> <citetitle>Foreign Policy in Focus
</citetitle> 4:
23 (August
1999), available at
12564 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
58</ulink>
12565 (describing U.S. policy); John A. Harrelson,
<quote>TRIPS, Pharmaceutical
12566 Patents, and the HIV/AIDS Crisis: Finding the Proper Balance Between
12567 Intellectual Property Rights and Compassion, a Synopsis,
</quote> <citetitle>Widener Law
12568 Symposium Journal
</citetitle> (Spring
2001):
175.
12569 <!-- PAGE BREAK 333 -->
12571 It was because
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> would be violated that these
12572 drugs should not flow into Africa. It was a principle about the
12573 importance of
<quote>intellectual property
</quote> that led these government actors
12574 to intervene against the South African response to AIDS.
12577 Now just step back for a moment. There will be a time thirty years
12578 from now when our children look back at us and ask, how could we have
12579 let this happen? How could we allow a policy to be pursued whose
12580 direct cost would be to speed the death of
15 to
30 million Africans,
12581 and whose only real benefit would be to uphold the
<quote>sanctity
</quote> of an
12582 idea? What possible justification could there ever be for a policy
12583 that results in so many deaths? What exactly is the insanity that
12584 would allow so many to die for such an abstraction?
12587 Some blame the drug companies. I don't. They are corporations.
12588 Their managers are ordered by law to make money for the corporation.
12589 They push a certain patent policy not because of ideals, but because it is
12590 the policy that makes them the most money. And it only makes them the
12591 most money because of a certain corruption within our political system
—
12592 a corruption the drug companies are certainly not responsible for.
12595 The corruption is our own politicians' failure of integrity. For the
12596 drug companies would love
—they say, and I believe them
—to
12597 sell their drugs as cheaply as they can to countries in Africa and
12598 elsewhere. There are issues they'd have to resolve to make sure the
12599 drugs didn't get back into the United States, but those are mere
12600 problems of technology. They could be overcome.
12603 A different problem, however, could not be overcome. This is the
12604 fear of the grandstanding politician who would call the presidents of
12605 the drug companies before a Senate or House hearing, and ask,
<quote>How
12606 is it you can sell this HIV drug in Africa for only $
1 a pill, but the same
12607 drug would cost an American $
1,
500?
</quote> Because there is no
<quote>sound
12608 bite
</quote> answer to that question, its effect would be to induce regulation
12609 of prices in America. The drug companies thus avoid this spiral by
12610 avoiding the first step. They reinforce the idea that property should be
12611 <!-- PAGE BREAK 268 -->
12612 sacred. They adopt a rational strategy in an irrational context, with the
12613 unintended consequence that perhaps millions die. And that rational
12614 strategy thus becomes framed in terms of this ideal
—the sanctity of an
12615 idea called
<quote>intellectual property.
</quote>
12618 So when the common sense of your child confronts you, what will
12619 you say? When the common sense of a generation finally revolts
12620 against what we have done, how will we justify what we have done?
12621 What is the argument?
12624 A sensible patent policy could endorse and strongly support the patent
12625 system without having to reach everyone everywhere in exactly the same
12626 way. Just as a sensible copyright policy could endorse and strongly
12627 support a copyright system without having to regulate the spread of
12628 culture perfectly and forever, a sensible patent policy could endorse
12629 and strongly support a patent system without having to block the
12630 spread of drugs to a country not rich enough to afford market prices
12631 in any case. A sensible policy, in other words, could be a balanced
12632 policy. For most of our history, both copyright and patent policies
12633 were balanced in just this sense.
12636 But we as a culture have lost this sense of balance. We have lost the
12637 critical eye that helps us see the difference between truth and
12638 extremism. A certain property fundamentalism, having no connection to
12639 our tradition, now reigns in this culture
—bizarrely, and with
12640 consequences more grave to the spread of ideas and culture than almost
12641 any other single policy decision that we as a democracy will make.
12643 <indexterm startref=
"idxafricahivmed" class='endofrange'
/>
12644 <indexterm startref=
"idxhivaidstherapies" class='endofrange'
/>
12645 <indexterm startref=
"idxantiretroviraldrugs" class='endofrange'
/>
12647 A simple idea blinds us, and under the cover of darkness, much happens
12648 that most of us would reject if any of us looked. So uncritically do
12649 we accept the idea of property in ideas that we don't even notice how
12650 monstrous it is to deny ideas to a people who are dying without
12651 them. So uncritically do we accept the idea of property in culture
12652 that we don't even question when the control of that property removes
12654 <!-- PAGE BREAK 269 -->
12655 ability, as a people, to develop our culture democratically. Blindness
12656 becomes our common sense. And the challenge for anyone who would
12657 reclaim the right to cultivate our culture is to find a way to make
12658 this common sense open its eyes.
12661 So far, common sense sleeps. There is no revolt. Common sense
12662 does not yet see what there could be to revolt about. The extremism
12663 that now dominates this debate fits with ideas that seem natural, and
12664 that fit is reinforced by the RCAs of our day. They wage a frantic war
12665 to fight
<quote>piracy,
</quote> and devastate a culture for creativity. They defend
12666 the idea of
<quote>creative property,
</quote> while transforming real creators into
12667 modern-day sharecroppers. They are insulted by the idea that rights
12668 should be balanced, even though each of the major players in this
12669 content war was itself a beneficiary of a more balanced ideal. The
12670 hypocrisy reeks. Yet in a city like Washington, hypocrisy is not even
12671 noticed. Powerful lobbies, complex issues, and MTV attention spans
12672 produce the
<quote>perfect storm
</quote> for free culture.
12674 <indexterm><primary>Reagan, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
12676 In August
2003, a fight broke out in the United States about a
12677 decision by the World Intellectual Property Organization to cancel a
12678 meeting.
<footnote><para>
12679 <!-- f6. --> Jonathan Krim,
<quote>The Quiet War over Open-Source,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
12680 August
2003, E1, available at
12681 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
59</ulink>; William New,
<quote>Global Group's
12682 Shift on `Open Source' Meeting Spurs Stir,
</quote> <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12683 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12684 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
60</ulink>; William New,
<quote>U.S. Official
12685 Opposes `Open Source' Talks at WIPO,
</quote> <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12686 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12687 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
61</ulink>.
12689 At the request of a wide range of interests, WIPO had decided to hold
12690 a meeting to discuss
<quote>open and collaborative projects to create public
12691 goods.
</quote> These are projects that have been successful in producing
12692 public goods without relying exclusively upon a proprietary use of
12693 intellectual property. Examples include the Internet and the World
12694 Wide Web, both of which were developed on the basis of protocols in
12695 the public domain. It included an emerging trend to support open
12696 academic journals, including the Public Library of Science project
12697 that I describe in the Afterword. It included a project to develop
12698 single nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs), which are thought to have
12699 great significance in biomedical research. (That nonprofit project
12700 comprised a consortium of the Wellcome Trust and pharmaceutical and
12701 technological companies, including Amersham Biosciences, AstraZeneca,
12702 <!-- PAGE BREAK 270 -->
12703 Aventis, Bayer, Bristol-Myers Squibb, Hoffmann-La Roche,
12704 Glaxo-SmithKline, IBM, Motorola, Novartis, Pfizer, and Searle.) It
12705 included the Global Positioning System, which Ronald Reagan set free
12706 in the early
1980s. And it included
<quote>open source and free software.
</quote>
12707 <indexterm><primary>academic journals
</primary></indexterm>
12708 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
12709 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
12712 The aim of the meeting was to consider this wide range of projects
12713 from one common perspective: that none of these projects relied upon
12714 intellectual property extremism. Instead, in all of them, intellectual
12715 property was balanced by agreements to keep access open or to impose
12716 limitations on the way in which proprietary claims might be used.
12719 From the perspective of this book, then, the conference was ideal.
<footnote><para>
12720 <!-- f7. --> I should disclose that I was one of the people who asked WIPO for the
12723 The projects within its scope included both commercial and
12724 noncommercial work. They primarily involved science, but from many
12725 perspectives. And WIPO was an ideal venue for this discussion, since
12726 WIPO is the preeminent international body dealing with intellectual
12730 Indeed, I was once publicly scolded for not recognizing this fact
12731 about WIPO. In February
2003, I delivered a keynote address to a
12732 preparatory conference for the World Summit on the Information Society
12733 (WSIS). At a press conference before the address, I was asked what I
12734 would say. I responded that I would be talking a little about the
12735 importance of balance in intellectual property for the development of
12736 an information society. The moderator for the event then promptly
12737 interrupted to inform me and the assembled reporters that no question
12738 about intellectual property would be discussed by WSIS, since those
12739 questions were the exclusive domain of WIPO. In the talk that I had
12740 prepared, I had actually made the issue of intellectual property
12741 relatively minor. But after this astonishing statement, I made
12742 intellectual property the sole focus of my talk. There was no way to
12743 talk about an
<quote>Information Society
</quote> unless one also talked about the
12744 range of information and culture that would be free. My talk did not
12745 make my immoderate moderator very happy. And she was no doubt correct
12746 that the scope of intellectual property protections was ordinarily the
12748 <!-- PAGE BREAK 271 -->
12749 WIPO. But in my view, there couldn't be too much of a conversation
12750 about how much intellectual property is needed, since in my view, the
12751 very idea of balance in intellectual property had been lost.
12754 So whether or not WSIS can discuss balance in intellectual property, I
12755 had thought it was taken for granted that WIPO could and should. And
12756 thus the meeting about
<quote>open and collaborative projects to create
12757 public goods
</quote> seemed perfectly appropriate within the WIPO agenda.
12760 But there is one project within that list that is highly
12761 controversial, at least among lobbyists. That project is
<quote>open source
12762 and free software.
</quote> Microsoft in particular is wary of discussion of
12763 the subject. From its perspective, a conference to discuss open source
12764 and free software would be like a conference to discuss Apple's
12765 operating system. Both open source and free software compete with
12766 Microsoft's software. And internationally, many governments have begun
12767 to explore requirements that they use open source or free software,
12768 rather than
<quote>proprietary software,
</quote> for their own internal uses.
12771 I don't mean to enter that debate here. It is important only to
12772 make clear that the distinction is not between commercial and
12773 noncommercial software. There are many important companies that depend
12774 fundamentally upon open source and free software, IBM being the most
12775 prominent. IBM is increasingly shifting its focus to the GNU/Linux
12776 operating system, the most famous bit of
<quote>free software
</quote>—and IBM
12777 is emphatically a commercial entity. Thus, to support
<quote>open source and
12778 free software
</quote> is not to oppose commercial entities. It is, instead,
12779 to support a mode of software development that is different from
12780 Microsoft's.
<footnote><para>
12782 Microsoft's position about free and open source software is more
12783 sophisticated. As it has repeatedly asserted, it has no problem with
12784 <quote>open source
</quote> software or software in the public domain. Microsoft's
12785 principal opposition is to
<quote>free software
</quote> licensed under a
<quote>copyleft
</quote>
12786 license, meaning a license that requires the licensee to adopt the
12787 same terms on any derivative work. See Bradford L. Smith,
<quote>The Future
12788 of Software: Enabling the Marketplace to Decide,
</quote> <citetitle>Government Policy
12789 Toward Open Source Software
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.: AEI-Brookings Joint
12790 Center for Regulatory Studies, American Enterprise Institute for
12791 Public Policy Research,
2002),
69, available at
12792 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
62</ulink>. See also
12793 Craig Mundie, Microsoft senior vice president,
<citetitle>The Commercial Software
12794 Model
</citetitle>, discussion at New York University Stern School of Business (
3
12795 May
2001), available at
12796 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
63</ulink>.
12798 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
12799 <indexterm><primary><quote>copyleft
</quote> licenses
</primary></indexterm>
12800 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
12801 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
12804 More important for our purposes, to support
<quote>open source and free
12805 software
</quote> is not to oppose copyright.
<quote>Open source and free software
</quote>
12806 is not software in the public domain. Instead, like Microsoft's
12807 software, the copyright owners of free and open source software insist
12808 quite strongly that the terms of their software license be respected
12810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 272 -->
12811 adopters of free and open source software. The terms of that license
12812 are no doubt different from the terms of a proprietary software
12813 license. Free software licensed under the General Public License
12814 (GPL), for example, requires that the source code for the software be
12815 made available by anyone who modifies and redistributes the
12816 software. But that requirement is effective only if copyright governs
12817 software. If copyright did not govern software, then free software
12818 could not impose the same kind of requirements on its adopters. It
12819 thus depends upon copyright law just as Microsoft does.
12822 It is therefore understandable that as a proprietary software
12823 developer, Microsoft would oppose this WIPO meeting, and
12824 understandable that it would use its lobbyists to get the United
12825 States government to oppose it, as well. And indeed, that is just what
12826 was reported to have happened. According to Jonathan Krim of the
12827 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>, Microsoft's lobbyists succeeded in getting the United
12828 States government to veto the meeting.
<footnote><para>
12830 Krim,
<quote>The Quiet War over Open-Source,
</quote> available at
<ulink
12831 url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
64</ulink>.
12833 And without U.S. backing, the meeting was canceled.
12834 <indexterm><primary>Krim, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
12837 I don't blame Microsoft for doing what it can to advance its own
12838 interests, consistent with the law. And lobbying governments is
12839 plainly consistent with the law. There was nothing surprising about
12840 its lobbying here, and nothing terribly surprising about the most
12841 powerful software producer in the United States having succeeded in
12842 its lobbying efforts.
12845 What was surprising was the United States government's reason for
12846 opposing the meeting. Again, as reported by Krim, Lois Boland, acting
12847 director of international relations for the U.S. Patent and Trademark
12848 Office, explained that
<quote>open-source software runs counter to the
12849 mission of WIPO, which is to promote intellectual-property rights.
</quote>
12850 She is quoted as saying,
<quote>To hold a meeting which has as its purpose
12851 to disclaim or waive such rights seems to us to be contrary to the
12852 goals of WIPO.
</quote>
12855 These statements are astonishing on a number of levels.
12857 <!-- PAGE BREAK 273 -->
12859 First, they are just flat wrong. As I described, most open source and
12860 free software relies fundamentally upon the intellectual property
12861 right called
<quote>copyright
</quote>. Without it, restrictions imposed by those
12862 licenses wouldn't work. Thus, to say it
<quote>runs counter
</quote> to the mission
12863 of promoting intellectual property rights reveals an extraordinary gap
12864 in understanding
—the sort of mistake that is excusable in a
12865 first-year law student, but an embarrassment from a high government
12866 official dealing with intellectual property issues.
12869 Second, who ever said that WIPO's exclusive aim was to
<quote>promote
</quote>
12870 intellectual property maximally? As I had been scolded at the
12871 preparatory conference of WSIS, WIPO is to consider not only how best
12872 to protect intellectual property, but also what the best balance of
12873 intellectual property is. As every economist and lawyer knows, the
12874 hard question in intellectual property law is to find that
12875 balance. But that there should be limits is, I had thought,
12876 uncontested. One wants to ask Ms. Boland, are generic drugs (drugs
12877 based on drugs whose patent has expired) contrary to the WIPO mission?
12878 Does the public domain weaken intellectual property? Would it have
12879 been better if the protocols of the Internet had been patented?
12882 Third, even if one believed that the purpose of WIPO was to maximize
12883 intellectual property rights, in our tradition, intellectual property
12884 rights are held by individuals and corporations. They get to decide
12885 what to do with those rights because, again, they are
12886 <emphasis>their
</emphasis> rights. If they want to
<quote>waive
</quote> or
12887 <quote>disclaim
</quote> their rights, that is, within our tradition, totally
12888 appropriate. When Bill Gates gives away more than $
20 billion to do
12889 good in the world, that is not inconsistent with the objectives of the
12890 property system. That is, on the contrary, just what a property system
12891 is supposed to be about: giving individuals the right to decide what
12892 to do with
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> property.
12893 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
12896 When Ms. Boland says that there is something wrong with a meeting
12897 <quote>which has as its purpose to disclaim or waive such rights,
</quote> she's
12898 saying that WIPO has an interest in interfering with the choices of
12899 <!-- PAGE BREAK 274 -->
12900 the individuals who own intellectual property rights. That somehow,
12901 WIPO's objective should be to stop an individual from
<quote>waiving
</quote> or
12902 <quote>disclaiming
</quote> an intellectual property right. That the interest of
12903 WIPO is not just that intellectual property rights be maximized, but
12904 that they also should be exercised in the most extreme and restrictive
12908 There is a history of just such a property system that is well known
12909 in the Anglo-American tradition. It is called
<quote>feudalism.
</quote> Under
12910 feudalism, not only was property held by a relatively small number of
12911 individuals and entities. And not only were the rights that ran with
12912 that property powerful and extensive. But the feudal system had a
12913 strong interest in assuring that property holders within that system
12914 not weaken feudalism by liberating people or property within their
12915 control to the free market. Feudalism depended upon maximum control
12916 and concentration. It fought any freedom that might interfere with
12919 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12920 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12922 As Peter Drahos and John Braithwaite relate, this is precisely the
12923 choice we are now making about intellectual property.
<footnote><para>
12925 See Drahos with Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism
</citetitle>,
210–20.
12926 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12928 We will have an information society. That much is certain. Our only
12929 choice now is whether that information society will be
12930 <emphasis>free
</emphasis> or
<emphasis>feudal
</emphasis>. The trend is
12934 When this battle broke, I blogged it. A spirited debate within the
12935 comment section ensued. Ms. Boland had a number of supporters who
12936 tried to show why her comments made sense. But there was one comment
12937 that was particularly depressing for me. An anonymous poster wrote,
12941 George, you misunderstand Lessig: He's only talking about the world as
12942 it should be (
<quote>the goal of WIPO, and the goal of any government,
12943 should be to promote the right balance of intellectual property rights,
12944 not simply to promote intellectual property rights
</quote>), not as it is. If
12945 we were talking about the world as it is, then of course Boland didn't
12946 say anything wrong. But in the world
12947 <!-- PAGE BREAK 275 -->
12948 as Lessig would have it, then of course she did. Always pay attention
12949 to the distinction between Lessig's world and ours.
12953 I missed the irony the first time I read it. I read it quickly and
12954 thought the poster was supporting the idea that seeking balance was
12955 what our government should be doing. (Of course, my criticism of Ms.
12956 Boland was not about whether she was seeking balance or not; my
12957 criticism was that her comments betrayed a first-year law student's
12958 mistake. I have no illusion about the extremism of our government,
12959 whether Republican or Democrat. My only illusion apparently is about
12960 whether our government should speak the truth or not.)
12963 Obviously, however, the poster was not supporting that idea. Instead,
12964 the poster was ridiculing the very idea that in the real world, the
12965 <quote>goal
</quote> of a government should be
<quote>to promote the right balance
</quote> of
12966 intellectual property. That was obviously silly to him. And it
12967 obviously betrayed, he believed, my own silly utopianism.
<quote>Typical for
12968 an academic,
</quote> the poster might well have continued.
12971 I understand criticism of academic utopianism. I think utopianism is
12972 silly, too, and I'd be the first to poke fun at the absurdly
12973 unrealistic ideals of academics throughout history (and not just in
12974 our own country's history).
12977 But when it has become silly to suppose that the role of our
12978 government should be to
<quote>seek balance,
</quote> then count me with the silly,
12979 for that means that this has become quite serious indeed. If it should
12980 be obvious to everyone that the government does not seek balance, that
12981 the government is simply the tool of the most powerful lobbyists, that
12982 the idea of holding the government to a different standard is absurd,
12983 that the idea of demanding of the government that it speak truth and
12984 not lies is just na
ïve, then who have we, the most powerful
12985 democracy in the world, become?
12988 It might be crazy to expect a high government official to speak
12989 the truth. It might be crazy to believe that government policy will be
12990 something more than the handmaiden of the most powerful interests.
12991 <!-- PAGE BREAK 276 -->
12992 It might be crazy to argue that we should preserve a tradition that has
12993 been part of our tradition for most of our history
—free culture.
12995 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
12997 If this is crazy, then let there be more crazies. Soon. There are
12998 moments of hope in this struggle. And moments that surprise. When the
12999 FCC was considering relaxing ownership rules, which would thereby
13000 further increase the concentration in media ownership, an
13001 extraordinary bipartisan coalition formed to fight this change. For
13002 perhaps the first time in history, interests as diverse as the NRA,
13003 the ACLU, Moveon.org, William Safire, Ted Turner, and CodePink Women
13004 for Peace organized to oppose this change in FCC policy. An
13005 astonishing
700,
000 letters were sent to the FCC, demanding more
13006 hearings and a different result.
13007 <indexterm><primary>Turner, Ted
</primary></indexterm>
13008 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
13011 This activism did not stop the FCC, but soon after, a broad coalition
13012 in the Senate voted to reverse the FCC decision. The hostile hearings
13013 leading up to that vote revealed just how powerful this movement had
13014 become. There was no substantial support for the FCC's decision, and
13015 there was broad and sustained support for fighting further
13016 concentration in the media.
13019 But even this movement misses an important piece of the puzzle.
13020 Largeness as such is not bad. Freedom is not threatened just because
13021 some become very rich, or because there are only a handful of big
13022 players. The poor quality of Big Macs or Quarter Pounders does not
13023 mean that you can't get a good hamburger from somewhere else.
13026 The danger in media concentration comes not from the concentration,
13027 but instead from the feudalism that this concentration, tied to the
13028 change in copyright, produces. It is not just that there are a few
13029 powerful companies that control an ever expanding slice of the
13030 media. It is that this concentration can call upon an equally bloated
13031 range of rights
—property rights of a historically extreme
13032 form
—that makes their bigness bad.
13034 <!-- PAGE BREAK 277 -->
13036 It is therefore significant that so many would rally to demand
13037 competition and increased diversity. Still, if the rally is understood
13038 as being about bigness alone, it is not terribly surprising. We
13039 Americans have a long history of fighting
<quote>big,
</quote> wisely or not. That
13040 we could be motivated to fight
<quote>big
</quote> again is not something new.
13043 It would be something new, and something very important, if an equal
13044 number could be rallied to fight the increasing extremism built within
13045 the idea of
<quote>intellectual property.
</quote> Not because balance is alien to
13046 our tradition; indeed, as I've argued, balance is our tradition. But
13047 because the muscle to think critically about the scope of anything
13048 called
<quote>property
</quote> is not well exercised within this tradition anymore.
13051 If we were Achilles, this would be our heel. This would be the place
13054 <indexterm><primary>Dylan, Bob
</primary></indexterm>
13056 As I write these final words, the news is filled with stories about
13057 the RIAA lawsuits against almost three hundred individuals.
<footnote><para>
13059 John Borland,
<quote>RIAA Sues
261 File Swappers,
</quote> CNET News.com, September
13061 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
65</ulink>; Paul
13062 R. La Monica,
<quote>Music Industry Sues Swappers,
</quote> CNN/Money,
8 September
13064 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
66</ulink>; Soni
13065 Sangha and Phyllis Furman with Robert Gearty,
<quote>Sued for a Song,
13066 N.Y.C.
12-Yr-Old Among
261 Cited as Sharers,
</quote> <citetitle>New York Daily News
</citetitle>,
9
13067 September
2003,
3; Frank Ahrens,
<quote>RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised
13068 Targets; Single Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among
13069 Defendants,
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Katie Dean,
13070 <quote>Schoolgirl Settles with RIAA,
</quote> <citetitle>Wired News
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003,
13072 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
67</ulink>.
13074 Eminem has just been sued for
<quote>sampling
</quote> someone else's
13075 music.
<footnote><para>
13077 Jon Wiederhorn,
<quote>Eminem Gets Sued
… by a Little Old Lady,
</quote>
13078 mtv.com,
17 September
2003, available at
13079 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
68</ulink>.
13081 The story about Bob Dylan
<quote>stealing
</quote> from a Japanese author has just
13082 finished making the rounds.
<footnote><para>
13084 Kenji Hall, Associated Press,
<quote>Japanese Book May Be Inspiration for
13085 Dylan Songs,
</quote> Kansascity.com,
9 July
2003, available at
13086 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
69</ulink>.
13087 <!-- PAGE BREAK 334 -->
13089 An insider from Hollywood
—who insists he must remain
13090 anonymous
—reports
<quote>an amazing conversation with these studio
13091 guys. They've got extraordinary [old] content that they'd love to use
13092 but can't because they can't begin to clear the rights. They've got
13093 scores of kids who could do amazing things with the content, but it
13094 would take scores of lawyers to clean it first.
</quote> Congressmen are
13095 talking about deputizing computer viruses to bring down computers
13096 thought to violate the law. Universities are threatening expulsion for
13097 kids who use a computer to share content.
13099 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
13100 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
13101 <indexterm><primary>Creative Commons
</primary></indexterm>
13102 <indexterm><primary>Gil, Gilberto
</primary></indexterm>
13104 Yet on the other side of the Atlantic, the BBC has just announced
13105 that it will build a
<quote>Creative Archive,
</quote> from which British citizens can
13106 download BBC content, and rip, mix, and burn it.
<footnote><para>
13107 <!-- f14. --> <quote>BBC Plans to Open Up Its Archive to the Public,
</quote> BBC press release,
13108 24 August
2003, available at
13109 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
70</ulink>.
13111 And in Brazil, the culture minister, Gilberto Gil, himself a folk hero
13112 of Brazilian music, has joined with Creative Commons to release
13113 content and free licenses in that Latin American
13114 country.
<footnote><para>
13116 <quote>Creative Commons and Brazil,
</quote> Creative Commons Weblog,
6 August
2003,
13118 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
71</ulink>.
13120 <!-- PAGE BREAK 278 -->
13121 I've told a dark story. The truth is more mixed. A technology has
13122 given us a new freedom. Slowly, some begin to understand that this
13123 freedom need not mean anarchy. We can carry a free culture into the
13124 twenty-first century, without artists losing and without the potential of
13125 digital technology being destroyed. It will take some thought, and
13126 more importantly, it will take some will to transform the RCAs of our
13127 day into the Causbys.
13130 Common sense must revolt. It must act to free culture. Soon, if this
13131 potential is ever to be realized.
13133 <!-- PAGE BREAK 279 -->
13137 <chapter label=
"16" id=
"c-afterword">
13138 <title>AFTERWORD
</title>
13141 <!-- PAGE BREAK 280 -->
13142 At least some who have read this far will agree with me that something
13143 must be done to change where we are heading. The balance of this book
13144 maps what might be done.
13147 I divide this map into two parts: that which anyone can do now,
13148 and that which requires the help of lawmakers. If there is one lesson
13149 that we can draw from the history of remaking common sense, it is that
13150 it requires remaking how many people think about the very same issue.
13153 That means this movement must begin in the streets. It must recruit a
13154 significant number of parents, teachers, librarians, creators,
13155 authors, musicians, filmmakers, scientists
—all to tell this
13156 story in their own words, and to tell their neighbors why this battle
13160 Once this movement has its effect in the streets, it has some hope of
13161 having an effect in Washington. We are still a democracy. What people
13162 think matters. Not as much as it should, at least when an RCA stands
13163 opposed, but still, it matters. And thus, in the second part below, I
13164 sketch changes that Congress could make to better secure a free culture.
13166 <!-- PAGE BREAK 281 -->
13168 <section id=
"usnow">
13169 <title>US, NOW
</title>
13171 Common sense is with the copyright warriors because the debate so far
13172 has been framed at the extremes
—as a grand either/or: either
13173 property or anarchy, either total control or artists won't be paid. If
13174 that really is the choice, then the warriors should win.
13177 The mistake here is the error of the excluded middle. There are
13178 extremes in this debate, but the extremes are not all that there
13179 is. There are those who believe in maximal copyright
—<quote>All Rights
13180 Reserved
</quote>— and those who reject copyright
—<quote>No Rights
13181 Reserved.
</quote> The
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts believe that you should ask
13182 permission before you
<quote>use
</quote> a copyrighted work in any way. The
<quote>No
13183 Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts believe you should be able to do with content
13184 as you wish, regardless of whether you have permission or not.
13187 When the Internet was first born, its initial architecture effectively
13188 tilted in the
<quote>no rights reserved
</quote> direction. Content could be copied
13189 perfectly and cheaply; rights could not easily be controlled. Thus,
13190 regardless of anyone's desire, the effective regime of copyright under
13193 <!-- PAGE BREAK 282 -->
13194 original design of the Internet was
<quote>no rights reserved.
</quote> Content was
13195 <quote>taken
</quote> regardless of the rights. Any rights were effectively
13199 This initial character produced a reaction (opposite, but not quite
13200 equal) by copyright owners. That reaction has been the topic of this
13201 book. Through legislation, litigation, and changes to the network's
13202 design, copyright holders have been able to change the essential
13203 character of the environment of the original Internet. If the original
13204 architecture made the effective default
<quote>no rights reserved,
</quote> the
13205 future architecture will make the effective default
<quote>all rights
13206 reserved.
</quote> The architecture and law that surround the Internet's
13207 design will increasingly produce an environment where all use of
13208 content requires permission. The
<quote>cut and paste
</quote> world that defines
13209 the Internet today will become a
<quote>get permission to cut and paste
</quote>
13210 world that is a creator's nightmare.
13213 What's needed is a way to say something in the middle
—neither
13214 <quote>all rights reserved
</quote> nor
<quote>no rights reserved
</quote> but
<quote>some rights
13215 reserved
</quote>— and thus a way to respect copyrights but enable
13216 creators to free content as they see fit. In other words, we need a
13217 way to restore a set of freedoms that we could just take for granted
13221 <section id=
"examples">
13222 <title>Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
</title>
13224 If you step back from the battle I've been describing here, you will
13225 recognize this problem from other contexts. Think about
13226 privacy. Before the Internet, most of us didn't have to worry much
13227 about data about our lives that we broadcast to the world. If you
13228 walked into a bookstore and browsed through some of the works of Karl
13229 Marx, you didn't need to worry about explaining your browsing habits
13230 to your neighbors or boss. The
<quote>privacy
</quote> of your browsing habits was
13234 What made it assured?
13236 <!-- PAGE BREAK 283 -->
13238 Well, if we think in terms of the modalities I described in chapter
13239 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"property-i"/>, your
13240 privacy was assured because of an inefficient architecture for
13241 gathering data and hence a market constraint (cost) on anyone who
13242 wanted to gather that data. If you were a suspected spy for North
13243 Korea, working for the CIA, no doubt your privacy would not be
13244 assured. But that's because the CIA would (we hope) find it valuable
13245 enough to spend the thousands required to track you. But for most of
13246 us (again, we can hope), spying doesn't pay. The highly inefficient
13247 architecture of real space means we all enjoy a fairly robust amount
13248 of privacy. That privacy is guaranteed to us by friction. Not by law
13249 (there is no law protecting
<quote>privacy
</quote> in public places), and in many
13250 places, not by norms (snooping and gossip are just fun), but instead,
13251 by the costs that friction imposes on anyone who would want to spy.
13253 <indexterm><primary>Amazon
</primary></indexterm>
13255 Enter the Internet, where the cost of tracking browsing in particular
13256 has become quite tiny. If you're a customer at Amazon, then as you
13257 browse the pages, Amazon collects the data about what you've looked
13258 at. You know this because at the side of the page, there's a list of
13259 <quote>recently viewed
</quote> pages. Now, because of the architecture of the Net
13260 and the function of cookies on the Net, it is easier to collect the
13261 data than not. The friction has disappeared, and hence any
<quote>privacy
</quote>
13262 protected by the friction disappears, too.
13263 <indexterm><primary>cookies, Internet
</primary></indexterm>
13266 Amazon, of course, is not the problem. But we might begin to worry
13267 about libraries. If you're one of those crazy lefties who thinks that
13268 people should have the
<quote>right
</quote> to browse in a library without the
13269 government knowing which books you look at (I'm one of those lefties,
13270 too), then this change in the technology of monitoring might concern
13271 you. If it becomes simple to gather and sort who does what in
13272 electronic spaces, then the friction-induced privacy of yesterday
13276 It is this reality that explains the push of many to define
<quote>privacy
</quote>
13277 on the Internet. It is the recognition that technology can remove what
13278 friction before gave us that leads many to push for laws to do what
13279 friction did.
<footnote><para>
13282 See, for example, Marc Rotenberg,
<quote>Fair Information Practices and the
13283 Architecture of Privacy (What Larry Doesn't Get),
</quote> <citetitle>Stanford Technology
13284 Law Review
</citetitle> 1 (
2001): par.
6–18, available at
13286 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>
13287 (describing examples in which technology defines privacy policy). See
13288 also Jeffrey Rosen,
<citetitle>The Naked Crowd: Reclaiming Security and Freedom
13289 in an Anxious Age
</citetitle> (New York: Random House,
2004) (mapping tradeoffs
13290 between technology and privacy).
</para></footnote>
13291 And whether you're in favor of those laws or not, it is the pattern
13292 that is important here. We must take affirmative steps to secure a
13294 <!-- PAGE BREAK 284 -->
13295 kind of freedom that was passively provided before. A change in
13296 technology now forces those who believe in privacy to affirmatively
13297 act where, before, privacy was given by default.
13300 A similar story could be told about the birth of the free software
13301 movement. When computers with software were first made available
13302 commercially, the software
—both the source code and the
13303 binaries
— was free. You couldn't run a program written for a
13304 Data General machine on an IBM machine, so Data General and IBM didn't
13305 care much about controlling their software.
13306 <indexterm><primary>IBM
</primary></indexterm>
13308 <indexterm><primary>Stallman, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
13310 That was the world Richard Stallman was born into, and while he was a
13311 researcher at MIT, he grew to love the community that developed when
13312 one was free to explore and tinker with the software that ran on
13313 machines. Being a smart sort himself, and a talented programmer,
13314 Stallman grew to depend upon the freedom to add to or modify other
13318 In an academic setting, at least, that's not a terribly radical
13319 idea. In a math department, anyone would be free to tinker with a
13320 proof that someone offered. If you thought you had a better way to
13321 prove a theorem, you could take what someone else did and change
13322 it. In a classics department, if you believed a colleague's
13323 translation of a recently discovered text was flawed, you were free to
13324 improve it. Thus, to Stallman, it seemed obvious that you should be
13325 free to tinker with and improve the code that ran a machine. This,
13326 too, was knowledge. Why shouldn't it be open for criticism like
13330 No one answered that question. Instead, the architecture of revenue
13331 for computing changed. As it became possible to import programs from
13332 one system to another, it became economically attractive (at least in
13333 the view of some) to hide the code of your program. So, too, as
13334 companies started selling peripherals for mainframe systems. If I
13335 could just take your printer driver and copy it, then that would make
13336 it easier for me to sell a printer to the market than it was for you.
13339 Thus, the practice of proprietary code began to spread, and by the
13340 early
1980s, Stallman found himself surrounded by proprietary code.
13341 <!-- PAGE BREAK 285 -->
13342 The world of free software had been erased by a change in the
13343 economics of computing. And as he believed, if he did nothing about
13344 it, then the freedom to change and share software would be
13345 fundamentally weakened.
13348 Therefore, in
1984, Stallman began a project to build a free operating
13349 system, so that at least a strain of free software would survive. That
13350 was the birth of the GNU project, into which Linus Torvalds's
<quote>Linux
</quote>
13351 kernel was added to produce the GNU/Linux operating system.
13352 <indexterm><primary>GNU/Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
13353 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
13356 Stallman's technique was to use copyright law to build a world of
13357 software that must be kept free. Software licensed under the Free
13358 Software Foundation's GPL cannot be modified and distributed unless
13359 the source code for that software is made available as well. Thus,
13360 anyone building upon GPL'd software would have to make their buildings
13361 free as well. This would assure, Stallman believed, that an ecology of
13362 code would develop that remained free for others to build upon. His
13363 fundamental goal was freedom; innovative creative code was a
13367 Stallman was thus doing for software what privacy advocates now
13368 do for privacy. He was seeking a way to rebuild a kind of freedom that
13369 was taken for granted before. Through the affirmative use of licenses
13370 that bind copyrighted code, Stallman was affirmatively reclaiming a
13371 space where free software would survive. He was actively protecting
13372 what before had been passively guaranteed.
13375 Finally, consider a very recent example that more directly resonates
13376 with the story of this book. This is the shift in the way academic and
13377 scientific journals are produced.
13379 <indexterm id=
"idxacademocjournals" class='startofrange'
>
13380 <primary>academic journals
</primary>
13383 As digital technologies develop, it is becoming obvious to many that
13384 printing thousands of copies of journals every month and sending them
13385 to libraries is perhaps not the most efficient way to distribute
13386 knowledge. Instead, journals are increasingly becoming electronic, and
13387 libraries and their users are given access to these electronic
13388 journals through password-protected sites. Something similar to this
13389 has been happening in law for almost thirty years: Lexis and Westlaw
13390 have had electronic versions of case reports available to subscribers
13391 to their service. Although a Supreme Court opinion is not
13392 copyrighted, and anyone is free to go to a library and read it, Lexis
13393 and Westlaw are also free
13394 <!-- PAGE BREAK 286 -->
13395 to charge users for the privilege of gaining access to that Supreme
13396 Court opinion through their respective services.
13399 There's nothing wrong in general with this, and indeed, the ability to
13400 charge for access to even public domain materials is a good incentive
13401 for people to develop new and innovative ways to spread knowledge.
13402 The law has agreed, which is why Lexis and Westlaw have been allowed
13403 to flourish. And if there's nothing wrong with selling the public
13404 domain, then there could be nothing wrong, in principle, with selling
13405 access to material that is not in the public domain.
13408 But what if the only way to get access to social and scientific data
13409 was through proprietary services? What if no one had the ability to
13410 browse this data except by paying for a subscription?
13413 As many are beginning to notice, this is increasingly the reality with
13414 scientific journals. When these journals were distributed in paper
13415 form, libraries could make the journals available to anyone who had
13416 access to the library. Thus, patients with cancer could become cancer
13417 experts because the library gave them access. Or patients trying to
13418 understand the risks of a certain treatment could research those risks
13419 by reading all available articles about that treatment. This freedom
13420 was therefore a function of the institution of libraries (norms) and
13421 the technology of paper journals (architecture)
—namely, that it
13422 was very hard to control access to a paper journal.
13425 As journals become electronic, however, the publishers are demanding
13426 that libraries not give the general public access to the
13427 journals. This means that the freedoms provided by print journals in
13428 public libraries begin to disappear. Thus, as with privacy and with
13429 software, a changing technology and market shrink a freedom taken for
13433 This shrinking freedom has led many to take affirmative steps to
13434 restore the freedom that has been lost. The Public Library of Science
13435 (PLoS), for example, is a nonprofit corporation dedicated to making
13436 scientific research available to anyone with a Web connection. Authors
13437 <!-- PAGE BREAK 287 -->
13438 of scientific work submit that work to the Public Library of Science.
13439 That work is then subject to peer review. If accepted, the work is
13440 then deposited in a public, electronic archive and made permanently
13441 available for free. PLoS also sells a print version of its work, but
13442 the copyright for the print journal does not inhibit the right of
13443 anyone to redistribute the work for free.
13444 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
13447 This is one of many such efforts to restore a freedom taken for
13448 granted before, but now threatened by changing technology and markets.
13449 There's no doubt that this alternative competes with the traditional
13450 publishers and their efforts to make money from the exclusive
13451 distribution of content. But competition in our tradition is
13452 presumptively a good
—especially when it helps spread knowledge
13455 <indexterm startref=
"idxacademocjournals" class='endofrange'
/>
13458 <section id=
"oneidea">
13459 <title>Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
</title>
13460 <indexterm id=
"idxcc" class='startofrange'
>
13461 <primary>Creative Commons
</primary>
13464 The same strategy could be applied to culture, as a response to the
13465 increasing control effected through law and technology.
13468 Enter the Creative Commons. The Creative Commons is a nonprofit
13469 corporation established in Massachusetts, but with its home at
13470 Stanford University. Its aim is to build a layer of
13471 <emphasis>reasonable
</emphasis> copyright on top of the extremes that
13472 now reign. It does this by making it easy for people to build upon
13473 other people's work, by making it simple for creators to express the
13474 freedom for others to take and build upon their work. Simple tags,
13475 tied to human-readable descriptions, tied to bulletproof licenses,
13476 make this possible.
13479 <emphasis>Simple
</emphasis>—which means without a middleman, or
13480 without a lawyer. By developing a free set of licenses that people
13481 can attach to their content, Creative Commons aims to mark a range of
13482 content that can easily, and reliably, be built upon. These tags are
13483 then linked to machine-readable versions of the license that enable
13484 computers automatically to identify content that can easily be
13485 shared. These three expressions together
—a legal license, a
13486 human-readable description, and
13487 <!-- PAGE BREAK 288 -->
13488 machine-readable tags
—constitute a Creative Commons license. A
13489 Creative Commons license constitutes a grant of freedom to anyone who
13490 accesses the license, and more importantly, an expression of the ideal
13491 that the person associated with the license believes in something
13492 different than the
<quote>All
</quote> or
<quote>No
</quote> extremes. Content is marked with the
13493 CC mark, which does not mean that copyright is waived, but that
13494 certain freedoms are given.
13497 These freedoms are beyond the freedoms promised by fair use. Their
13498 precise contours depend upon the choices the creator makes. The
13499 creator can choose a license that permits any use, so long as
13500 attribution is given. She can choose a license that permits only
13501 noncommercial use. She can choose a license that permits any use so
13502 long as the same freedoms are given to other uses (
<quote>share and share
13503 alike
</quote>). Or any use so long as no derivative use is made. Or any use
13504 at all within developing nations. Or any sampling use, so long as full
13505 copies are not made. Or lastly, any educational use.
13508 These choices thus establish a range of freedoms beyond the default of
13509 copyright law. They also enable freedoms that go beyond traditional
13510 fair use. And most importantly, they express these freedoms in a way
13511 that subsequent users can use and rely upon without the need to hire a
13512 lawyer. Creative Commons thus aims to build a layer of content,
13513 governed by a layer of reasonable copyright law, that others can build
13514 upon. Voluntary choice of individuals and creators will make this
13515 content available. And that content will in turn enable us to rebuild
13519 This is just one project among many within the Creative Commons. And
13520 of course, Creative Commons is not the only organization pursuing such
13521 freedoms. But the point that distinguishes the Creative Commons from
13522 many is that we are not interested only in talking about a public
13523 domain or in getting legislators to help build a public domain. Our
13524 aim is to build a movement of consumers and producers
13525 <!-- PAGE BREAK 289 -->
13526 of content (
<quote>content conducers,
</quote> as attorney Mia Garlick calls them)
13527 who help build the public domain and, by their work, demonstrate the
13528 importance of the public domain to other creativity.
13529 <indexterm><primary>Garlick, Mia
</primary></indexterm>
13532 The aim is not to fight the
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote> sorts. The aim is to
13533 complement them. The problems that the law creates for us as a culture
13534 are produced by insane and unintended consequences of laws written
13535 centuries ago, applied to a technology that only Jefferson could have
13536 imagined. The rules may well have made sense against a background of
13537 technologies from centuries ago, but they do not make sense against
13538 the background of digital technologies. New rules
—with different
13539 freedoms, expressed in ways so that humans without lawyers can use
13540 them
—are needed. Creative Commons gives people a way effectively
13541 to begin to build those rules.
13544 Why would creators participate in giving up total control? Some
13545 participate to better spread their content. Cory Doctorow, for
13546 example, is a science fiction author. His first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
13547 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, was released on-line and for free, under a Creative
13548 Commons license, on the same day that it went on sale in bookstores.
13551 Why would a publisher ever agree to this? I suspect his publisher
13552 reasoned like this: There are two groups of people out there: (
1)
13553 those who will buy Cory's book whether or not it's on the Internet,
13554 and (
2) those who may never hear of Cory's book, if it isn't made
13555 available for free on the Internet. Some part of (
1) will download
13556 Cory's book instead of buying it. Call them bad-(
1)s. Some part of (
2)
13557 will download Cory's book, like it, and then decide to buy it. Call
13558 them (
2)-goods. If there are more (
2)-goods than bad-(
1)s, the
13559 strategy of releasing Cory's book free on-line will probably
13560 <emphasis>increase
</emphasis> sales of Cory's book.
13563 Indeed, the experience of his publisher clearly supports that
13564 conclusion. The book's first printing was exhausted months before the
13565 publisher had expected. This first novel of a science fiction author
13566 was a total success.
13569 The idea that free content might increase the value of nonfree content
13570 was confirmed by the experience of another author. Peter Wayner,
13571 <!-- PAGE BREAK 290 -->
13572 who wrote a book about the free software movement titled
<citetitle>Free for All
</citetitle>,
13573 made an electronic version of his book free on-line under a Creative
13574 Commons license after the book went out of print. He then monitored
13575 used book store prices for the book. As predicted, as the number of
13576 downloads increased, the used book price for his book increased, as
13578 <indexterm><primary>Free for All (Wayner)
</primary></indexterm>
13579 <indexterm><primary>Wayner, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
13581 <indexterm><primary>Public Enemy
</primary></indexterm>
13582 <indexterm><primary>rap music
</primary></indexterm>
13584 These are examples of using the Commons to better spread proprietary
13585 content. I believe that is a wonderful and common use of the
13586 Commons. There are others who use Creative Commons licenses for other
13587 reasons. Many who use the
<quote>sampling license
</quote> do so because anything
13588 else would be hypocritical. The sampling license says that others are
13589 free, for commercial or noncommercial purposes, to sample content from
13590 the licensed work; they are just not free to make full copies of the
13591 licensed work available to others. This is consistent with their own
13592 art
—they, too, sample from others. Because the
13593 <emphasis>legal
</emphasis> costs of sampling are so high (Walter
13594 Leaphart, manager of the rap group Public Enemy, which was born
13595 sampling the music of others, has stated that he does not
<quote>allow
</quote>
13596 Public Enemy to sample anymore, because the legal costs are so
13597 high
<footnote><para>
13599 <citetitle>Willful Infringement: A Report from the Front Lines of the Real
13600 Culture Wars
</citetitle> (
2003), produced by Jed Horovitz, directed by Greg
13601 Hittelman, a Fiat Lucre production, available at
13602 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>.
13603 </para></footnote>),
13604 these artists release into the creative environment content
13605 that others can build upon, so that their form of creativity might grow.
13606 <indexterm><primary>Leaphart, Walter
</primary></indexterm>
13609 Finally, there are many who mark their content with a Creative Commons
13610 license just because they want to express to others the importance of
13611 balance in this debate. If you just go along with the system as it is,
13612 you are effectively saying you believe in the
<quote>All Rights Reserved
</quote>
13613 model. Good for you, but many do not. Many believe that however
13614 appropriate that rule is for Hollywood and freaks, it is not an
13615 appropriate description of how most creators view the rights
13616 associated with their content. The Creative Commons license expresses
13617 this notion of
<quote>Some Rights Reserved,
</quote> and gives many the chance to
13621 In the first six months of the Creative Commons experiment, over
13622 1 million objects were licensed with these free-culture licenses. The next
13623 step is partnerships with middleware content providers to help them
13624 build into their technologies simple ways for users to mark their content
13626 <!-- PAGE BREAK 291 -->
13627 with Creative Commons freedoms. Then the next step is to watch and
13628 celebrate creators who build content based upon content set free.
13631 These are first steps to rebuilding a public domain. They are not
13632 mere arguments; they are action. Building a public domain is the first
13633 step to showing people how important that domain is to creativity and
13634 innovation. Creative Commons relies upon voluntary steps to achieve
13635 this rebuilding. They will lead to a world in which more than voluntary
13636 steps are possible.
13639 Creative Commons is just one example of voluntary efforts by
13640 individuals and creators to change the mix of rights that now govern
13641 the creative field. The project does not compete with copyright; it
13642 complements it. Its aim is not to defeat the rights of authors, but to
13643 make it easier for authors and creators to exercise their rights more
13644 flexibly and cheaply. That difference, we believe, will enable
13645 creativity to spread more easily.
13647 <indexterm startref=
"idxcc" class='endofrange'
/>
13649 <!-- PAGE BREAK 292 -->
13652 <section id=
"themsoon">
13653 <title>THEM, SOON
</title>
13655 We will not reclaim a free culture by individual action alone. It will
13656 also take important reforms of laws. We have a long way to go before
13657 the politicians will listen to these ideas and implement these reforms.
13658 But that also means that we have time to build awareness around the
13659 changes that we need.
13662 In this chapter, I outline five kinds of changes: four that are general,
13663 and one that's specific to the most heated battle of the day, music. Each
13664 is a step, not an end. But any of these steps would carry us a long way
13668 <section id=
"formalities">
13669 <title>1. More Formalities
</title>
13671 If you buy a house, you have to record the sale in a deed. If you buy land
13672 upon which to build a house, you have to record the purchase in a deed.
13673 If you buy a car, you get a bill of sale and register the car. If you buy an
13674 airplane ticket, it has your name on it.
13677 <!-- PAGE BREAK 293 -->
13678 These are all formalities associated with property. They are
13679 requirements that we all must bear if we want our property to be
13683 In contrast, under current copyright law, you automatically get a
13684 copyright, regardless of whether you comply with any formality. You
13685 don't have to register. You don't even have to mark your content. The
13686 default is control, and
<quote>formalities
</quote> are banished.
13692 As I suggested in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
13693 linkend=
"property-i"/>, the motivation to abolish formalities was a
13694 good one. In the world before digital technologies, formalities
13695 imposed a burden on copyright holders without much benefit. Thus, it
13696 was progress when the law relaxed the formal requirements that a
13697 copyright owner must bear to protect and secure his work. Those
13698 formalities were getting in the way.
13701 But the Internet changes all this. Formalities today need not be a
13702 burden. Rather, the world without formalities is the world that
13703 burdens creativity. Today, there is no simple way to know who owns
13704 what, or with whom one must deal in order to use or build upon the
13705 creative work of others. There are no records, there is no system to
13706 trace
— there is no simple way to know how to get permission. Yet
13707 given the massive increase in the scope of copyright's rule, getting
13708 permission is a necessary step for any work that builds upon our
13709 past. And thus, the
<emphasis>lack
</emphasis> of formalities forces
13710 many into silence where they otherwise could speak.
13713 The law should therefore change this requirement
<footnote><para>
13715 The proposal I am advancing here would apply to American works only.
13716 Obviously, I believe it would be beneficial for the same idea to be
13717 adopted by other countries as well.
</para></footnote>—but it
13718 should not change it by going back to the old, broken system. We
13719 should require formalities, but we should establish a system that will
13720 create the incentives to minimize the burden of these formalities.
13723 The important formalities are three: marking copyrighted work,
13724 registering copyrights, and renewing the claim to
13725 copyright. Traditionally, the first of these three was something the
13726 copyright owner did; the second two were something the government
13727 did. But a revised system of formalities would banish the government
13728 from the process, except for the sole purpose of approving standards
13729 developed by others.
13732 <!-- PAGE BREAK 294 -->
13734 <section id=
"registration">
13735 <title>REGISTRATION AND RENEWAL
</title>
13737 Under the old system, a copyright owner had to file a registration
13738 with the Copyright Office to register or renew a copyright. When
13739 filing that registration, the copyright owner paid a fee. As with most
13740 government agencies, the Copyright Office had little incentive to
13741 minimize the burden of registration; it also had little incentive to
13742 minimize the fee. And as the Copyright Office is not a main target of
13743 government policymaking, the office has historically been terribly
13744 underfunded. Thus, when people who know something about the process
13745 hear this idea about formalities, their first reaction is
13746 panic
—nothing could be worse than forcing people to deal with
13747 the mess that is the Copyright Office.
13750 Yet it is always astonishing to me that we, who come from a tradition
13751 of extraordinary innovation in governmental design, can no longer
13752 think innovatively about how governmental functions can be designed.
13753 Just because there is a public purpose to a government role, it
13754 doesn't follow that the government must actually administer the
13755 role. Instead, we should be creating incentives for private parties to
13756 serve the public, subject to standards that the government sets.
13759 In the context of registration, one obvious model is the Internet.
13760 There are at least
32 million Web sites registered around the world.
13761 Domain name owners for these Web sites have to pay a fee to keep their
13762 registration alive. In the main top-level domains (.com, .org, .net),
13763 there is a central registry. The actual registrations are, however,
13764 performed by many competing registrars. That competition drives the
13765 cost of registering down, and more importantly, it drives the ease
13766 with which registration occurs up.
13769 We should adopt a similar model for the registration and renewal of
13770 copyrights. The Copyright Office may well serve as the central
13771 registry, but it should not be in the registrar business. Instead, it
13772 should establish a database, and a set of standards for registrars. It
13773 should approve registrars that meet its standards. Those registrars
13774 would then compete with one another to deliver the cheapest and
13775 simplest systems for registering and renewing copyrights. That
13776 competition would substantially lower the burden of this
13777 formality
—while producing a database
13778 <!-- PAGE BREAK 295 -->
13779 of registrations that would facilitate the licensing of content.
13783 <section id=
"marking">
13784 <title>MARKING
</title>
13786 It used to be that the failure to include a copyright notice on a
13787 creative work meant that the copyright was forfeited. That was a harsh
13788 punishment for failing to comply with a regulatory rule
—akin to
13789 imposing the death penalty for a parking ticket in the world of
13790 creative rights. Here again, there is no reason that a marking
13791 requirement needs to be enforced in this way. And more importantly,
13792 there is no reason a marking requirement needs to be enforced
13793 uniformly across all media.
13796 The aim of marking is to signal to the public that this work is
13797 copyrighted and that the author wants to enforce his rights. The mark
13798 also makes it easy to locate a copyright owner to secure permission to
13802 One of the problems the copyright system confronted early on was
13803 that different copyrighted works had to be differently marked. It wasn't
13804 clear how or where a statue was to be marked, or a record, or a film. A
13805 new marking requirement could solve these problems by recognizing
13806 the differences in media, and by allowing the system of marking to
13807 evolve as technologies enable it to. The system could enable a special
13808 signal from the failure to mark
—not the loss of the copyright, but the
13809 loss of the right to punish someone for failing to get permission first.
13812 Let's start with the last point. If a copyright owner allows his work
13813 to be published without a copyright notice, the consequence of that
13814 failure need not be that the copyright is lost. The consequence could
13815 instead be that anyone has the right to use this work, until the
13816 copyright owner complains and demonstrates that it is his work and he
13817 doesn't give permission.
<footnote><para>
13819 There would be a complication with derivative works that I have not
13820 solved here. In my view, the law of derivatives creates a more complicated
13821 system than is justified by the marginal incentive it creates.
13823 The meaning of an unmarked work would therefore be
<quote>use unless someone
13824 complains.
</quote> If someone does complain, then the obligation would be to
13825 stop using the work in any new
13826 <!-- PAGE BREAK 296 -->
13827 work from then on though no penalty would attach for existing uses.
13828 This would create a strong incentive for copyright owners to mark
13832 That in turn raises the question about how work should best be
13833 marked. Here again, the system needs to adjust as the technologies
13834 evolve. The best way to ensure that the system evolves is to limit the
13835 Copyright Office's role to that of approving standards for marking
13836 content that have been crafted elsewhere.
13839 For example, if a recording industry association devises a method for
13840 marking CDs, it would propose that to the Copyright Office. The
13841 Copyright Office would hold a hearing, at which other proposals could
13842 be made. The Copyright Office would then select the proposal that it
13843 judged preferable, and it would base that choice
13844 <emphasis>solely
</emphasis> upon the consideration of which method
13845 could best be integrated into the registration and renewal system. We
13846 would not count on the government to innovate; but we would count on
13847 the government to keep the product of innovation in line with its
13848 other important functions.
13851 Finally, marking content clearly would simplify registration
13852 requirements. If photographs were marked by author and year, there
13853 would be little reason not to allow a photographer to reregister, for
13854 example, all photographs taken in a particular year in one quick
13855 step. The aim of the formality is not to burden the creator; the
13856 system itself should be kept as simple as possible.
13859 The objective of formalities is to make things clear. The existing
13860 system does nothing to make things clear. Indeed, it seems designed to
13861 make things unclear.
13864 If formalities such as registration were reinstated, one of the most
13865 difficult aspects of relying upon the public domain would be removed.
13866 It would be simple to identify what content is presumptively free; it
13867 would be simple to identify who controls the rights for a particular
13868 kind of content; it would be simple to assert those rights, and to renew
13869 that assertion at the appropriate time.
13872 <!-- PAGE BREAK 297 -->
13875 <section id=
"shortterms">
13876 <title>2. Shorter Terms
</title>
13878 The term of copyright has gone from fourteen years to ninety-five
13879 years for corporate authors, and life of the author plus seventy years for
13883 In
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>, I proposed a seventy-five-year term,
13884 granted in five-year increments with a requirement of renewal every
13885 five years. That seemed radical enough at the time. But after we lost
13886 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, the proposals became even more
13887 radical.
<citetitle>The Economist
</citetitle> endorsed a proposal for a fourteen-year
13888 copyright term.
<footnote><para>
13891 <quote>A Radical Rethink,
</quote> <citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
366:
8308 (
25 January
2003):
15,
13893 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
74</ulink>.
13895 Others have proposed tying the term to the term for patents.
13898 I agree with those who believe that we need a radical change in
13899 copyright's term. But whether fourteen years or seventy-five, there
13900 are four principles that are important to keep in mind about copyright
13903 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
13906 <emphasis>Keep it short:
</emphasis> The term should be as long as
13907 necessary to give incentives to create, but no longer. If it were tied
13908 to very strong protections for authors (so authors were able to
13909 reclaim rights from publishers), rights to the same work (not
13910 derivative works) might be extended further. The key is not to tie the
13911 work up with legal regulations when it no longer benefits an author.
13915 <emphasis>Keep it simple:
</emphasis> The line between the public
13916 domain and protected content must be kept clear. Lawyers like the
13917 fuzziness of
<quote>fair use,
</quote> and the distinction between
<quote>ideas
</quote> and
13918 <quote>expression.
</quote> That kind of law gives them lots of work. But our
13919 framers had a simpler idea in mind: protected versus unprotected. The
13920 value of short terms is that there is little need to build exceptions
13921 into copyright when the term itself is kept short. A clear and active
13922 <quote>lawyer-free zone
</quote> makes the complexities of
<quote>fair use
</quote> and
13923 <quote>idea/expression
</quote> less necessary to navigate.
13924 <!-- PAGE BREAK 298 -->
13928 <emphasis>Keep it alive:
</emphasis> Copyright should have to be
13929 renewed. Especially if the maximum term is long, the copyright owner
13930 should be required to signal periodically that he wants the protection
13931 continued. This need not be an onerous burden, but there is no reason
13932 this monopoly protection has to be granted for free. On average, it
13933 takes ninety minutes for a veteran to apply for a
13934 pension.
<footnote><para>
13936 Department of Veterans Affairs, Veteran's Application for Compensation
13937 and/or Pension, VA Form
21-
526 (OMB Approved No.
2900-
0001),
13939 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
75</ulink>.
13941 If we make veterans suffer that burden, I don't see why we couldn't
13942 require authors to spend ten minutes every fifty years to file a
13944 <indexterm><primary>veterans' pensions
</primary></indexterm>
13948 <emphasis>Keep it prospective:
</emphasis> Whatever the term of
13949 copyright should be, the clearest lesson that economists teach is that
13950 a term once given should not be extended. It might have been a mistake
13951 in
1923 for the law to offer authors only a fifty-six-year term. I
13952 don't think so, but it's possible. If it was a mistake, then the
13953 consequence was that we got fewer authors to create in
1923 than we
13954 otherwise would have. But we can't correct that mistake today by
13955 increasing the term. No matter what we do today, we will not increase
13956 the number of authors who wrote in
1923. Of course, we can increase
13957 the reward that those who write now get (or alternatively, increase
13958 the copyright burden that smothers many works that are today
13959 invisible). But increasing their reward will not increase their
13960 creativity in
1923. What's not done is not done, and there's nothing
13961 we can do about that now.
</para></listitem>
13964 These changes together should produce an
<emphasis>average
</emphasis>
13965 copyright term that is much shorter than the current term. Until
1976,
13966 the average term was just
32.2 years. We should be aiming for the
13970 No doubt the extremists will call these ideas
<quote>radical.
</quote> (After all, I
13971 call them
<quote>extremists.
</quote>) But again, the term I recommended was longer
13972 than the term under Richard Nixon. How
<quote>radical
</quote> can it be to ask for
13973 a more generous copyright law than Richard Nixon presided over?
13976 <!-- PAGE BREAK 299 -->
13979 <section id=
"freefairuse">
13980 <title>3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
</title>
13981 <indexterm><primary>land ownership, air traffic and
</primary></indexterm>
13983 <primary>property rights
</primary>
13984 <secondary>air traffic vs.
</secondary>
13987 As I observed at the beginning of this book, property law originally
13988 granted property owners the right to control their property from the
13989 ground to the heavens. The airplane came along. The scope of property
13990 rights quickly changed. There was no fuss, no constitutional
13991 challenge. It made no sense anymore to grant that much control, given
13992 the emergence of that new technology.
13995 Our Constitution gives Congress the power to give authors
<quote>exclusive
13996 right
</quote> to
<quote>their writings.
</quote> Congress has given authors an exclusive
13997 right to
<quote>their writings
</quote> plus any derivative writings (made by
13998 others) that are sufficiently close to the author's original
13999 work. Thus, if I write a book, and you base a movie on that book, I
14000 have the power to deny you the right to release that movie, even
14001 though that movie is not
<quote>my writing.
</quote>
14004 Congress granted the beginnings of this right in
1870, when it
14005 expanded the exclusive right of copyright to include a right to
14006 control translations and dramatizations of a work.
<footnote><para>
14008 Benjamin Kaplan,
<citetitle>An Unhurried View of Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Columbia
14009 University Press,
1967),
32.
14011 The courts have expanded it slowly through judicial interpretation
14012 ever since. This expansion has been commented upon by one of the law's
14013 greatest judges, Judge Benjamin Kaplan.
14014 <indexterm><primary>Kaplan, Benjamin
</primary></indexterm>
14018 So inured have we become to the extension of the monopoly to a
14019 large range of so-called derivative works, that we no longer sense
14020 the oddity of accepting such an enlargement of copyright while
14021 yet intoning the abracadabra of idea and expression.
<footnote><para>
14022 <!-- f6. --> Ibid.,
56.
14027 I think it's time to recognize that there are airplanes in this field and
14028 the expansiveness of these rights of derivative use no longer make
14029 sense. More precisely, they don't make sense for the period of time that
14030 a copyright runs. And they don't make sense as an amorphous grant.
14031 Consider each limitation in turn.
14034 <emphasis>Term:
</emphasis> If Congress wants to grant a derivative
14035 right, then that right should be for a much shorter term. It makes
14036 sense to protect John
14038 <!-- PAGE BREAK 300 -->
14039 Grisham's right to sell the movie rights to his latest novel (or at least
14040 I'm willing to assume it does); but it does not make sense for that right
14041 to run for the same term as the underlying copyright. The derivative
14042 right could be important in inducing creativity; it is not important long
14043 after the creative work is done.
14044 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
14047 <emphasis>Scope:
</emphasis> Likewise should the scope of derivative
14048 rights be narrowed. Again, there are some cases in which derivative
14049 rights are important. Those should be specified. But the law should
14050 draw clear lines around regulated and unregulated uses of copyrighted
14051 material. When all
<quote>reuse
</quote> of creative material was within the control
14052 of businesses, perhaps it made sense to require lawyers to negotiate
14053 the lines. It no longer makes sense for lawyers to negotiate the
14054 lines. Think about all the creative possibilities that digital
14055 technologies enable; now imagine pouring molasses into the
14056 machines. That's what this general requirement of permission does to
14057 the creative process. Smothers it.
14059 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
14061 This was the point that Alben made when describing the making of the
14062 Clint Eastwood CD. While it makes sense to require negotiation for
14063 foreseeable derivative rights
—turning a book into a movie, or a
14064 poem into a musical score
—it doesn't make sense to require
14065 negotiation for the unforeseeable. Here, a statutory right would make
14069 In each of these cases, the law should mark the uses that are
14070 protected, and the presumption should be that other uses are not
14071 protected. This is the reverse of the recommendation of my colleague
14072 Paul Goldstein.
<footnote>
14075 Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>Copyright's Highway: From Gutenberg to the Celestial
14076 Jukebox
</citetitle> (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
2003),
187–216.
14077 <indexterm><primary>Goldstein, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
14079 His view is that the law should be written so that
14080 expanded protections follow expanded uses.
14083 Goldstein's analysis would make perfect sense if the cost of the legal
14084 system were small. But as we are currently seeing in the context of
14085 the Internet, the uncertainty about the scope of protection, and the
14086 incentives to protect existing architectures of revenue, combined with
14087 a strong copyright, weaken the process of innovation.
14090 The law could remedy this problem either by removing protection
14091 <!-- PAGE BREAK 301 -->
14092 beyond the part explicitly drawn or by granting reuse rights upon
14093 certain statutory conditions. Either way, the effect would be to free
14094 a great deal of culture to others to cultivate. And under a statutory
14095 rights regime, that reuse would earn artists more income.
14099 <section id=
"liberatemusic">
14100 <title>4. Liberate the Music
—Again
</title>
14102 The battle that got this whole war going was about music, so it
14103 wouldn't be fair to end this book without addressing the issue that
14104 is, to most people, most pressing
—music. There is no other
14105 policy issue that better teaches the lessons of this book than the
14106 battles around the sharing of music.
14109 The appeal of file-sharing music was the crack cocaine of the
14110 Internet's growth. It drove demand for access to the Internet more
14111 powerfully than any other single application. It was the Internet's
14112 killer app
—possibly in two senses of that word. It no doubt was
14113 the application that drove demand for bandwidth. It may well be the
14114 application that drives demand for regulations that in the end kill
14115 innovation on the network.
14118 The aim of copyright, with respect to content in general and music in
14119 particular, is to create the incentives for music to be composed,
14120 performed, and, most importantly, spread. The law does this by giving
14121 an exclusive right to a composer to control public performances of his
14122 work, and to a performing artist to control copies of her performance.
14125 File-sharing networks complicate this model by enabling the spread of
14126 content for which the performer has not been paid. But of course,
14127 that's not all the file-sharing networks do. As I described in chapter
14128 <xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber" linkend=
"piracy"/>, they enable
14129 four different kinds of sharing:
14131 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
14134 There are some who are using sharing networks as substitutes
14135 for purchasing CDs.
14139 There are also some who are using sharing networks to sample,
14140 on the way to purchasing CDs.
14143 <!-- PAGE BREAK 302 -->
14145 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
14146 content that is no longer sold but is still under copyright or that
14147 would have been too cumbersome to buy off the Net.
14151 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
14152 content that is not copyrighted or to get access that the copyright
14153 owner plainly endorses.
14157 Any reform of the law needs to keep these different uses in focus. It
14158 must avoid burdening type D even if it aims to eliminate type A. The
14159 eagerness with which the law aims to eliminate type A, moreover,
14160 should depend upon the magnitude of type B. As with VCRs, if the net
14161 effect of sharing is actually not very harmful, the need for regulation is
14162 significantly weakened.
14165 As I said in chapter
<xref xrefstyle=
"select: labelnumber"
14166 linkend=
"piracy"/>, the actual harm caused by sharing is
14167 controversial. For the purposes of this chapter, however, I assume
14168 the harm is real. I assume, in other words, that type A sharing is
14169 significantly greater than type B, and is the dominant use of sharing
14173 Nonetheless, there is a crucial fact about the current technological
14174 context that we must keep in mind if we are to understand how the law
14178 Today, file sharing is addictive. In ten years, it won't be. It is
14179 addictive today because it is the easiest way to gain access to a
14180 broad range of content. It won't be the easiest way to get access to
14181 a broad range of content in ten years. Today, access to the Internet
14182 is cumbersome and slow
—we in the United States are lucky to have
14183 broadband service at
1.5 MBs, and very rarely do we get service at
14184 that speed both up and down. Although wireless access is growing, most
14185 of us still get access across wires. Most only gain access through a
14186 machine with a keyboard. The idea of the always on, always connected
14187 Internet is mainly just an idea.
14190 But it will become a reality, and that means the way we get access to
14191 the Internet today is a technology in transition. Policy makers should
14192 not make policy on the basis of technology in transition. They should
14193 <!-- PAGE BREAK 303 -->
14194 make policy on the basis of where the technology is going. The
14195 question should not be, how should the law regulate sharing in this
14196 world? The question should be, what law will we require when the
14197 network becomes the network it is clearly becoming? That network is
14198 one in which every machine with electricity is essentially on the Net;
14199 where everywhere you are
—except maybe the desert or the
14200 Rockies
—you can instantaneously be connected to the
14201 Internet. Imagine the Internet as ubiquitous as the best cell-phone
14202 service, where with the flip of a device, you are connected.
14205 In that world, it will be extremely easy to connect to services that
14206 give you access to content on the fly
—such as Internet radio,
14207 content that is streamed to the user when the user demands. Here,
14208 then, is the critical point: When it is
<emphasis>extremely
</emphasis>
14209 easy to connect to services that give access to content, it will be
14210 <emphasis>easier
</emphasis> to connect to services that give you
14211 access to content than it will be to download and store content
14212 <emphasis>on the many devices you will have for playing
14213 content
</emphasis>. It will be easier, in other words, to subscribe
14214 than it will be to be a database manager, as everyone in the
14215 download-sharing world of Napster-like technologies essentially
14216 is. Content services will compete with content sharing, even if the
14217 services charge money for the content they give access to. Already
14218 cell-phone services in Japan offer music (for a fee) streamed over
14219 cell phones (enhanced with plugs for headphones). The Japanese are
14220 paying for this content even though
<quote>free
</quote> content is available in the
14221 form of MP3s across the Web.
<footnote><para>
14223 See, for example,
<quote>Music Media Watch,
</quote> The J@pan Inc. Newsletter,
3
14224 April
2002, available at
14225 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
76</ulink>.
14230 This point about the future is meant to suggest a perspective on the
14231 present: It is emphatically temporary. The
<quote>problem
</quote> with file
14232 sharing
—to the extent there is a real problem
—is a problem
14233 that will increasingly disappear as it becomes easier to connect to
14234 the Internet. And thus it is an extraordinary mistake for policy
14235 makers today to be
<quote>solving
</quote> this problem in light of a technology
14236 that will be gone tomorrow. The question should not be how to
14237 regulate the Internet to eliminate file sharing (the Net will evolve
14238 that problem away). The question instead should be how to assure that
14239 artists get paid, during
14241 <!-- PAGE BREAK 304 -->
14242 this transition between twentieth-century models for doing business
14243 and twenty-first-century technologies.
14246 The answer begins with recognizing that there are different
<quote>problems
</quote>
14247 here to solve. Let's start with type D content
—uncopyrighted
14248 content or copyrighted content that the artist wants shared. The
14249 <quote>problem
</quote> with this content is to make sure that the technology that
14250 would enable this kind of sharing is not rendered illegal. You can
14251 think of it this way: Pay phones are used to deliver ransom demands,
14252 no doubt. But there are many who need to use pay phones who have
14253 nothing to do with ransoms. It would be wrong to ban pay phones in
14254 order to eliminate kidnapping.
14257 Type C content raises a different
<quote>problem.
</quote> This is content that was,
14258 at one time, published and is no longer available. It may be
14259 unavailable because the artist is no longer valuable enough for the
14260 record label he signed with to carry his work. Or it may be
14261 unavailable because the work is forgotten. Either way, the aim of the
14262 law should be to facilitate the access to this content, ideally in a
14263 way that returns something to the artist.
14266 Again, the model here is the used book store. Once a book goes out of
14267 print, it may still be available in libraries and used book
14268 stores. But libraries and used book stores don't pay the copyright
14269 owner when someone reads or buys an out-of-print book. That makes
14270 total sense, of course, since any other system would be so burdensome
14271 as to eliminate the possibility of used book stores' existing. But
14272 from the author's perspective, this
<quote>sharing
</quote> of his content without
14273 his being compensated is less than ideal.
14276 The model of used book stores suggests that the law could simply deem
14277 out-of-print music fair game. If the publisher does not make copies of
14278 the music available for sale, then commercial and noncommercial
14279 providers would be free, under this rule, to
<quote>share
</quote> that content,
14280 even though the sharing involved making a copy. The copy here would be
14281 incidental to the trade; in a context where commercial publishing has
14282 ended, trading music should be as free as trading books.
14286 <!-- PAGE BREAK 305 -->
14287 Alternatively, the law could create a statutory license that would
14288 ensure that artists get something from the trade of their work. For
14289 example, if the law set a low statutory rate for the commercial
14290 sharing of content that was not offered for sale by a commercial
14291 publisher, and if that rate were automatically transferred to a trust
14292 for the benefit of the artist, then businesses could develop around
14293 the idea of trading this content, and artists would benefit from this
14297 This system would also create an incentive for publishers to keep
14298 works available commercially. Works that are available commercially
14299 would not be subject to this license. Thus, publishers could protect
14300 the right to charge whatever they want for content if they kept the
14301 work commercially available. But if they don't keep it available, and
14302 instead, the computer hard disks of fans around the world keep it
14303 alive, then any royalty owed for such copying should be much less than
14304 the amount owed a commercial publisher.
14307 The hard case is content of types A and B, and again, this case is
14308 hard only because the extent of the problem will change over time, as
14309 the technologies for gaining access to content change. The law's
14310 solution should be as flexible as the problem is, understanding that
14311 we are in the middle of a radical transformation in the technology for
14312 delivering and accessing content.
14315 So here's a solution that will at first seem very strange to both sides
14316 in this war, but which upon reflection, I suggest, should make some sense.
14319 Stripped of the rhetoric about the sanctity of property, the basic
14320 claim of the content industry is this: A new technology (the Internet)
14321 has harmed a set of rights that secure copyright. If those rights are to
14322 be protected, then the content industry should be compensated for that
14323 harm. Just as the technology of tobacco harmed the health of millions
14324 of Americans, or the technology of asbestos caused grave illness to
14325 thousands of miners, so, too, has the technology of digital networks
14326 harmed the interests of the content industry.
14329 <!-- PAGE BREAK 306 -->
14330 I love the Internet, and so I don't like likening it to tobacco or
14331 asbestos. But the analogy is a fair one from the perspective of the
14332 law. And it suggests a fair response: Rather than seeking to destroy
14333 the Internet, or the p2p technologies that are currently harming
14334 content providers on the Internet, we should find a relatively simple
14335 way to compensate those who are harmed.
14338 The idea would be a modification of a proposal that has been
14339 floated by Harvard law professor William Fisher.
<footnote>
14342 William Fisher,
<citetitle>Digital Music: Problems and Possibilities
</citetitle> (last
14343 revised:
10 October
2000), available at
14344 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
77</ulink>; William
14345 Fisher,
<citetitle>Promises to Keep: Technology, Law, and the Future of
14346 Entertainment
</citetitle> (forthcoming) (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
14347 2004), ch.
6, available at
14348 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
78</ulink>. Professor
14349 Netanel has proposed a related idea that would exempt noncommercial
14350 sharing from the reach of copyright and would establish compensation
14351 to artists to balance any loss. See Neil Weinstock Netanel,
<quote>Impose a
14352 Noncommercial Use Levy to Allow Free P2P File Sharing,
</quote> available at
14353 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
79</ulink>. For other proposals, see Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>Who's Holding Back
14354 Broadband?
</quote> <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
8 January
2002, A17; Philip S. Corwin on
14355 behalf of Sharman Networks, A Letter to Senator Joseph R. Biden, Jr.,
14356 Chairman of the Senate Foreign Relations Committee,
26 February
2002,
14358 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
80</ulink>; Serguei Osokine,
<citetitle>A Quick Case for Intellectual Property
14359 Use Fee (IPUF)
</citetitle>,
3 March
2002, available at
14360 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
81</ulink>; Jefferson Graham,
14361 <quote>Kazaa, Verizon Propose to Pay Artists Directly,
</quote> <citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
13 May
14363 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
82</ulink>; Steven M. Cherry,
<quote>Getting Copyright Right,
</quote>
14364 IEEE Spectrum Online,
1 July
2002, available at
14365 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
83</ulink>; Declan
14366 McCullagh,
<quote>Verizon's Copyright Campaign,
</quote> CNET News.com,
27 August
14368 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
84</ulink>.
14369 Fisher's proposal is very similar to Richard Stallman's proposal for
14370 DAT. Unlike Fisher's, Stallman's proposal would not pay artists directly
14371 proportionally, though more popular artists would get more than the less
14372 popular. As is typical with Stallman, his proposal predates the current
14373 debate by about a decade. See
14374 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
85</ulink>.
14375 <indexterm><primary>Fisher, William
</primary></indexterm>
14376 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
14377 <indexterm><primary>Promises to Keep (Fisher)
</primary></indexterm>
14379 Fisher suggests a very clever way around the current impasse of the
14380 Internet. Under his plan, all content capable of digital transmission
14381 would (
1) be marked with a digital watermark (don't worry about how
14382 easy it is to evade these marks; as you'll see, there's no incentive
14383 to evade them). Once the content is marked, then entrepreneurs would
14384 develop (
2) systems to monitor how many items of each content were
14385 distributed. On the basis of those numbers, then (
3) artists would be
14386 compensated. The compensation would be paid for by (
4) an appropriate
14390 Fisher's proposal is careful and comprehensive. It raises a million
14391 questions, most of which he answers well in his upcoming book,
14392 <citetitle>Promises to Keep
</citetitle>. The modification that I would make is relatively
14393 simple: Fisher imagines his proposal replacing the existing copyright
14394 system. I imagine it complementing the existing system. The aim of
14395 the proposal would be to facilitate compensation to the extent that
14396 harm could be shown. This compensation would be temporary, aimed at
14397 facilitating a transition between regimes. And it would require
14398 renewal after a period of years. If it continues to make sense to
14399 facilitate free exchange of content, supported through a taxation
14400 system, then it can be continued. If this form of protection is no
14401 longer necessary, then the system could lapse into the old system of
14402 controlling access.
14403 <indexterm><primary>Promises to Keep (Fisher)
</primary></indexterm>
14406 Fisher would balk at the idea of allowing the system to lapse. His aim
14407 is not just to ensure that artists are paid, but also to ensure that
14408 the system supports the widest range of
<quote>semiotic democracy
</quote>
14409 possible. But the aims of semiotic democracy would be satisfied if the
14410 other changes I described were accomplished
—in particular, the
14411 limits on derivative
14413 <!-- PAGE BREAK 307 -->
14414 uses. A system that simply charges for access would not greatly burden
14415 semiotic democracy if there were few limitations on what one was
14416 allowed to do with the content itself.
14418 <indexterm><primary>Real Networks
</primary></indexterm>
14420 No doubt it would be difficult to calculate the proper measure of
14421 <quote>harm
</quote> to an industry. But the difficulty of making that calculation
14422 would be outweighed by the benefit of facilitating innovation. This
14423 background system to compensate would also not need to interfere with
14424 innovative proposals such as Apple's MusicStore. As experts predicted
14425 when Apple launched the MusicStore, it could beat
<quote>free
</quote> by being
14426 easier than free is. This has proven correct: Apple has sold millions
14427 of songs at even the very high price of
99 cents a song. (At
99 cents,
14428 the cost is the equivalent of a per-song CD price, though the labels
14429 have none of the costs of a CD to pay.) Apple's move was countered by
14430 Real Networks, offering music at just
79 cents a song. And no doubt
14431 there will be a great deal of competition to offer and sell music
14435 This competition has already occurred against the background of
<quote>free
</quote>
14436 music from p2p systems. As the sellers of cable television have known
14437 for thirty years, and the sellers of bottled water for much more than
14438 that, there is nothing impossible at all about
<quote>competing with free.
</quote>
14439 Indeed, if anything, the competition spurs the competitors to offer
14440 new and better products. This is precisely what the competitive market
14441 was to be about. Thus in Singapore, though piracy is rampant, movie
14442 theaters are often luxurious
—with
<quote>first class
</quote> seats, and meals
14443 served while you watch a movie
—as they struggle and succeed in
14444 finding ways to compete with
<quote>free.
</quote>
14447 This regime of competition, with a backstop to assure that artists
14448 don't lose, would facilitate a great deal of innovation in the
14449 delivery of content. That competition would continue to shrink type A
14450 sharing. It would inspire an extraordinary range of new
14451 innovators
—ones who would have a right to the content, and would
14452 no longer fear the uncertain and barbarically severe punishments of
14456 In summary, then, my proposal is this:
14460 <!-- PAGE BREAK 308 -->
14461 The Internet is in transition. We should not be regulating a
14462 technology in transition. We should instead be regulating to minimize
14463 the harm to interests affected by this technological change, while
14464 enabling, and encouraging, the most efficient technology we can
14468 We can minimize that harm while maximizing the benefit to innovation
14471 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
14474 guaranteeing the right to engage in type D sharing;
14478 permitting noncommercial type C sharing without liability,
14479 and commercial type C sharing at a low and fixed rate set by
14484 while in this transition, taxing and compensating for type A
14485 sharing, to the extent actual harm is demonstrated.
14489 But what if
<quote>piracy
</quote> doesn't disappear? What if there is a competitive
14490 market providing content at a low cost, but a significant number of
14491 consumers continue to
<quote>take
</quote> content for nothing? Should the law do
14495 Yes, it should. But, again, what it should do depends upon how the
14496 facts develop. These changes may not eliminate type A sharing. But the
14497 real issue is not whether it eliminates sharing in the abstract. The
14498 real issue is its effect on the market. Is it better (a) to have a
14499 technology that is
95 percent secure and produces a market of size
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>,
14500 or (b) to have a technology that is
50 percent secure but produces a
14501 market of five times
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>? Less secure might produce more unauthorized
14502 sharing, but it is likely to also produce a much bigger market in
14503 authorized sharing. The most important thing is to assure artists'
14504 compensation without breaking the Internet. Once that's assured, then
14505 it may well be appropriate to find ways to track down the petty
14509 But we're a long way away from whittling the problem down to this
14510 subset of type A sharers. And our focus until we're there should not
14511 be on finding ways to break the Internet. Our focus until we're there
14513 <!-- PAGE BREAK 309 -->
14514 should be on how to make sure the artists are paid, while protecting
14515 the space for innovation and creativity that the Internet is.
14519 <section id=
"firelawyers">
14520 <title>5. Fire Lots of Lawyers
</title>
14522 I'm a lawyer. I make lawyers for a living. I believe in the law. I believe
14523 in the law of copyright. Indeed, I have devoted my life to working in
14524 law, not because there are big bucks at the end but because there are
14525 ideals at the end that I would love to live.
14528 Yet much of this book has been a criticism of lawyers, or the role
14529 lawyers have played in this debate. The law speaks to ideals, but it
14530 is my view that our profession has become too attuned to the
14531 client. And in a world where the rich clients have one strong view,
14532 the unwillingness of the profession to question or counter that one
14533 strong view queers the law.
14536 The evidence of this bending is compelling. I'm attacked as a
14537 <quote>radical
</quote> by many within the profession, yet the positions that I am
14538 advocating are precisely the positions of some of the most moderate
14539 and significant figures in the history of this branch of the
14540 law. Many, for example, thought crazy the challenge that we brought to
14541 the Copyright Term Extension Act. Yet just thirty years ago, the
14542 dominant scholar and practitioner in the field of copyright, Melville
14543 Nimmer, thought it obvious.
<footnote><para>
14545 Lawrence Lessig,
<quote>Copyright's First Amendment
</quote> (Melville B. Nimmer
14546 Memorial Lecture),
<citetitle>UCLA Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
2001):
1057,
1069–70.
14551 However, my criticism of the role that lawyers have played in this
14552 debate is not just about a professional bias. It is more importantly
14553 about our failure to actually reckon the costs of the law.
14556 Economists are supposed to be good at reckoning costs and benefits.
14557 But more often than not, economists, with no clue about how the legal
14558 system actually functions, simply assume that the transaction costs of
14559 the legal system are slight.
<footnote><para>
14561 A good example is the work of Professor Stan Liebowitz. Liebowitz is
14562 to be commended for his careful review of data about infringement,
14563 leading him to question his own publicly stated
14564 position
—twice. He initially predicted that downloading would
14565 substantially harm the industry. He then revised his view in light of
14566 the data, and he has since revised his view again. Compare Stan
14567 J. Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy: The True Forces That
14568 Drive the Digital Marketplace
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002), (reviewing his
14569 original view but expressing skepticism) with Stan J. Liebowitz,
14570 <quote>Will MP3s Annihilate the Record Industry?
</quote> working paper, June
2003,
14572 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
86</ulink>.
14573 Liebowitz's careful analysis is extremely valuable in estimating the
14574 effect of file-sharing technology. In my view, however, he
14575 underestimates the costs of the legal system. See, for example,
14576 <citetitle>Rethinking
</citetitle>,
174–76.
14577 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
14579 They see a system that has been around for hundreds of years, and they
14580 assume it works the way their elementary school civics class taught
14584 <!-- PAGE BREAK 310 -->
14585 But the legal system doesn't work. Or more accurately, it doesn't work
14586 for anyone except those with the most resources. Not because the
14587 system is corrupt. I don't think our legal system (at the federal
14588 level, at least) is at all corrupt. I mean simply because the costs of
14589 our legal system are so astonishingly high that justice can
14590 practically never be done.
14593 These costs distort free culture in many ways. A lawyer's time is
14594 billed at the largest firms at more than $
400 per hour. How much time
14595 should such a lawyer spend reading cases carefully, or researching
14596 obscure strands of authority? The answer is the increasing reality:
14597 very little. The law depended upon the careful articulation and
14598 development of doctrine, but the careful articulation and development
14599 of legal doctrine depends upon careful work. Yet that careful work
14600 costs too much, except in the most high-profile and costly cases.
14603 The costliness and clumsiness and randomness of this system mock
14604 our tradition. And lawyers, as well as academics, should consider it
14605 their duty to change the way the law works
—or better, to change the
14606 law so that it works. It is wrong that the system works well only for the
14607 top
1 percent of the clients. It could be made radically more efficient,
14608 and inexpensive, and hence radically more just.
14611 But until that reform is complete, we as a society should keep the law
14612 away from areas that we know it will only harm. And that is precisely
14613 what the law will too often do if too much of our culture is left to
14617 Think about the amazing things your kid could do or make with digital
14618 technology
—the film, the music, the Web page, the blog. Or think
14619 about the amazing things your community could facilitate with digital
14620 technology
—a wiki, a barn raising, activism to change something.
14621 Think about all those creative things, and then imagine cold molasses
14622 poured onto the machines. This is what any regime that requires
14623 permission produces. Again, this is the reality of Brezhnev's Russia.
14626 The law should regulate in certain areas of culture
—but it should
14627 regulate culture only where that regulation does good. Yet lawyers
14629 <!-- PAGE BREAK 311 -->
14630 rarely test their power, or the power they promote, against this
14631 simple pragmatic question:
<quote>Will it do good?
</quote> When challenged about
14632 the expanding reach of the law, the lawyer answers,
<quote>Why not?
</quote>
14635 We should ask,
<quote>Why?
</quote> Show me why your regulation of culture is
14636 needed. Show me how it does good. And until you can show me both,
14637 keep your lawyers away.
14639 <!-- PAGE BREAK 312 -->
14643 <chapter label=
"17" id=
"c-notes">
14644 <title>NOTES
</title>
14646 Throughout this text, there are references to links on the World Wide
14647 Web. As anyone who has tried to use the Web knows, these links can be
14648 highly unstable. I have tried to remedy the instability by redirecting
14649 readers to the original source through the Web site associated with
14650 this book. For each link below, you can go to
14651 http://free-culture.cc/notes and locate the original source by
14652 clicking on the number after the # sign. If the original link remains
14653 alive, you will be redirected to that link. If the original link has
14654 disappeared, you will be redirected to an appropriate reference for
14657 <!--PAGE BREAK 336-->
14660 <chapter label=
"18" id=
"c-acknowledgments">
14661 <title>ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
</title>
14663 This book is the product of a long and as yet unsuccessful struggle that
14664 began when I read of Eric Eldred's war to keep books free. Eldred's
14665 work helped launch a movement, the free culture movement, and it is
14666 to him that this book is dedicated.
14668 <indexterm><primary>Rose, Mark
</primary></indexterm>
14670 I received guidance in various places from friends and academics,
14671 including Glenn Brown, Peter DiCola, Jennifer Mnookin, Richard Posner,
14672 Mark Rose, and Kathleen Sullivan. And I received correction and
14673 guidance from many amazing students at Stanford Law School and
14674 Stanford University. They included Andrew B. Coan, John Eden, James
14675 P. Fellers, Christopher Guzelian, Erica Goldberg, Robert Hallman,
14676 Andrew Harris, Matthew Kahn, Brian Link, Ohad Mayblum, Alina Ng, and
14677 Erica Platt. I am particularly grateful to Catherine Crump and Harry
14678 Surden, who helped direct their research, and to Laura Lynch, who
14679 brilliantly managed the army that they assembled, and provided her own
14680 critical eye on much of this.
14683 Yuko Noguchi helped me to understand the laws of Japan as well as
14684 its culture. I am thankful to her, and to the many in Japan who helped
14685 me prepare this book: Joi Ito, Takayuki Matsutani, Naoto Misaki,
14686 Michihiro Sasaki, Hiromichi Tanaka, Hiroo Yamagata, and Yoshihiro
14687 <!--PAGE BREAK 337-->
14688 Yonezawa. I am thankful as well as to Professor Nobuhiro Nakayama,
14689 and the Tokyo University Business Law Center, for giving me the
14690 chance to spend time in Japan, and to Tadashi Shiraishi and Kiyokazu
14691 Yamagami for their generous help while I was there.
14694 These are the traditional sorts of help that academics regularly draw
14695 upon. But in addition to them, the Internet has made it possible to
14696 receive advice and correction from many whom I have never even
14697 met. Among those who have responded with extremely helpful advice to
14698 requests on my blog about the book are Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli, David
14699 Gerstein, and Peter DiMauro, as well as a long list of those who had
14700 specific ideas about ways to develop my argument. They included
14701 Richard Bondi, Steven Cherry, David Coe, Nik Cubrilovic, Bob Devine,
14702 Charles Eicher, Thomas Guida, Elihu M. Gerson, Jeremy Hunsinger,
14703 Vaughn Iverson, John Karabaic, Jeff Keltner, James Lindenschmidt,
14704 K. L. Mann, Mark Manning, Nora McCauley, Jeffrey McHugh, Evan
14705 McMullen, Fred Norton, John Pormann, Pedro A. D. Rezende, Shabbir
14706 Safdar, Saul Schleimer, Clay Shirky, Adam Shostack, Kragen Sitaker,
14707 Chris Smith, Bruce Steinberg, Andrzej Jan Taramina, Sean Walsh, Matt
14708 Wasserman, Miljenko Williams,
<quote>Wink,
</quote> Roger Wood,
<quote>Ximmbo da Jazz,
</quote>
14709 and Richard Yanco. (I apologize if I have missed anyone; with
14710 computers come glitches, and a crash of my e-mail system meant I lost
14711 a bunch of great replies.)
14714 Richard Stallman and Michael Carroll each read the whole book in
14715 draft, and each provided extremely helpful correction and advice.
14716 Michael helped me to see more clearly the significance of the
14717 regulation of derivitive works. And Richard corrected an
14718 embarrassingly large number of errors. While my work is in part
14719 inspired by Stallman's, he does not agree with me in important places
14720 throughout this book.
14723 Finally, and forever, I am thankful to Bettina, who has always
14724 insisted that there would be unending happiness away from these
14725 battles, and who has always been right. This slow learner is, as ever,
14726 grateful for her perpetual patience and love.
14728 <!--PAGE BREAK 338-->